UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
 
FORM 10-Q
 
QUARTERLY REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF
THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the quarterly period ended June 30, 2017
 
Commission file number 001-2979
 
WELLS FARGO & COMPANY
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
Delaware
 
No. 41-0449260
(State of incorporation)
 
(I.R.S. Employer Identification No.)
 
420 Montgomery Street, San Francisco, California 94163
(Address of principal executive offices)  (Zip Code)
 
Registrant’s telephone number, including area code:  1-866-249-3302 
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.
Yes þ
 
No o

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).
Yes þ
 
No o
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, a smaller reporting company, or an emerging growth company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer,” “smaller reporting company,” and “emerging growth company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.
 
 
Large accelerated filer     þ
 
Accelerated filer  o
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Non-accelerated filer     o (Do not check if a smaller reporting company)
 
Smaller reporting company  o
 
 
 
 
Emerging growth company  o
 
          
If an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or revised financial accounting standards provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act. o

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).
Yes o
 
No þ
 
Indicate the number of shares outstanding of each of the issuer’s classes of common stock, as of the latest practicable date.
 
 
 
Shares Outstanding
 
 
July 26, 2017
Common stock, $1-2/3 par value
 
4,963,944,641
          




FORM 10-Q
 
CROSS-REFERENCE INDEX
 
PART I
Financial Information
 
Item 1.
Financial Statements
Page
 
Consolidated Statement of Income
 
Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income
 
Consolidated Balance Sheet
 
Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity
 
Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows
 
Notes to Financial Statements
  
 
1

Summary of Significant Accounting Policies  
 
2

Business Combinations
 
3

Federal Funds Sold, Securities Purchased under Resale Agreements and Other Short-Term Investments  
 
4

Investment Securities
 
5

Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses
 
6

Other Assets
 
7

Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities
 
8

Mortgage Banking Activities
 
9

Intangible Assets
 
10

Guarantees, Pledged Assets and Collateral
 
11

Legal Actions
 
12

Derivatives
 
13

Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities
 
14

Preferred Stock
 
15

Employee Benefits
 
16

Earnings Per Common Share
 
17

Other Comprehensive Income
 
18

Operating Segments
 
19

Regulatory and Agency Capital Requirements
Item 2.
Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (Financial Review)
 
 
Summary Financial Data  
 
Overview
 
Earnings Performance
 
Balance Sheet Analysis
 
Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements  
 
Risk Management
 
Capital Management
 
Regulatory Matters
 
Critical Accounting Policies  
 
Current Accounting Developments
 
Forward-Looking Statements  
 
Risk Factors 
 
Glossary of Acronyms
Item 3.
Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk
Item 4.
Controls and Procedures
 
 
 
PART II
Other Information
 
Item 1.
Legal Proceedings
Item 1A.
Risk Factors
Item 2.
Unregistered Sales of Equity Securities and Use of Proceeds
Item 6.
Exhibits
 
 
 
 
 
Signature
 
 
Exhibit Index

1



PART I - FINANCIAL INFORMATION

FINANCIAL REVIEW
Summary Financial Data
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
% Change
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
Quarter ended
 
 
Jun 30, 2017 from
 
 
Six months ended
 
 
  

($ in millions, except per share amounts)
Jun 30,
2017

 
Mar 31,
2017

 
Jun 30,
2016

 
Mar 31,
2017

 
Jun 30,
2016

 
Jun 30,
2017


Jun 30,
2016

 
%
Change

For the Period
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
Wells Fargo net income
$
5,810

 
5,457

 
5,558

 
6
 %
 
5

 
$
11,267

 
11,020

 
2
 %
Wells Fargo net income applicable to common stock
5,404

 
5,056

 
5,173

 
7

 
4

 
10,460

 
10,258

 
2

Diluted earnings per common share
1.07

 
1.00

 
1.01

 
7

 
6

 
2.07

 
2.00

 
4

Profitability ratios (annualized):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Wells Fargo net income to average assets (ROA)
1.21
%
 
1.15

 
1.20

 
5

 
1

 
1.18
%
 
1.20

 
(2
)
Wells Fargo net income applicable to common stock to average Wells Fargo common stockholders' equity (ROE)
11.95

 
11.54

 
11.70

 
4

 
2

 
11.75

 
11.72

 

Return on average tangible common equity (ROTCE) (1)
14.26

 
13.85

 
14.15

 
3

 
1

 
14.06

 
14.15

 
(1
)
Efficiency ratio (2)
61.1

 
62.7

 
58.1

 
(3
)
 
5

 
61.9

 
58.4

 
6

Total revenue
$
22,169

 
22,002

 
22,162

 
1

 

 
$
44,171

 
44,357

 

Pre-tax pre-provision profit (PTPP) (3)
8,628

 
8,210

 
9,296

 
5

 
(7
)
 
16,838

 
18,463

 
(9
)
Dividends declared per common share
0.380

 
0.380

 
0.380

 

 

 
0.760

 
0.755

 
1

Average common shares outstanding
4,989.9

 
5,008.6

 
5,066.9

 

 
(2
)
 
4,999.2

 
5,071.3

 
(1
)
Diluted average common shares outstanding
5,037.7

 
5,070.4

 
5,118.1

 
(1
)
 
(2
)
 
5,054.8

 
5,129.8

 
(1
)
Average loans
$
956,879

 
963,645

 
950,751

 
(1
)
 
1

 
$
960,243

 
938,986

 
2

Average assets
1,927,079

 
1,931,041

 
1,862,084

 

 
3

 
1,929,049

 
1,840,980

 
5

Average total deposits
1,301,195

 
1,299,191

 
1,236,658

 

 
5

 
1,300,198

 
1,228,044

 
6

Average consumer and small business banking deposits (4)
760,149

 
758,754

 
726,359

 

 
5

 
759,455

 
720,598

 
5

Net interest margin
2.90
%
 
2.87

 
2.86

 
1

 
1

 
2.89
%
 
2.88

 

At Period End
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
Investment securities
$
409,594

 
407,560

 
353,426

 

 
16

 
$
409,594

 
353,426

 
16

Loans
957,423

 
958,405

 
957,157

 

 

 
957,423

 
957,157

 

Allowance for loan losses
11,073

 
11,168

 
11,664

 
(1
)
 
(5
)
 
11,073

 
11,664

 
(5
)
Goodwill
26,573

 
26,666

 
26,963

 

 
(1
)
 
26,573

 
26,963

 
(1
)
Assets
1,930,871

 
1,951,564

 
1,889,235

 
(1
)
 
2

 
1,930,871

 
1,889,235

 
2

Deposits
1,305,830

 
1,325,444

 
1,245,473

 
(1
)
 
5

 
1,305,830

 
1,245,473

 
5

Common stockholders' equity
181,428

 
178,388

 
178,633

 
2

 
2

 
181,428

 
178,633

 
2

Wells Fargo stockholders' equity
205,230

 
201,500

 
201,745

 
2

 
2

 
205,230

 
201,745

 
2

Total equity
206,145

 
202,489

 
202,661

 
2

 
2

 
206,145

 
202,661

 
2

Tangible common equity (1)
152,064

 
148,850

 
148,110

 
2

 
3

 
152,064

 
148,110

 
3

Capital ratios (5)(6):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
Total equity to assets
10.68
%
 
10.38

 
10.73

 
3

 

 
10.68
%
 
10.73

 

Risk-based capital:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 


 
  
 
  
 


Common Equity Tier 1
11.87

 
11.52

 
10.82

 
3

 
10

 
11.87

 
10.82

 
10

Tier 1 capital
13.68

 
13.27

 
12.50

 
3

 
9

 
13.68

 
12.50

 
9

Total capital
16.91

 
16.41

 
15.14

 
3

 
12

 
16.91

 
15.14

 
12

Tier 1 leverage
9.28

 
9.07

 
9.25

 
2

 

 
9.28

 
9.25

 

Common shares outstanding
4,966.8

 
4,996.7

 
5,048.5

 
(1
)
 
(2
)
 
4,966.8

 
5,048.5

 
(2
)
Book value per common share (7)
$
36.53

 
35.70

 
35.38

 
2

 
3

 
$
36.53

 
35.38

 
3

Tangible book value per common share (1) (7)
30.62

 
29.79

 
29.34

 
3

 
4

 
30.62

 
29.34
 
4

Common stock price:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
High
56.60

 
59.99

 
51.41

 
(6
)
 
10

 
59.99

 
53.27

 
13

Low
50.84

 
53.35

 
44.50

 
(5
)
 
14

 
50.84

 
44.50

 
14

Period end
55.41

 
55.66

 
47.33

 

 
17

 
55.41

 
47.33

 
17

Team members (active, full-time equivalent)
270,600

 
272,800

 
267,900

 
(1
)
 
1

 
270,600

 
267,900

 
1

(1)
Tangible common equity is a non-GAAP financial measure and represents total equity less preferred equity, noncontrolling interests, and goodwill and certain identifiable intangible assets (including goodwill and intangible assets associated with certain of our nonmarketable equity investments and held-for-sale assets, but excluding mortgage servicing rights), net of applicable deferred taxes. The methodology of determining tangible common equity may differ among companies. Management believes that return on average tangible common equity and tangible book value per common share, which utilize tangible common equity, are useful financial measures because they enable investors and others to assess the Company's use of equity. For additional information, including a corresponding reconciliation to GAAP financial measures, see the “Capital Management – Tangible Common Equity” section in this Report.
(2)
The efficiency ratio is noninterest expense divided by total revenue (net interest income and noninterest income).
(3)
Pre-tax pre-provision profit (PTPP) is total revenue less noninterest expense. Management believes that PTPP is a useful financial measure because it enables investors and others to assess the Company's ability to generate capital to cover credit losses through a credit cycle.
(4)
Consumer and small business banking deposits are total deposits excluding mortgage escrow and wholesale deposits.
(5)
The risk-based capital ratios were calculated under the lower of Standardized or Advanced Approach determined pursuant to Basel III with Transition Requirements. Accordingly, the total capital ratio was calculated under the Advanced Approach and the other ratios were calculated under the Standardized Approach, for each of the periods.
(6)
See the “Capital Management” section and Note 19 (Regulatory and Agency Capital Requirements) to Financial Statements in this Report for additional information.
(7)
Book value per common share is common stockholders' equity divided by common shares outstanding. Tangible book value per common share is tangible common equity divided by common shares outstanding.

2

Overview (continued)

This Quarterly Report, including the Financial Review and the Financial Statements and related Notes, contains forward-looking statements, which may include forecasts of our financial results and condition, expectations for our operations and business, and our assumptions for those forecasts and expectations. Do not unduly rely on forward-looking statements. Actual results may differ materially from our forward-looking statements due to several factors. Factors that could cause our actual results to differ materially from our forward-looking statements are described in this Report, including in the “Forward-Looking Statements” section, and the “Risk Factors” and “Regulation and Supervision” sections of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2016 ( 2016 Form 10-K).
 
When we refer to “Wells Fargo,” “the Company,” “we,” “our” or “us” in this Report, we mean Wells Fargo & Company and Subsidiaries (consolidated). When we refer to the “Parent,” we mean Wells Fargo & Company. See the Glossary of Acronyms for terms used throughout this Report.
 
Financial Review

Overview
Wells Fargo & Company is a diversified, community-based financial services company with $1.93 trillion in assets. Founded in 1852 and headquartered in San Francisco, we provide banking, insurance, investments, mortgage, and consumer and commercial finance through more than 8,500 locations, 13,000 ATMs, digital (online, mobile and social), and contact centers (phone, email and correspondence), and we have offices in 42 countries and territories to support customers who conduct business in the global economy. With approximately 271,000 active, full-time equivalent team members, we serve one in three households in the United States and ranked No. 25 on Fortune’s  2017 rankings of America’s largest corporations. We ranked third in assets and second in the market value of our common stock among all U.S. banks at June 30, 2017 .
We use our Vision and Values to guide us toward growth and success. Our vision is to satisfy our customers’ financial needs, help them succeed financially, be recognized as the premier financial services company in our markets, and be one of America’s great companies. We aspire to create deep and enduring relationships with our customers by providing them with an exceptional experience and by understanding their needs and delivering the most relevant products, services, advice, and guidance.
We have five primary values, which are based on our vision and provide the foundation for everything we do. First, we value and support our people as a competitive advantage and strive to attract, develop, retain, and motivate the most talented people we can find. Second, we strive for the highest ethical standards with our team members, our customers, our communities, and our shareholders. Third, with respect to our customers, we strive to base our decisions and actions on what is right for them in everything we do. Fourth, for team members we strive to build and sustain a diverse and inclusive culture – one where they feel valued and respected for who they are as well as for the skills and experiences they bring to our company. Fifth, we also look to each of our team members to be leaders in establishing, sharing, and communicating our vision. In addition to our five primary values, one of our key day-to-day priorities is to make risk management a competitive advantage by working hard to ensure that appropriate controls are in place to reduce risks to our customers, maintain and increase our competitive market position, and protect Wells Fargo’s long-term safety, soundness, and reputation.
In keeping with our primary values and risk management priorities, we announced six new long-term goals for the Company in March 2017, which entail becoming the leader in the following areas:
Customer service and advice – provide best-in-class service and guidance to our customers to help them reach their
 
financial goals.
Team member engagement – be a company where people matter, teamwork is rewarded, everyone feels respected and empowered to speak up, diversity and inclusion are embraced, and “how” our work gets done is just as important as getting the work done.
Innovation – create new kinds of lasting value for our customers and businesses by using innovative technologies and moving quickly to bring about change.
Risk management – desire to set the global standard in managing all forms of risk.
Corporate citizenship – make better every community in which we live and do business.
Shareholder value – earn the confidence of shareholders by maximizing long-term value.

Over the past several months, our Board of Directors (Board) has undertaken a series of significant actions to enhance Board oversight and governance. The actions the Board has taken to date, many of which reflect the feedback we received from our investors and other stakeholders, include separating the roles of Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer, amending Wells Fargo’s By-Laws to require that the Chairman be an independent director, adding two new independent directors in February 2017, and amending Board committee charters to enhance oversight of conduct risk. The Board recognizes that there is still work to be done and, in response to feedback received at our annual stockholders meeting in April 2017, the Board is engaging in an ongoing comprehensive review of its structure, composition and practices. This review is expected to result in actions in third quarter 2017, which will be publicly announced at that time. As has been our practice, we will continue our engagement efforts with our investors and other stakeholders.

Sales Practices Matters
As we have previously reported, on September 8, 2016, we announced settlements with the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau (CFPB), the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (OCC), and the Office of the Los Angeles City Attorney, and entered into consent orders with the CFPB and the OCC, in connection with allegations that some of our retail customers received products and services they did not request. As a result, it remains our top priority to rebuild trust through a comprehensive action plan that includes making things right for our customers, team members, and other stakeholders, and to build a better Company for the future.
The job of rebuilding trust in Wells Fargo is a long-term effort – one requiring our commitment and perseverance. As we move forward, Wells Fargo has a specific action plan in place focused on reaching out to stakeholders who may have been affected by improper retail banking sales practices, including our

3


communities, our customers, our regulators, our team members, and our investors.
Our priority of rebuilding trust has included the following additional actions, which have been focused on identifying potential financial harm and customer remediation:
Identifying Potential Financial Harm
In the fall of 2016, the Board and management undertook an enterprise-wide review of sales practices issues. This review is ongoing.
A third-party consulting firm performed an initial review of accounts opened from May 2011 to mid-2015 to identify financial harm stemming from potentially unauthorized accounts.
We expanded the time periods of this review to cover the entire consent order period of January 2011 through September 2016, and to perform a voluntary review of accounts from 2009 to 2010. We expect to complete this expanded review process and commence remaining remediation for these additional periods by the end of third quarter 2017.
As part of this expanded review process, we also expect to complete the review and validation of the number of potentially unauthorized accounts previously identified by the third-party consulting firm, including refinements to the practices and methodologies previously used to determine such number and to remediate sales practices related matters. We expect that our review of the expanded time periods, which adds over three years to the initial review period of approximately four years (May 2011 to mid-2015), and our review and validation efforts for the initial review period, may lead to a significant increase in the identified number of potentially unauthorized accounts. However, we do not expect any incremental customer remediation costs as a result of these efforts to have a significant financial impact on the Company.
Customer Remediation
We refunded $3.26 million to customers under the stipulated judgment with the Los Angeles City Attorney and under the CFPB and OCC consent orders, covering the period from May 2011 to mid-2015.
As of May 31, 2017, we had paid $1.8 million in additional payments to customers nationwide through our ongoing complaints process and free mediation services that were put in place in connection with the sales practices matters.
On July 9, 2017, we announced updates to the settlement agreement for a class-action lawsuit concerning improper retail sales practices. With the court’s preliminary approval of the settlement agreement, Wells Fargo and the plaintiffs are preparing to issue notices that will provide information about the process for making claims. We expect this settlement to resolve substantially all claims in other similar pending class actions that allege unauthorized accounts were opened in customers’ names or that customers were enrolled in certain products or services without their consent. The settlement class covers the period from May 1, 2002 to April 20, 2017, and includes funds to ensure that each customer who was affected by improper retail sales practices has an opportunity for remediation.
We are working to complete the requirements of our regulatory consent orders, which include a review by an independent consultant to determine the “root cause” of the sales practices issues and the implementation of an action plan that addresses the findings of the independent review. The independent consultant's report, which is regulatory
 
supervisory information that cannot be publicly disclosed, is expected to be completed in third quarter 2017.
For additional information regarding sales practices matters, including related legal matters, see the “Risk Factors” section in our 2016 Form 10-K and Note 11 (Legal Actions) to Financial Statements in this Report.
 
Additional Efforts to Rebuild Trust
Our priority of rebuilding trust has also included an effort to identify other areas or instances where customers may have experienced financial harm. We are working with our regulatory agencies in this effort. As part of this effort, we are focused on the following key areas:
Practices concerning the origination, servicing, and/or collection of indirect consumer auto loans, including related insurance products. For example:
The Company recently announced a plan to remediate customers who may have been financially harmed due to issues related to automobile collateral protection insurance (CPI) policies purchased through a third-party vendor on their behalf (based on an understanding by the vendor that the borrowers’ insurance had lapsed). The plan currently consists of approximately $64 million in cash remediation and $16 million in account adjustments. The Company discontinued the CPI placement program in September 2016.
The Company has identified certain issues related to the unused portion of guaranteed automobile protection waiver or insurance agreements between the dealer and, by assignment, the lender, which may result in refunds to customers in certain states.
Policies and procedures regarding the circumstances in which the Company required customers to pay fees for the extension of interest rate lock periods for residential mortgages.
Practices related to certain consumer “add-on” products (e.g., identity theft and debt protection), including those products that are subject to an OCC consent order entered into in May 2015.
Procedures regarding the freezing (and, in many cases, closing) of consumer deposit accounts after the Company detected suspected fraudulent activity (by third-parties or account holders) that affected those accounts.

For more information, see the “Risk Factors” section in our 2016 Form 10-K and Note 11 (Legal Actions) to Financial Statements in this Report.
       This effort to identify similar instances in which customers may have experienced harm is ongoing, and it is possible that we may identify other areas of potential concern.

Financial Performance
Wells Fargo net income was $5.8 billion in second quarter 2017 with diluted earnings per common share (EPS) of $ 1.07 , compared with $5.6 billion and $1.01 , respectively, a year ago. We have now generated quarterly earnings of more than $5 billion for 19 consecutive quarters, which reflected the ability of our diversified business model and risk discipline to generate consistent financial performance during a period that included market volatility and economic uncertainty. We remain focused on meeting the financial needs of our customers and on investing in our businesses so we may continue to meet the evolving needs of our customers in the future.

4

Overview (continued)

Compared with a year ago:
revenue was $22.2 billion , stable compared with a year ago, with record net interest income in second quarter 2017, up 6% from a year ago;
average loans of $956.9 billion increased $6.1 billion , or 1% ;
total deposits were $1.3 trillion , up $60.4 billion , or 5% ;
our credit results improved with a net charge-off rate of 0.27% (annualized) of average loans and we had a $100 million release from the allowance for credit losses; and
we returned $3.4 billion to shareholders through common stock dividends and net share repurchases, which was the eighth consecutive quarter of returning more than $3 billion.

Balance Sheet and Liquidity
Our balance sheet remained strong during second quarter 2017 with high levels of liquidity and capital. Our total assets were $1.93 trillion at June 30, 2017 . Investment securities reached $409.6 billion , with approximately $37 billion of gross purchases during second quarter 2017 , largely offset by runoff and the sale of approximately $15 billion of lower-yielding short-duration securities. Loans were down $10.2 billion, or 1%, from December 31, 2016 , largely due to a decline in junior lien mortgage and automobile loans.
Average deposits in second quarter 2017 reached a record $1.30 trillion , up $64.5 billion , or 5% , from second quarter 2016 . Our average deposit cost in second quarter 2017 was 21 basis points, up 10 basis points from a year ago, which reflected an increase in commercial deposit rates. We successfully grew our primary consumer checking customers (i.e., customers who actively use their checking account with transactions such as debit card purchases, online bill payments, and direct deposit) by 0.7% (May 2017 compared with May 2016).

Credit Quality
Solid overall credit results continued in second quarter 2017 as losses remained low and we continued to originate high quality loans, reflecting our long-term risk focus. Net charge-offs were $655 million , or 0.27% (annualized) of average loans, in second quarter 2017 , compared with $924 million a year ago ( 0.39% ). The decrease in net charge-offs in second quarter 2017 , compared with a year ago, was driven by lower losses in the oil and gas portfolio and increased recoveries in the commercial portfolio. Our total oil and gas loan exposure of $48.3 billion, which includes unfunded commitments and loans outstanding, was down 14% from a year ago.
Our commercial portfolio net charge-offs were $75 million , or 6 basis points of average commercial loans, in second quarter 2017 , compared with net charge-offs of $357 million , or 29 basis points, a year ago. Net consumer credit losses increased to 51 basis points of average consumer loans in second quarter 2017 from 49 basis points in second quarter 2016 . Our commercial real estate portfolios were in a net recovery position for the 18th consecutive quarter, reflecting our conservative risk discipline and improved market conditions. Losses on our consumer real estate portfolios declined $96 million, or 126%, from a year ago, reflecting the benefit of the continued improvement in the housing market and our continued focus on originating high quality loans. Approximately 76% of the consumer first mortgage portfolio outstanding at June 30, 2017 , was originated after 2008, when more stringent underwriting standards were implemented.
 
The allowance for credit losses as of June 30, 2017 , decreased $603 million compared with a year ago and decreased $394 million from December 31, 2016. The allowance coverage for total loans was 1.27% at June 30, 2017 , compared with 1.33% a year ago and 1.30% at December 31, 2016. The allowance covered 4.6 times annualized second quarter net charge-offs, compared with 3.4 times a year ago. Future allowance levels will be based on a variety of factors, including loan growth, portfolio performance and general economic conditions. Our provision for loan losses was $555 million in second quarter 2017 , down from $1.1 billion a year ago, primarily reflecting improvement in the oil and gas portfolio.
Nonperforming assets decreased $827 million , or 8% , from March 31, 2017 , with improvement across our consumer and commercial portfolios and lower foreclosed assets. Nonperforming assets were only 1.03% of total loans, the lowest level since the merger with Wachovia in 2008. Nonaccrual loans decreased $703 million from the prior quarter partially due to a $321 million decrease in commercial nonaccruals. In addition, foreclosed assets were down $124 million from the prior quarter.

Capital
Our financial performance in second quarter 2017 resulted in strong capital generation, which increased total equity to a record $206.1 billion at June 30, 2017 , up $5.6 billion from December 31, 2016. We returned $3.4 billion to shareholders in second quarter 2017 through common stock dividends and net share repurchases and our net payout ratio (which is the ratio of (i) common stock dividends and share repurchases less issuances and stock compensation-related items, divided by (ii) net income applicable to common stock) was 63%, up from 61% in the prior quarter, and within our targeted range of 55-75%. We continued to reduce our common shares outstanding through the repurchase of 43.0 million common shares in the quarter. We also entered into a $1 billion forward repurchase contract with an unrelated third party in July 2017 that is expected to settle in fourth quarter 2017 for approximately 19 million shares. We expect to reduce our common shares outstanding through share repurchases throughout the remainder of 2017 .
We believe an important measure of our capital strength is the Common Equity Tier 1 ratio under Basel III, fully phased-in, which was 11.59 % at June 30, 2017 . Likewise, our other regulatory capital ratios remained strong. We also received a non-objection to our 2017 Capital Plan submission from the Federal Reserve. See the “Capital Management” section in this Report for more information regarding our capital, including the calculation of our regulatory capital amounts.

5


Earnings Performance  
Wells Fargo net income for second quarter 2017 was $5.8 billion ( $1.07 diluted earnings per common share), compared with $5.6 billion ( $1.01 diluted per share) for second quarter 2016 . Net income for the first half of 2017 was $11.3 billion ( $2.07 ), compared with $11.0 billion ( $2.00 ) for the same period a year ago. We generated revenue growth across many of our businesses. Our financial performance in the first half of 2017 , compared with the same period a year ago, benefited from a $1.4 billion increase in net interest income and a $1.0 billion decrease in our provision for credit losses, offset by a $1.6 billion decrease in noninterest income and a $1.4 billion increase in noninterest expense. In the first half of 2017 , net interest income represented 56% of revenue, compared with 53% for the same period in 2016 . Noninterest income was $19.4 billion in the first half of 2017 , representing 44% of revenue, compared with $21.0 billion ( 47% ) in the first half of 2016 .
Revenue, the sum of net interest income and noninterest income, was $22.2 billion in the second quarter of both 2017 and 2016. Revenue for the first half of 2017 was $44.2 billion , compared with $44.4 billion for the first half of 2016 . The decrease in revenue for the first half of 2017 , compared with the same period in 2016 , was due to a decline in noninterest income, partially offset by an increase in interest income from loans and investment securities.


6

Earnings Performance ( continued )




Net Interest Income
Net interest income is the interest earned on debt securities, loans (including yield-related loan fees) and other interest-earning assets minus the interest paid on deposits, short-term borrowings and long-term debt. The net interest margin is the average yield on earning assets minus the average interest rate paid for deposits and our other sources of funding. Net interest income and the net interest margin are presented on a taxable-equivalent basis in Table 1 to consistently reflect income from taxable and tax-exempt loans and securities based on a 35% federal statutory tax rate.
While the Company believes that it has the ability to increase net interest income over time, net interest income and the net interest margin in any one period can be significantly affected by a variety of factors including the mix and overall size of our earning assets portfolio and the cost of funding those assets. In addition, some variable sources of interest income, such as resolutions from purchased credit-impaired (PCI) loans, loan fees and collection of interest on nonaccrual loans, can vary from period to period. Net interest income and net interest margin growth has been challenged during the prolonged low interest rate environment as higher yielding loans and securities have run off and been replaced with lower yielding assets.
Net interest income on a taxable-equivalent basis was $12.8 billion and $25.4 billion in the second quarter and first half of 2017 , respectively, compared with $12.0 billion and $24.0 billion for the same periods a year ago. The net interest margin was 2.90% and 2.89% for the second quarter and first half of 2017 , respectively, up from 2.86% and 2.88% for the same periods a year ago. The increase in net interest income in the second quarter and first half of 2017 from the same periods a year ago resulted from an increase in interest income, partially offset by an increase in interest expense on funding sources. The increase in interest income was driven by balance growth in earning assets and the benefit of higher interest rates, offset by lower variable income. Interest expense on funding sources increased in the second quarter and first half of 2017 , compared with the same periods a year ago, with a significant portion due to growth and repricing of long-term debt. Deposit interest expense was also higher, predominantly due to an increase in wholesale pricing resulting from higher interest rates.
 
The increase in net interest margin in the second quarter and first half of 2017 , compared with the same periods a year ago, was primarily due to repricing benefits of earning assets from higher interest rates exceeding the repricing costs of deposits and market based funding sources.
Average earning assets increased $82.4 billion and $101.9 billion in the second quarter and first half of 2017 , respectively, compared with the same periods a year ago, as average loans increased $6.1 billion in the second quarter and $21.3 billion in the first half of 2017 , average investment securities increased $67.5 billion in second quarter 2017 and $68.6 billion in the first half of 2017 , and average trading assets increased $16.7 billion in the second quarter and $15.0 billion in the first half of 2017 , compared with the same periods a year ago. In addition, average federal funds sold and other short-term investments decreased $12.2 billion and $6.6 billion in the second quarter and first half of 2017 , respectively, compared with the same periods a year ago.
Deposits are an important low-cost source of funding and affect both net interest income and the net interest margin. Deposits include noninterest-bearing deposits, interest-bearing checking, market rate and other savings, savings certificates, other time deposits, and deposits in foreign offices. Average deposits of $1.30 trillion in both the second quarter and first half of 2017 , increased compared with $1.24 trillion and $1.23 trillion for the same periods a year ago, and represented 136% of average loans in second quarter 2017 ( 135% in the first half of 2017 ), compared with 130% in second quarter 2016 ( 131% in the first half of 2016 ). Average deposits remained stable at 74% and 73% of average earning assets in the second quarter and first half of 2017 , respectively, compared with 73% and 74% for the same periods a year ago.

7


Table 1: Average Balances, Yields and Rates Paid (Taxable-Equivalent Basis) (1)(2)
  
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
 
 
 
 
2017

 
 
 
 
 
2016

(in millions)
Average
balance

 
Yields/
rates

 
Interest
income/
expense

 
Average
balance

 
Yields/
rates

 
Interest
income/
expense

Earning assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal funds sold, securities purchased under resale agreements and other short-term investments
$
281,619

 
0.99
%
 
$
698

 
293,783

 
0.49
%
 
$
359

Trading assets
98,086

 
2.95

 
722

 
81,380

 
2.86

 
582

Investment securities (3): 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Available-for-sale securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
18,099

 
1.53

 
69

 
31,525

 
1.56

 
123

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
53,492

 
4.03

 
540

 
52,201

 
4.24

 
553

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal agencies
132,032

 
2.63

 
868

 
92,010

 
2.53

 
583

Residential and commercial
12,586

 
5.55

 
175

 
19,571

 
5.44

 
266

Total mortgage-backed securities
144,618

 
2.89

 
1,043

 
111,581

 
3.04

 
849

Other debt and equity securities
48,962

 
3.87

 
472

 
53,301

 
3.48

 
461

Total available-for-sale securities
265,171

 
3.21

 
2,124

 
248,608

 
3.20

 
1,986

Held-to-maturity securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
44,701

 
2.19

 
244

 
44,671

 
2.19

 
243

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
6,270

 
5.29

 
83

 
2,155

 
5.41

 
29

Federal agency and other mortgage-backed securities
83,116

 
2.44

 
507

 
35,057

 
1.90

 
166

Other debt securities
2,798

 
2.34

 
16

 
4,077

 
1.92

 
20

Total held-to-maturity securities
136,885

 
2.49

 
850

 
85,960

 
2.14

 
458

Total investment securities
402,056

 
2.96

 
2,974

 
334,568

 
2.93

 
2,444

Mortgages held for sale (4)
19,758

 
3.94

 
195

 
20,140

 
3.60

 
181

Loans held for sale (4)
210

 
6.95

 
4

 
239

 
4.83

 
3

Loans:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial – U.S.
273,073

 
3.70

 
2,521

 
270,862

 
3.45

 
2,328

Commercial and industrial – Non U.S.
56,426

 
2.86

 
402

 
51,201

 
2.35

 
300

Real estate mortgage
131,293

 
3.68

 
1,206

 
126,126

 
3.41

 
1,069

Real estate construction
25,271

 
4.10

 
259

 
23,115

 
3.49

 
200

Lease financing
19,058

 
4.82

 
230

 
18,930

 
5.12

 
242

Total commercial
505,121

 
3.67

 
4,618

 
490,234

 
3.39

 
4,139

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
275,108

 
4.08

 
2,805

 
275,854

 
4.01

 
2,765

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
43,602

 
4.78

 
521

 
50,609

 
4.37

 
551

Credit card
34,868

 
12.18

 
1,059

 
33,368

 
11.52

 
956

Automobile
59,112

 
5.43

 
800

 
61,149

 
5.66

 
860

Other revolving credit and installment
39,068

 
6.13

 
596

 
39,537

 
5.91

 
581

Total consumer
451,758

 
5.13

 
5,781

 
460,517

 
4.98

 
5,713

Total loans (4)
956,879

 
4.36

 
10,399

 
950,751

 
4.16

 
9,852

Other
10,713

 
2.00

 
54

 
6,014

 
2.30

 
35

Total earning assets
$
1,769,321

 
3.41
%
 
$
15,046

 
1,686,875

 
3.20
%
 
$
13,456

Funding sources
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest-bearing checking
$
48,465

 
0.41
%
 
$
50

 
39,772

 
0.13
%
 
$
13

Market rate and other savings
683,014

 
0.13

 
214

 
658,944

 
0.07

 
110

Savings certificates
22,599

 
0.30

 
17

 
26,246

 
0.35

 
23

Other time deposits
57,158

 
1.43

 
203

 
61,170

 
0.85

 
129

Deposits in foreign offices
123,684

 
0.65

 
199

 
97,525

 
0.23

 
57

Total interest-bearing deposits
934,920

 
0.29

 
683

 
883,657

 
0.15

 
332

Short-term borrowings
95,763

 
0.69

 
164

 
111,848

 
0.28

 
78

Long-term debt
249,518

 
2.05

 
1,278

 
236,156

 
1.56

 
921

Other liabilities
20,981

 
2.05

 
108

 
16,336

 
2.06

 
83

Total interest-bearing liabilities
1,301,182

 
0.69

 
2,233

 
1,247,997

 
0.45

 
1,414

Portion of noninterest-bearing funding sources
468,139

 

 

 
438,878

 


 

Total funding sources
$
1,769,321

 
0.51

 
2,233

 
1,686,875

 
0.34

 
1,414

Net interest margin and net interest income on a taxable-equivalent basis (5)
 
 
2.90
%
 
$
12,813

 
 
 
2.86
%
 
$
12,042

Noninterest-earning assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and due from banks
$
18,171

 
  
 
  
 
18,818

 
  
 
  
Goodwill
26,664

 
  
 
  
 
27,037

 
  
 
  
Other
112,923

 
 
 
 
 
129,354

 
 
 
 
Total noninterest-earning assets
$
157,758

 
 
 
 
 
175,209

 
 
 
 
Noninterest-bearing funding sources
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
Deposits
$
366,275

 
 
 
 
 
353,001

 
 
 
 
Other liabilities
53,654

 
 
 
 
 
60,083

 
 
 
 
Total equity
205,968

 
 
 
 
 
201,003

 
 
 
 
Noninterest-bearing funding sources used to fund earning assets
(468,139
)
 
 
 
 
 
(438,878
)
 
 
 
 
Net noninterest-bearing funding sources
$
157,758

 
 
 
 
 
175,209

 
 
 
 
Total assets
$
1,927,079

 
 
 
 
 
1,862,084

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1)
Our average prime rate was 4.05% and 3.50% for the quarters ended June 30, 2017 and 2016 , respectively, and 3.92% and 3.50% for the first half of 2017 and 2016 , respectively. The average three-month London Interbank Offered Rate (LIBOR) was 1.21% and 0.64% for the quarters ended June 30, 2017 and 2016 , respectively, and 1.14% and 0.63% for the first half of 2017 and 2016 , respectively.
(2)
Yields/rates and amounts include the effects of hedge and risk management activities associated with the respective asset and liability categories.
(3)
Yields and rates are based on interest income/expense amounts for the period, annualized based on the accrual basis for the respective accounts. The average balance amounts represent amortized cost for the periods presented.
(4)
Nonaccrual loans and related income are included in their respective loan categories.
(5)
Includes taxable-equivalent adjustments of $330 million and $309 million for the quarters ended June 30, 2017 and 2016 , respectively, and $648 million and $599 million for the first half of 2017 and 2016 , respectively, predominantly related to tax-exempt income on certain loans and securities. The federal statutory tax rate utilized was 35% for the periods presented.

8




 
Six months ended June 30,
 
 
  
 
  
 
2017

 
  
 
  
 
2016

(in millions)
Average
balance

 
Yields/
rates

 
Interest
income/
expense

 
Average
balance

 
Yields/
rates

 
Interest
income/
expense

Earning assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal funds sold, securities purchased under resale agreements and other short-term investments
$
282,687

 
0.88
%
 
$
1,230

 
289,240

 
0.49
%
 
$
703

Trading assets
95,937

 
2.87

 
1,377

 
80,922

 
2.94

 
1,187

Investment securities (3):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Available-for-sale securities: 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
21,547

 
1.53

 
164

 
33,000

 
1.58

 
259

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
52,873

 
4.03

 
1,066

 
51,357

 
4.24

 
1,088

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal agencies
144,257

 
2.61

 
1,879

 
94,216

 
2.67

 
1,258

Residential and commercial
13,514

 
5.43

 
367

 
20,199

 
5.32

 
537

Total mortgage-backed securities
157,771

 
2.85

 
2,246

 
114,415

 
3.14

 
1,795

Other debt and equity securities
49,787

 
3.73

 
924

 
53,430

 
3.34

 
890

Total available-for-sale securities
281,978

 
3.13

 
4,400

 
252,202

 
3.20

 
4,032

Held-to-maturity securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
44,697

 
2.20

 
487

 
44,667

 
2.19

 
487

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
6,271

 
5.30

 
166

 
2,155

 
5.41

 
58

Federal agency and other mortgage-backed securities
67,538

 
2.46

 
831

 
31,586

 
2.16

 
341

Other debt securities
3,062

 
2.34

 
35

 
4,338

 
1.92

 
42

Total held-to-maturity securities
121,568

 
2.51

 
1,519

 
82,746

 
2.25

 
928

Total investment securities
403,546

 
2.94

 
5,919

 
334,948

 
2.97

 
4,960

Mortgages held for sale (4)
19,825

 
3.82

 
379

 
19,005

 
3.60

 
342

Loans held for sale (4)
161

 
6.08

 
5

 
260

 
3.97

 
5

Loans:
  
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
  
Commercial:
  
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
  
Commercial and industrial – U.S.
273,905

 
3.65

 
4,957

 
264,295

 
3.42

 
4,505

Commercial and industrial – Non U.S.
55,890

 
2.80

 
775

 
50,354

 
2.23

 
558

Real estate mortgage
131,868

 
3.62

 
2,370

 
124,432

 
3.41

 
2,109

Real estate construction
24,933

 
3.91

 
484

 
22,859

 
3.55

 
403

Lease financing
19,064

 
4.88

 
465

 
16,989

 
4.95

 
420

Total commercial
505,660

 
3.61

 
9,051

 
478,929

 
3.35

 
7,995

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
275,293

 
4.05

 
5,571

 
275,288

 
4.03

 
5,547

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
44,439

 
4.69

 
1,036

 
51,423

 
4.38

 
1,122

Credit card
35,151

 
12.07

 
2,105

 
33,367

 
11.56

 
1,919

Automobile
60,304

 
5.45

 
1,628

 
60,631

 
5.66

 
1,708

Other revolving credit and installment
39,396

 
6.07

 
1,186

 
39,348

 
5.95

 
1,165

Total consumer
454,583

 
5.09

 
11,526

 
460,057

 
5.00

 
11,461

Total loans (4)
960,243

 
4.31

 
20,577

 
938,986

 
4.16

 
19,456

Other
8,801

 
2.37

 
104

 
5,910

 
2.18

 
65

Total earning assets
$
1,771,200

 
3.36
%
 
$
29,591

 
1,669,271

 
3.21
%
 
$
26,718

Funding sources
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits:
  
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
  
Interest-bearing checking
$
49,569

 
0.35
%
 
$
87

 
39,242

 
0.12
%
 
$
24

Market rate and other savings
683,591

 
0.11

 
371

 
655,247

 
0.07

 
217

Savings certificates
23,030

 
0.29

 
34

 
27,063

 
0.40

 
54

Other time deposits
56,043

 
1.37

 
381

 
59,688

 
0.80

 
236

Deposits in foreign offices
122,946

 
0.57

 
347

 
97,604

 
0.22

 
108

Total interest-bearing deposits
935,179

 
0.26

 
1,220

 
878,844

 
0.15

 
639

Short-term borrowings
97,149

 
0.58

 
279

 
109,853

 
0.27

 
145

Long-term debt
254,627

 
1.94

 
2,461

 
226,519

 
1.56

 
1,763

Other liabilities
18,905

 
2.12

 
200

 
16,414

 
2.10

 
172

Total interest-bearing liabilities
1,305,860

 
0.64

 
4,160

 
1,231,630

 
0.44

 
2,719

Portion of noninterest-bearing funding sources
465,340

 
 
 

 
437,641

 

 

Total funding sources
$
1,771,200

 
0.47

 
4,160

 
1,669,271

 
0.33

 
2,719

Net interest margin and net interest income on a taxable-equivalent basis (5)
  
 
2.89
%
 
$
25,431

 
  
 
2.88
%
 
$
23,999

Noninterest-earning assets
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Cash and due from banks
$
18,437

 
 
 
 
 
18,407

 
 
 
 
Goodwill
26,668

 
 
 
 
 
26,553

 
 
 
 
Other
112,744

 
 
 
 
 
126,749

 
 
 
 
Total noninterest-earning assets
$
157,849

 
 
 
 
 
171,709

 
 
 
 
Noninterest-bearing funding sources
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
Deposits
$
365,019

 
 
 
 
 
349,200

 
 
 
 
Other liabilities
54,291

 
 
 
 
 
61,355

 
 
 
 
Total equity
203,879

 
 
 
 
 
198,795

 
 
 
 
Noninterest-bearing funding sources used to fund earning assets
(465,340
)
 
 
 
 
 
(437,641
)
 
 
 
 
Net noninterest-bearing funding sources
$
157,849

 
 
 
 
 
171,709

 
 
 
 
Total assets
$
1,929,049

 
 
 
 
 
1,840,980

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 



9


Noninterest Income
Table 2: Noninterest Income
 
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
%

 
Six months ended June 30,
 
 
%

(in millions)
2017

 
2016

 
Change

 
2017

 
2016

 
Change

Service charges on deposit accounts
$
1,276

 
1,336

 
(4
)%
 
$
2,589

 
2,645

 
(2
)%
Trust and investment fees:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Brokerage advisory, commissions and other fees
2,329

 
2,291

 
2

 
4,653

 
4,530

 
3

Trust and investment management
837

 
835

 

 
1,666

 
1,650

 
1

Investment banking
463

 
421

 
10

 
880

 
752

 
17

Total trust and investment fees
3,629

 
3,547

 
2

 
7,199

 
6,932

 
4

Card fees
1,019

 
997

 
2

 
1,964

 
1,938

 
1

Other fees:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

Charges and fees on loans
325

 
317

 
3

 
632

 
630

 

Cash network fees
134

 
138

 
(3
)
 
260

 
269

 
(3
)
Commercial real estate brokerage commissions
102

 
86

 
19

 
183

 
203

 
(10
)
Letters of credit fees
76

 
83

 
(8
)
 
150

 
161

 
(7
)
Wire transfer and other remittance fees
112

 
101

 
11

 
219

 
193

 
13

All other fees
153

 
181

 
(15
)
 
323

 
383

 
(16
)
Total other fees
902

 
906

 

 
1,767


1,839

 
(4
)
Mortgage banking:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

Servicing income, net
400

 
360

 
11

 
856

 
1,210

 
(29
)
Net gains on mortgage loan origination/sales activities
748

 
1,054

 
(29
)
 
1,520

 
1,802

 
(16
)
Total mortgage banking
1,148

 
1,414

 
(19
)
 
2,376


3,012

 
(21
)
Insurance
280

 
286

 
(2
)
 
557

 
713

 
(22
)
Net gains from trading activities
237

 
328

 
(28
)
 
676

 
528

 
28

Net gains on debt securities
120

 
447

 
(73
)
 
156

 
691

 
(77
)
Net gains from equity investments
188

 
189

 
(1
)
 
591

 
433

 
36

Lease income
493

 
497

 
(1
)
 
974

 
870

 
12

Life insurance investment income
145

 
149

 
(3
)
 
289

 
303

 
(5
)
All other
249

 
333

 
(25
)
 
250

 
1,053

 
(76
)
Total
$
9,686

 
10,429

 
(7
)
 
$
19,388


20,957

 
(7
)

Noninterest income was $9.7 billion and $19.4 billion for the second quarter and first half of 2017 , respectively, compared with $10.4 billion and $21.0 billion for the same periods a year ago. This income represented 44% of revenue for both the second quarter and first half of 2017, compared with 47% for the same periods a year ago. The decline in noninterest income in the second quarter and first half of 2017 , compared with the same periods a year ago, was driven by lower net gains on debt securities, and lower mortgage banking income. Noninterest income in the first half of 2017 also reflected lower insurance income due to the divestiture of our crop insurance business in first quarter 2016, and lower all other noninterest income due to unfavorable net hedge ineffectiveness accounting results, but benefited from higher trust and investment fees, net gains on equity investments, deferred compensation plan investment results (offset in employee benefits expense), and lease income related to the GE Capital business acquisitions in 2016.
Brokerage advisory, commissions and other fees are received for providing full-service and discount brokerage services predominantly to retail brokerage clients. Income from these brokerage-related activities include asset-based fees for advisory accounts, which are based on the market value of the client’s assets, and transactional commissions based on the number and size of transactions executed at the client’s direction. These fees were $2.33 billion and $4.65 billion in the second quarter and first half of 2017 , respectively, compared with $2.29 billion and
 
$4.53 billion for the same periods in 2016 . The increase in both periods was due to higher asset-based fees, partially offset by lower transactional commission revenue. Retail brokerage client assets totaled $1.6 trillion  at June 30, 2017 , compared with $1.5 trillion at June 30, 2016 , with all retail brokerage services provided by our Wealth and Investment Management (WIM) operating segment. For additional information on retail brokerage client assets, see the discussion and Tables 4d and 4e in the “Operating Segment Results – Wealth and Investment Management – Retail Brokerage Client Assets” section in this Report.
We earn trust and investment management fees from managing and administering assets, including mutual funds, institutional separate accounts, corporate trust, personal trust, employee benefit trust and agency assets. Trust and investment management fee income is primarily from client assets under management (AUM) for which the fees are determined based on a tiered scale relative to the market value of the AUM. AUM consists of assets for which we have investment management discretion. Our AUM totaled $663.2 billion at June 30, 2017 , compared with $649.1 billion at June 30, 2016 , with substantially all of our AUM managed by our WIM operating segment. Additional information regarding our WIM operating segment AUM is provided in Table 4f and the related discussion in the “Operating Segment Results – Wealth and Investment Management – Trust and Investment Client Assets Under

10

Earnings Performance ( continued )




Management” section in this Report. In addition to AUM we have client assets under administration (AUA) that earn various administrative fees which are generally based on the extent of the services provided to administer the account. Our AUA totaled $1.7 trillion at June 30, 2017 , compared with $1.6 trillion at June 30, 2016 . Trust and investment management fees increased slightly to $837 million and $1.67 billion in the second quarter and first half of 2017 , respectively, from $835 million and $1.65 billion for the same periods in 2016 due to growth in management fees for investment advice on mutual funds, and corporate trust fees.
We earn investment banking fees from underwriting debt and equity securities, arranging loan syndications, and performing other related advisory services. Investment banking fees increased to $463 million and $880 million in the second quarter and first half of 2017 , respectively, from $421 million and $752 million for the same periods in 2016 , due to an increase in advisory services, and equity originations.
Card fees were $1.0 billion and $2.0 billion in the second quarter and first half of 2017 , respectively, compared with $997 million and $1.9 billion for the same periods a year ago, predominantly due to an increase in debit card purchase activity.
Other fees decreased to $902 million and $1.77 billion in the second quarter and first half of 2017 , respectively, from $906 million and $1.84 billion for the same periods in 2016 , driven by lower all other fees. All other fees were $153 million and $323 million in the second quarter and first half of 2017 , respectively, compared with $181 million and $383 million for the same periods in 2016 , driven by lower hedge fund fees, merchant-related services, and the impact of the sale of our global fund services business in fourth quarter 2016. Commercial real estate brokerage commissions increased to $102 million in second quarter 2017, compared with $86 million in second quarter 2016, driven by higher sales and other property-related activities, but decreased to $183 million in the first half of 2017 , compared with $203 million for the same period a year ago, driven by lower sales and other property-related activities including financing and advisory services.
Mortgage banking noninterest income, consisting of net servicing income and net gains on mortgage loan origination/sales activities, totaled $1.1 billion and $2.4 billion in the second quarter and first half of 2017 , respectively, compared with $1.4 billion and $3.0 billion for the same periods a year ago.
In addition to servicing fees, net mortgage loan servicing income includes amortization of commercial mortgage servicing rights (MSRs), changes in the fair value of residential MSRs during the period, as well as changes in the value of derivatives (economic hedges) used to hedge the residential MSRs. Net servicing income of $400 million for second quarter 2017  included a $71 million net MSR valuation gain ( $360 million decrease in the fair value of the MSRs and a $431 million hedge gain). Net servicing income of $360 million for second quarter 2016 included a $154 million net MSR valuation gain ( $824 million decrease in the fair value of the MSRs and a $978 million hedge gain). For the first half of 2017, net servicing income of $856 million included a $173 million net MSR valuation gain ( $186 million decrease in the fair value of the MSRs and a $359 million hedge gain), and for the same period in 2016 net servicing income of $1.2 billion included a $652 million net MSR valuation gain ($1.8 billion decrease in the fair value of the MSRs and a $2.4 billion hedge gain). Net servicing income decreased for the first half of 2017, compared with the same period a year ago, due to lower net MSR valuation gains. The decrease in net MSR valuation gains in the first half of 2017, compared with the same period in 2016, was primarily
 
attributable to MSR valuation adjustments in the first quarter of 2016 that reflected a reduction in forecasted prepayments due to updated economic, customer data attributes, and mortgage market rate inputs as well as higher actual prepayments experienced in second quarter 2017.
Our portfolio of mortgage loans serviced for others was $1.66 trillion at June 30, 2017 and $1.68 trillion at December 31, 2016 . At both June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016 , the ratio of combined residential and commercial MSRs to related loans serviced for others was 0.85% . See the “Risk Management – Asset/Liability Management – Mortgage Banking Interest Rate and Market Risk” section in this Report for additional information regarding our MSRs risks and hedging approach.
Net gains on mortgage loan origination/sales activities was $748 million and $1.5 billion in the second quarter and first half of 2017 , respectively, compared with $1.1 billion and $1.8 billion for the same periods a year ago. The decrease in the second quarter and first half of 2017 , compared with the same periods a year ago, was due to lower held for sale funding volume and production margins. Total mortgage loan originations were $56 billion and $100 billion for the second quarter and first half of 2017 , respectively, compared with $63 billion and $107 billion for the same periods a year ago. The production margin on residential held-for-sale mortgage originations, which represents net gains on residential mortgage loan origination/sales activities divided by total residential held-for-sale mortgage originations, provides a measure of the profitability of our residential mortgage origination activity. Table 2a presents the information used in determining the production margin.

Table 2a: Selected Mortgage Production Data
 
 
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
 
 
2017

2016

 
2017

2016

Net gains on mortgage loan origination/sales activities (in millions):
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential
(A)
$
521

744

 
1,090

1,276

Commercial
 
81

72

 
182

143

Residential pipeline and unsold/repurchased loan management (1)
 
146

238

 
248

383

Total
 
$
748

1,054

 
1,520

1,802

Residential real estate originations (in billions):
 
 
 
 
 
 
Held-for-sale
(B)
$
42

46

 
76

77

Held-for-investment
 
14

17

 
24

30

Total
 
$
56

63

 
100

107

Production margin on residential held-for-sale mortgage originations
(A)/(B)
1.24
%
1.66

 
1.44

1.67

(1)
Largely includes the results of GNMA loss mitigation activities, interest rate management activities and changes in estimate to the liability for mortgage loan repurchase losses.

The production margin was 1.24% and 1.44% for the second quarter and first half of 2017 , respectively, compared with 1.66% and 1.67% for the same periods in 2016. The decline in production margin in the second quarter and first half of 2017 was attributable to lower margins in both our retail and correspondent production channels as well as a shift to more correspondent origination volume, which has a lower production margin. Mortgage applications were $83 billion and $142 billion for the second quarter and first half of 2017 , respectively,

11


compared with $95 billion and $172 billion for the same periods a year ago. The 1-4 family first mortgage unclosed pipeline was $34 billion at June 30, 2017 , compared with $47 billion at June 30, 2016 . For additional information about our mortgage banking activities and results, see the “Risk Management – Asset/Liability Management – Mortgage Banking Interest Rate and Market Risk” section and Note 8 (Mortgage Banking Activities) and Note 13 (Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities) to Financial Statements in this Report.
Net gains on mortgage loan origination/sales activities include adjustments to the mortgage repurchase liability. Mortgage loans are repurchased from third parties based on standard representations and warranties, and early payment default clauses in mortgage sale contracts. For the first half of 2017 , we had a net $39 million release to the repurchase liability, compared with a net $93 million release for the first half of 2016 . For additional information about mortgage loan repurchases, see the “Risk Management – Credit Risk Management – Liability for Mortgage Loan Repurchase Losses” section and Note 8 (Mortgage Banking Activities) to Financial Statements in this Report.
Insurance income was $280 million and $557 million in the second quarter and first half of 2017 , respectively, compared with $286 million and $713 million in the same periods a year ago. The decrease was driven by the divestiture of our crop insurance business in first quarter 2016.
Net gains from trading activities, which reflect unrealized changes in fair value of our trading positions and realized gains and losses, were $237 million and $676 million in the second quarter and first half of 2017 , respectively, compared with $328 million and $528 million in the same periods a year ago. The decrease in second quarter 2017, compared with second quarter 2016, was predominantly driven by lower customer accommodation trading activity, partially offset by higher deferred compensation plan investment results (offset in employee benefits expense) and higher economic hedge income. The increase in the first half of 2017, compared with the same period in 2016, was predominantly driven by higher deferred compensation plan investment results (offset in employee benefits expense). Net gains from trading activities do not include interest and dividend income and expense on trading securities. Those amounts are reported within interest income from trading assets and other interest expense from trading liabilities. For additional information about trading activities, see the “Risk Management – Asset/Liability Management – Market Risk – Trading Activities” section in this Report. 
 
Net gains on debt and equity securities totaled $308 million and $747 million for the second quarter and first half of 2017 , respectively, compared with $636 million and $1.1 billion in the second quarter and first half of 2016 , after other-than-temporary impairment (OTTI) write-downs of $73 million and $202 million for the second quarter and first half of 2017 , respectively, compared with $130 million and $328 million for the same periods in 2016 . The decreases in net gains on debt and equity securities for the second quarter and first half of 2017, compared with the same periods a year ago, primarily reflected lower net gains from debt securities.
Lease income was $493 million and $974 million in the second quarter and first half of 2017 , respectively, compared with $497 million and $870 million for the same periods a year ago. The increase in the first half of 2017, compared with the same period a year ago, was predominantly driven by the GE Capital business acquisitions completed in the first quarter of 2016, partially offset by lower gains on early leveraged lease terminations.
All other income was $249 million and $250 million in the second quarter and first half of 2017 , respectively, compared with $333 million and $1.1 billion for the same periods a year ago. All other income includes ineffectiveness recognized on derivatives that qualify for hedge accounting, the results of certain economic hedges, losses on low income housing tax credit investments, foreign currency adjustments, and income from investments accounted for under the equity method, any of which can cause decreases and net losses in other income. The decrease in other income in the first half of 2017 , compared with the same period a year ago, was predominantly due to net hedge ineffectiveness results, the gain from the sale of our crop insurance business in first quarter 2016, and a gain from the sale of our health benefits services business in second quarter 2016, partially offset by a $309 million gain from the sale of a Pick-a-Pay PCI loan portfolio in second quarter 2017 and higher income from equity method investments. Hedge ineffectiveness was driven by changes in ineffectiveness recognized on interest rate swaps used to hedge our exposure to interest rate risk on long-term debt and cross-currency swaps, cross-currency interest rate swaps and forward contracts used to hedge our exposure to foreign currency risk and interest rate risk involving non-U.S. dollar denominated long-term debt. The portion of the hedge ineffectiveness recognized was partially offset by the results of certain economic hedges and, accordingly, we recognized a net hedge benefit of $21 million for second quarter 2017 and a net hedge loss of $172 million for the first half of 2017 , compared with a net hedge benefit of $56 million and $435 million for the same periods a year ago. For additional information about derivatives used as part of our asset/liability management, see Note 12 (Derivatives) to Financial Statements in this Report.

12

Earnings Performance ( continued )




Noninterest Expense
Table 3: Noninterest Expense
 
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
%

 
Six months ended June 30,
 
 
%

(in millions)
2017

 
2016

 
Change

 
2017

 
2016

 
Change

Salaries
$
4,343

 
4,099

 
6
 %
 
$
8,604

 
8,135

 
6
 %
Commission and incentive compensation
2,499

 
2,604

 
(4
)
 
5,224

 
5,249

 

Employee benefits
1,308

 
1,244

 
5

 
2,994

 
2,770

 
8

Equipment
529

 
493

 
7

 
1,106

 
1,021

 
8

Net occupancy
706

 
716

 
(1
)
 
1,418

 
1,427

 
(1
)
Core deposit and other intangibles
287

 
299

 
(4
)
 
576

 
592

 
(3
)
FDIC and other deposit assessments
328

 
255

 
29

 
661

 
505

 
31

Outside professional services
1,029

 
769

 
34

 
1,833

 
1,352

 
36

Operating losses
350

 
334

 
5

 
632

 
788

 
(20
)
Operating leases
334

 
352

 
(5
)
 
679

 
587

 
16

Contract services
349

 
283

 
23

 
674

 
565

 
19

Outside data processing
236

 
225

 
5

 
456

 
433

 
5

Travel and entertainment
171

 
193

 
(11
)
 
350

 
365

 
(4
)
Postage, stationery and supplies
134

 
153

 
(12
)
 
279

 
316

 
(12
)
Advertising and promotion
150

 
166

 
(10
)
 
277

 
300

 
(8
)
Telecommunications
91

 
94

 
(3
)
 
182

 
186

 
(2
)
Foreclosed assets
52

 
66

 
(21
)
 
138

 
144

 
(4
)
Insurance
24

 
22

 
9

 
48

 
133

 
(64
)
All other
621

 
499

 
24

 
1,202

 
1,026

 
17

Total
$
13,541

 
12,866

 
5

 
$
27,333

 
25,894

 
6

NM - Not meaningful
Noninterest expense was $13.5 billion in second quarter 2017 , up 5% from $12.9 billion a year ago, driven by higher outside professional and contract services, personnel expenses, FDIC expense, and other expense. In the first half of 2017, noninterest expense was $27.3 billion , up 6% from the same period a year ago, due to higher personnel expenses, outside professional and contract services, FDIC expense, operating lease expense and other expense, partially offset by lower operating losses and insurance expense.
Personnel expenses, which include salaries, commissions, incentive compensation, and employee benefits, were up $203 million , or 3% , in second quarter 2017 compared with the same quarter last year, and up $668 million , or 4% , in the first half of 2017 compared with the same period a year ago. The increase in both periods was due to annual salary increases and staffing growth in technology and risk management. The increase in the first half of 2017 was also driven by higher deferred compensation costs (offset in trading revenue).
FDIC and other deposit assessments were up 29% and 31% in the second quarter and first half of 2017, compared with the same periods a year ago, due to an increase in deposit assessments as a result of a temporary surcharge which became effective on July 1, 2016. The FDIC expects the surcharge to be in effect for approximately two years.
Outside professional and contract services expense was up 31% in both the second quarter and first half of 2017 , compared with the same periods a year ago. The increase in both periods reflected higher project and technology spending on regulatory and compliance related initiatives, as well as higher legal expense related to sales practices matters.
Operating losses were up 5% in second quarter 2017 and down 20% in the first half of 2017, compared with the same periods in 2016, predominantly due to litigation accruals for various legal matters.
 
Operating lease expense was down 5% in second quarter 2017 and up 16% in the first half of 2017, compared with the same periods a year ago, predominantly due to depreciation expense on the leases acquired from GE Capital.
Insurance expense was up 9% in second quarter 2017, compared with the same period a year ago, predominantly driven by our reinsurance business, and down 64% in the first half of 2017, compared with the same period a year ago, predominantly driven by the sale of our crop insurance business in first quarter 2016 .
All other noninterest expense was up 24% and 17% , in the second quarter and first half of 2017 , respectively, compared with the same periods a year ago, largely driven by higher donations expense. All other noninterest expense in second quarter 2017 included a $94 million contribution to the Wells Fargo Foundation.
The efficiency ratio was 61.1% in second quarter 2017 , compared with 58.1% in second quarter 2016 .

Income Tax Expense
Our effective tax rate was 27.7% and 32.3% for second quarter 2017 and 2016, respectively, and was 27.5% in the first half of 2017, down from 32.1% in the first half of 2016. The effective tax rate for the first half of 2017 included discrete tax benefits associated with stock compensation activity subject to ASU 2016-09 accounting guidance adopted in first quarter 2017 , and the tax benefits associated with our agreement to sell Wells Fargo Insurance Services USA (and related businesses) in second quarter 2017. See Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) to Financial Statements in this Report for additional information about ASU 2016-09.


13


Operating Segment Results
We are organized for management reporting purposes into three operating segments: Community Banking; Wholesale Banking; and Wealth and Investment Management (WIM). These segments are defined by product type and customer segment and their results are based on our management accounting process, for which there is no comprehensive, authoritative financial accounting guidance equivalent to generally accepted accounting principles (GAAP). Commencing in second quarter 2016, operating segment results reflect a shift in expenses between the personnel and other expense categories as a result of the
 
movement of support staff from the Wholesale Banking and WIM segments into a consolidated organization within the Community Banking segment. Since then personnel expenses associated with the transferred support staff have been allocated from Community Banking back to the Wholesale Banking and WIM segments through other expense. Table 4 and the following discussion present our results by operating segment. For additional description of our operating segments, including additional financial information and the underlying management accounting process, see Note 18 (Operating Segments) to Financial Statements in this Report.
Table 4: Operating Segment Results – Highlights
(income/expense in millions,
 
Community Banking
 
 
Wholesale Banking
 
 
Wealth and Investment Management
 
 
Other (1)
 
 
Consolidated
Company
 
average balances in billions)
 
2017

 
2016

 
2017

 
2016

 
2017

 
2016

 
2017

 
2016

 
2017

 
2016

Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revenue
 
$
12,289

 
12,204

 
6,951

 
7,284

 
4,182

 
3,919

 
(1,253
)
 
(1,245
)
 
22,169

 
22,162

Provision (reversal of provision) for credit losses
 
623

 
689

 
(65
)
 
385

 
7

 
2

 
(10
)
 
(2
)
 
555

 
1,074

Noninterest expense
 
7,223

 
6,648

 
4,078

 
4,036

 
3,075

 
2,976

 
(835
)
 
(794
)
 
13,541

 
12,866

Net income (loss)
 
2,993

 
3,179

 
2,388

 
2,073

 
682

 
584

 
(253
)
 
(278
)
 
5,810

 
5,558

Average loans
 
$
477.2

 
485.7

 
464.9

 
451.4

 
71.7

 
66.7

 
(56.9
)
 
(53.0
)
 
956.9

 
950.8

Average deposits
 
727.2

 
703.7

 
463.0

 
425.8

 
188.2

 
182.5

 
(77.2
)
 
(75.3
)
 
1,301.2

 
1,236.7

Six months ended June 30,
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revenue
 
$
24,382

 
24,818

 
13,989

 
14,242

 
8,375

 
7,773

 
(2,575
)
 
(2,476
)
 
44,171

 
44,357

Provision (reversal of provision) for credit losses
 
1,269

 
1,409

 
(108
)
 
748

 
3

 
(12
)
 
(4
)
 
15

 
1,160

 
2,160

Noninterest expense
 
14,444

 
13,484

 
8,303

 
8,004

 
6,281

 
6,018

 
(1,695
)
 
(1,612
)
 
27,333

 
25,894

Net income (loss)
 
6,002

 
6,475

 
4,503

 
3,994

 
1,305

 
1,096

 
(543
)
 
(545
)
 
11,267

 
11,020

Average loans
 
$
479.9

 
485.0

 
465.6

 
440.6

 
71.2

 
65.4

 
(56.5
)
 
(52.0
)
 
960.2

 
939.0

Average deposits
 
722.2

 
693.3

 
464.5

 
426.9

 
191.9

 
183.5

 
(78.4
)
 
(75.7
)
 
1,300.2

 
1,228.0

(1)
Includes the elimination of certain items that are included in more than one business segment, substantially all of which represents products and services for WIM customers served through Community Banking distribution channels.

14

Earnings Performance ( continued )




Community Banking offers a complete line of diversified financial products and services for consumers and small businesses including checking and savings accounts, credit and debit cards, and automobile, student, mortgage, home equity and small business lending, as well as referrals to Wholesale Banking and WIM business partners. The Community Banking segment
 
also includes the results of our Corporate Treasury activities net of allocations in support of the other operating segments and results of investments in our affiliated venture capital partnerships. Table 4a provides additional financial information for Community Banking.
Table 4a: Community Banking
 
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
 
 
(in millions, except average balances which are in billions)
2017

 
2016

 
% Change
 
2017

 
2016

 
% Change

Net interest income
$
7,548

 
7,379

 
2
 %
 
$
15,175

 
14,847

 
2
 %
Noninterest income:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Service charges on deposit accounts
724

 
773

 
(6
)
 
1,465

 
1,526

 
(4
)
Trust and investment fees:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

Brokerage advisory, commissions and other fees (1)
452

 
455

 
(1
)
 
896

 
905

 
(1
)
Trust and investment management (1)
216

 
204

 
6

 
434

 
409

 
6

Investment banking (2)
(20
)
 
(50
)
 
60

 
(47
)
 
(69
)
 
32

Total trust and investment fees
648

 
609

 
6

 
1,283

 
1,245

 
3

Card fees
925

 
907

 
2

 
1,793

 
1,759

 
2

Other fees
395

 
366

 
8

 
790

 
738

 
7

Mortgage banking
1,040

 
1,325

 
(22
)
 
2,145

 
2,833

 
(24
)
Insurance
16

 

 
NM

 
28

 
2

 
NM

Net gains (losses) from trading activities
19

 
(60
)
 
132

 
69

 
(87
)
 
179

Net gains on debt securities
184

 
394

 
(53
)
 
286

 
613

 
(53
)
Net gains from equity investments (3)
169

 
164

 
3

 
536

 
339

 
58

Other income of the segment
621

 
347

 
79

 
812

 
1,003

 
(19
)
Total noninterest income
4,741

 
4,825

 
(2
)
 
9,207

 
9,971

 
(8
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

Total revenue
12,289

 
12,204

 
1

 
24,382

 
24,818

 
(2
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

Provision for credit losses
623

 
689

 
(10
)
 
1,269

 
1,409

 
(10
)
Noninterest expense:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

Personnel expense
4,985

 
4,662

 
7

 
10,166

 
9,280

 
10

Equipment
507

 
466

 
9

 
1,058

 
959

 
10

Net occupancy
517

 
521

 
(1
)
 
1,041

 
1,031

 
1

Core deposit and other intangibles
111

 
129

 
(14
)
 
223

 
257

 
(13
)
FDIC and other deposit assessments
185

 
148

 
25

 
376

 
294

 
28

Outside professional services
549

 
264

 
108

 
891

 
449

 
98

Operating losses
298

 
292

 
2

 
559

 
699

 
(20
)
Other expense of the segment
71

 
166

 
(57
)
 
130

 
515

 
(75
)
Total noninterest expense
7,223

 
6,648

 
9

 
14,444

 
13,484

 
7

Income before income tax expense and noncontrolling interests
4,443

 
4,867

 
(9
)
 
8,669

 
9,925

 
(13
)
Income tax expense
1,404

 
1,667

 
(16
)
 
2,531

 
3,364

 
(25
)
Net income from noncontrolling interests (4)
46

 
21

 
119

 
136

 
86

 
58

Net income
$
2,993

 
3,179

 
(6
)
 
$
6,002

 
6,475

 
(7
)
Average loans
$
477.2

 
485.7

 
(2
)
 
$
479.9

 
485.0

 
(1
)
Average deposits
727.2

 
703.7

 
3

 
722.2

 
693.3

 
4

NM - Not meaningful
(1)
Represents income on products and services for WIM customers served through Community Banking distribution channels and is eliminated in consolidation.
(2)
Includes syndication and underwriting fees paid to Wells Fargo Securities which are offset in our Wholesale Banking segment.
(3)
Predominantly represents gains resulting from venture capital investments.
(4)
Reflects results attributable to noncontrolling interests largely associated with the Company’s consolidated venture capital investments.
Community Banking reported net income of $3.0 billion, down $186 million, or 6%, from second quarter 2016, and $6.0 billion for the first half of 2017, down $473 million, or 7%, compared with the same period a year ago. First half 2017 results included a discrete tax benefit of $172 million, largely associated with stock compensation activity subject to the adoption of accounting guidance in first quarter 2017. Revenue of $12.3 billion increased $85 million, or 1%, from second quarter 2016, and was $24.4 billion for the first half of 2017, a decrease of $436 million, or 2%, compared with the same period last year. The increase from second quarter 2016 was primarily due to the gain on the sale of a Pick-a-Pay PCI loan portfolio, higher net interest income, deferred compensation plan investments (offset in employee benefits expense), and card fees, partially offset by lower mortgage banking revenue and gains on sales of debt securities. The decrease from the first half of 2016 was primarily due to lower mortgage revenue, gains on sales of debt securities, and other income driven by net hedge ineffectiveness accounting
 
related to our long-term debt hedging results, partially offset by higher net interest income and gains on equity investments. Average loans of $477.2 billion in second quarter 2017 decreased $8.5 billion, or 2%, from second quarter 2016, and average loans of $479.9 billion in the first half of 2017 decreased $5.1 billion, or 1%, from the first half of 2016. Average deposits increased $23.5 billion, or 3%, from second quarter 2016 and $28.9 billion, or 4%, from the first half of 2016. Primary consumer checking customers (customers who actively use their checking account with transactions such as debit card purchases, online bill payments, and direct deposit) as of May 2017 were up 0.7% from May 2016. Noninterest expense increased 9% from second quarter 2016 and 7% from the first half of 2016. The increase from second quarter 2016 was driven by higher personnel expenses mainly due to the impact of annual salary increases and increased personnel, including the movement of certain support functions from our other operating segments into the Community Banking operating segment, and higher professional services

15


driven by increased project spending. The increase from the first half of 2016 was primarily due to higher personnel expenses, including deferred compensation plan expense (offset in trading revenue), and higher professional services, partially offset by lower other expense and operating losses. The provision for credit losses decreased $66 million from second quarter 2016 and $140 million from the first half of 2016 mostly due to an improvement in the consumer lending portfolio, primarily consumer real estate, compared with the same periods a year ago.
 
Wholesale Banking provides financial solutions to businesses across the United States and globally with annual sales generally in excess of $5 million. Products and businesses include Business Banking, Commercial Real Estate, Corporate Banking, Financial Institutions Group, Government and Institutional Banking, Insurance, Middle Market Banking, Principal Investments, Treasury Management, Wells Fargo Commercial Capital, and Wells Fargo Securities. Table 4b provides additional financial information for Wholesale Banking.
Table 4b: Wholesale Banking
 
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
 
 
(in millions, except average balances which are in billions)
2017

 
2016

 
% Change
 
2017

 
2016

 
% Change

Net interest income
$
4,278

 
3,919

 
9
 %
 
$
8,426

 
7,667

 
10
 %
Noninterest income:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Service charges on deposit accounts
552

 
563

 
(2
)
 
1,123

 
1,118

 

Trust and investment fees:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

Brokerage advisory, commissions and other fees
82

 
94

 
(13
)
 
166

 
185

 
(10
)
Trust and investment management
131

 
123

 
7

 
260

 
234

 
11

Investment banking
484

 
471

 
3

 
929

 
821

 
13

Total trust and investment fees
697

 
688

 
1

 
1,355

 
1,240

 
9

Card fees
93

 
89

 
4

 
170

 
178

 
(4
)
Other fees
506

 
538

 
(6
)
 
974

 
1,098

 
(11
)
Mortgage banking
110

 
90

 
22

 
233

 
181

 
29

Insurance
256

 
286

 
(10
)
 
512

 
711

 
(28
)
Net gains from trading activities
168

 
344

 
(51
)
 
458

 
551

 
(17
)
Net gains (losses) on debt securities
(64
)
 
52

 
NM

 
(130
)
 
77

 
NM

Net gains from equity investments
16

 
26

 
(38
)
 
52

 
92

 
(43
)
Other income of the segment
339

 
689

 
(51
)
 
816

 
1,329

 
(39
)
Total noninterest income
2,673

 
3,365

 
(21
)
 
5,563

 
6,575

 
(15
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

Total revenue
6,951

 
7,284

 
(5
)
 
13,989

 
14,242

 
(2
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

Provision (reversal of provision) for credit losses
(65
)
 
385

 
NM

 
(108
)
 
748

 
NM

Noninterest expense:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

Personnel expense
1,618

 
1,783

 
(9
)
 
3,441

 
3,757

 
(8
)
Equipment
14

 
16

 
(13
)
 
30

 
37

 
(19
)
Net occupancy
110

 
116

 
(5
)
 
220

 
234

 
(6
)
Core deposit and other intangibles
103

 
95

 
8

 
208

 
185

 
12

FDIC and other deposit assessments
120

 
88

 
36

 
238

 
174

 
37

Outside professional services
293

 
276

 
6

 
541

 
490

 
10

Operating losses
6

 
38

 
(84
)
 
12

 
75

 
(84
)
Other expense of the segment
1,814

 
1,624

 
12

 
3,613

 
3,052

 
18

Total noninterest expense
4,078

 
4,036

 
1

 
8,303

 
8,004

 
4

Income before income tax expense and noncontrolling interests
2,938

 
2,863

 
3

 
5,794

 
5,490

 
6

Income tax expense
559

 
795

 
(30
)
 
1,305

 
1,514

 
(14
)
Net loss from noncontrolling interests
(9
)
 
(5
)
 
(80
)
 
(14
)
 
(18
)
 
22

Net income
$
2,388

 
2,073

 
15

 
$
4,503

 
3,994

 
13

Average loans
$
464.9

 
451.4

 
3

 
$
465.6

 
440.6

 
6

Average deposits
463.0

 
425.8

 
9

 
464.5

 
426.9

 
9

NM – Not meaningful
Wholesale Banking reported net income of $2.4 billion in second quarter 2017, up $315 million, or 15%, from second quarter 2016. In the first half of 2017, net income of $4.5 billion increased $509 million, or 13%, from the same period a year ago. Net income results in second quarter 2017 included a tax benefit resulting from our agreement to sell Wells Fargo Insurance Services USA and related businesses. Revenue decreased $333 million, or 5%, from second quarter 2016 and $253 million, or 2%, from the first half of 2016 as increased net interest income was more than offset by lower noninterest income. Net interest income increased $359 million, or 9%, from second quarter 2016 and $759 million, or 10%, from the first half of 2016 driven by strong loan growth, which included the benefit from the GE Capital business acquisitions in 2016, and rising interest rates. Noninterest income decreased $692 million, or 21%, from second quarter 2016 due primarily to the second quarter 2016 gain on the sale of our health benefits services business as well as lower
 
customer accommodation trading and principal investing gains. Noninterest income decreased $1.0 billion, or 15%, from the first half of 2016 primarily due to the first quarter 2016 sale of our crop insurance business, which resulted in lower insurance and gain on sale income, and the second quarter 2016 gain on the sale of our health benefits services business, as well as lower gains on debt securities and customer accommodation trading. The decreases in noninterest income from the first half of 2016 were partially offset by higher investment banking fees as well as higher lease income related to the GE Capital business acquisitions. Average loans of $464.9 billion in second quarter 2017 increased $13.5 billion, or 3%, from second quarter 2016, and average loans of $465.6 billion in the first half of 2017 increased $25.0 billion, or 6%, from the first half of 2016. Average loan growth was driven by broad-based growth in asset backed finance, business banking, capital finance, commercial real estate, global banking, government and institutional banking

16

Earnings Performance ( continued )




and middle market banking, as well as the GE Capital business acquisitions in 2016. Average deposits of $463.0 billion increased $37.2 billion, or 9%, from second quarter 2016 and $37.6 billion, or 9%, from the first half of 2016 reflecting growth in corporate banking, commercial real estate, corporate trust and financial institutions. Noninterest expense increased $42 million, or 1%, from second quarter 2016 and $299 million, or 4%, from the first half of 2016, substantially due to the GE Capital business acquisitions and higher expense related to growth initiatives, compliance and regulatory requirements. The provision for credit losses decreased $450 million from second quarter 2016 and $856 million from the first half of 2016 driven by improvement in the oil and gas portfolio.
 
Wealth and Investment Management provides a full range of personalized wealth management, investment and retirement products and services to clients across U.S. based businesses including Wells Fargo Advisors, The Private Bank, Abbot Downing, Wells Fargo Institutional Retirement and Trust, and Wells Fargo Asset Management. We deliver financial planning, private banking, credit, investment management and fiduciary services to high-net worth and ultra-high-net worth individuals and families. We also serve clients’ brokerage needs, supply retirement and trust services to institutional clients and provide investment management capabilities delivered to global institutional clients through separate accounts and the Wells Fargo Funds. Table 4c provides additional financial information for WIM.
Table 4c: Wealth and Investment Management
 
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
 
 
(in millions, except average balances which are in billions)
2017

 
2016

 
% Change
 
2017

 
2016

 
% Change

Net interest income
$
1,127

 
932

 
21
 %
 
$
2,201

 
1,875

 
17
 %
Noninterest income:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Service charges on deposit accounts
5

 
5

 

 
10

 
10

 

Trust and investment fees:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Brokerage advisory, commissions and other fees
2,255

 
2,208

 
2

 
4,500

 
4,362

 
3

Trust and investment management
713

 
718

 
(1
)
 
1,420

 
1,430

 
(1
)
Investment banking (1)
(1
)
 
(1
)
 

 
(2
)
 
(1
)
 
(100
)
Total trust and investment fees
2,967

 
2,925

 
1

 
5,918

 
5,791

 
2

Card fees
2

 
2

 

 
3

 
3

 

Other fees
4

 
5

 
(20
)
 
9

 
9

 

Mortgage banking
(3
)
 
(2
)
 
(50
)
 
(5
)
 
(4
)
 
(25
)
Insurance
22

 

 
NM

 
42

 

 
NM

Net gains from trading activities
50

 
44

 
14

 
149

 
64

 
133

Net gains on debt securities

 
1

 
NM

 

 
1

 
NM

Net gains (losses) from equity investments
3

 
(1
)
 
400

 
3

 
2

 
50

Other income of the segment
5

 
8

 
(38
)
 
45

 
22

 
105

Total noninterest income
3,055

 
2,987

 
2

 
6,174

 
5,898

 
5

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total revenue
4,182

 
3,919

 
7

 
8,375

 
7,773

 
8

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Provision (reversal of provision) for credit losses
7

 
2

 
250

 
3

 
(12
)
 
125

Noninterest expense:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Personnel expense
1,980

 
1,911

 
4

 
4,085

 
3,936

 
4

Equipment
9

 
13

 
(31
)
 
20

 
28

 
(29
)
Net occupancy
108

 
109

 
(1
)
 
215

 
221

 
(3
)
Core deposit and other intangibles
73

 
75

 
(3
)
 
145

 
150

 
(3
)
FDIC and other deposit assessments
39

 
31

 
26

 
79

 
62

 
27

Outside professional services
193

 
236

 
(18
)
 
415

 
427

 
(3
)
Operating losses
48

 
6

 
700

 
65

 
18

 
261

Other expense of the segment
625

 
595

 
5

 
1,257

 
1,176

 
7

Total noninterest expense
3,075

 
2,976

 
3

 
6,281

 
6,018

 
4

Income before income tax expense and noncontrolling interests
1,100

 
941

 
17

 
2,091

 
1,767

 
18

Income tax expense
417

 
358

 
16

 
779

 
672

 
16

Net income (loss) from noncontrolling interests
1

 
(1
)
 
200

 
7

 
(1
)
 
800

Net income
$
682

 
584

 
17

 
$
1,305

 
1,096

 
19

Average loans
$
71.7

 
66.7

 
7

 
$
71.2

 
65.4

 
9

Average deposits
188.2

 
182.5

 
3

 
191.9

 
183.5

 
5

NM – Not meaningful
(1)
Includes syndication and underwriting fees paid to Wells Fargo Securities which are offset in our Wholesale Banking segment.
WIM reported net income of $682 million in second quarter 2017, up $98 million from second quarter 2016. Net income for the first half of 2017 was $1.3 billion, up $209 million, or 19%, compared with the same period a year ago. Revenue was up $263 million, or 7%, from second quarter 2016 and up $602 million, or 8%, from the first half of 2016, due to increases in both net interest income and noninterest income. Net interest income increased 21% from second quarter 2016 and 17% from the first half of 2016, due to higher interest rates and growth in investment securities and loan balances. Noninterest income increased 2% from second quarter 2016 and 5% from the first half of 2016 substantially driven by higher asset-based fees and
 
deferred compensation plan investments (offset in employee benefits expense), partially offset by lower brokerage transaction revenue. Asset-based fees were up primarily due to higher brokerage advisory account client assets driven by higher market valuations and positive net flows. Average loans of $71.7 billion in second quarter 2017 increased 7% from second quarter 2016. Average loans in the first half of 2017 increased 9% from the same period a year ago. Average loan growth was driven by growth in non-conforming mortgage loans. Average deposits in second quarter 2017 of $188.2 billion increased 3% from second quarter 2016. Average deposits in the first half of 2017 increased 5% from the same period a year ago. Noninterest expense was up

17


3% from second quarter 2016 and up 4% from the first half of 2016, due to higher broker commissions mainly due to higher brokerage revenue, higher non-personnel expenses, and higher deferred compensation plan expense (offset in trading revenue). Total provision for credit losses increased $5 million from second quarter 2016 and increased $15 million from the first half of 2016 driven by loan growth, and higher net charge-offs in the first half of 2017 compared with the first half of 2016.
The following discussions provide additional information for client assets we oversee in our retail brokerage advisory and trust and investment management business lines.

Retail Brokerage Client Assets Brokerage advisory, commissions and other fees are received for providing full-service and discount brokerage services predominantly to retail
 
brokerage clients. Offering advisory account relationships to our brokerage clients is an important component of our broader strategy of meeting their financial needs. Although a majority of our retail brokerage client assets are in accounts that earn brokerage commissions, the fees from those accounts generally represent transactional commissions based on the number and size of transactions executed at the client’s direction. Fees earned from advisory accounts are asset-based and depend on changes in the value of the client’s assets as well as the level of assets resulting from inflows and outflows. A majority of our brokerage advisory, commissions and other fee income is earned from advisory accounts. Table 4d shows advisory account client assets as a percentage of total retail brokerage client assets at June 30, 2017 and 2016 .
Table 4d: Retail Brokerage Client Assets
 
June 30,
 
(in billions)
2017

 
2016

Retail brokerage client assets
$
1,575.9

 
1,455.4

Advisory account client assets
502.5

 
443.7

Advisory account client assets as a percentage of total client assets
32
%
 
30

Retail Brokerage advisory accounts include assets that are financial advisor-directed and separately managed by third-party managers, as well as certain client-directed brokerage assets where we earn a fee for advisory and other services, but do not have investment discretion. These advisory accounts generate fees as a percentage of the market value of the assets, which vary across the account types based on the distinct services provided,
 
and are affected by investment performance as well as asset inflows and outflows. For the second quarter and first half of 2017 and 2016 , the average fee rate by account type ranged from 80 to 120 basis points. Table 4e presents retail brokerage advisory account client assets activity by account type for the second quarter and first half of 2017 and 2016 .
Table 4e: Retail Brokerage Advisory Account Client Assets
 
Quarter ended
 
 
Six months ended
 
(in billions)
Balance, beginning of period

Inflows (1)

Outflows (2)

Market impact (3)

Balance, end of period

 
Balance, beginning of period

Inflows (1)

Outflows (2)

Market impact (3)

Balance, end of period

June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Client directed (4)
$
163.3

8.3

(9.6
)
1.8

163.8

 
159.1

20.3

(21.2
)
5.6

163.8

Financial advisor directed (5)
126.2

6.9

(6.2
)
4.8

131.7

 
115.7

16.3

(12.2
)
11.9

131.7

Separate accounts (6)
133.7

6.3

(6.0
)
3.7

137.7

 
125.7

14.5

(12.2
)
9.7

137.7

Mutual fund advisory (7)
66.9

2.9

(2.7
)
2.2

69.3

 
63.3

6.7

(5.7
)
5.0

69.3

Total advisory client assets
$
490.1

24.4

(24.5
)
12.5

502.5

 
463.8

57.8

(51.3
)
32.2

502.5

June 30, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Client directed (4)
$
155.3

9.3

(9.0
)
2.9

158.5

 
154.7

18.2

(18.2
)
3.8

158.5

Financial advisor directed (5)
97.4

7.8

(4.8
)
3.8

104.2

 
91.9

15.1

(8.8
)
6.0

104.2

Separate accounts (6)
113.5

7.3

(5.2
)
3.3

118.9

 
110.4

13.0

(10.0
)
5.5

118.9

Mutual fund advisory (7)
62.0

2.0

(2.9
)
1.0

62.1

 
62.9

3.9

(5.9
)
1.2

62.1

Total advisory client assets
$
428.2

26.4

(21.9
)
11.0

443.7

 
419.9

50.2

(42.9
)
16.5

443.7

(1)
Inflows include new advisory account assets, contributions, dividends and interest.
(2)
Outflows include closed advisory account assets, withdrawals, and client management fees.
(3)
Market impact reflects gains and losses on portfolio investments.
(4)
Investment advice and other services are provided to client, but decisions are made by the client and the fees earned are based on a percentage of the advisory account assets, not the number and size of transactions executed by the client.
(5)
Professionally managed portfolios with fees earned based on respective strategies and as a percentage of certain client assets.
(6)
Professional advisory portfolios managed by Wells Fargo Asset Management advisors or third-party asset managers. Fees are earned based on a percentage of certain client assets.
(7)
Program with portfolios constructed of load-waived, no-load and institutional share class mutual funds. Fees are earned based on a percentage of certain client assets.


18

Earnings Performance ( continued )




Trust and Investment Client Assets Under Management We earn trust and investment management fees from managing and administering assets, including mutual funds, institutional separate accounts, personal trust, employee benefit trust and agency assets through our asset management, wealth and retirement businesses. Our asset management business is conducted by Wells Fargo Asset Management (WFAM), which offers Wells Fargo proprietary mutual funds and manages institutional separate accounts. Our wealth business manages assets for high net worth clients, and our retirement business
 
provides total retirement management, investments, and trust and custody solutions tailored to meet the needs of institutional clients. Substantially all of our trust and investment management fee income is earned from AUM where we have discretionary management authority over the investments and generate fees as a percentage of the market value of the AUM. Table 4f presents AUM activity for the second quarter and first half of 2017 and 2016 .
Table 4f: WIM Trust and Investment – Assets Under Management
 
Quarter ended
 

Six months ended
 
(in billions)
Balance, beginning of period

Inflows (1)

Outflows (2)

Market impact (3)

Balance, end of period

 
Balance, beginning of period

Inflows (1)

Outflows (2)

Market impact (3)

Balance, end of period

June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Assets managed by WFAM (4):
 
 
 
 


 
 
 
 
 
 
Money market funds (5)
$
96.7


(2.0
)

94.7

 
102.6


(7.9
)

94.7

Other assets managed
384.4

34.2

(33.4
)
7.3

392.5

 
379.6

63.6

(67.6
)
16.9

392.5

Assets managed by Wealth and Retirement (6)
173.5

10.0

(11.0
)
3.1

175.6

 
168.5

19.4

(20.4
)
8.1

175.6

Total assets under management
$
654.6

44.2

(46.4
)
10.4

662.8

 
650.7

83.0

(95.9
)
25.0

662.8

June 30, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Assets managed by WFAM (4):

 

 

 
 
 
 
 
 
Money market funds (5)
$
113.9


(5.0
)

108.9

 
123.6


(14.7
)

108.9

Other assets managed
367.1

28.8

(26.4
)
5.4

374.9

 
366.1

55.9

(54.9
)
7.8

374.9

Assets managed by Wealth and Retirement (6)
163.4

8.2

(9.2
)
2.2

164.6

 
162.1

17.3

(18.0
)
3.2

164.6

Total assets under management
$
644.4

37.0

(40.6
)
7.6

648.4

 
651.8

73.2

(87.6
)
11.0

648.4

(1)
Inflows include new managed account assets, contributions, dividends and interest.
(2)
Outflows include closed managed account assets, withdrawals and client management fees.
(3)
Market impact reflects gains and losses on portfolio investments.
(4)
Assets managed by WFAM consist of equity, alternative, balanced, fixed income, money market, and stable value, and include client assets that are managed or sub-advised on behalf of other Wells Fargo lines of business.
(5)
Money Market funds activity is presented on a net inflow or net outflow basis, because the gross flows are not meaningful nor used by management as an indicator of performance.
(6)
Includes $5.7 billion and $7.6 billion as of June 30, 2017 and 2016 , respectively, of client assets invested in proprietary funds managed by WFAM.


19


Balance Sheet Analysis 
At June 30, 2017 , our assets totaled $1.93 trillion , up $756 million from December 31, 2016 . Asset growth was predominantly driven by growth in held-to-maturity investment securities, which increased $40.8 billion , partially offset by a $39.2 billion decrease in available-for-sale investment securities and a $10.2 billion decrease in loans. Total equity growth of $5.6 billion from December 31, 2016, was the predominant source that funded our asset growth from December 31, 2016.
 
Equity growth benefited from $6.4 billion in earnings net of dividends paid.
The following discussion provides additional information about the major components of our balance sheet. Information regarding our capital and changes in our asset mix is included in the “Earnings Performance – Net Interest Income” and “Capital Management” sections and Note 19 (Regulatory and Agency Capital Requirements) to Financial Statements in this Report.

Investment Securities
Table 5: Investment Securities – Summary
 
June 30, 2017
 
 
December 31, 2016
 
(in millions)
Amortized Cost

 
Net
 unrealized
gain (loss)

 
Fair value

 
Amortized Cost

 
Net
unrealized
gain (loss)

 
Fair value

Available-for-sale securities:
 
 





 
 
 
 
 
 
Debt securities
$
267,476

 
698

 
268,174

 
309,447

 
(2,294
)
 
307,153

Marketable equity securities
614

 
414

 
1,028

 
706

 
505

 
1,211

Total available-for-sale securities
268,090

 
1,112

 
269,202

 
310,153

 
(1,789
)
 
308,364

Held-to-maturity debt securities
140,392

 
(2
)
 
140,390

 
99,583

 
(428
)
 
99,155

Total investment securities (1)
$
408,482

 
1,110

 
409,592

 
409,736

 
(2,217
)
 
407,519

(1)
Available-for-sale securities are carried on the balance sheet at fair value. Held-to-maturity securities are carried on the balance sheet at amortized cost.
Table 5 presents a summary of our investment securities portfolio, which increased $1.6 billion from December 31, 2016 , predominantly due to purchases of federal agency mortgage-backed securities partially offset by sales and paydowns on other security classes including securities of U.S. treasury and federal agencies, commercial mortgage-backed securities, corporate debt securities and collateralized debt obligations.
The total net unrealized gains on available-for-sale securities were $1.1 billion at June 30, 2017 , up from net unrealized losses of $1.8 billion at December 31, 2016 , primarily due to lower long-term interest rates, tighter credit spreads and the transfer of available-for-sale securities to held-to-maturity. For a discussion of our investment management objectives and practices, see the “Balance Sheet Analysis” section in our 2016 Form 10-K. Also, see the “Risk Management – Asset/Liability Management” section in this Report for information on our use of investments to manage liquidity and interest rate risk.
We analyze securities for other-than-temporary impairment (OTTI) quarterly or more often if a potential loss-triggering event occurs. Of the $202 million in OTTI write-downs recognized in earnings in the first half of 2017 , $100 million related to debt securities, $ 4 million related to marketable equity securities, which are included in available-for-sale securities, and $98 million related to nonmarketable equity investments, which are included in other assets. OTTI write-downs recognized in earnings related to oil and gas investments totaled $58 million in the first half of 2017 , of which $22 million related to investment securities and $36 million related to nonmarketable equity investments. For a discussion of our OTTI accounting policies and underlying considerations and analysis see Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) to Financial Statements in our 2016 Form 10-K and Note 4 (Investment Securities) to Financial Statements in this Report.
At June 30, 2017 , investment securities included $58.3 billion of municipal bonds, of which 95.5% were rated “A-” or better based largely on external and, in some cases, internal ratings. Additionally, some of the securities in our total municipal bond portfolio are guaranteed against loss by bond insurers.
 
These guaranteed bonds are predominantly investment grade and were generally underwritten in accordance with our own investment standards prior to the determination to purchase, without relying on the bond insurer’s guarantee in making the investment decision. The credit quality of our municipal bond holdings are monitored as part of our ongoing impairment analysis.
The weighted-average expected maturity of debt securities available-for-sale was 6.7 years at June 30, 2017 . The expected remaining maturity is shorter than the remaining contractual maturity for the 55% of this portfolio that is MBS because borrowers generally have the right to prepay obligations before the underlying mortgages mature. The estimated effects of a 200 basis point increase or decrease in interest rates on the fair value and the expected remaining maturity of the MBS available-for-sale portfolio are shown in Table 6 .
Table 6: Mortgage-Backed Securities Available for Sale
(in billions)
Fair value

 
Net unrealized gain (loss)

 
Expected remaining maturity
(in years)

At June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
Actual
$
148.7

 
0.2

 
6.7

Assuming a 200 basis point:
 
 
 
 
 
Increase in interest rates
132.8

 
(15.7
)
 
8.5

Decrease in interest rates
155.0

 
6.5

 
2.9

The weighted-average expected maturity of debt securities held-to-maturity was 6.8 years at June 30, 2017 . See Note 4 (Investment Securities) to Financial Statements in this Report for a summary of investment securities by security type.

20

Balance Sheet Analysis ( continued )

Loan Portfolios
Table 7 provides a summary of total outstanding loans by portfolio segment. Total loans decreased $10.2 billion from December 31, 2016 , driven by a continued decline in junior lien
 
mortgage loans, as well as an expected decline in automobile loans as continued proactive steps to tighten underwriting standards resulted in lower origination volume.
Table 7: Loan Portfolios
(in millions)
June 30, 2017

 
December 31, 2016

Commercial
$
505,901

 
506,536

Consumer
451,522

 
461,068

Total loans
$
957,423

 
967,604

Change from prior year-end
$
(10,181
)
 
51,045


A discussion of average loan balances and a comparative detail of average loan balances is included in Table 1 under “Earnings Performance – Net Interest Income” earlier in this Report. Additional information on total loans outstanding by portfolio segment and class of financing receivable is included in the “Risk Management – Credit Risk Management” section in this Report. Period-end balances and other loan related
 
information are in Note 5 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses) to Financial Statements in this Report. 
Table 8 shows contractual loan maturities for loan categories normally not subject to regular periodic principal reduction and the contractual distribution of loans in those categories to changes in interest rates.
Table 8: Maturities for Selected Commercial Loan Categories
 
 
June 30, 2017
 
 
December 31, 2016
 
(in millions)
 
Within
one
 year

 
After one
year
through
five years

 
After
 five
years

 
Total

 
Within
one
year

 
After one
year
through
 five years

 
After
five
years

 
Total

Selected loan maturities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
 
$
98,198

 
207,201

 
25,714

 
331,113

 
105,421

 
199,211

 
26,208

 
330,840

Real estate mortgage
 
21,818

 
66,665

 
41,794

 
130,277

 
22,713

 
68,928

 
40,850

 
132,491

Real estate construction
 
10,877

 
13,087

 
1,373

 
25,337

 
9,576

 
13,102

 
1,238

 
23,916

Total selected loans
 
$
130,893

 
286,953

 
68,881

 
486,727

 
137,710

 
281,241

 
68,296

 
487,247

Distribution of loans to changes in interest
rates:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loans at fixed interest rates
 
$
18,632

 
28,857

 
26,229

 
73,718

 
19,389

 
29,748

 
26,859

 
75,996

Loans at floating/variable interest rates
 
112,261

 
258,096

 
42,652

 
413,009

 
118,321

 
251,493

 
41,437

 
411,251

Total selected loans
 
$
130,893

 
286,953

 
68,881

 
486,727

 
137,710

 
281,241

 
68,296

 
487,247



21


Deposits
Deposits were $1.3 trillion at June 30, 2017 , down $249 million from December 31, 2016 , reflecting lower wealth and commercial deposits, partially offset by growth in retail deposits and Treasury institutional certificates of deposit. Table 9 provides additional
 
information regarding deposits. Information regarding the impact of deposits on net interest income and a comparison of average deposit balances is provided in the “Earnings Performance – Net Interest Income” section and Table 1 earlier in this Report. 
Table 9: Deposits
($ in millions)
Jun 30,
2017

 
% of
total
deposits

 
Dec 31,
2016

 
% of
total
deposits

 

% Change

Noninterest-bearing
$
372,766

 
28
%
 
$
375,967

 
29
%
 
(1
)
Interest-bearing checking
47,080

 
4

 
49,403

 
4

 
(5
)
Market rate and other savings
680,971

 
52

 
687,846

 
52

 
(1
)
Savings certificates
22,225

 
2

 
23,968

 
2

 
(7
)
Other time and deposits
61,666

 
5

 
52,649

 
4

 
17

Deposits in foreign offices (1)
121,122

 
9

 
116,246

 
9

 
4

Total deposits
$
1,305,830

 
100
%
 
$
1,306,079

 
100
%
 

(1)
Includes Eurodollar sweep balances of $75.4 billion and $74.8 billion at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , respectively.

Fair Value of Financial Instruments
We use fair value measurements to record fair value adjustments to certain financial instruments and to determine fair value disclosures. See our 2016 Form 10-K for a description of our critical accounting policy related to fair value of financial instruments and a discussion of our fair value measurement techniques.
Table 10 presents the summary of the fair value of financial instruments recorded at fair value on a recurring basis, and the amounts measured using significant Level 3 inputs (before derivative netting adjustments). The fair value of the remaining assets and liabilities were measured using valuation methodologies involving market-based or market-derived information (collectively Level 1 and 2 measurements).
Table 10: Fair Value Level 3 Summary
 
June 30, 2017
 
 
December 31, 2016
 
($ in billions)
Total
balance

 
Level 3 (1)

 
Total
balance

 
Level 3 (1)

Assets carried
at fair value
$
402.8

 
24.2

 
436.3

 
23.5

As a percentage
of total assets
21
%
 
1

 
23

 
1

Liabilities carried
at fair value
$
28.5

 
1.9

 
30.9

 
1.7

As a percentage of
total liabilities
2
%
 
*

 
2

 
*

* Less than 1%.
(1)
Before derivative netting adjustments.

 
See Note 13 (Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities) to Financial Statements in this Report for additional information on fair value measurements and a description of the Level 1, 2 and 3 fair value hierarchy.

Equity
Total equity was $206.1 billion at June 30, 2017 , compared with $200.5 billion at December 31, 2016 . The increase was predominantly driven by a $6.4 billion increase in retained earnings from earnings net of dividends paid, partially offset by a net reduction in common stock due to repurchases.



22



Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements
In the ordinary course of business, we engage in financial transactions that are not recorded on the balance sheet, or may be recorded on the balance sheet in amounts that are different from the full contract or notional amount of the transaction. Our off-balance sheet arrangements include commitments to lend and purchase securities, transactions with unconsolidated entities, guarantees, derivatives, and other commitments. These transactions are designed to (1) meet the financial needs of customers, (2) manage our credit, market or liquidity risks, and/or (3) diversify our funding sources.
 
Commitments to Lend and Purchase Securities
We enter into commitments to lend funds to customers, which are usually at a stated interest rate, if funded, and for specific purposes and time periods. When we make commitments, we are exposed to credit risk. However, the maximum credit risk for these commitments will generally be lower than the contractual amount because a significant portion of these commitments is expected to expire without being used by the customer. For more information on lending commitments, see Note 5 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses) to Financial Statements in this Report. We also enter into commitments to purchase securities under resale agreements. For more information on commitments to purchase securities under resale agreements, see Note 3 (Federal Funds Sold, Securities Purchased under Resale Agreements and Other Short-Term Investments) to Financial Statements in this Report.
 
Transactions with Unconsolidated Entities
In the normal course of business, we enter into various types of on- and off-balance sheet transactions with special purpose entities (SPEs), which are corporations, trusts, limited liability companies or partnerships that are established for a limited purpose. Generally, SPEs are formed in connection with securitization transactions and are considered variable interest entities (VIEs). For more information on securitizations, including sales proceeds and cash flows from securitizations, see Note 7 (Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities) to Financial Statements in this Report.
 
Guarantees and Certain Contingent Arrangements
Guarantees are contracts that contingently require us to make payments to a guaranteed party based on an event or a change in an underlying asset, liability, rate or index. Guarantees are generally in the form of standby letters of credit, securities lending and other indemnifications, written put options, recourse obligations and other types of arrangements. For more information on guarantees and certain contingent arrangements, see Note 10 (Guarantees, Pledged Assets and Collateral) to Financial Statements in this Report.

Derivatives
We use derivatives to manage exposure to market risk, including interest rate risk, credit risk and foreign currency risk, and to assist customers with their risk management objectives. Derivatives are recorded on the balance sheet at fair value, and volume can be measured in terms of the notional amount, which is generally not exchanged but is used only as the basis on which interest and other payments are determined. The notional amount is not recorded on the balance sheet and is not, when viewed in isolation, a meaningful measure of the risk profile of the instruments. For more information on derivatives, see Note 12 (Derivatives) to Financial Statements in this Report.
 
Other Commitments
We also have other off-balance sheet transactions, including obligations to make rental payments under noncancelable operating leases and commitments to purchase certain debt and equity securities. Our operating lease obligations are discussed in Note 7 (Premises, Equipment, Lease Commitments and Other Assets) to Financial Statements in our 2016 Form 10-K. For more information on commitments to purchase debt and equity securities, see the “Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements – Contractual Cash Obligations” section in our 2016 Form 10-K.


23


Risk Management
Wells Fargo manages a variety of risks that can significantly affect our financial performance and our ability to meet the expectations of our customers, stockholders, regulators and other stakeholders. Among the risks that we manage are conduct risk, operational risk, credit risk, and asset/liability management related risks, which include interest rate risk, market risk, liquidity risk, and funding related risks. We operate under a Board-level approved risk framework which outlines our company-wide approach to risk management and oversight, and describes the structures and practices employed to manage current and emerging risks inherent to Wells Fargo. For more information about how we manage these risks, see the “Risk Management” section in our 2016 Form 10-K. The discussion that follows provides an update regarding these risks.
Conduct Risk Management
Our Board oversees the alignment of team member conduct to the Company’s risk appetite (which the Board approves annually) and culture as reflected in our Vision and Values and Code of Ethics and Business Conduct. The Board’s Risk Committee has primary oversight responsibility for enterprise-wide conduct risk, while certain other Board committees have primary oversight responsibility for specific components of conduct risk.
At the management level, several committees have primary oversight responsibility for key elements of conduct risk, including internal investigations, sales practices oversight, complaints oversight, and ethics oversight. These management-level committees have escalation and informational reporting paths to the relevant Board committee.
Our Office of Ethics, Oversight and Integrity, which reports to our Chief Risk Officer and has an informational reporting path to the Board's Risk Committee, is responsible for fostering and promoting an enterprise-wide culture of prudent conduct risk management and compliance with internal directives, rules, regulations, and regulatory expectations throughout the Company and to provide assurance that the Company’s internal operations and its treatment of customers and other external stakeholders are safe and sound, fair, and ethical.

Operational Risk Management
Operational risk is the risk of loss resulting from inadequate or failed internal controls and processes, people and systems, or resulting from external events. These losses may be caused by events such as fraud, breaches of customer privacy, business disruptions, vendors that do not adequately or appropriately perform their responsibilities, and regulatory fines and penalties.
Information security is a significant operational risk for financial institutions such as Wells Fargo, and includes the risk of losses resulting from cyber attacks. Wells Fargo and other financial institutions continue to be the target of various evolving and adaptive cyber attacks, including malware and denial-of-service, as part of an effort to disrupt the operations of financial institutions, potentially test their cybersecurity capabilities, or obtain confidential, proprietary or other information. Cyber attacks have also focused on targeting the infrastructure of the internet, causing the widespread unavailability of websites and degrading website performance. Wells Fargo has not experienced any material losses relating to these or other cyber attacks. Addressing cybersecurity risks is a priority for Wells Fargo, and we continue to develop and enhance our controls, processes and systems in order to protect our networks, computers, software and data from attack, damage or unauthorized access. We are
 
also proactively involved in industry cybersecurity efforts and working with other parties, including our third-party service providers and governmental agencies, to continue to enhance defenses and improve resiliency to cybersecurity threats. See the “Risk Factors” section in our 2016 Form 10-K for additional information regarding the risks associated with a failure or breach of our operational or security systems or infrastructure, including as a result of cyber attacks.

Credit Risk Management
We define credit risk as the risk of loss associated with a borrower or counterparty default (failure to meet obligations in accordance with agreed upon terms). Credit risk exists with many of our assets and exposures such as debt security holdings, certain derivatives, and loans. The following discussion focuses on our loan portfolios, which represent the largest component of assets on our balance sheet for which we have credit risk.  Table 11 presents our total loans outstanding by portfolio segment and class of financing receivable.
Table 11: Total Loans Outstanding by Portfolio Segment and Class of Financing Receivable
(in millions)
Jun 30, 2017

 
Dec 31, 2016

Commercial:
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
331,113

 
330,840

Real estate mortgage
130,277

 
132,491

Real estate construction
25,337

 
23,916

Lease financing
19,174

 
19,289

Total commercial
505,901

 
506,536

Consumer:
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
276,566

 
275,579

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
42,747

 
46,237

Credit card
35,305

 
36,700

Automobile
57,958

 
62,286

Other revolving credit and installment
38,946

 
40,266

Total consumer
451,522

 
461,068

Total loans
$
957,423

 
967,604


We manage our credit risk by establishing what we believe are sound credit policies for underwriting new business, while monitoring and reviewing the performance of our existing loan portfolios. We employ various credit risk management and monitoring activities to mitigate risks associated with multiple risk factors affecting loans we hold, could acquire or originate including:
Loan concentrations and related credit quality
Counterparty credit risk
Economic and market conditions
Legislative or regulatory mandates
Changes in interest rates
Merger and acquisition activities
Reputation risk

Our credit risk management oversight process is governed centrally, but provides for decentralized management and accountability by our lines of business. Our overall credit process

24



includes comprehensive credit policies, disciplined credit underwriting, frequent and detailed risk measurement and modeling, extensive credit training programs, and a continual loan review and audit process.
A key to our credit risk management is adherence to a well-controlled underwriting process, which we believe is appropriate for the needs of our customers as well as investors who purchase the loans or securities collateralized by the loans.
Credit Quality Overview   Credit quality improved in second quarter 2017 , as our loss rate improved to 0.27% (annualized) of average total loans. We continued to benefit from improvements in the performance of our residential real estate portfolio as well as reduced losses in our oil and gas portfolio. In particular:
Nonaccrual loans were $9.1 billion at June 30, 2017 , down from $10.4 billion at December 31, 2016 . Commercial nonaccrual loans declined to $3.4 billion at June 30, 2017 , compared with $4.1 billion at December 31, 2016 , and consumer nonaccrual loans declined to $5.7 billion at June 30, 2017 , compared with $6.3 billion at December 31, 2016 . The decline in consumer nonaccrual loans reflected an improved housing market, while the decline in commercial nonaccrual loans was predominantly driven by loans in our oil and gas portfolio. Nonaccrual loans represented 0.95% of total loans at June 30, 2017 , compared with 1.07% at December 31, 2016 .
Net charge-offs (annualized) as a percentage of average total loans decreased to 0.27% and 0.31% in the second quarter and first half of 2017 , respectively, compared with 0.39% in the same periods a year ago. Net charge-offs (annualized) as a percentage of our average commercial and consumer portfolios were 0.06% and 0.51% in the second quarter and 0.09% and 0.55% in the first half of 2017 , respectively, compared with 0.29% and 0.49% in the second quarter and 0.25% and 0.53% in the first half of 2016 .
Loans that are not government insured/guaranteed and 90 days or more past due and still accruing were $54 million and $789 million in our commercial and consumer portfolios, respectively, at June 30, 2017 , compared with $64 million and $908 million at December 31, 2016 .
Our provision for credit losses was $555 million and $1.2 billion in the second quarter and first half of 2017 , respectively, compared with $1.1 billion and $2.2 billion for the same periods a year ago.
The allowance for credit losses totaled $12.1 billion , or 1.27% of total loans, at June 30, 2017 , down from $12.5 billion , or 1.30% , at December 31, 2016 .
 
Additional information on our loan portfolios and our credit quality trends follows.


 
PURCHASED CREDIT-IMPAIRED (PCI) LOANS Loans acquired with evidence of credit deterioration since their origination and where it is probable that we will not collect all contractually required principal and interest payments are PCI loans. Substantially all of our PCI loans were acquired in the Wachovia acquisition on December 31, 2008. PCI loans are recorded at fair value at the date of acquisition, and the historical allowance for credit losses related to these loans is not carried over. The carrying value of PCI loans at June 30, 2017 , totaled $14.3 billion , compared with $16.7 billion at December 31, 2016 , and $58.8 billion at December 31, 2008. The decrease from December 31, 2016, was due in part to higher prepayment trends observed in our Pick-a-Pay PCI portfolio, as home price appreciation and the resulting reduction in loan to collateral value ratios enabled more borrowers to qualify for refinancing options, as well as the sale of $569 million of Pick-a-Pay PCI loans in second quarter 2017. PCI loans are considered to be accruing due to the existence of the accretable yield amount, which represents the cash expected to be collected in excess of their carrying value, and not based on consideration given to contractual interest payments. The accretable yield at June 30, 2017 , was $9.4 billion .
A nonaccretable difference is established for PCI loans to absorb losses expected on the contractual amounts of those loans in excess of the fair value recorded at the date of acquisition. Amounts absorbed by the nonaccretable difference do not affect the income statement or the allowance for credit losses. Since December 31, 2008, we have released $13.3 billion in nonaccretable difference, including $11.3 billion transferred from the nonaccretable difference to the accretable yield due to decreases in our initial estimate of loss on contractual amounts, and $2.0 billion released to income through loan resolutions. Also, we have provided $1.7 billion for losses on certain PCI loans or pools of PCI loans that have had credit-related decreases to cash flows expected to be collected. The net result is an $11.6 billion reduction from December 31, 2008, through June 30, 2017 , in our initial projected losses of $41.0 billion on all PCI loans acquired in the Wachovia acquisition. At June 30, 2017 , $649 million in nonaccretable difference remained to absorb losses on PCI loans.
For additional information on PCI loans, see the “Risk Management – Credit Risk Management – Real Estate 1-4 Family First and Junior Lien Mortgage Loans – Pick-a-Pay Portfolio” section in this Report, Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) to Financial Statements in our 2016 Form 10-K, and Note 5 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses) to Financial Statements in this Report.


25


Significant Loan Portfolio Reviews Measuring and monitoring our credit risk is an ongoing process that tracks delinquencies, collateral values, FICO scores, economic trends by geographic areas, loan-level risk grading for certain portfolios (typically commercial) and other indications of credit risk. Our credit risk monitoring process is designed to enable early identification of developing risk and to support our determination of an appropriate allowance for credit losses. The following discussion provides additional characteristics and analysis of our significant portfolios. See Note 5 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses) to Financial Statements in this Report for more analysis and credit metric information for each of the following portfolios.

COMMERCIAL AND INDUSTRIAL LOANS AND LEASE FINANCING   For purposes of portfolio risk management, we aggregate commercial and industrial loans and lease financing according to market segmentation and standard industry codes. We generally subject commercial and industrial loans and lease financing to individual risk assessment using our internal borrower and collateral quality ratings. Our ratings are aligned to regulatory definitions of pass and criticized categories with criticized divided between special mention, substandard, doubtful and loss categories.
The commercial and industrial loans and lease financing portfolio totaled $350.3 billion , or 37% of total loans, at June 30, 2017 . The annualized net charge-off rate for this portfolio was 0.10% and 0.15% in the second quarter and first half of 2017 , respectively, compared with 0.45% and 0.40% for the same periods a year ago. At June 30, 2017 , 0.78% of this portfolio was nonaccruing, compared with 0.95% at December 31, 2016 , reflecting a decrease of $610 million in nonaccrual loans, predominantly due to improvement in the oil and gas portfolio. Also, $20.3 billion of the commercial and industrial loan and lease financing portfolio was internally classified as criticized in accordance with regulatory guidance at June 30, 2017 , compared with $24.0 billion at December 31, 2016 . The decrease in criticized loans, which also includes the decrease in nonaccrual loans, was mostly due to improvement in the oil and gas portfolio.
Most of our commercial and industrial loans and lease financing portfolio is secured by short-term assets, such as accounts receivable, inventory and securities, as well as long-lived assets, such as equipment and other business assets. Generally, the collateral securing this portfolio represents a secondary source of repayment.
Table 12 provides a breakout of commercial and industrial loans and lease financing by industry, and includes $58.9 billion of foreign loans at June 30, 2017 . Foreign loans totaled $18.8 billion within the investor category, $15.8 billion within the financial institutions category and $1.4 billion within the oil and gas category.
The investors category includes loans to special purpose vehicles (SPVs) formed by sponsoring entities to invest in financial assets backed predominantly by commercial and residential real estate or corporate cash flow, and are repaid from the asset cash flows or the sale of assets by the SPV. We limit loan amounts to a percentage of the value of the underlying assets, as determined by us, based on analysis of underlying credit risk and other factors such as asset duration and ongoing performance.
 
We provide financial institutions with a variety of relationship focused products and services, including loans supporting short-term trade finance and working capital needs. The $15.8 billion of foreign loans in the financial institutions category were predominantly originated by our Financial Institutions business.
The oil and gas loan portfolio totaled $12.7 billion , or 1% of total outstanding loans at June 30, 2017 , compared with $14.8 billion , or 2% of total outstanding loans, at December 31, 2016 . Unfunded loan commitments in the oil and gas loan portfolio totaled $22.9 billion at June 30, 2017 . Almost half of our oil and gas loans were to businesses in the exploration and production (E&P) sector. Most of these E&P loans are secured by oil and/or gas reserves and have underlying borrowing base arrangements which include regular (typically semi-annual) “redeterminations” that consider refinements to borrowing structure and prices used to determine borrowing limits. The majority of the other oil and gas loans were to midstream companies. We proactively monitor our oil and gas loan portfolio and work with customers to address any emerging issues. Oil and gas nonaccrual loans decreased to $1.8 billion at June 30, 2017 , compared with $2.4 billion at December 31, 2016 , due to improved portfolio performance.
Table 12: Commercial and Industrial Loans and Lease Financing by Industry (1)
 
June 30, 2017
 
(in millions)
Nonaccrual
loans

 
Total
portfolio

 
(2)
 
% of
total
loans

Investors
$
7

 
61,744

 
 
 
6
%
Financial institutions
2

 
38,160

 
 
 
4

Cyclical retailers
84

 
26,987

 
 
 
3

Food and beverage
10

 
16,523

 
 
 
2

Healthcare
27

 
16,277

 
 
 
2

Industrial equipment
189

 
14,984

 
 
 
2

Real estate lessor
9

 
14,775

 
 
 
2

Technology
48

 
13,451

 
 
 
1

Oil and gas
1,823

 
12,723

 
 
 
1

Transportation
135

 
9,516

 
 
 
1

Public administration
58

 
9,349

 
 
 
1

Business services
27

 
8,451

 
 
 
1

Other
302

 
107,347

 
(3)
 
11

Total
$
2,721

 
350,287

 
 
 
37
%
(1)
Industry categories are based on the North American Industry Classification System and the amounts reported include foreign loans. See Note 5 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses) to Financial Statements in this Report for a breakout of commercial foreign loans.
(2)
Includes $131 million of PCI loans, which are considered to be accruing due to the existence of the accretable yield and not based on consideration given to contractual interest payments.
(3)
No other single industry had total loans in excess of $6.9 billion

26

Risk Management - Credit Risk Management ( continued )

COMMERCIAL REAL ESTATE (CRE) We generally subject CRE loans to individual risk assessment using our internal borrower and collateral quality ratings. Our ratings are aligned to regulatory definitions of pass and criticized categories with criticized divided among special mention, substandard, doubtful and loss categories. The CRE portfolio, which included $8.9 billion of foreign CRE loans, totaled $155.6 billion , or 16% of total loans, at June 30, 2017 , and consisted of $130.3 billion of mortgage loans and $25.3 billion of construction loans.
Table 13 summarizes CRE loans by state and property type with the related nonaccrual totals. The portfolio is diversified both geographically and by property type. The largest geographic concentrations of CRE loans are in California, New York, Texas and Florida, which combined represented 49% of the total CRE
 
portfolio. By property type, the largest concentrations are office buildings at 28% and apartments at 16% of the portfolio. CRE nonaccrual loans totaled 0.4% of the CRE outstanding balance at June 30, 2017 , compared with 0.5% at December 31, 2016 . At June 30, 2017 , we had $4.9 billion of criticized CRE mortgage loans, compared with $5.4 billion at December 31, 2016 , and $320 million of criticized CRE construction loans, compared with $461 million at December 31, 2016 .
At June 30, 2017 , the recorded investment in PCI CRE loans totaled $132 million , down from $12.3 billion when acquired at December 31, 2008, reflecting principal payments, loan resolutions and write-downs.
Table 13: CRE Loans by State and Property Type
 
June 30, 2017
 
 
Real estate mortgage
 
 
 
 
Real estate construction
 
 
 
 
Total
 
 
 
 
 
(in millions)
Nonaccrual
loans

 
Total
portfolio

 
(1)
 
Nonaccrual
loans

 
Total
portfolio

 
(1)
 
Nonaccrual
loans

 
Total
portfolio

 
(1)
 
% of
total
loans

By state:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
California
$
132

 
37,277

 
 
 

 
4,747

 
 
 
132

 
42,024

 
 
 
4
%
New York
29

 
9,935

 
 
 

 
2,932

 
 
 
29

 
12,867

 
 
 
1

Texas
96

 
9,393

 
 
 

 
2,378

 
 
 
96

 
11,771

 
 
 
1

Florida
36

 
8,103

 
 
 
1

 
1,875

 
 
 
37

 
9,978

 
 
 
1

North Carolina
31

 
4,055

 
 
 
6

 
857

 
 
 
37

 
4,912

 
 
 
1

Arizona
26

 
4,020

 
 
 

 
609

 
 
 
26

 
4,629

 
 
 
*

Georgia
19

 
3,555

 
 
 
1

 
860

 
 
 
20

 
4,415

 
 
 
*

Washington
19

 
3,546

 
 
 

 
866

 
 
 
19

 
4,412

 
 
 
*

Virginia
12

 
3,395

 
 
 

 
864

 
 
 
12

 
4,259

 
 
 
*

Illinois
5

 
3,756

 
 
 

 
350

 
 
 
5

 
4,106

 
 
 
*

Other
225

 
43,242

 
 
 
26

 
8,999

 
 
 
251

 
52,241

 
(2)
 
5

Total
$
630

 
130,277

 
 
 
34

 
25,337

 
 
 
664

 
155,614

 
 
 
16
%
By property:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Office buildings
$
126

 
39,975

 
 
 

 
3,326

 
 
 
126

 
43,301

 
 
 
5
%
Apartments
24

 
15,741

 
 
 

 
9,300

 
 
 
24

 
25,041

 
 
 
3

Retail (excluding shopping center)
93

 
17,236

 
 
 

 
709

 
 
 
93

 
17,945

 
 
 
2

Industrial/warehouse
135

 
14,832

 
 
 

 
1,887

 
 
 
135

 
16,719

 
 
 
2

Shopping center
24

 
11,469

 
 
 

 
1,274

 
 
 
24

 
12,743

 
 
 
1

Hotel/motel
8

 
10,388

 
 
 
4

 
1,630

 
 
 
12

 
12,018

 
 
 
1

Real estate - other
97

 
7,360

 
 
 

 
168

 
 
 
97

 
7,528

 
 
 
1

Institutional
30

 
3,080

 
 
 

 
1,392

 
 
 
30

 
4,472

 
 
 
*

Agriculture
32

 
2,586

 
 
 

 
17

 
 
 
32

 
2,603

 
 
 
*

1-4 family structure

 
10

 
 
 
7

 
2,520

 
 
 
7

 
2,530

 
 
 
*

Other
61

 
7,600

 
 
 
23

 
3,114

 
 
 
84

 
10,714

 
 
 
1

Total
$
630

 
130,277

 
 
 
34

 
25,337

 
 
 
664

 
155,614

 
 
 
16
%
*
Less than 1%.
(1)
Includes a total of $132 million PCI loans, consisting of $119 million of real estate mortgage and $13 million of real estate construction, which are considered to be accruing due to the existence of the accretable yield and not based on consideration given to contractual interest payments.
(2)
Includes 40 states; no state had loans in excess of $3.6 billion .


27


FOREIGN LOANS AND COUNTRY RISK EXPOSURE We classify loans for financial statement and certain regulatory purposes as foreign primarily based on whether the borrower’s primary address is outside of the United States. At June 30, 2017 , foreign loans totaled $68.3 billion , representing approximately 7% of our total consolidated loans outstanding, compared with $65.7 billion , or approximately 7% of total consolidated loans outstanding, at December 31, 2016 . Foreign loans were approximately 4%  of our consolidated total assets at June 30, 2017 and 3% at December 31, 2016 .
Our country risk monitoring process incorporates frequent dialogue with our financial institution customers, counterparties and regulatory agencies, enhanced by centralized monitoring of macroeconomic and capital markets conditions in the respective countries. We establish exposure limits for each country through a centralized oversight process based on customer needs, and in consideration of relevant economic, political, social, legal, and transfer risks. We monitor exposures closely and adjust our country limits in response to changing conditions.
We evaluate our individual country risk exposure based on our assessment of the borrower’s ability to repay, which gives consideration for allowable transfers of risk such as guarantees and collateral and may be different from the reporting based on the borrower’s primary address. Our largest single foreign country exposure based on our assessment of risk at June 30, 2017 , was the United Kingdom, which totaled $26.8 billion , or approximately 1% of our total assets, and included $4.8 billion of sovereign claims. Our United Kingdom sovereign claims arise predominantly from deposits we have placed with the Bank of England pursuant to regulatory requirements in support of our London branch. The United Kingdom officially announced its intention to leave the European Union (Brexit) on March 29, 2017, starting the two-year negotiation process leading to its departure. We continue to conduct assessments and are executing our implementation plans to ensure we can continue to prudently serve our customers post-Brexit.
 
We conduct periodic stress tests of our significant country risk exposures, analyzing the direct and indirect impacts on the risk of loss from various macroeconomic and capital markets scenarios. We do not have significant exposure to foreign country risks because our foreign credit exposure is relatively small. However, we have identified exposure to increased loss from U.S. borrowers associated with the potential impact of a regional or worldwide economic downturn on the U.S. economy. We seek to mitigate these potential impacts on the risk of loss through our normal risk management processes which include active monitoring and, if necessary, the application of aggressive loss mitigation strategies.
Table 14 provides information regarding our top 20 exposures by country (excluding the U.S.) and our Eurozone exposure, based on our assessment of risk, which gives consideration to the country of any guarantors and/or underlying collateral. Our exposure to Puerto Rico (considered part of U.S. exposure) is largely through automobile lending and was not material to our consolidated country exposure. We do not expect Puerto Rico's recent bankruptcy announcement to significantly impact these exposures.

28

Risk Management - Credit Risk Management ( continued )

Table 14: Select Country Exposures -
 
June 30, 2017
 
 
Lending (1)
 
 
Securities (2)
 
 
Derivatives and other (3)
 
 
Total exposure
 
(in millions)
Sovereign

 
Non-
sovereign

 
Sovereign

 
Non-
sovereign

 
Sovereign

 
Non-
sovereign

 
Sovereign

 
Non-
sovereign (4)

 
Total

Top 20 country exposures:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
United Kingdom
$
4,752

 
19,840

 
4

 
1,646

 

 
587

 
4,756

 
22,073

 
26,829

Canada
23

 
17,875

 
118

 
137

 

 
608

 
141

 
18,620

 
18,761

Cayman Islands

 
6,098

 

 

 

 
159

 

 
6,257

 
6,257

Germany
2,790

 
1,334

 
39

 
16

 
4

 
374

 
2,833

 
1,724

 
4,557

Ireland

 
3,597

 

 
100

 

 
111

 

 
3,808

 
3,808

Bermuda

 
2,819

 

 
173

 

 
198

 

 
3,190

 
3,190

Netherlands

 
2,375

 
21

 
361

 
2

 
160

 
23

 
2,896

 
2,919

China

 
2,577

 
(2
)
 
152

 
19

 
45

 
17

 
2,774

 
2,791

India
200

 
1,865

 

 
168

 

 

 
200

 
2,033

 
2,233

Australia

 
1,407

 

 
654

 

 
49

 

 
2,110

 
2,110

Luxembourg

 
1,232

 

 
640

 

 
68

 

 
1,940

 
1,940

Brazil

 
1,901

 

 
38

 

 

 

 
1,939

 
1,939

Guernsey

 
1,879

 

 
(2
)
 

 
3

 

 
1,880

 
1,880

Switzerland

 
1,246

 

 
(18
)
 

 
140

 

 
1,368

 
1,368

Mexico
149

 
1,123

 
1

 
4

 

 
6

 
150

 
1,133

 
1,283

Chile

 
1,272

 

 
10

 
1

 

 
1

 
1,282

 
1,283

South Korea

 
1,207

 
6

 
54

 
1

 
2

 
7

 
1,263

 
1,270

France

 
847

 

 
154

 

 
159

 

 
1,160

 
1,160

Japan
315

 
675

 
6

 
62

 

 
99

 
321

 
836

 
1,157

Jersey, Channel Islands

 
671

 

 
236

 

 
17

 

 
924

 
924

Total top 20 country exposures
$
8,229

 
71,840

 
193

 
4,585

 
27

 
2,785

 
8,449

 
79,210

 
87,659

Eurozone exposure:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Eurozone countries included in Top 20 above (5)
$
2,790

 
9,385

 
60

 
1,271

 
6

 
872

 
2,856

 
11,528

 
14,384

Austria

 
581

 

 
(1
)
 

 
1

 

 
581

 
581

Spain

 
309

 

 
46

 

 
21

 

 
376

 
376

Belgium

 
295

 

 
(19
)
 

 
1

 

 
277

 
277

Other Eurozone exposure (6)
23

 
223

 

 
44

 

 

 
23

 
267

 
290

Total Eurozone exposure
$
2,813

 
10,793

 
60

 
1,341

 
6

 
895

 
2,879

 
13,029

 
15,908

(1)
Lending exposure includes funded loans and unfunded commitments, leveraged leases, and money market placements presented on a gross basis prior to the deduction of impairment allowance and collateral received under the terms of the credit agreements. For the countries listed above, includes $16 million in PCI loans to customers in Germany and the Netherlands, and $753 million in defeased leases secured primarily by U.S. Treasury and government agency securities.
(2)
Represents exposure on debt and equity securities of foreign issuers. Long and short positions are netted and net short positions are reflected as negative exposure.
(3)
Represents counterparty exposure on foreign exchange and derivative contracts, and securities resale and lending agreements. This exposure is presented net of counterparty netting adjustments and reduced by the amount of cash collateral. It includes credit default swaps (CDS) predominantly used for market making activities in the U.S. and London based trading businesses, which sometimes results in selling and purchasing protection on the identical reference entities. Generally, we do not use market instruments such as CDS to hedge the credit risk of our investment or loan positions, although we do use them to manage risk in our trading businesses At June 30, 2017 , the gross notional amount of our CDS sold that reference assets in the Top 20 or Eurozone countries was $316 million , which was offset by the notional amount of CDS purchased of $404 million . We did not have any CDS purchased or sold that reference pools of assets that contain sovereign debt or where the reference asset was solely the sovereign debt of a foreign country.
(4)
For countries presented in the table, total non-sovereign exposure comprises $32.9 billion exposure to financial institutions and $47.8 billion to non-financial corporations at June 30, 2017 .
(5)
Consists of exposure to Germany, Ireland, Netherlands, Luxembourg, and France included in Top 20.
(6)
Includes non-sovereign exposure to Italy, Portugal, and Greece in the amount of $132 million , $27 million and $3 million , respectively. We had no sovereign debt exposure in these countries at June 30, 2017 .

29


REAL ESTATE 1-4 FAMILY FIRST AND JUNIOR LIEN MORTGAGE LOANS   Our real estate 1-4 family first and junior lien mortgage loans, as presented in Table 15 , include loans we have made to customers and retained as part of our asset/liability management strategy, the Pick-a-Pay portfolio acquired from
 
Wachovia which is discussed later in this Report and other purchased loans, and loans included on our balance sheet as a result of consolidation of variable interest entities (VIEs).
Table 15: Real Estate 1-4 Family First and Junior Lien Mortgage Loans
 
June 30, 2017
 
 
December 31, 2016
 
(in millions)
Balance

 
% of
portfolio

 
Balance

 
% of
portfolio

Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
$
276,566

 
87
%
 
$
275,579

 
86
%
Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
42,747

 
13

 
46,237

 
14

Total real estate 1-4 family mortgage loans
$
319,313

 
100
%
 
$
321,816

 
100
%

The real estate 1-4 family mortgage loan portfolio includes some loans with adjustable-rate features and some with an interest-only feature as part of the loan terms. Interest-only loans were approximately 6% and 7% of total loans at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , respectively. We believe we have manageable adjustable-rate mortgage (ARM) reset risk across our owned mortgage loan portfolios. We do not offer option ARM products, nor do we offer variable-rate mortgage products with fixed payment amounts, commonly referred to within the financial services industry as negative amortizing mortgage loans. The option ARMs we do have are included in the Pick-a-Pay portfolio which was acquired from Wachovia. Since our acquisition of the Pick-a-Pay loan portfolio at the end of 2008, the option payment portion of the portfolio has reduced from 86% to 37% at June 30, 2017 , as a result of our modification and loss mitigation efforts. For more information, see the “Pick-a-Pay Portfolio” section in this Report.
We continue to modify real estate 1-4 family mortgage loans to assist homeowners and other borrowers experiencing financial difficulties. For more information on our modification programs, see the “Risk Management – Credit Risk Management – Real Estate 1-4 Family First and Junior Lien Mortgage Loans” section in our 2016 Form 10-K.
Part of our credit monitoring includes tracking delinquency, current FICO scores and loan/combined loan to collateral values (LTV/CLTV) on the entire real estate 1-4 family mortgage loan portfolio. These credit risk indicators, which exclude government insured/guaranteed loans, continued to improve in second quarter 2017 on the non-PCI mortgage portfolio. Loans 30 days or more delinquent at June 30, 2017 , totaled $5.0 billion , or 2% of total non-PCI mortgages, compared with $5.9 billion , or 2% , at December 31, 2016 . Loans with FICO scores lower than 640 totaled $13.1 billion , or 4% of total non-PCI mortgages at June 30, 2017 , compared with $16.6 billion , or 5% , at December 31, 2016 . Mortgages with a LTV/CLTV greater than 100% totaled $7.8 billion at June 30, 2017 , or 3% of total non-PCI mortgages, compared with $8.9 billion , or 3% , at December 31, 2016 . Information regarding credit quality indicators, including PCI credit quality indicators, can be found in Note 5 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses) to Financial Statements in this Report.
Real estate 1-4 family first and junior lien mortgage loans by state are presented in Table 16 . Our real estate 1-4 family mortgage loans (including PCI loans) to borrowers in California represented approximately 12% of total loans at June 30, 2017 , located mostly within the larger metropolitan areas, with no single California metropolitan area consisting of more than 5% of total loans. We monitor changes in real estate values and underlying economic or market conditions for all geographic areas of our real estate 1-4 family mortgage portfolio as part of
 
our credit risk management process. Our underwriting and periodic review of loans secured by residential real estate collateral includes appraisals or estimates from automated valuation models (AVMs) to support property values. Additional information about AVMs and our policy for their use can be found in Note 5 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses) to Financial Statements in this Report and the “Risk Management – Credit Risk Management – Real Estate 1-4 Family First and Junior Lien Mortgage Loans” section in our 2016 Form 10-K.
Table 16: Real Estate 1-4 Family First and Junior Lien Mortgage Loans by State
 
June 30, 2017
 
(in millions)
Real estate
1-4 family
first
mortgage

 
Real estate
1-4 family
junior lien
mortgage

 
Total real
estate 1-4
family
mortgage

 
% of
total
loans

Real estate 1-4 family loans (excluding PCI):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
California
$
96,603

 
11,516

 
108,119

 
11
%
New York
25,145

 
2,058

 
27,203

 
3

Florida
13,411

 
3,948

 
17,359

 
2

New Jersey
12,831

 
3,809

 
16,640

 
2

Virginia
7,718

 
2,519

 
10,237

 
1

Texas
8,688

 
763

 
9,451

 
1

Washington
8,240

 
945

 
9,185

 
1

North Carolina
6,054

 
1,994

 
8,048

 
1

Pennsylvania
5,667

 
2,345

 
8,012

 
1

Other (1)
64,641

 
12,819

 
77,460

 
8

Government insured/
guaranteed loans (2)
13,589

 

 
13,589

 
1

Real estate 1-4 family loans (excluding PCI)
262,587

 
42,716

 
305,303

 
32

Real estate 1-4 family PCI loans (3)
13,979

 
31

 
14,010

 
1

Total
$
276,566

 
42,747

 
319,313

 
33
%
(1)
Consists of 41 states; no state had loans in excess of $7.0 billion .
(2)
Represents loans whose repayments are predominantly insured by the Federal Housing Administration (FHA) or guaranteed by the Department of Veterans Affairs (VA).
(3)
Includes $9.5 billion in real estate 1-4 family mortgage PCI loans in California.


30

Risk Management - Credit Risk Management ( continued )

First Lien Mortgage Portfolio   Our total real estate 1-4 family first lien mortgage portfolio increased $1.9 billion in second quarter 2017 and $987 million in the first half of 2017 , as non-conforming loan growth was partially offset by a decline in Pick-a-Pay loan balances. We retained $13.2 billion and $22.4 billion in non-conforming originations, consisting of loans that exceed conventional conforming loan amount limits established by federal government-sponsored entities (GSEs) in the second quarter and first half of 2017 , respectively.
The credit performance associated with our real estate 1-4 family first lien mortgage portfolio continued to improve in second quarter 2017 , as measured through net charge-offs and nonaccrual loans. Net charge-offs (annualized) as a percentage of average real estate 1-4 family first lien mortgage loans improved
 
to a net recovery of 0.02% and 0.01% in the second quarter and first half of 2017 , respectively, compared with a net charge-off of 0.02% and 0.05% for the same periods a year ago. Nonaccrual loans were $4.4 billion at June 30, 2017 , compared with $5.0 billion at December 31, 2016 . Improvement in the credit performance was driven by an improving housing environment. Real estate 1-4 family first lien mortgage loans originated after 2008, which generally utilized tighter underwriting standards, have resulted in minimal losses to date and were approximately 76% of our total real estate 1-4 family first lien mortgage portfolio as of June 30, 2017 .
Table 17 shows certain delinquency and loss information for the first lien mortgage portfolio and lists the top five states by outstanding balance.
Table 17: First Lien Mortgage Portfolio Performance
 
Outstanding balance
 
 
% of loans 30 days or more past due
 
Loss (recovery) rate (annualized) quarter ended
 
(in millions)
Jun 30,
2017

Dec 31,
2016

 
Jun 30,
2017

Dec 31,
2016
 
Jun 30,
2017

Mar 31,
2017

Dec 31,
2016

Sep 30,
2016

Jun 30,
2016

California
$
96,603

94,015

 
1.00
%
1.21
 
(0.08
)
(0.05
)
(0.08
)
(0.08
)
(0.09
)
New York
25,145

23,815

 
1.67

1.97
 
0.02

0.06

0.04

0.07

0.11

Florida
13,411

13,737

 
3.11

3.62
 
(0.18
)
(0.08
)
(0.18
)
(0.04
)
(0.19
)
New Jersey
12,831

12,669

 
2.89

3.66
 
0.17

0.22

0.21

0.37

0.42

Texas
8,688

8,584

 
1.89

2.19
 

(0.01
)
(0.01
)
0.06

0.09

Other
92,320

91,136

 
2.09

2.51
 
0.01

0.05

0.06

0.10

0.10

Total
248,998

243,956

 
1.71

2.07
 
(0.03
)
0.01


0.03

0.02

Government insured/guaranteed loans
13,589

15,605

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
PCI
13,979

16,018

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total first lien mortgages
$
276,566

275,579

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Pick-a-Pay Portfolio   The Pick-a-Pay portfolio was one of the consumer residential first lien mortgage portfolios we acquired from Wachovia and a majority of the portfolio was identified as PCI loans.
The Pick-a-Pay portfolio includes loans that offer payment options (Pick-a-Pay option payment loans), and also includes loans that were originated without the option payment feature, loans that no longer offer the option feature as a result of our modification efforts since the acquisition, and loans where the customer voluntarily converted to a fixed-rate product. The Pick-a-Pay portfolio is included in the consumer real estate 1-4 family
 
first mortgage class of loans throughout this Report. Table 18 provides balances by types of loans as of June 30, 2017 , as a result of modification efforts, compared to the types of loans included in the portfolio at acquisition. Total adjusted unpaid principal balance of PCI Pick-a-Pay loans was $18.1 billion at June 30, 2017 , compared with $61.0 billion at acquisition. Due to loan modification and loss mitigation efforts, the adjusted unpaid principal balance of option payment PCI loans has declined to 14% of the total Pick-a-Pay portfolio at June 30, 2017 , compared with 51% at acquisition.
Table 18: Pick-a-Pay Portfolio – Comparison to Acquisition Date
 
 
 
December 31,
 
 
June 30, 2017
 
 
2016
 
 
2008
 
(in millions)
Adjusted
unpaid
principal
balance (1)

 
% of
total

 
Adjusted
unpaid
principal
balance (1)

 
% of
total

 
Adjusted
unpaid
principal
balance (1)

 
% of
total

Option payment loans
$
12,099

 
37
%
 
$
13,618

 
37
%
 
$
99,937

 
86
%
Non-option payment adjustable-rate
and fixed-rate loans
4,148

 
13

 
4,630

 
13

 
15,763

 
14

Full-term loan modifications
16,589

 
50

 
18,598

 
50

 

 

Total adjusted unpaid principal balance
$
32,836

 
100
%
 
$
36,846

 
100
%
 
$
115,700

 
100
%
Total carrying value
$
28,696

 
 
 
32,292

 
 
 
95,615

 
 
(1)
Adjusted unpaid principal balance includes write-downs taken on loans where severe delinquency (normally 180 days) or other indications of severe borrower financial stress exist that indicate there will be a loss of contractually due amounts upon final resolution of the loan.

 

31


Table 19 reflects the geographic distribution of the Pick-a-Pay portfolio broken out between PCI loans and all other loans. The LTV ratio is a useful metric in evaluating future real estate 1-4 family first mortgage loan performance, including potential charge-offs. Because PCI loans were initially recorded at fair value, including write-downs for expected credit losses, the ratio
 
of the carrying value to the current collateral value will be lower compared with the LTV based on the adjusted unpaid principal balance. For informational purposes, we have included both ratios for PCI loans in the following table.
Table 19: Pick-a-Pay Portfolio (1)
 
June 30, 2017
 
 
PCI loans
 
 
All other loans
 
(in millions)
Adjusted
unpaid
principal
balance (2)

 
Current
LTV
ratio (3)

 
Carrying
value (4)

 
Ratio of
carrying
value to
current
value (5)

 
Carrying
value (4)

 
Ratio of
carrying
value to
current
value (5)

California
$
12,263

 
63
%
 
$
9,511

 
48
%
 
$
7,077

 
45
%
Florida
1,540

 
70

 
1,146

 
51

 
1,502

 
56

New Jersey
609

 
77

 
447

 
56

 
995

 
63

New York
458

 
70

 
360

 
51

 
497

 
60

Texas
141

 
49

 
108

 
37

 
598

 
38

Other
3,057

 
70

 
2,308

 
52

 
4,147

 
57

Total Pick-a-Pay loans
$
18,068

 
65

 
$
13,880

 
49

 
$
14,816

 
51

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1)
The individual states shown in this table represent the top five states based on the total net carrying value of the Pick-a-Pay loans at the beginning of 2017 .
(2)
Adjusted unpaid principal balance includes write-downs taken on loans where severe delinquency (normally 180 days) or other indications of severe borrower financial stress exist that indicate there will be a loss of contractually due amounts upon final resolution of the loan.
(3)
The current LTV ratio is calculated as the adjusted unpaid principal balance divided by the collateral value. Collateral values are generally determined using automated valuation models (AVM) and are updated quarterly. AVMs are computer-based tools used to estimate market values of homes based on processing large volumes of market data including market comparables and price trends for local market areas.
(4)
Carrying value does not reflect related allowance for loan losses but does reflect remaining purchase accounting adjustments and any charge-offs.
(5)
The ratio of carrying value to current value is calculated as the carrying value divided by the collateral value.

Since the Wachovia acquisition, we have completed over 137,500 proprietary and Home Affordability Modification Program (HAMP) Pick-a-Pay loan modifications, including over 600 modifications in second quarter 2017 . Pick-a-Pay loan modifications have resulted in over $6.1 billion of principal forgiveness since December 31, 2008. We have also provided interest rate reductions and loan term extensions to enable sustainable homeownership for our Pick-a-Pay customers. As a result of these loss mitigation programs, approximately 71% of our Pick-a-Pay PCI adjusted unpaid principal balance as of June 30, 2017 has been modified.
The predominant portion of our PCI loans is included in the Pick-a-Pay portfolio. We regularly evaluate our estimates, of cash flows expected to be collected on our PCI loans. Our cash flows expected to be collected have been favorably affected over time by lower expected defaults and losses as a result of observed and forecasted economic strengthening, particularly in housing prices, and our loan modification efforts. When we periodically update our cash flow estimates we have historically expected that the credit-stressed borrower characteristics and distressed collateral values associated with our Pick-a-Pay PCI loans would limit the ability of these borrowers to prepay their loans, thus increasing the future expected weighted-average life of the portfolio since acquisition. However, the higher prepayment trend that emerged in our Pick-a-Pay PCI loans portfolio in the prior year, which we attribute to the benefits of home price appreciation has continued to result in more loan (unpaid principal balance) to value ratios reaching an important industry refinancing inflection point of below 80% . As a result, we have continued to experience an increased level of borrowers qualifying for products to refinance their loans which may not have previously been available to them. Therefore, during first quarter 2017, we revised our Pick-a-Pay PCI loan cash flow estimates to reflect our expectation that the modified portion of the portfolio will have higher prepayments over the remainder of
 
its life. The increase in expected prepayments in the first quarter and passage of time lowered our estimated weighted-average life to approximately 6.4  years at June 30, 2017 , from 7.4 years at December 31, 2016 . During second quarter 2017, we sold $569 million of Pick-a-Pay PCI loans that resulted in a gain of $309 million . Also, the accretable yield balance related to our Pick-a-Pay PCI loan portfolio declined $916 million ( $946 million for all PCI loans) during second quarter 2017 , driven by realized accretion of $348 million ( $374 million for all PCI loans), $309 million from the gain on sale of the Pick-a-Pay PCI loans in second quarter 2017 and a $259 million reduction in expected interest cash flows resulting from the loan sale. The accretable yield percentage for Pick-a-Pay PCI loans for second quarter 2017 was 9.47%, up from 8.22% for fourth quarter 2016, due to an increase in the amount of accretable yield relative to the shortened weighted-average life. Due to the sale of the Pick-a-Pay PCI loans in second quarter 2017, we expect the accretable yield percentage to be 9.32% for third quarter 2017.
Since acquisition, due to better than expected performance observed on the PCI portion of the Pick-a-Pay portfolio compared with the original acquisition estimates, we have reclassified $8.7 billion from the nonaccretable difference to the accretable yield. Fluctuations in the accretable yield are driven by changes in interest rate indices for variable rate PCI loans, prepayment assumptions, and expected principal and interest payments over the estimated life of the portfolio, which will be affected by the pace and degree of improvements in the U.S. economy and housing markets and projected lifetime performance resulting from loan modification activity. Changes in the projected timing of cash flow events, including loan liquidations, modifications and short sales, can also affect the accretable yield and the estimated weighted-average life of the portfolio.
For further information on the judgment involved in estimating expected cash flows for PCI loans, see the “Critical Accounting Policies – Purchased Credit-Impaired Loans” section

32

Risk Management - Credit Risk Management ( continued )

and Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) to Financial Statements in our 2016 Form 10-K.
For further information on the Pick-a-Pay portfolio, including recast risk, deferral of interest and loan modifications, see the “Risk Management – Credit Risk Management – Pick-a-Pay Portfolio” section in our 2016 Form 10-K.
Junior Lien Mortgage Portfolio   The junior lien mortgage portfolio consists of residential mortgage lines and loans that are subordinate in rights to an existing lien on the same property. It is not unusual for these lines and loans to have draw periods, interest only payments, balloon payments, adjustable rates and similar features. Junior lien loan products are mostly amortizing payment loans with fixed interest rates and repayment periods between five to 30 years. 
We continuously monitor the credit performance of our junior lien mortgage portfolio for trends and factors that influence the frequency and severity of loss. We have observed that the severity of loss for junior lien mortgages is high and generally not affected by whether we or a third party own or service the related first lien mortgage, but the frequency of delinquency is typically lower when we own or service the first lien mortgage. In general, we have limited information available on the delinquency status of the third party owned or serviced senior lien where we also hold a junior lien. To capture this inherent loss content, our allowance process for junior lien
 
mortgages considers the relative difference in loss experience for junior lien mortgages behind first lien mortgage loans we own or service, compared with those behind first lien mortgage loans owned or serviced by third parties. In addition, our allowance process for junior lien mortgages that are current, but are in their revolving period, considers the inherent loss where the borrower is delinquent on the corresponding first lien mortgage loans.
Table 20 shows certain delinquency and loss information for the junior lien mortgage portfolio and lists the top five states by outstanding balance. The decrease in outstanding balances since December 31, 2016 , predominantly reflects loan paydowns. As of June 30, 2017 , 11% of the outstanding balance of the junior lien mortgage portfolio was associated with loans that had a combined loan to value (CLTV) ratio in excess of 100%. Of those junior lien mortgages with a CLTV ratio in excess of 100%, 2.60% were 30 days or more past due. CLTV means the ratio of the total loan balance of first lien mortgages and junior lien mortgages (including unused line amounts for credit line products) to property collateral value. The unsecured portion (the outstanding amount that was in excess of the most recent property collateral value) of the outstanding balances of these loans totaled 4% of the junior lien mortgage portfolio at June 30, 2017 . For additional information on consumer loans by LTV/CLTV, see Table 5.12 in Note 5 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses) to Financial Statements in this Report.
Table 20: Junior Lien Mortgage Portfolio Performance
 
Outstanding balance
 
 
% of loans 30 days or more past due
 
Loss (recovery) rate (annualized) quarter ended
 
(in millions)
Jun 30,
2017

 
Dec 31,
2016

 
Jun 30,
2017

 
Dec 31,
2016
 
Jun 30,
2017

 
Mar 31,
2017

 
Dec 31,
2016

 
Sep 30,
2016

 
Jun 30,
2016

California
$
11,516

 
12,539

 
1.82
%
 
1.86
 
(0.42
)
 
(0.37
)
 
(0.18
)
 
(0.13
)
 
0.07

Florida
3,948

 
4,252

 
2.19

 
2.17
 
(0.10
)
 
0.30

 
0.47

 
0.56

 
0.76

New Jersey
3,809

 
4,031

 
2.59

 
2.79
 
0.44

 
1.06

 
1.36

 
0.96

 
1.10

Virginia
2,519

 
2,696

 
1.94

 
1.97
 
0.17

 
0.48

 
0.67

 
0.55

 
0.87

Pennsylvania
2,345

 
2,494

 
1.94

 
2.07
 
0.29

 
0.67

 
1.01

 
0.75

 
0.58

Other
18,579

 
20,189

 
1.97

 
2.09
 
0.05

 
0.28

 
0.39

 
0.51

 
0.53

 Total
42,716


46,201

 
2.00

 
2.09
 
(0.03
)
 
0.21

 
0.38

 
0.40

 
0.49

PCI
31

 
36

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total junior lien mortgages
$
42,747

 
46,237

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 


33


Our junior lien, as well as first lien, lines of credit portfolios generally have draw periods of 10, 15 or 20 years with variable interest rate and payment options during the draw period of (1) interest only or (2) 1.5% of outstanding principal balance plus accrued interest. During the draw period, the borrower has the option of converting all or a portion of the line from a variable interest rate to a fixed rate with terms including interest-only payments for a fixed period between three to seven years or a fully amortizing payment with a fixed period between five to 30 years. At the end of the draw period, a line of credit generally converts to an amortizing payment schedule with repayment terms of up to 30 years based on the balance at time of conversion. Certain lines and loans have been structured with a balloon payment, which requires full repayment of the outstanding balance at the end of the term period. The conversion of lines or loans to fully amortizing or balloon payoff may result in a significant payment increase, which can affect some borrowers’ ability to repay the outstanding balance.
On a monthly basis, we monitor the payment characteristics of borrowers in our junior lien portfolio. In June 2017 , approximately 48% of these borrowers paid only the minimum amount due and approximately 46% paid more than the minimum amount due. The rest were either delinquent or paid less than the minimum amount due. For the borrowers with an
 
interest only payment feature, approximately 33% paid only the minimum amount due and approximately 62% paid more than the minimum amount due.
The lines that enter their amortization period may experience higher delinquencies and higher loss rates than the ones in their draw or term period. We have considered this increased inherent risk in our allowance for credit loss estimate.
In anticipation of our borrowers reaching the end of their contractual commitment, we have created a program to inform, educate and help these borrowers transition from interest-only to fully-amortizing payments or full repayment. We monitor the performance of the borrowers moving through the program in an effort to refine our ongoing program strategy.
Table 21 reflects the outstanding balance of our portfolio of junior lien mortgages, including lines and loans, and senior lien lines segregated into scheduled end of draw or end of term periods and products that are currently amortizing, or in balloon repayment status. It excludes real estate 1-4 family first lien line reverse mortgages, which total $151 million , because they are predominantly insured by the FHA, and it excludes PCI loans, which total $55 million , because their losses were generally reflected in our nonaccretable difference established at the date of acquisition.
Table 21: Junior Lien Mortgage Line and Loan and Senior Lien Mortgage Line Portfolios Payment Schedule
 
 
 
 
 
Scheduled end of draw / term
 
 
 
(in millions)
Outstanding balance June 30, 2017

 
Remainder of 2017

 
2018

 
2019

 
2020

 
2021

 
2022 and
thereafter (1)

 
Amortizing

Junior lien lines and loans
$
42,716

 
1,371

 
1,941

 
822

 
747

 
1,474

 
22,866

 
13,495

First lien lines
14,265

 
221

 
621

 
305

 
281

 
633

 
10,120

 
2,084

Total (2)(3)
$
56,981

 
1,592

 
2,562

 
1,127

 
1,028

 
2,107

 
32,986

 
15,579

% of portfolios
100
%
 
3

 
4

 
2

 
2

 
4

 
58

 
27

(1)
Substantially all lines and loans are scheduled to convert to amortizing loans by the end of 2026, with annual scheduled amounts through that date ranging from $4.4 billion to $7.5 billion and averaging $6.3 billion per year.
(2)
Junior and first lien lines are mostly interest-only during their draw period. The unfunded credit commitments for junior and first lien lines totaled $63.9 billion at June 30, 2017 .
(3)
Includes scheduled end-of-term balloon payments for lines and loans totaling $109 million , $284 million , $292 million , $320 million , $504 million and $302 million for 2017 , 2018 , 2019 , 2020 , 2021 , and 2022 and thereafter , respectively. Amortizing lines and loans include $104 million of end-of-term balloon payments, which are past due. At June 30, 2017 , $501 million , or 4% of outstanding lines of credit that are amortizing, are 30 days or more past due compared to $631 million or 2% for lines in their draw period.
CREDIT CARDS   Our credit card portfolio totaled $35.3 billion at June 30, 2017 , which represented 4% of our total outstanding loans. The net charge-off rate (annualized) for our credit card portfolio was 3.67% for second quarter 2017 , compared with 3.25% for second quarter 2016 and 3.61% and 3.20% for the first half of 2017 and 2016 , respectively, principally from portfolio growth and seasoning of newer vintages.
 
AUTOMOBILE   Our automobile portfolio, predominantly composed of indirect loans, totaled $58.0 billion at June 30, 2017 . The net charge-off rate (annualized) for our automobile portfolio was 0.86% for second quarter 2017 , compared with 0.59% for second quarter 2016 and 0.98% and 0.72% for the first half of 2017 and 2016 , respectively. The increase in net charge-offs in 2017, compared with 2016, was due to increased loss severities and was consistent with trends in the automobile lending industry.
 
OTHER REVOLVING CREDIT AND INSTALLMENT Other revolving credit and installment loans totaled $38.9 billion at June 30, 2017 , and primarily included student and securities-based loans. Our private student loan portfolio totaled $ 12.2 billion at June 30, 2017 . All remaining student loans guaranteed by agencies on behalf of the U.S. Department of Education under the Federal Family Education Loan Program (FFELP) were sold as of March 31, 2017. The net charge-off rate (annualized) for other revolving credit and installment loans was 1.58% for second quarter 2017 , compared with 1.32% for second quarter 2016 and 1.59% and 1.29% for the first half of 2017 and 2016 , respectively.
 


34

Risk Management - Credit Risk Management ( continued )

NONPERFORMING ASSETS (NONACCRUAL LOANS AND FORECLOSED ASSETS) Table 22 summarizes nonperforming assets (NPAs) for each of the last four quarters. Total NPAs decreased $827 million from first quarter to $9.8 billion with improvement across our consumer and commercial portfolios. Nonaccrual loans decreased $703 million from first quarter to $9.1 billion reflecting declines across all major commercial asset classes, as well as continued lower consumer real estate nonaccruals. Foreclosed assets of $781 million were down $124 million from first quarter 2017 .

We generally place loans on nonaccrual status when:
the full and timely collection of interest or principal becomes uncertain (generally based on an assessment of the borrower’s financial condition and the adequacy of collateral, if any);
 
they are 90 days (120 days with respect to real estate 1-4 family first and junior lien mortgages) past due for interest or principal, unless both well-secured and in the process of collection;
part of the principal balance has been charged off;
for junior lien mortgages, we have evidence that the related first lien mortgage may be 120 days past due or in the process of foreclosure regardless of the junior lien delinquency status; or
consumer real estate and automobile loans are discharged in bankruptcy, regardless of their delinquency status.

Credit card loans are not placed on nonaccrual status, but are generally fully charged off when the loan reaches 180 days past due.

Table 22: Nonperforming Assets (Nonaccrual Loans and Foreclosed Assets)
 
 
June 30, 2017
 
 
March 31, 2017
 
 
December 31, 2016
 
 
September 30, 2016
 
($ in millions)
 
Balance

 
% of
total
loans

 
Balance

 
% of
total
loans

 
Balance

 
% of
total
loans

 
Balance

 
% of
total
loans

Nonaccrual loans:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
 
$
2,632

 
0.79
%
 
$
2,898

 
0.88
%
 
$
3,216

 
0.97
%
 
$
3,331

 
1.03
%
Real estate mortgage
 
630

 
0.48

 
672

 
0.51

 
685

 
0.52

 
780

 
0.60

Real estate construction
 
34

 
0.13

 
40

 
0.16

 
43

 
0.18

 
59

 
0.25

Lease financing
 
89

 
0.46

 
96

 
0.50

 
115

 
0.60

 
92

 
0.49

Total commercial
 
3,385

 
0.67

 
3,706

 
0.73

 
4,059

 
0.80

 
4,262

 
0.86

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage (1)
 
4,413

 
1.60

 
4,743

 
1.73

 
4,962

 
1.80

 
5,310

 
1.91

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
 
1,095

 
2.56

 
1,153

 
2.60

 
1,206

 
2.61

 
1,259

 
2.62

Automobile
 
104

 
0.18

 
101

 
0.17

 
106

 
0.17

 
108

 
0.17

Other revolving credit and installment
 
59

 
0.15

 
56

 
0.14

 
51

 
0.13

 
47

 
0.12

Total consumer
 
5,671

 
1.26

 
6,053

 
1.34

 
6,325

 
1.37

 
6,724

 
1.45

Total nonaccrual loans (2)(3)(4)
 
9,056

 
0.95

 
9,759

 
1.02

 
10,384

 
1.07

 
10,986

 
1.14

Foreclosed assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Government insured/guaranteed (5)
 
149

 
 
 
179

 
 
 
197

 
 
 
282

 
 
Non-government insured/guaranteed
 
632

 
 
 
726

 
 
 
781

 
 
 
738

 
 
Total foreclosed assets
 
781

 
 
 
905

 
 
 
978

 
 
 
1,020

 
 
Total nonperforming assets
 
$
9,837

 
1.03
%
 
$
10,664

 
1.11
%
 
$
11,362

 
1.17
%
 
$
12,006

 
1.25
%
Change in NPAs from prior quarter
 
$
(827
)
 
 
 
(698
)
 
 
 
(644
)
 
 
 
(1,074
)
 
 
(1)
Includes MHFS of $140 million , $145 million , $149 million , and $150 million at June 30 and March 31, 2017 , and December 31 and September 30, 2016 , respectively.
(2)
Excludes PCI loans because they continue to earn interest income from accretable yield, independent of performance in accordance with their contractual terms.
(3)
Real estate 1-4 family mortgage loans predominantly insured by the FHA or guaranteed by the VA and student loans largely guaranteed by agencies on behalf of the U.S. Department of Education under the FFELP are not placed on nonaccrual status because they are insured or guaranteed. All remaining student loans guaranteed under the FFELP were sold as of March 31, 2017.
(4)
See Note 5 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses) to Financial Statements in this Report for further information on impaired loans.
(5)
Consistent with regulatory reporting requirements, foreclosed real estate resulting from government insured/guaranteed loans are classified as nonperforming. However, both principal and interest related to these foreclosed real estate assets are collectible because the loans were predominantly insured by the FHA or guaranteed by the VA. Foreclosure of certain government guaranteed residential real estate mortgage loans that meet criteria specified by Accounting Standards Update (ASU) 2014-14, Classification of Certain Government-Guaranteed Mortgage Loans Upon Foreclosure , effective as of January 1, 2014 are excluded from this table and included in Accounts Receivable in Other Assets. For more information on the changes in foreclosures for government guaranteed residential real estate mortgage loans, see Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) to Financial Statements in our 2016 Form 10-K.

35


Table 23 provides an analysis of the changes in nonaccrual loans.
Table 23: Analysis of Changes in Nonaccrual Loans
 
Quarter ended
 
(in millions)
Jun 30,
2017

 
Mar 31,
2017

 
Dec 31,
2016

 
Sep 30,
2016

 
Jun 30,
2016

Commercial nonaccrual loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance, beginning of period
$
3,706

 
4,059

 
4,262

 
4,507

 
3,969

Inflows
704

 
945

 
951

 
1,180

 
1,936

Outflows:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Returned to accruing
(61
)
 
(133
)
 
(59
)
 
(80
)
 
(32
)
Foreclosures
(15
)
 
(1
)
 
(15
)
 
(1
)
 
(6
)
Charge-offs
(116
)
 
(202
)
 
(292
)
 
(290
)
 
(420
)
Payments, sales and other
(833
)
 
(962
)
 
(788
)
 
(1,054
)
 
(940
)
Total outflows
(1,025
)
 
(1,298
)
 
(1,154
)
 
(1,425
)
 
(1,398
)
Balance, end of period
3,385


3,706


4,059


4,262


4,507

Consumer nonaccrual loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance, beginning of period
6,053

 
6,325

 
6,724

 
7,456

 
8,265

Inflows
676

 
814

 
863

 
868

 
829

Outflows:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Returned to accruing
(425
)
 
(428
)
 
(410
)
 
(597
)
 
(546
)
Foreclosures
(72
)
 
(81
)
 
(59
)
 
(85
)
 
(85
)
Charge-offs
(117
)
 
(151
)
 
(158
)
 
(192
)
 
(167
)
Payments, sales and other
(444
)
 
(426
)
 
(635
)
 
(726
)
 
(840
)
Total outflows
(1,058
)
 
(1,086
)
 
(1,262
)
 
(1,600
)
 
(1,638
)
Balance, end of period
5,671


6,053


6,325


6,724


7,456

Total nonaccrual loans
$
9,056

 
9,759

 
10,384

 
10,986

 
11,963


Typically, changes to nonaccrual loans period-over-period represent inflows for loans that are placed on nonaccrual status in accordance with our policy, offset by reductions for loans that are paid down, charged off, sold, foreclosed, or are no longer classified as nonaccrual as a result of continued performance and an improvement in the borrower’s financial condition and loan repayment capabilities. Also, reductions can come from borrower repayments even if the loan remains on nonaccrual.
While nonaccrual loans are not free of loss content, we believe exposure to loss is significantly mitigated by the following factors at June 30, 2017 :
96% of total commercial nonaccrual loans and 99% of total consumer nonaccrual loans are secured. Of the consumer nonaccrual loans, 97% are secured by real estate and 81% have a combined LTV (CLTV) ratio of 80% or less.
losses of $448 million and $2.0 billion  have already been recognized on 14% of commercial nonaccrual loans and 46% of consumer nonaccrual loans, respectively. Generally, when a consumer real estate loan is 120 days past due (except when required earlier by guidance issued by bank regulatory agencies), we transfer it to nonaccrual status. When the loan reaches 180 days past due, or is discharged in bankruptcy, it is our policy to write these loans down to net realizable value (fair value of collateral less estimated costs to sell), except for modifications in their trial period that are not written down as long as trial payments are made on time. Thereafter, we reevaluate each loan regularly and record additional write-downs if needed.
 
90% of commercial nonaccrual loans were current on interest, but were on nonaccrual status because the full or timely collection of interest or principal had become uncertain.
the remaining risk of loss of all nonaccrual loans has been considered and we believe is adequately covered by the allowance for loan losses.
$1.5 billion of consumer loans discharged in bankruptcy and classified as nonaccrual were 60 days or less past due, of which $1.4 billion were current.

We continue to work with our customers experiencing financial difficulty to determine if they can qualify for a loan modification so that they can stay in their homes. Under both our proprietary modification programs and the Making Home Affordable (MHA) programs, customers may be required to provide updated documentation, and some programs require completion of payment during trial periods to demonstrate sustained performance before the loan can be removed from nonaccrual status.

36

Risk Management - Credit Risk Management ( continued )

Table 24 provides a summary of foreclosed assets and an analysis of changes in foreclosed assets.

Table 24: Foreclosed Assets
(in millions)
Jun 30,
2017

 
Mar 31,
2017

 
Dec 31,
2016

 
Sep 30,
2016

 
Jun 30,
2016

Summary by loan segment
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Government insured/guaranteed
$
149

 
179

 
197

 
282

 
321

PCI loans:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial
79

 
84

 
91

 
98

 
124

Consumer
67

 
80

 
75

 
88

 
91

Total PCI loans
146

 
164

 
166

 
186

 
215

All other loans:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial
259

 
275

 
287

 
298

 
313

Consumer
227

 
287

 
328

 
254

 
268

Total all other loans
486

 
562

 
615

 
552

 
581

Total foreclosed assets
$
781

 
905

 
978

 
1,020

 
1,117

Analysis of changes in foreclosed assets (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance, beginning of period
$
905

 
978

 
1,020

 
1,117

 
1,279

Net change in government insured/guaranteed (2)
(30
)
 
(18
)
 
(85
)
 
(39
)
 
(65
)
Additions to foreclosed assets (3)
233

 
288

 
405

 
261

 
281

Reductions:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Sales
(330
)
 
(307
)
 
(296
)
 
(421
)
 
(405
)
Write-downs and gains (losses) on sales
3

 
(36
)
 
(66
)
 
102

 
27

Total reductions
(327
)
 
(343
)
 
(362
)
 
(319
)
 
(378
)
Balance, end of period
$
781

 
905

 
978

 
1,020

 
1,117

(1)
During fourth quarter 2016, we evaluated a population of foreclosed properties that were previously security for FHA insured loans, and made the decision to retain some of the properties as foreclosed real estate, thereby foregoing the FHA insurance claim. Accordingly, the loans for which we decided not to file a claim are reported as additions to foreclosed assets rather than included as net change in government insured/guaranteed foreclosures.
(2)
Foreclosed government insured/guaranteed loans are temporarily transferred to and held by us as servicer, until reimbursement is received from FHA or VA. The net change in government insured/guaranteed foreclosed assets is generally made up of inflows from mortgages held for investment and MHFS, and outflows when we are reimbursed by FHA/VA.
(3)
Includes loans moved into foreclosure from nonaccrual status, PCI loans transitioned directly to foreclosed assets and repossessed automobiles.

Foreclosed assets at June 30, 2017 , included $434 million  of foreclosed residential real estate, of which 34% is predominantly FHA insured or VA guaranteed and expected to have minimal or no loss content. The remaining foreclosed assets balance of $347 million has been written down to estimated net realizable value. Of the $781 million in foreclosed assets at June 30, 2017 , 52% have been in the foreclosed assets portfolio one year or less.


37


TROUBLED DEBT RESTRUCTURINGS (TDRs)

Table 25: Troubled Debt Restructurings (TDRs)
(in millions)
Jun 30,
2017


Mar 31,
2017


Dec 31,
2016


Sep 30,
2016


Jun 30,
2016

Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
2,629

 
2,484

 
2,584

 
2,445

 
1,951

Real estate mortgage
1,024

 
1,090

 
1,119

 
1,256

 
1,324

Real estate construction
62

 
73

 
91

 
95

 
106

Lease financing
21

 
8

 
6

 
8

 
5

Total commercial TDRs
3,736

 
3,655

 
3,800

 
3,804

 
3,386

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
13,141

 
13,680

 
14,134

 
14,761

 
15,518

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
1,975

 
2,027

 
2,074

 
2,144

 
2,214

Credit Card
316

 
308

 
300

 
294

 
291

Automobile
85

 
80

 
85

 
89

 
92

Other revolving credit and installment
118

 
107

 
101

 
93

 
86

Trial modifications
215

 
261

 
299

 
348

 
364

Total consumer TDRs (1)
15,850

 
16,463

 
16,993

 
17,729

 
18,565

Total TDRs
$
19,586

 
20,118

 
20,793

 
21,533

 
21,951

TDRs on nonaccrual status
$
5,637

 
5,819

 
6,193

 
6,429

 
6,404

TDRs on accrual status (1)
13,949

 
14,299

 
14,600

 
15,104

 
15,547

Total TDRs
$
19,586

 
20,118

 
20,793

 
21,533

 
21,951

(1)
TDR loans include $1.4 billion , $1.5 billion , $1.5 billion , $1.6 billion , and $1.7 billion at June 30 and March 31 , 2017 , and December 31, September 30 and June 30, 2016 , respectively, of government insured/guaranteed loans that are predominantly insured by the FHA or guaranteed by the VA and accruing.
 
Table 25 provides information regarding the recorded investment of loans modified in TDRs. The allowance for loan losses for TDRs was $1.9 billion and $2.2 billion at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , respectively. See Note 5 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses) to Financial Statements in this Report for additional information regarding TDRs. In those situations where principal is forgiven, the entire amount of such forgiveness is immediately charged off to the extent not done so prior to the modification. When we delay the timing on the repayment of a portion of principal (principal forbearance), we charge off the amount of forbearance if that amount is not considered fully collectible.
For more information on our nonaccrual policies when a restructuring is involved, see the “Risk Management – Credit Risk Management – Troubled Debt Restructurings (TDRs)” section in our 2016 Form 10-K.
 
Table 26 provides an analysis of the changes in TDRs. Loans modified more than once are reported as TDR inflows only in the period they are first modified. Other than resolutions such as foreclosures, sales and transfers to held for sale, we may remove loans held for investment from TDR classification, but only if they have been refinanced or restructured at market terms and qualify as a new loan.

38

Risk Management - Credit Risk Management ( continued )

Table 26: Analysis of Changes in TDRs
 
 
 
 
 
Quarter ended
 
(in millions)
Jun 30,
2017

 
Mar 31,
2017

 
Dec 31,
2016

 
Sep 30,
2016

 
Jun 30,
2016

Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance, beginning of quarter
$
3,655

 
3,800

 
3,804

 
3,386

 
3,092

Inflows (1)
730

 
642

 
615

 
914

 
797

Outflows
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Charge-offs
(59
)
 
(108
)
 
(120
)
 
(76
)
 
(153
)
Foreclosures
(12
)
 

 
(13
)
 
(2
)
 

Payments, sales and other (2)
(578
)
 
(679
)
 
(486
)
 
(418
)
 
(350
)
Balance, end of quarter
3,736

 
3,655

 
3,800

 
3,804

 
3,386

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance, beginning of quarter
16,463

 
16,993

 
17,729

 
18,565

 
19,413

Inflows (1)
444

 
517

 
513

 
542

 
508

Outflows
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Charge-offs
(51
)
 
(51
)
 
(48
)
 
(65
)
 
(38
)
Foreclosures
(159
)
 
(179
)
 
(166
)
 
(230
)
 
(217
)
Payments, sales and other (2)
(801
)
 
(779
)
 
(987
)
 
(1,067
)
 
(1,085
)
Net change in trial modifications (3)
(46
)
 
(38
)
 
(48
)
 
(16
)
 
(16
)
Balance, end of quarter
15,850

 
16,463

 
16,993

 
17,729

 
18,565

Total TDRs
$
19,586

 
20,118

 
20,793

 
21,533

 
21,951

(1)
Inflows include loans that modify, even if they resolve within the period as well as advances on loans that modified in a prior period.
(2)
Other outflows include normal amortization/accretion of loan basis adjustments and loans transferred to held-for-sale. It also includes $4 million of loans refinanced or restructured at market terms and qualifying as new loans and removed from TDR classification for the quarter ended December 31, 2016 , while no loans were removed from TDR classification for the quarters ended June 30 and March 31 , 2017 , and September 30 and June 30, 2016 .
(3)
Net change in trial modifications includes: inflows of new TDRs entering the trial payment period, net of outflows for modifications that either (i) successfully perform and enter into a permanent modification, or (ii) did not successfully perform according to the terms of the trial period plan and are subsequently charged-off, foreclosed upon or otherwise resolved.


39


LOANS 90 DAYS OR MORE PAST DUE AND STILL ACCRUING
Loans 90 days or more past due as to interest or principal are still accruing if they are (1) well-secured and in the process of collection or (2) real estate 1-4 family mortgage loans or consumer loans exempt under regulatory rules from being classified as nonaccrual until later delinquency, usually 120 days past due. PCI loans are not included in past due and still accruing loans even when they are 90 days or more contractually past due. These PCI loans are considered to be accruing because they continue to earn interest from accretable yield, independent of performance in accordance with their contractual terms.
Excluding insured/guaranteed loans, loans 90 days or more past due and still accruing at June 30, 2017 , were down $129 million , or 13% , from December 31, 2016 , due to payoffs, modifications and other loss mitigation activities and credit
 
stabilization. Also, fluctuations from quarter to quarter are influenced by seasonality.
Loans 90 days or more past due and still accruing whose repayments are predominantly insured by the FHA or guaranteed by the VA for mortgages were $8.9 billion at June 30, 2017 , down from $10.9 billion at December 31, 2016 , due to improving credit trends. All remaining student loans guaranteed by agencies on behalf of the U.S. Department of Education under the FFELP were sold as of March 31, 2017.
Table 27 reflects non-PCI loans 90 days or more past due and still accruing by class for loans not government insured/guaranteed. For additional information on delinquencies by loan class, see Note 5 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses) to Financial Statements in this Report.
Table 27: Loans 90 Days or More Past Due and Still Accruing
(in millions)
Jun 30, 2017

 
Mar 31, 2017

 
Dec 31, 2016

 
Sep 30, 2016

 
Jun 30, 2016

Total (excluding PCI (1)):
$
9,716

 
10,525

 
11,858

 
12,068

 
12,385

Less: FHA insured/VA guaranteed (2)(3)
8,873

 
9,585

 
10,883

 
11,198

 
11,577

Less: Student loans guaranteed under the FFELP (4)

 

 
3

 
17

 
20

Total, not government insured/guaranteed
$
843

 
940

 
972

 
853

 
788

By segment and class, not government insured/guaranteed:
Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
42

 
88

 
28

 
47

 
36

Real estate mortgage
2

 
11

 
36

 
4

 
22

Real estate construction
10

 
3

 

 

 

Total commercial
54


102


64


51


58

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage (3)
145

 
149

 
175

 
171

 
169

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage (3)
44

 
42

 
56

 
54

 
52

Credit card
411

 
453

 
452

 
392

 
348

Automobile
91

 
79

 
112

 
81

 
64

Other revolving credit and installment
98

 
115

 
113

 
104

 
97

Total consumer
789

 
838


908


802


730

Total, not government insured/guaranteed
$
843

 
940


972


853


788

(1)
PCI loans totaled $1.5 billion , $1.8 billion , $2.0 billion , $2.2 billion , and $2.4 billion at June 30 and March 31 , 2017 and December 31 , September 30, and June 30, 2016 , respectively.
(2)
Represents loans whose repayments are predominantly insured by the FHA or guaranteed by the VA.
(3)
Includes mortgages held for sale 90 days or more past due and still accruing.
(4)
Represents loans whose repayments are largely guaranteed by agencies on behalf of the U.S. Department of Education under the FFELP. All remaining student loans guaranteed under the FFELP were sold as of March 31, 2017.


40

Risk Management - Credit Risk Management ( continued )

NET CHARGE-OFFS

Table 28: Net Charge-offs
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Quarter ended 
 
 
Jun 30, 2017
 
 
Mar 31, 2017
 
 
Dec 31, 2016
 
 
Sep 30, 2016
 
 
Jun 30, 2016
 
($ in millions)
Net loan
charge-
offs

 
% of 
avg. 
loans (1) 

 
Net loan
charge-
offs

 
% of avg. loans (1)

 
Net loan
charge-
offs

 
% of avg. loans (1)

 
Net loan
charge-offs

 
% of
avg. loans (1)

 
Net loan
charge-offs

 
% of
avg.
loans (1)

Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
78

 
0.10
 %
 
$
171

 
0.21
 %
 
$
256

 
0.31
 %
 
$
259

 
0.32
 %
 
$
368

 
0.46
 %
Real estate mortgage
(6
)
 
(0.02
)
 
(25
)
 
(0.08
)
 
(12
)
 
(0.04
)
 
(28
)
 
(0.09
)
 
(20
)
 
(0.06
)
Real estate construction
(4
)
 
(0.05
)
 
(8
)
 
(0.15
)
 
(8
)
 
(0.13
)
 
(18
)
 
(0.32
)
 
(3
)
 
(0.06
)
Lease financing
7

 
0.15

 
5

 
0.11

 
15

 
0.32

 
2

 
0.04

 
12

 
0.27

Total commercial
75

 
0.06

 
143

 
0.11

 
251

 
0.20

 
215

 
0.17

 
357

 
0.29

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family
first mortgage
(16
)
 
(0.02
)
 
7

 
0.01

 
(3
)
 

 
20

 
0.03

 
14

 
0.02

Real estate 1-4 family
junior lien mortgage
(4
)
 
(0.03
)
 
23

 
0.21

 
44

 
0.38

 
49

 
0.40

 
62

 
0.49

Credit card
320

 
3.67

 
309

 
3.54

 
275

 
3.09

 
245

 
2.82

 
270

 
3.25

Automobile
126

 
0.86

 
167

 
1.10

 
166

 
1.05

 
137

 
0.87

 
90

 
0.59

Other revolving credit and
installment
154

 
1.58

 
156

 
1.60

 
172

 
1.70

 
139

 
1.40

 
131

 
1.32

Total consumer
580

 
0.51

 
662

 
0.59

 
654

 
0.56

 
590

 
0.51

 
567

 
0.49

Total
$
655

 
0.27
 %
 
$
805

 
0.34
 %
 
$
905

 
0.37
 %
 
$
805

 
0.33
 %
 
$
924

 
0.39
 %
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1)
Quarterly net charge-offs (recoveries) as a percentage of average respective loans are annualized.

Table 28 presents net charge-offs for second quarter 2017 and the previous four quarters. Net charge-offs in second quarter 2017 were $655 million ( 0.27% of average total loans outstanding) compared with $924 million ( 0.39% ) in second quarter 2016 .
The decrease in commercial and industrial net charge-offs from second quarter 2016 , reflected continued improvement in our oil and gas portfolio. Our commercial real estate portfolios were in a net recovery position. Total consumer net charge-offs increased slightly from the prior year due to an increase in credit card, automobile and other revolving credit and installment losses, partially offset by a decrease in residential real estate net charge-offs.
ALLOWANCE FOR CREDIT LOSSES   The allowance for credit losses, which consists of the allowance for loan losses and the allowance for unfunded credit commitments, is management’s estimate of credit losses inherent in the loan portfolio and unfunded credit commitments at the balance sheet date, excluding loans carried at fair value. The detail of the changes in the allowance for credit losses by portfolio segment (including charge-offs and recoveries by loan class) is in Note 5 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses) to Financial Statements in this Report.
 
We apply a disciplined process and methodology to establish our allowance for credit losses each quarter. This process takes into consideration many factors, including historical and forecasted loss trends, loan-level credit quality ratings and loan grade-specific characteristics. The process involves subjective and complex judgments. In addition, we review a variety of credit metrics and trends. These credit metrics and trends, however, do not solely determine the amount of the allowance as we use several analytical tools. Our estimation approach for the commercial portfolio reflects the estimated probability of default in accordance with the borrower’s financial strength, and the severity of loss in the event of default, considering the quality of any underlying collateral. Probability of default and severity at the time of default are statistically derived through historical observations of defaults and losses after default within each credit risk rating. Our estimation approach for the consumer portfolio uses forecasted losses that represent our best estimate of inherent loss based on historical experience, quantitative and other mathematical techniques. For additional information on our allowance for credit losses, see the “Critical Accounting Policies – Allowance for Credit Losses” section in our 2016 Form 10-K and Note 5 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses) to Financial Statements in this Report.
Table 29 presents the allocation of the allowance for credit losses by loan segment and class for the most recent quarter end and last four year ends.

41


Table 29: Allocation of the Allowance for Credit Losses (ACL)
 
Jun 30, 2017
 
 
Dec 31, 2016
 
 
Dec 31, 2015
 
 
Dec 31, 2014
 
 
Dec 31, 2013
 
(in millions)
ACL

 
Loans
as %
of total
loans

 
ACL

 
Loans
as %
of total
loans

 
ACL

 
Loans
as %
of total
loans

 
ACL

 
Loans
as %
of total
loans

 
ACL

 
Loans
as %
of total
loans

Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
4,178

 
34
%
 
$
4,560

 
34
%
 
$
4,231

 
33
%
 
$
3,506

 
32
%
 
$
3,040

 
29
%
Real estate mortgage
1,269

 
14

 
1,320

 
14

 
1,264

 
13

 
1,576

 
13

 
2,157

 
14

Real estate construction
1,276

 
3

 
1,294

 
2

 
1,210

 
3

 
1,097

 
2

 
775

 
2

Lease financing
238

 
2

 
220

 
2

 
167

 
1

 
198

 
1

 
131

 
1

Total commercial
6,961

 
53

 
7,394

 
52

 
6,872

 
50

 
6,377

 
48

 
6,103

 
46

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
1,180

 
29

 
1,270

 
29

 
1,895

 
30

 
2,878

 
31

 
4,087

 
32

Real estate 1-4 family
junior lien mortgage
690

 
4

 
815

 
5

 
1,223

 
6

 
1,566

 
7

 
2,534

 
8

Credit card
1,851

 
4

 
1,605

 
4

 
1,412

 
4

 
1,271

 
4

 
1,224

 
3

Automobile
786

 
6

 
817

 
6

 
529

 
6

 
516

 
6

 
475

 
6

Other revolving credit and installment
678

 
4

 
639

 
4

 
581

 
4

 
561

 
4

 
548

 
5

Total consumer
5,185

 
47

 
5,146

 
48

 
5,640

 
50

 
6,792

 
52

 
8,868

 
54

Total
$
12,146

 
100
%
 
$
12,540

 
100
%
 
$
12,512

 
100
%
 
$
13,169

 
100
%
 
$
14,971

 
100
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Jun 30, 2017
 
 
Dec 31, 2016
 
 
Dec 31, 2015
 
 
Dec 31, 2014
 
 
Dec 31, 2013
 
Components:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Allowance for loan losses
$
11,073
 
 
11,419
 
 
11,545
 
 
12,319
 
 
14,502
 
Allowance for unfunded
credit commitments
1,073
 
 
1,121
 
 
967
 
 
850
 
 
469
 
Allowance for credit losses
$
12,146
 
 
12,540
 
 
12,512
 
 
13,169
 
 
14,971
 
Allowance for loan losses as a percentage of total loans
1.16
%
 
1.18
 
 
1.26
 
 
1.43
 
 
1.76
 
Allowance for loan losses as a percentage of total net charge-offs (1)
421
 
 
324
 
 
399
 
 
418
 
 
322
 
Allowance for credit losses as a percentage of total loans
1.27
 
 
1.30
 
 
1.37
 
 
1.53
 
 
1.82
 
Allowance for credit losses as a percentage of total nonaccrual loans
134
 
 
121
 
 
110
 
 
103
 
 
96
 
(1)
Total net charge-offs are annualized for quarter ended June 30, 2017 .

In addition to the allowance for credit losses, there was $649 million at June 30, 2017 , and $954 million at December 31, 2016 , of nonaccretable difference to absorb losses for PCI loans, which totaled $14.3 billion at June 30, 2017 . The allowance for credit losses is lower than otherwise would have been required without PCI loan accounting. As a result of PCI loans, certain ratios of the Company may not be directly comparable with credit-related metrics for other financial institutions. Additionally, loans purchased at fair value, including loans from the GE Capital business acquisitions, generally reflect a lifetime credit loss adjustment and therefore do not initially require additions to the allowance as is typically associated with loan growth. For additional information on PCI loans, see the “Risk Management – Credit Risk Management – Purchased Credit-Impaired Loans” section and Note 5 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses) to Financial Statements in this Report.
The ratio of the allowance for credit losses to total nonaccrual loans may fluctuate significantly from period to period due to such factors as the mix of loan types in the portfolio, borrower credit strength and the value and marketability of collateral. Our nonaccrual loans consisted
 
primarily of real estate 1-4 family first and junior lien mortgage loans at June 30, 2017 .
The allowance for credit losses decreased $394 million , or 3% , from December 31, 2016 , due to a decrease in our commercial allowance reflecting credit quality improvement, including in the oil and gas portfolio, as well as improvement in our residential real estate and automobile portfolios, partially offset by increased allowance in the credit card portfolio. Total provision for credit losses was $555 million in second quarter 2017 , compared with $1.1 billion in second quarter 2016 , reflecting the same changes mentioned above for the allowance for credit losses.
We believe the allowance for credit losses of $12.1 billion at June 30, 2017 , was appropriate to cover credit losses inherent in the loan portfolio, including unfunded credit commitments, at that date. Approximately $959 million of the allowance at June 30, 2017 , was allocated to our oil and gas portfolio, compared with $1.3 billion at December 31, 2016 . This represented 7.5% and 8.5% of total oil and gas loans outstanding at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , respectively. However, the entire allowance is available to absorb credit losses inherent

42

Risk Management - Credit Risk Management ( continued )

in the total loan portfolio. The allowance for credit losses is subject to change and reflects existing factors as of the date of determination, including economic or market conditions and ongoing internal and external examination processes. Due to the sensitivity of the allowance for credit losses to changes in the economic and business environment, it is possible that we will incur incremental credit losses not anticipated as of the balance sheet date. Future allowance levels will be based on a variety of factors, including loan growth, portfolio performance and general economic conditions. Our process for determining the allowance for credit losses is discussed in the “Critical Accounting Policies – Allowance for Credit Losses” section and Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) to Financial Statements in our 2016 Form 10-K.
LIABILITY FOR MORTGAGE LOAN REPURCHASE LOSSES 
In connection with our sales and securitization of residential mortgage loans to various parties, we have established a mortgage repurchase liability, initially at fair value, related to various representations and warranties that reflect management’s estimate of losses for loans for which we could have a repurchase obligation, whether or not we currently service those loans, based on a combination of factors. Our mortgage repurchase liability estimation process also incorporates a forecast of repurchase demands associated with mortgage insurance rescission activity.
Because we typically retain the servicing for the mortgage loans we sell or securitize, we believe the quality of our residential mortgage loan servicing portfolio provides helpful information in evaluating our repurchase liability. Of the $1.5 trillion in the residential mortgage loan servicing portfolio at June 30, 2017 , 96% was current and less than 1% was subprime at origination. Our combined delinquency and foreclosure rate on this portfolio was 4.14% at June 30, 2017 , compared with 4.83% at December 31, 2016 . Two percent of this portfolio is private label securitizations for which we originated the loans and, therefore have some repurchase risk.
The overall level of unresolved repurchase demands and mortgage insurance rescissions outstanding at June 30, 2017 , was $121 million , representing 562 loans, up from a year ago both in number of outstanding loans and in total dollar balances. The increase was predominantly due to private investor demands we expect to resolve with minimal repurchase risk.
Our liability for mortgage repurchases, included in “Accrued expenses and other liabilities” in our consolidated balance sheet, represents our best estimate of the probable loss that we expect to incur for various representations and warranties in the contractual provisions of our sales of mortgage loans. The liability was $178 million at June 30, 2017 , and $229 million at December 31, 2016 . In second quarter 2017 , we released $39 million , which increased net gains on mortgage loan origination/sales activities, compared with a release of $81 million in second quarter 2016 . The release in second quarter 2017 was due to a re-estimation of our liability based on recently observed trends. We incurred net losses on repurchased loans and investor reimbursements totaling $5 million in second quarter 2017 , compared with $19 million in second quarter 2016 .
 
Because of the uncertainty in the various estimates underlying the mortgage repurchase liability, there is a range of losses in excess of the recorded mortgage repurchase liability that are reasonably possible. The estimate of the range of possible loss for representations and warranties does not represent a probable loss, and is based on currently available information, significant judgment, and a number of assumptions that are subject to change. The high end of this range of reasonably possible losses exceeded our recorded liability by $167 million at June 30, 2017 , and was determined based upon modifying the assumptions (particularly to assume significant changes in investor repurchase demand practices) used in our best estimate of probable loss to reflect what we believe to be the high end of reasonably possible adverse assumptions.
For additional information on our repurchase liability, see the “Risk Management – Credit Risk Management – Liability For Mortgage Loan Repurchase Losses” section in our 2016 Form 10-K and Note 8 (Mortgage Banking Activities) to Financial Statements in this Report.

RISKS RELATING TO SERVICING ACTIVITIES In addition to servicing loans in our portfolio, we act as servicer and/or master servicer of residential mortgage loans included in GSE-guaranteed mortgage securitizations, GNMA-guaranteed mortgage securitizations of FHA-insured/VA-guaranteed mortgages and private label mortgage securitizations, as well as for unsecuritized loans owned by institutional investors. In connection with our servicing activities, we have entered into various settlements with federal and state regulators to resolve certain alleged servicing issues and practices. In general, these settlements required us to provide customers with loan modification relief, refinancing relief, and foreclosure prevention and assistance, as well as imposed certain monetary penalties on us.
For additional information about the risks and various settlements related to our servicing activities, see the “Risk Management – Credit Risk Management – Risks Relating to Servicing Activities” section in our 2016 Form 10-K.



43


Asset/Liability Management
Asset/liability management involves evaluating, monitoring and managing interest rate risk, market risk, liquidity and funding. Primary oversight of interest rate risk and market risk resides with the Finance Committee of our Board of Directors (Board), which oversees the administration and effectiveness of financial risk management policies and processes used to assess and manage these risks. Primary oversight of liquidity and funding resides with the Risk Committee of the Board. At the management level we utilize a Corporate Asset/Liability Management Committee (Corporate ALCO), which consists of senior financial, risk, and business executives, to oversee these risks and report on them periodically to the Board’s Finance Committee and Risk Committee as appropriate. As discussed in more detail for trading activities below, we employ separate management level oversight specific to market risk.
 
INTEREST RATE RISK Interest rate risk, which potentially can have a significant earnings impact, is an integral part of being a financial intermediary. We are subject to interest rate risk because:
assets and liabilities may mature or reprice at different times (for example, if assets reprice faster than liabilities and interest rates are generally falling, earnings will initially decline);
assets and liabilities may reprice at the same time but by different amounts (for example, when the general level of interest rates is falling, we may reduce rates paid on checking and savings deposit accounts by an amount that is less than the general decline in market interest rates);
short-term and long-term market interest rates may change by different amounts (for example, the shape of the yield curve may affect new loan yields and funding costs differently);
the remaining maturity of various assets or liabilities may shorten or lengthen as interest rates change (for example, if long-term mortgage interest rates decline sharply, MBS held in the investment securities portfolio may prepay significantly earlier than anticipated, which could reduce portfolio income); or
interest rates may also have a direct or indirect effect on loan demand, collateral values, credit losses, mortgage origination volume, the fair value of MSRs and other financial instruments, the value of the pension liability and other items affecting earnings.

We assess interest rate risk by comparing outcomes under various net interest income simulations using many interest rate scenarios that differ in the direction of interest rate changes, the degree of change over time, the speed of change and the projected shape of the yield curve. These simulations require assumptions regarding drivers of earnings and balance sheet composition such as loan originations, prepayment speeds on loans and investment securities, deposit flows and mix, as well as pricing strategies.
Currently, our profile is such that we project net interest income will benefit modestly from higher interest rates as our assets would reprice faster and to a greater degree than our liabilities, while in the case of lower interest rates, our assets would reprice downward and to a greater degree than our liabilities.
As of June 30, 2017 , our most recent simulations estimate net interest income sensitivity over the next two years under a range of both lower and higher interest rates. Measured impacts from standardized ramps (gradual changes) and shocks
 
(instantaneous changes) are summarized in Table 30 , indicating net interest income sensitivity relative to the Company's base net interest income plan. Ramp scenarios assume interest rates move gradually in parallel across the yield curve relative to the base scenario in year one, and the full amount of the ramp is held as a constant differential to the base scenario in year two. The following describes the simulation assumptions for the scenarios presented in Table 30 :
Simulations are dynamic and reflect anticipated growth across assets and liabilities.
Other macroeconomic variables that could be correlated with the changes in interest rates are held constant.
Mortgage prepayment and origination assumptions vary across scenarios and reflect only the impact of the higher or lower interest rates.
Our base scenario deposit forecast incorporates mix changes consistent with the base interest rate trajectory. Deposit mix is modeled to be the same as in the base scenario across the alternative scenarios. In higher rate scenarios, customer activity that shifts balances into higher-yielding products could reduce expected net interest income.
We hold the size of the projected investment securities portfolio constant across scenarios.
Table 30: Net Interest Income Sensitivity Over Next Two-Year Horizon Relative to Base Expectation
 
 
Lower Rates
 
Higher Rates
($ in billions)
Base
100 bps
Ramp
Parallel
 Decrease
 
100 bps Instantaneous
Parallel
Increase
 
200 bps
Ramp
Parallel
Increase
First Year of Forecasting Horizon
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net Interest Income Sensitivity to Base Scenario
 
$(0.9) - (0.4)
 
1.1 - 1.6
 
0.9 - 1.4
Key Rates at Horizon End
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fed Funds Target
1.89%
0.89
 
2.89
 
3.89
10-year CMT (1)
3.04
2.04
 
4.04
 
5.04
Second Year of Forecasting Horizon
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net Interest Income Sensitivity to Base Scenario
 
$(1.5) - (1.0)
 
1.4 - 1.9
 
1.8 - 2.3
Key Rates at Horizon End
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fed Funds Target
2.50%
1.50
 
3.50
 
4.50
10-year CMT (1)
3.55
2.55
 
4.55
 
5.55
(1)
U.S. Constant Maturity Treasury Rate

The sensitivity results above do not capture interest rate sensitive noninterest income and expense impacts. Our interest rate sensitive noninterest income and expense is primarily driven by mortgage activity, and may move in the opposite direction of our net interest income. Typically, in response to higher interest rates, mortgage activity, primarily refinancing activity, generally declines. And in response to lower interest rates, mortgage activity generally increases. Mortgage results are also impacted by the valuation of MSRs and related hedge positions. See the “Risk Management – Asset/Liability Management – Mortgage Banking Interest Rate and Market Risk” section in this Report for more information.
We use the investment securities portfolio and exchange-traded and over-the-counter (OTC) interest rate derivatives to hedge our interest rate exposures. See the “Balance Sheet Analysis – Investment Securities” section in this Report for more information on the use of the available-for-sale and held-to-

44

Asset/Liability Management ( continued )

maturity securities portfolios. The notional or contractual amount, credit risk amount and fair value of the derivatives used to hedge our interest rate risk exposures as of June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , are presented in Note 12 (Derivatives) to Financial Statements in this Report. We use derivatives for asset/liability management in two main ways:
to convert the cash flows from selected asset and/or liability instruments/portfolios including investments, commercial loans and long-term debt, from fixed-rate payments to floating-rate payments, or vice versa; and
to economically hedge our mortgage origination pipeline, funded mortgage loans and MSRs using interest rate swaps, swaptions, futures, forwards and options.
 
MORTGAGE BANKING INTEREST RATE AND MARKET RISK  We originate, fund and service mortgage loans, which subjects us to various risks, including credit, liquidity and interest rate risks. For more information on mortgage banking interest rate and market risk, see the “Risk Management – Asset/Liability Management – Mortgage Banking Interest Rate and Market Risk” section in our 2016 Form 10-K.
While our hedging activities are designed to balance our mortgage banking interest rate risks, the financial instruments we use may not perfectly correlate with the values and income being hedged. For example, the change in the value of ARM production held for sale from changes in mortgage interest rates may or may not be fully offset by LIBOR index-based financial instruments used as economic hedges for such ARMs. Additionally, hedge-carry income on our economic hedges for the MSRs may not continue at recent levels if the spread between short-term and long-term rates decreases or there are other changes in the market for mortgage forwards that affect the implied carry.
The total carrying value of our residential and commercial MSRs was $ 14.2 billion at June 30, 2017 , and $ 14.4 billion at December 31, 2016 . The weighted-average note rate on our portfolio of loans serviced for others was 4.23% at June 30, 2017 , and 4.26% at December 31, 2016 . The carrying value of our total MSRs represented 0.85% of mortgage loans serviced for others at both June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016 .
 
MARKET RISK – TRADING ACTIVITIES   The Finance Committee of our Board of Directors reviews the acceptable market risk appetite for our trading activities. We engage in trading activities to accommodate the investment and risk management activities of our customers (which generally comprises a subset of the transactions recorded as trading and derivative assets and liabilities on our balance sheet), and to execute economic hedging to manage certain balance sheet risks. These activities primarily occur within our Wholesale Banking businesses and to a lesser extent other divisions of the Company. All of our trading assets, and derivative assets and liabilities, (including securities, foreign exchange transactions, and commodity transactions) are carried at fair value. Income earned related to these trading activities include net interest income and changes in fair value related to trading assets and derivative assets and liabilities. Net interest income earned from trading activity is reflected in the interest income and interest expense components of our income statement. Changes in fair value related to trading assets, and derivative assets and liabilities are reflected in net gains on trading activities, a component of noninterest income in our income statement.
 
Table 31 presents total revenue from trading activities.
Table 31: Net Gains (Losses) from Trading Activities
 
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
(in millions)
 
2017

 
2016

 
2017

 
2016

Interest income (1)
 
$
710

 
572

 
$
1,353

 
1,168

Less: Interest expense (2)
 
108

 
83

 
200

 
172

Net interest income
 
602

 
489

 
1,153

 
996

Noninterest income:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net gains (losses) from trading activities (3):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Customer accommodation
 
187

 
380

 
532

 
599

Economic hedges and other (4)
 
50

 
(52
)
 
144

 
(71
)
Total net gains from trading activities
 
237

 
328

 
676

 
528

Total trading-related net interest and noninterest income
 
$
839

 
817

 
$
1,829

 
1,524

(1)
Represents interest and dividend income earned on trading securities.
(2)
Represents interest and dividend expense incurred on trading securities we have sold but have not yet purchased.
(3)
Represents realized gains (losses) from our trading activity and unrealized gains (losses) due to changes in fair value of our trading positions, attributable to the type of business activity.
(4)
Excludes economic hedging of mortgage banking and asset/liability management activities, for which hedge results (realized and unrealized) are reported with the respective hedged activities.
Customer accommodation  Customer accommodation activities are conducted to help customers manage their investment and risk management needs. We engage in market-making activities or act as an intermediary to purchase or sell financial instruments in anticipation of or in response to customer needs. This category also includes positions we use to manage our exposure to customer transactions.
In our customer accommodation trading, we serve as intermediary between buyer and seller. For example, we may purchase or sell a derivative to a customer who wants to manage interest rate risk exposure. We typically enter into offsetting derivative or security positions with a separate counterparty or exchange to manage our exposure to the derivative with our customer. We earn income on this activity based on the transaction price difference between the customer and offsetting derivative or security positions, which is reflected in the fair value changes of the positions recorded in net gains on trading activities.
Customer accommodation trading also includes net gains related to market-making activities in which we take positions to facilitate customer order flow. For example, we may own securities recorded as trading assets (long positions) or sold securities we have not yet purchased, recorded as trading liabilities (short positions), typically on a short-term basis, to facilitate support of buying and selling demand from our customers. As a market maker in these securities, we earn income due to: (1) the difference between the price paid or received for the purchase and sale of the security (bid-ask spread), (2) the net interest income, and (3) the change in fair value of the long or short positions during the short-term period held on our balance sheet. Additionally, we may enter into separate derivative or security positions to manage our exposure related to our long or short security positions. Income earned on this type of market-making activity is reflected in the fair value changes of these positions recorded in net gains on trading activities.

45


Economic hedges and other  Economic hedges in trading activities are not designated in a hedge accounting relationship and exclude economic hedging related to our asset/liability risk management and mortgage banking risk management activities. Economic hedging activities include the use of trading securities to economically hedge risk exposures related to non-trading activities or derivatives to hedge risk exposures related to trading assets or trading liabilities. Economic hedges are unrelated to our customer accommodation activities. Other activities include financial assets held for investment purposes that we elected to carry at fair value with changes in fair value recorded to earnings in order to mitigate accounting measurement mismatches or avoid embedded derivative accounting complexities.
 
Daily Trading-Related Revenue  Table 32 provides information on the distribution of daily trading-related revenues for the Company’s trading portfolio. This trading-related revenue is defined as the change in value of the trading assets and trading liabilities, trading-related net interest income, and trading-related intra-day gains and losses. Net trading-related revenue does not include activity related to long-term positions held for economic hedging purposes, period-end adjustments, and other activity not representative of daily price changes driven by market factors.
Table 32: Distribution of Daily Trading-Related Revenues MKTRISKTABLE32.JPG

Market Risk Market risk is the risk of possible economic loss from adverse changes in market risk factors such as interest rates, credit spreads, foreign exchange rates, equity, commodity prices, mortgage rates, and market liquidity. Market risk is intrinsic to the Company’s sales and trading, market making, investing, and risk management activities.
The Company uses value-at-risk (VaR) metrics complemented with sensitivity analysis and stress testing in measuring and monitoring market risk. VaR is a statistical risk measure used to estimate the potential loss from adverse moves in the financial markets. For more information on VaR, see the “Risk Management – Asset/Liability Management – Market Risk – Trading Activities” section in our 2016 Form 10-K.
 

Trading VaR is the measure used to provide insight into the market risk exhibited by the Company’s trading positions. The
Company calculates Trading VaR for risk management purposes to establish line of business and Company-wide risk limits. Trading VaR is calculated based on all trading positions classified as trading assets or other liabilities, derivative assets or derivative liabilities on our balance sheet.

46

Asset/Liability Management ( continued )

Table 33 shows the Company’s Trading General VaR by risk category. As presented in the table, average Company Trading General VaR was $ 29 million for the quarter ended June 30, 2017 , compared with $ 26 million for the quarter ended March 31,
 
2017 . The increase was primarily driven by changes in portfolio composition.
Table 33: Trading 1-Day 99% General VaR by Risk Category
 
 
 
Quarter ended
 
 
June 30, 2017
 
 
March 31, 2017
 
(in millions)
Period
end

 
Average

 
Low

 
High

 
Period
end

 
Average

 
Low

 
High

Company Trading General VaR Risk Categories
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Credit
$
23

 
29

 
23

 
36

 
27

 
25

 
19

 
30

Interest rate
10

 
20

 
10

 
27

 
22

 
18

 
13

 
23

Equity
10

 
11

 
9

 
14

 
10

 
12

 
9

 
17

Commodity
1

 
1

 
1

 
2

 
1

 
1

 
1

 
2

Foreign exchange
1

 
1

 
0

 
1

 
1

 
1

 
0

 
1

Diversification benefit (1)
(29
)
 
(33
)
 
 
 
 
 
(35
)
 
(31
)
 
 
 
 
Company Trading General VaR
$
16

 
29

 
 
 
 
 
26

 
26

 
 
 
 
(1)
The period-end VaR was less than the sum of the VaR components described above, which is due to portfolio diversification. The diversification effect arises because the risks are not perfectly correlated causing a portfolio of positions to usually be less risky than the sum of the risks of the positions alone. The diversification benefit is not meaningful for low and high metrics since they may occur on different days.

Regulatory Market Risk Capital   reflects U.S. regulatory agency risk-based capital regulations that are based on the Basel Committee Capital Accord of the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision. The Company must calculate regulatory capital under the Basel III market risk capital rule, which requires banking organizations with significant trading activities to adjust their capital requirements to reflect the market risks of those activities based on comprehensive and risk sensitive methods and models. The market risk capital rule is intended to cover the risk of loss in value of covered positions due to changes in market conditions.
 
Composition of Material Portfolio of Covered Positions  The positions that are “covered” by the market risk capital rule are generally a subset of our trading assets, and derivative assets and liabilities, specifically those held by the Company for the purpose of short-term resale or with the intent of benefiting from actual or expected short-term price movements, or to lock in arbitrage profits. Positions excluded from market risk regulatory capital treatment are subject to the credit risk capital rules applicable to the “non-covered” trading positions.
The material portfolio of the Company’s “covered” positions is mostly concentrated in the trading assets, and derivative assets and liabilities within Wholesale Banking where the substantial portion of market risk capital resides. Wholesale Banking engages in the fixed income, traded credit, foreign exchange, equities, and commodities markets businesses. Other business segments hold smaller trading positions covered under the market risk capital rule.

 
Regulatory Market Risk Capital Components   The capital required for market risk on the Company’s “covered” positions is determined by internally developed models or standardized specific risk charges. The market risk regulatory capital models are subject to internal model risk management and validation. The models are continuously monitored and enhanced in response to changes in market conditions, improvements in system capabilities, and changes in the Company’s market risk exposure. The Company is required to obtain and has received prior written approval from its regulators before using its internally developed models to calculate the market risk capital charge.
Basel III prescribes various VaR measures in the determination of regulatory capital and RWAs. The Company uses the same VaR models for both market risk management purposes as well as regulatory capital calculations. For regulatory purposes, we use the following metrics to determine the Company’s market risk capital requirements:
 
General VaR measures the risk of broad market movements such as changes in the level of credit spreads, interest rates, equity prices, commodity prices, and foreign exchange rates. General VaR uses historical simulation analysis based on 99% confidence level and a 10-day holding period.

47


Table 34 shows the General VaR measure categorized by major risk categories. Average 10-day Company Regulatory General VaR was $30 million for the quarter ended June 30, 2017 , compared with $26 million for the quarter ended March 31,
 
2017 . The increase was primarily driven by changes in portfolio composition.
Table 34: Regulatory 10-Day 99% General VaR by Risk Category
 
 
 
Quarter ended
 
 
June 30, 2017
 
 
March 31, 2017
 
(in millions)
Period
end

 
Average

 
Low

 
High

 
Period
end

 
Average

 
Low

 
High

Wholesale Regulatory General VaR Risk Categories
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Credit
$
60

 
72

 
57

 
93

 
69

 
67

 
52

 
81

Interest rate
17

 
39

 
17

 
71

 
47

 
38

 
25

 
50

Equity (1)
6

 
4

 
2

 
7

 
4

 
4

 
1

 
7

Commodity
11

 
4

 
3

 
11

 
3

 
4

 
2

 
6

Foreign exchange
8

 
6

 
3

 
29

 
7

 
6

 
4

 
10

Diversification benefit (2)
(71
)
 
(96
)
 
 
 
 
 
(103
)
 
(94
)
 
 
 
 
Wholesale Regulatory General VaR
$
31

 
29

 
24

 
37

 
27

 
25

 
16

 
37

Company Regulatory General VaR
35

 
30

 
25

 
40

 
27

 
26

 
17

 
38

(1)
The period-end VaR was less than the sum of the VaR components described above, which is due to portfolio diversification. The diversification benefit arises because the risks are not perfectly correlated causing a portfolio of positions to usually be less risky than the sum of the risks of the positions alone. The diversification benefit is not meaningful for low and high metrics since they may occur on different days.

Specific Risk measures the risk of loss that could result from factors other than broad market movements, or name-specific market risk. Specific Risk uses Monte Carlo simulation analysis based on a 99% confidence level and a 10-day holding period.

Total VaR (as presented in Table 35 ) is composed of General VaR and Specific Risk and uses the previous 12 months of historical market data in compliance with regulatory requirements.

Total Stressed VaR (as presented in Table 35 ) uses a historical period of significant financial stress over a continuous 12 month period using historically available market data and is composed of Stressed General VaR and Stressed Specific Risk. Total Stressed VaR uses the same methodology and models as Total VaR. 

Incremental Risk Charge (as presented in Table 35 ) captures losses due to both issuer default and migration risk at the 99.9% confidence level over the one-year capital horizon under the assumption of constant level of risk or a constant position assumption. The model covers non-securitized credit-sensitive trading products.
 
The Company calculates Incremental Risk by generating a portfolio loss distribution using Monte Carlo simulation, which assumes numerous scenarios, where an assumption is made that the portfolio’s composition remains constant for a one-year time horizon. Individual issuer credit grade migration and issuer default risk is modeled through generation of the issuer’s credit rating transition based upon statistical modeling. Correlation between credit grade migration and default is captured by a multifactor proprietary model which takes into account industry classifications as well as regional effects. Additionally, the impact of market and issuer specific concentrations is reflected in the modeling framework by assignment of a higher charge for portfolios that have increasing concentrations in particular issuers or sectors. Lastly, the model captures product basis risk; that is, it reflects the material disparity between a position and its hedge.
Table 35 provides information on Total VaR, Total Stressed VaR and the Incremental Risk Charge results for the quarter ended June 30, 2017 . Incremental Risk Charge uses the higher of the quarterly average or the quarter end result. For second quarter 2017 , the required capital for market risk equals the quarter end results.

Table 35: Market Risk Regulatory Capital Modeled Components
 
Quarter ended June 30, 2017
 
 
June 30, 2017
 
(in millions)
Average

 
Low

 
High

 
Period end

 
Risk-
based
capital (1)

 
Risk-
weighted
assets (1)

Total VaR
$
51

 
45

 
57

 
53

 
152

 
1,898

Total Stressed VaR
300

 
235

 
368

 
284

 
899

 
11,235

Incremental Risk Charge
26

 
20

 
40

 
30

 
30

 
375

(1)
Results represent the risk-based capital and RWAs based on the VaR and Incremental Risk Charge models.

Securitized Products Charge   Basel III requires a separate market risk capital charge for positions classified as a securitization or re-securitization. The primary criteria for classification as a securitization are whether there is a transfer of risk and whether the credit risk associated with the underlying exposures has been separated into at least two tranches reflecting different levels of
 
seniority. Covered trading securitizations positions include consumer and commercial asset-backed securities (ABS), commercial mortgage-backed securities (CMBS), residential mortgage-backed securities (RMBS), and collateralized loan and other debt obligations (CLO/CDO) positions. The securitization capital requirements are the greater of the capital requirements

48

Asset/Liability Management ( continued )

of the net long or short exposure, and are capped at the maximum loss that could be incurred on any given transaction.
Table 36 shows the aggregate net fair market value of securities and derivative securitization positions by exposure type that meet the regulatory definition of a covered trading securitization position at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 .
Table 36: Covered Securitization Positions by Exposure Type (Net Market Value)
(in millions)
ABS

 
CMBS

 
RMBS

 
CLO/CDO

June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securitization exposure:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities
$
961

 
306

 
630

 
782

Derivatives
3

 
(2
)
 
1

 
(3
)
Total
$
964

 
304

 
631

 
779

December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securitization exposure:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities
$
801

 
397

 
911

 
791

Derivatives
3

 
4

 
1

 
(8
)
Total
$
804

 
401

 
912

 
783

Securitization Due Diligence and Risk Monitoring The market risk capital rule requires that the Company conduct due diligence on the risk of each securitization position within three days of its purchase. The Company’s due diligence seeks to provide an understanding of the features that would materially affect the performance of a securitization or re-securitization. The due diligence analysis is re-performed on a quarterly basis for each
 
securitization and re-securitization position. The Company uses an automated solution to track the due diligence associated with securitization activity. The Company aims to manage the risks associated with securitization and re-securitization positions through the use of offsetting positions and portfolio diversification.

Standardized Specific Risk Charge   For debt and equity positions that are not evaluated by the approved internal specific risk models, a regulatory prescribed standard specific risk charge is applied. The standard specific risk add-on for sovereign entities, public sector entities, and depository institutions is based on the Organization for Economic Co-operation and Development (OECD) country risk classifications (CRC) and the remaining contractual maturity of the position. These risk add-ons for debt positions range from 0.25% to 12%. The add-on for corporate debt is based on creditworthiness and the remaining contractual maturity of the position. All other types of debt positions are subject to an 8% add-on. The standard specific risk add-on for equity positions is generally 8%.
 
Comprehensive Risk Charge / Correlation Trading   The market risk capital rule requires capital for correlation trading positions. The Company's remaining correlation trading exposure covered under the market risk capital rule matured in fourth quarter 2014.
Table 37 summarizes the market risk-based capital requirements charge and market RWAs in accordance with the Basel III market risk capital rule as of June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 . The market RWAs are calculated as the sum of the components in the table below.

Table 37: Market Risk Regulatory Capital and RWAs
 
June 30, 2017
 
 
December 31, 2016
 
(in millions)
Risk-
based
capital

 
Risk-
weighted
assets

 
Risk-
based
capital

 
Risk-
weighted
assets

Total VaR
$
152

 
1,898

 
247

 
3,091

Total Stressed VaR
899

 
11,235

 
1,135

 
14,183

Incremental Risk Charge
30

 
375

 
217

 
2,710

Securitized Products Charge
622

 
7,779

 
561

 
7,007

Standardized Specific Risk Charge
1,315

 
16,437

 
1,357

 
16,962

De minimis Charges (positions not included in models)
8

 
103

 
11

 
147

Total
$
3,026

 
37,827

 
3,528

 
44,100



49


RWA Rollforward   Table 38 depicts the changes in the market risk regulatory capital and RWAs under Basel III for the first half and second quarter of 2017 .
Table 38: Analysis of Changes in Market Risk Regulatory Capital and RWAs
(in millions)
Risk-
based
capital

 
Risk-
weighted
assets

Balance, December 31, 2016
$
3,528

 
44,100

Total VaR
(95
)
 
(1,192
)
Total Stressed VaR
(236
)
 
(2,948
)
Incremental Risk Charge
(187
)
 
(2,335
)
Securitized Products Charge
62

 
772

Standardized Specific Risk Charge
(42
)
 
(525
)
De minimis Charges
(4
)
 
(45
)
Balance, June 30, 2017
$
3,026

 
37,827

 
 
 
 
Balance, March 31, 2017
$
3,421

 
42,759

Total VaR
(63
)
 
(782
)
Total Stressed VaR
(159
)
 
(1,989
)
Incremental Risk Charge
(147
)
 
(1,837
)
Securitized Products Charge
53

 
663

Standardized Specific Risk Charge
(14
)
 
(178
)
De minimis Charges
(65
)
 
(809
)
Balance, June 30, 2017
$
3,026

 
37,827


The largest contributor to the changes to market risk regulatory capital and RWAs in the first half of 2017 was associated with changes in positions due to normal trading activity.

VaR Backtesting   The market risk capital rule requires backtesting as one form of validation of the VaR model. Backtesting is a comparison of the daily VaR estimate with the actual clean profit and loss (clean P&L) as defined by the market risk capital rule. Clean P&L is the change in the value of the Company’s covered trading positions that would have occurred had previous end-of-day covered trading positions remained unchanged (therefore, excluding fees, commissions, net interest income, and intraday trading gains and losses). The backtesting analysis compares the daily Total VaR for each of the trading days in the preceding 12 months with the net clean P&L. Clean P&L does not include credit adjustments and other activity not representative of daily price changes driven by market risk factors. The clean P&L measure of revenue is used to evaluate the performance of the Total VaR and is not comparable to our actual daily trading net revenues, as reported elsewhere in this Report.
 
Any observed clean P&L loss in excess of the Total VaR is considered a market risk regulatory capital backtesting exception. The actual number of exceptions (that is, the number of business days for which the clean P&L losses exceed the corresponding 1-day, 99% Total VaR measure) over the preceding 12 months is used to determine the capital multiplier for the capital calculation. The number of actual backtesting exceptions is dependent on current market performance relative to historic market volatility in addition to model performance and assumptions. This capital multiplier increases from a minimum of three to a maximum of four, depending on the number of exceptions. No backtesting exceptions occurred over the preceding 12 months. Backtesting is also performed at line of business levels within the Company.
Table 39 shows daily Total VaR (1-day, 99%) used for regulatory market risk capital backtesting for the 12 months ended June 30, 2017 . The Company’s average Total VaR for second quarter 2017 was $24 million with a low of $18 million and a high of $34 million . The decrease in Total 1-day VaR in second quarter 2017 was attributable to a decline in modeled Specific Risk.


50

Asset/Liability Management ( continued )

Table 39: Daily Total 1-Day 99% VaR Measure (Rolling 12 Months)
MKTRISKTABLE39.JPG

Market Risk Governance,   Measurement, Monitoring and Model Risk Management We employ a well-defined and structured market risk governance process and market risk measurement process, which incorporates value-at-risk (VaR) measurements combined with sensitivity analysis and stress testing to help us monitor our market risk. These monitoring measurements require the use of market risk models, which we govern by our Corporate Model Risk policies and procedures. For more information on our governance, measurement, monitoring, and model risk management practices, see the “Risk Management – Asset/Liability Management – Market Risk – Trading Activities” section in our 2016 Form 10-K.

MARKET RISK – EQUITY INVESTMENTS   We are directly and indirectly affected by changes in the equity markets. We make and manage direct equity investments in start-up businesses, emerging growth companies, management buy-outs, acquisitions and corporate recapitalizations. We also invest in non-affiliated funds that make similar private equity investments. These private equity investments are made within capital allocations approved by management and the Board. The Board’s policy is to review business developments, key risks and historical returns for the private equity investment portfolio at least annually. Management reviews these investments at least quarterly and assesses them for possible OTTI. For nonmarketable investments, the analysis is based on facts and circumstances of each individual investment and the expectations for that investment’s cash flows and capital needs, the viability of its business model and our exit strategy. Nonmarketable investments include private equity investments accounted for under the cost method, equity method and fair value option.
In conjunction with the March 2008 initial public offering (IPO) of Visa, Inc. (Visa), we received approximately 20.7 million shares of Visa Class B common stock, the class which was apportioned to member banks of Visa at the time of the IPO. To manage our exposure to Visa and realize the value of the appreciated Visa shares, we incrementally sold these shares
 

through a series of sales over the past few years, thereby eliminating this position as of September 30, 2015. As part of these sales, we agreed to compensate the buyer for any additional contributions to a litigation settlement fund for the litigation matters associated with the Class B shares we sold. Our exposure to this retained litigation risk has been updated quarterly and is reflected on our balance sheet. For additional information about the associated litigation matters, see the “Interchange Litigation” section in Note 11 (Legal Actions) to Financial Statements in this Report.
As part of our business to support our customers, we trade public equities, listed/OTC equity derivatives and convertible bonds. We have parameters that govern these activities. We also have marketable equity securities in the available-for-sale securities portfolio, including securities relating to our venture capital activities. We manage these investments within capital risk limits approved by management and the Board and monitored by Corporate ALCO and the Corporate Market Risk Committee. Gains and losses on these securities are recognized in net income when realized and periodically include OTTI charges.
Changes in equity market prices may also indirectly affect our net income by (1) the value of third party assets under management and, hence, fee income, (2) borrowers whose ability to repay principal and/or interest may be affected by the stock market, or (3) brokerage activity, related commission income and other business activities. Each business line monitors and manages these indirect risks.
Table 40 provides information regarding our marketable and nonmarketable equity investments as of June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 .

51


Table 40: Nonmarketable and Marketable Equity Investments
(in millions)
Jun 30,
2017

 
Dec 31,
2016

Nonmarketable equity investments:
 
 
 
Cost method:
 
 
 
Federal bank stock
$
5,820

 
6,407

Private equity
1,367

 
1,465

Auction rate securities
420

 
525

Total cost method
7,607

 
8,397

Equity method:
 
 
 
LIHTC (1)
9,828

 
9,714

Private equity
3,740

 
3,635

Tax-advantaged renewable energy
1,960

 
2,054

New market tax credit and other
295

 
305

Total equity method
15,823

 
15,708

Fair value (2)
3,986

 
3,275

Total nonmarketable equity investments (3)
$
27,416

 
27,380

Marketable equity securities:
 
 
 
Cost
$
614

 
706

Net unrealized gains
414

 
505

Total marketable equity securities (4)
$
1,028

 
1,211

(1)
Represents low income housing tax credit investments.
(2)
Represents nonmarketable equity investments for which we have elected the fair value option. See Note 6 (Other Assets) and Note 13 (Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities) to Financial Statements in this Report for additional information.
(3)
Included in other assets on the balance sheet. See Note 6 (Other Assets) to Financial Statements in this Report for additional information.
(4)
Included in available-for-sale securities. See Note 4 (Investment Securities) to Financial Statements in this Report for additional information.

LIQUIDITY AND FUNDING   The objective of effective liquidity management is to ensure that we can meet customer loan requests, customer deposit maturities/withdrawals and other cash commitments efficiently under both normal operating conditions and under periods of Wells Fargo-specific and/or market stress. To achieve this objective, the Board of Directors establishes liquidity guidelines that require sufficient asset-based liquidity to cover potential funding requirements and to avoid over-dependence on volatile, less reliable funding markets. These guidelines are monitored on a monthly basis by the Corporate ALCO and on a quarterly basis by the Board of Directors. These guidelines are established and monitored for both the consolidated company and for the Parent on a stand-alone basis to ensure that the Parent is a source of strength for its regulated, deposit-taking banking subsidiaries.

Liquidity Standards On September 3, 2014, the FRB, OCC and FDIC issued a final rule that implements a quantitative liquidity requirement consistent with the liquidity coverage ratio (LCR) established by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (BCBS). The rule requires banking institutions, such as Wells Fargo, to hold high-quality liquid assets (HQLA), such as central bank reserves and government and corporate debt that can be converted easily and quickly into cash, in an amount equal to or greater than its projected net cash outflows during a 30-day stress period. The rule is applicable to the Company on a consolidated basis and to our insured depository institutions with total assets greater than $10 billion. In addition, the FRB finalized rules imposing enhanced liquidity management standards on large bank holding companies (BHC) such as Wells Fargo, and finalized a rule that requires large bank holding companies to publicly disclose on a quarterly basis beginning
 
April 1, 2017, certain quantitative and qualitative information regarding their LCR calculations.
The FRB, OCC and FDIC have proposed a rule that would implement a stable funding requirement, the net stable funding ratio (NSFR), which would require large banking organizations, such as Wells Fargo, to maintain a sufficient amount of stable funding in relation to their assets, derivative exposures and commitments over a one-year horizon period. As proposed, the rule would become effective on January 1, 2018.

Liquidity Coverage Ratio As of June 30, 2017, the consolidated Company and Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. were above the minimum LCR requirement of 100%, which is calculated as HQLA divided by projected net cash outflows, as each is defined under the LCR rule. Table 41 presents the Company’s quarterly average values for the daily-calculated LCR and its components calculated pursuant to the LCR rule requirements.

Table 41: Liquidity Coverage Ratio
(in billions)
Average for Quarter ended June 30, 2017

HQLA (1)(2)
389

Projected net cash outflows
314

LCR
124
%
HQLA in excess of projected net cash outflows
75

(1) Excludes excess HQLA at Wells Fargo Bank, N.A.
(2) Net of applicable haircuts required under the LCR rule.
Liquidity Sources We maintain liquidity in the form of cash, cash equivalents and unencumbered high-quality, liquid securities. These assets make up our primary sources of liquidity which are presented in Table 42 . Our primary sources of liquidity are substantially the same in composition as HQLA under the LCR rule; however, our primary sources of liquidity will generally exceed HQLA calculated under the LCR rule due to the applicable haircuts to HQLA and the exclusion of excess HQLA at our subsidiary insured depository institutions required under the LCR rule.
Our cash is predominantly on deposit with the Federal Reserve. Securities included as part of our primary sources of liquidity are comprised of U.S. Treasury and federal agency debt, and mortgage-backed securities issued by federal agencies within our investment securities portfolio. We believe these securities provide quick sources of liquidity through sales or by pledging to obtain financing, regardless of market conditions. Some of these securities are within the held-to-maturity portion of our investment securities portfolio and as such are not intended for sale but may be pledged to obtain financing. Some of the legal entities within our consolidated group of companies are subject to various regulatory, tax, legal and other restrictions that can limit the transferability of their funds. We believe we maintain adequate liquidity for these entities in consideration of such funds transfer restrictions.

52

Asset/Liability Management ( continued )

Table 42: Primary Sources of Liquidity
 
June 30, 2017
 
 
December 31, 2016
 
(in millions)
Total

 
Encumbered

 
Unencumbered

 
Total

 
Encumbered

 
Unencumbered

Interest-earning deposits
$
195,700

 

 
195,700

 
$
200,671

 

 
200,671

Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
63,231

 
1,182

 
62,049

 
70,898

 
1,160

 
69,738

Mortgage-backed securities of federal agencies (1)
222,643

 
53,146

 
169,497

 
205,655

 
52,672

 
152,983

Total
$
481,574

 
54,328

 
427,246

 
$
477,224

 
53,832

 
423,392

(1)
Included in encumbered securities at June 30, 2017 , were securities with a fair value of $6.2 billion which were purchased in June 2017, but settled in July 2017.

In addition to our primary sources of liquidity shown in Table 42 , liquidity is also available through the sale or financing of other securities including trading and/or available-for-sale securities, as well as through the sale, securitization or financing of loans, to the extent such securities and loans are not encumbered. In addition, other securities in our held-to-maturity portfolio, to the extent not encumbered, may be pledged to obtain financing.
 
Deposits have historically provided a sizable source of relatively low-cost funds. Deposits were 136% of total loans at June 30, 2017 and 135% at December 31, 2016 . Additional funding is provided by long-term debt and short-term borrowings.
Table 43 shows selected information for short-term borrowings, which generally mature in less than 30 days.
Table 43: Short-Term Borrowings
 
Quarter ended
 
(in millions)
Jun 30
2017

 
Mar 31,
2017

 
Dec 31,
2016

 
Sep 30,
2016

 
Jun 30,
2016

Balance, period end
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal funds purchased and securities sold under agreements to repurchase
$
78,683

 
76,366

 
78,124

 
108,468

 
104,812

Commercial paper
11

 
10

 
120

 
123

 
154

Other short-term borrowings
16,662

 
18,495

 
18,537

 
16,077

 
15,292

Total
$
95,356

 
94,871

 
96,781

 
124,668

 
120,258

Average daily balance for period
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal funds purchased and securities sold under agreements to repurchase
$
79,826

 
79,942

 
107,271

 
101,252

 
97,702

Commercial paper
10

 
51

 
121

 
137

 
326

Other short-term borrowings
15,927

 
18,556

 
17,306

 
14,839

 
13,820

Total
$
95,763

 
98,549

 
124,698

 
116,228

 
111,848

Maximum month-end balance for period
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal funds purchased and securities sold under agreements to repurchase (1)
$
78,683

 
81,284

 
109,645

 
108,468

 
104,812

Commercial paper (2)
11

 
78

 
121

 
138

 
451

Other short-term borrowings (3)
18,281

 
19,439

 
18,537

 
16,077

 
15,292

(1)
Highest month-end balance in each of the last five quarters was in June , February 2017, October, September and June 2016.
(2)
Highest month-end balance in each of the last five quarters was in June , January 2017, November, July and April 2016.
(3)
Highest month-end balance in each of the last five quarters was in April , February 2017, December, September and June 2016.
We access domestic and international capital markets for long-term funding (generally greater than one year) through issuances of registered debt securities, private placements and asset-backed secured funding.

Long-Term Debt We issue long-term debt in a variety of maturities and currencies to achieve cost-efficient funding and to maintain an appropriate maturity profile. Long-term debt of $238.9 billion at June 30, 2017 , decreased $16.2 billion from December 31, 2016. We issued $14.8 billion and $28.0 billion of long-term debt in the second quarter and first half of 2017 , respectively. Table 44 provides the aggregate carrying value of long-term debt maturities (based on contractual payment dates) for the remainder of 2017 and the following years thereafter, as of June 30, 2017 .

53


Table 44: Maturity of Long-Term Debt
 
June 30, 2017
 
(in millions)
Remaining 2017

 
2018

 
2019

 
2020

 
2021

 
Thereafter

 
Total

Wells Fargo & Company (Parent Only)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Senior notes
$
5,305

 
8,006

 
6,717

 
13,214

 
17,865

 
65,461

 
116,568

Subordinated notes

 
591

 

 

 

 
26,338

 
26,929

Junior subordinated notes

 

 

 

 

 
1,657

 
1,657

Total long-term debt - Parent
$
5,305

 
8,597

 
6,717

 
13,214

 
17,865

 
93,456

 
145,154

Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. and other bank entities (Bank)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Senior notes
$
8,203

 
28,153

 
21,388

 
5,510

 
10,236

 
218

 
73,708

Subordinated notes
1,029

 

 

 

 

 
5,387

 
6,416

Junior subordinated notes

 

 

 

 

 
337

 
337

Securitizations and other bank debt
3,744

 
1,715

 
679

 
614

 
144

 
2,965

 
9,861

Total long-term debt - Bank
$
12,976

 
29,868

 
22,067

 
6,124

 
10,380

 
8,907

 
90,322

Other consolidated subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Senior notes
$

 
778

 
1,160

 

 
988

 
394

 
3,320

Junior subordinated notes

 

 

 

 

 

 

Securitizations and other bank debt

 
73

 

 

 

 

 
73

Total long-term debt - Other consolidated subsidiaries
$

 
851

 
1,160

 

 
988

 
394

 
3,393

Total long-term debt
$
18,281

 
39,316

 
29,944

 
19,338

 
29,233

 
102,757

 
238,869

Parent Under SEC rules, our Parent is classified as a “well-known seasoned issuer,” which allows it to file a registration statement that does not have a limit on issuance capacity. In February 2017, the Parent filed a registration statement with the SEC for the issuance of senior and subordinated notes, preferred stock and other securities. The Parent’s ability to issue debt and other securities under this registration statement is limited by the debt issuance authority granted by the Board. As of June 30, 2017 , the Parent was authorized by the Board to issue up to $50 billion in outstanding short-term debt and $180 billion in outstanding long-term debt. The Parent’s short-term debt issuance authority granted by the Board is limited to debt issued to affiliates, while the Parent’s long-term debt issuance authority granted by the Board includes debt issued to affiliates and others. At June 30, 2017 , the Parent had available $49.5 billion in short-term debt issuance authority and $26.5 billion in long-term debt issuance authority. During the first half of 2017 , the Parent issued $16.9 billion of senior notes, of which $12.1 billion were registered with the SEC. Additionally, in July 2017, the Parent issued $4.6 billion of senior notes, of which $3.8 billion were registered with the SEC.
The Parent’s proceeds from securities issued were used for general corporate purposes, and, unless otherwise specified in the applicable prospectus or prospectus supplement, we expect the proceeds from securities issued in the future will be used for the same purposes. Depending on market conditions, we may purchase our outstanding debt securities from time to time in privately negotiated or open market transactions, by tender offer, or otherwise.

Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. As of June 30, 2017 , Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. was authorized by its board of directors to issue $100 billion  in outstanding short-term debt and $175 billion in outstanding long-term debt and had available $95.8 billion in short-term debt issuance authority and $95.0 billion in long-term debt issuance authority. In April 2015, Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. established a $100 billion bank note program under which, subject to any other debt outstanding under the limits described above, it may issue $50 billion in outstanding short-term senior
 
notes and $50 billion in outstanding long-term senior or subordinated notes. At June 30, 2017 , Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. had remaining issuance capacity under the bank note program of $50.0 billion in short-term senior notes and $36.0 billion in long-term senior or subordinated notes. During the first half of 2017 , Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. issued $585 million of unregistered senior notes, none of which were issued under the bank note program. In addition, during the first half of 2017 , Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. executed advances of $14.4 billion with the Federal Home Loan Bank of Des Moines, and as of June 30, 2017 , Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. had outstanding advances of $62.6 billion across the Federal Home Loan Bank System. In addition, in July 2017, Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. executed $2.0 billion of Federal Home Loan Bank advances.

Credit Ratings Investors in the long-term capital markets, as well as other market participants, generally will consider, among other factors, a company’s debt rating in making investment decisions. Rating agencies base their ratings on many quantitative and qualitative factors, including capital adequacy, liquidity, asset quality, business mix, the level and quality of earnings, and rating agency assumptions regarding the probability and extent of federal financial assistance or support for certain large financial institutions. Adverse changes in these factors could result in a reduction of our credit rating; however, our debt securities do not contain credit rating covenants.
On May 24, 2017, Moody’s Investors Service affirmed all of the Company’s ratings. There were no other significant actions undertaken by the rating agencies with regard to our ratings during second quarter 2017. Both the Parent and Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. remain among the top-rated financial firms in the U.S.
See the “Risk Factors” section in our 2016 Form 10-K for additional information regarding our credit ratings and the potential impact a credit rating downgrade would have on our liquidity and operations, as well as Note 12 (Derivatives) to Financial Statements in this Report for information regarding additional collateral and funding obligations required for certain

54

Asset/Liability Management ( continued )

derivative instruments in the event our credit ratings were to fall below investment grade.
The credit ratings of the Parent and Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. as of June 30, 2017 , are presented in Table 45 .
 

Table 45: Credit Ratings as of June 30, 2017
 
Wells Fargo & Company
 
Wells Fargo Bank, N.A.
 
Senior debt
 
Short-term
borrowings 
 
Long-term
deposits 
 
Short-term
borrowings 
Moody's
 A2
 
 P-1
 
 Aa1
 
 P-1
S&P
 A
 
 A-1
 
 AA-
 
 A-1+
Fitch Ratings, Inc.
 AA-
 
 F1+
 
 AA+
 
 F1+
DBRS
 AA
 
 R-1*
 
 AA**
 
 R-1**
* middle ** high
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
FEDERAL HOME LOAN BANK MEMBERSHIP The Federal Home Loan Banks (the FHLBs) are a group of cooperatives that lending institutions use to finance housing and economic development in local communities. We are a member of the FHLBs based in Dallas, Des Moines and San Francisco. Each member of the FHLBs is required to maintain a minimum investment in capital stock of the applicable FHLB. The board of directors of each FHLB can increase the minimum investment requirements in the event it has concluded that additional capital is required to allow it to meet its own regulatory capital requirements. Any increase in the minimum investment requirements outside of specified ranges requires the approval of the Federal Housing Finance Board. Because the extent of any obligation to increase our investment in any of the FHLBs depends entirely upon the occurrence of a future event, potential future payments to the FHLBs are not determinable.


55


Capital Management

We have an active program for managing capital through a comprehensive process for assessing the Company’s overall capital adequacy. Our objective is to maintain capital at an amount commensurate with our risk profile and risk tolerance objectives, and to meet both regulatory and market expectations. We primarily fund our capital needs through the retention of earnings net of both dividends and share repurchases, as well as through the issuance of preferred stock and long and short-term debt. Retained earnings increased $6.4 billion from December 31, 2016 , predominantly from Wells Fargo net income of $11.3 billion , less common and preferred stock dividends of $4.6 billion . During second quarter 2017 , we issued 13.0 million shares of common stock. We also issued 27.6 million Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/1,000 th interest in a share of the Company’s newly issued Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock, Series Y, for an aggregate public offering price of $690 million. During second quarter 2017, we repurchased 43.0 million shares of common stock in open market transactions, private transactions and from employee benefit plans, at a cost of $2.3 billion . We also entered into a $1 billion forward repurchase contract with an unrelated third party in July 2017 that is expected to settle in fourth quarter 2017 for approximately 19 million shares. For additional information about our forward repurchase agreements, see Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) to Financial Statements in this Report.
 
Regulatory Capital Guidelines
The Company and each of our insured depository institutions are subject to various regulatory capital adequacy requirements administered by the FRB and the OCC. Risk-based capital (RBC) guidelines establish a risk-adjusted ratio relating capital to different categories of assets and off-balance sheet exposures as discussed below.

RISK-BASED CAPITAL AND RISK-WEIGHTED ASSETS The Company is subject to final and interim final rules issued by federal banking regulators to implement Basel III capital requirements for U.S. banking organizations. These rules are based on international guidelines for determining regulatory capital issued by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (BCBS). The federal banking regulators’ capital rules, among other things, require on a fully phased-in basis:
a minimum Common Equity Tier 1 (CET1) ratio of 9.0%, comprised of a 4.5% minimum requirement plus a capital conservation buffer of 2.5% and for us, as a global systemically important bank (G-SIB), a capital surcharge to be calculated annually, which is 2.0% based on our year-end 2015 data;
a minimum tier 1 capital ratio of 10.5%, comprised of a 6.0% minimum requirement plus the capital conservation buffer of 2.5% and the G-SIB capital surcharge of 2.0%;
a minimum total capital ratio of 12.5%, comprised of a 8.0% minimum requirement plus the capital conservation buffer of 2.5% and the G-SIB capital surcharge of 2.0%;
a potential countercyclical buffer of up to 2.5% to be added to the minimum capital ratios, which is currently not in effect but could be imposed by regulators at their discretion if it is determined that a period of excessive credit growth is contributing to an increase in systemic risk;
 
a minimum tier 1 leverage ratio of 4.0%; and
a minimum supplementary leverage ratio (SLR) of 5.0% (comprised of a 3.0% minimum requirement plus a supplementary leverage buffer of 2.0%) for large and internationally active bank holding companies (BHCs).

We were required to comply with the final Basel III capital rules beginning January 2014, with certain provisions subject to phase-in periods. The Basel III capital rules are scheduled to be fully phased in by the end of 2021. The Basel III capital rules contain two frameworks for calculating capital requirements, a Standardized Approach, which replaced Basel I, and an Advanced Approach applicable to certain institutions, including Wells Fargo. Accordingly, in the assessment of our capital adequacy, we must report the lower of our CET1, tier 1 and total capital ratios calculated under the Standardized Approach and under the Advanced Approach.
Because the Company has been designated as a G-SIB, we will also be subject to the FRB’s rule implementing the additional capital surcharge of between 1.0-4.5% on G-SIBs. Under the rule, we must annually calculate our surcharge under two methods and use the higher of the two surcharges. The first method (method one) will consider our size, interconnectedness, cross-jurisdictional activity, substitutability, and complexity, consistent with a methodology developed by the BCBS and the Financial Stability Board (FSB). The second (method two) will use similar inputs, but will replace substitutability with use of short-term wholesale funding and will generally result in higher surcharges than the BCBS methodology. The phase-in period for the G-SIB surcharge began on January 1, 2016 and will become fully effective on January 1, 2019. Based on year-end 2015 data, our 2017 G-SIB surcharge under method two is 2.0% of the Company’s RWAs, which is the higher of method one and method two. Because the G-SIB surcharge is calculated annually based on data that can differ over time, the amount of the surcharge is subject to change in future years. Under the Standardized Approach (fully phased-in), our CET1 ratio of 11.59% exceeded the minimum of 9.0% by 259 basis points at June 30, 2017 .
The tables that follow provide information about our risk- based capital and related ratios as calculated under Basel III capital guidelines. For banking industry regulatory reporting purposes, we report our capital in accordance with Transition Requirements but are managing our capital based on a fully phased-in calculation. For information about our capital requirements calculated in accordance with Transition Requirements, see Note 19 (Regulatory and Agency Capital Requirements) to Financial Statements in this Report.

56

Capital Management ( continued )

Table 46 summarizes our CET1, tier 1 capital, total capital, risk-weighted assets and capital ratios on a fully phased-in basis at June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016 . As of June 30, 2017 , our CET1 and tier 1 capital ratios were lower using RWAs calculated under the Standardized Approach.
 




Table 46: Capital Components and Ratios (Fully Phased-In) (1)
 
 
June 30, 2017
 
 
 
December 31, 2016
 
 
(in millions)
 
Advanced Approach

 
Standardized Approach

 
 
Advanced Approach

 
Standardized Approach

 
Common Equity Tier 1
(A)
$
151,854

 
151,854

 
 
146,424

 
146,424

 
Tier 1 Capital
(B)
175,258

 
175,258

 
 
169,063

 
169,063

 
Total Capital
(C)
206,454

 
216,318

 
 
200,344

 
210,796

 
Risk-Weighted Assets
(D)
1,257,523

 
1,310,483

 
 
1,298,688

 
1,358,933

 
Common Equity Tier 1 Capital Ratio
(A)/(D)
12.08
%
 
11.59

*
 
11.27

 
10.77

*
Tier 1 Capital Ratio
(B)/(D)
13.94

 
13.37

*
 
13.02

 
12.44

*
Total Capital Ratio
(C)/(D)
16.42

*
16.51

 
 
15.43

*
15.51

 
*Denotes the lowest capital ratio as determined under the Advanced and Standardized Approaches.
(1)
Fully phased-in regulatory capital amounts, ratios and RWAs are considered non-GAAP financial measures that are used by management, bank regulatory agencies, investors and analysts to assess and monitor the Company’s capital position. See Table 47 for information regarding the calculation and components of CET1, tier 1 capital, total capital and RWAs, as well as the corresponding reconciliation of our regulatory capital amounts to GAAP financial measures.

57


Table 47 provides information regarding the calculation and composition of our risk-based capital under the Advanced and Standardized Approaches at June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016 .
 


Table 47: Risk-Based Capital Calculation and Components
 
 
June 30, 2017
 
 
December 31, 2016
 
(in millions)
 
Advanced Approach

 
Standardized Approach

 
Advanced Approach

 
Standardized Approach

Total equity
 
$
206,145

 
206,145

 
200,497

 
200,497

Adjustments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Preferred stock
 
(25,785
)
 
(25,785
)
 
(24,551
)
 
(24,551
)
Additional paid-in capital on ESOP preferred stock
 
(136
)
 
(136
)
 
(126
)
 
(126
)
Unearned ESOP shares
 
2,119

 
2,119

 
1,565

 
1,565

Noncontrolling interests
 
(915
)
 
(915
)
 
(916
)
 
(916
)
Total common stockholders' equity

181,428

 
181,428

 
176,469

 
176,469

Adjustments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Goodwill
 
(26,573
)
 
(26,573
)
 
(26,693
)
 
(26,693
)
Certain identifiable intangible assets (other than MSRs)
 
(2,147
)
 
(2,147
)
 
(2,723
)
 
(2,723
)
Other assets (1)
 
(2,268
)
 
(2,268
)
 
(2,088
)
 
(2,088
)
Applicable deferred taxes (2)
 
1,624

 
1,624

 
1,772

 
1,772

Investment in certain subsidiaries and other
 
(210
)
 
(210
)
 
(313
)
 
(313
)
Common Equity Tier 1 (Fully Phased-In)

151,854

 
151,854

 
146,424

 
146,424

Effect of Transition Requirements
 
888

 
888


2,361

 
2,361

Common Equity Tier 1 (Transition Requirements)
 
$
152,742

 
152,742

 
148,785

 
148,785

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Common Equity Tier 1 (Fully Phased-In)
 
$
151,854

 
151,854

 
146,424

 
146,424

Preferred stock
 
25,785

 
25,785

 
24,551

 
24,551

Additional paid-in capital on ESOP preferred stock
 
136

 
136

 
126

 
126

Unearned ESOP shares
 
(2,119
)
 
(2,119
)
 
(1,565
)
 
(1,565
)
Other
 
(398
)
 
(398
)
 
(473
)
 
(473
)
Total Tier 1 capital (Fully Phased-In)
(A)
175,258

 
175,258

 
169,063

 
169,063

Effect of Transition Requirements
 
876

 
876

 
2,301

 
2,301

Total Tier 1 capital (Transition Requirements)
 
$
176,134

 
176,134

 
171,364

 
171,364

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total Tier 1 capital (Fully Phased-In)
 
$
175,258

 
175,258

 
169,063

 
169,063

Long-term debt and other instruments qualifying as Tier 2
 
29,223

 
29,223

 
29,465

 
29,465

Qualifying allowance for credit losses (3)
 
2,282

 
12,146

 
2,088

 
12,540

Other
 
(309
)
 
(309
)
 
(272
)
 
(272
)
Total Tier 2 capital (Fully Phased-In)
(B)
31,196

 
41,060

 
31,281

 
41,733

Effect of Transition Requirements
 
1,205

 
1,205

 
1,780

 
1,780

Total Tier 2 capital (Transition Requirements)
 
$
32,401

 
42,265

 
33,061

 
43,513

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total qualifying capital (Fully Phased-In)
(A)+(B)
$
206,454

 
216,318

 
200,344

 
210,796

Total Effect of Transition Requirements
 
2,081

 
2,081

 
4,081

 
4,081

Total qualifying capital (Transition Requirements)
 
$
208,535

 
218,399

 
204,425

 
214,877

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Risk-Weighted Assets (RWAs) (4)(5):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Credit risk
 
$
920,271

 
1,272,656

 
960,763

 
1,314,833

Market risk
 
37,827

 
37,827

 
44,100

 
44,100

Operational risk
 
299,425

 
N/A

 
293,825

 
N/A

Total RWAs (Fully Phased-In)
 
$
1,257,523

 
1,310,483

 
1,298,688

 
1,358,933

Credit risk
 
$
895,726

 
1,249,500

 
936,664

 
1,292,098

Market risk
 
37,827

 
37,827

 
44,100

 
44,100

Operational risk
 
299,424

 
N/A

 
293,825

 
N/A

Total RWAs (Transition Requirements)
 
$
1,232,977

 
1,287,327

 
1,274,589

 
1,336,198

(1)
Represents goodwill and other intangibles on nonmarketable equity investments and on held-for-sale assets, which are included in other assets.
(2)
Applicable deferred taxes relate to goodwill and other intangible assets. They were determined by applying the combined federal statutory rate and composite state income tax rates to the difference between book and tax basis of the respective goodwill and intangible assets at period end.
(3)
Under the Advanced Approach the allowance for credit losses that exceeds expected credit losses is eligible for inclusion in Tier 2 Capital, to the extent the excess allowance does not exceed 0.6% of Advanced credit RWAs, and under the Standardized Approach, the allowance for credit losses is includable in Tier 2 Capital up to 1.25% of Standardized credit RWAs, with any excess allowance for credit losses being deducted from total RWAs.
(4)
RWAs calculated under the Advanced Approach utilize a risk-sensitive methodology, which relies upon the use of internal credit models based upon our experience with internal rating grades. Advanced Approach also includes an operational risk component, which reflects the risk of operating loss resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes or systems.
(5)
Under the regulatory guidelines for risk-based capital, on-balance sheet assets and credit equivalent amounts of derivatives and off-balance sheet items are assigned to one of several broad risk categories according to the obligor, or, if relevant, the guarantor or the nature of any collateral. The aggregate dollar amount in each risk category is then multiplied by the risk weight associated with that category. The resulting weighted values from each of the risk categories are aggregated for determining total RWAs.

58

Capital Management ( continued )

Table 48 presents the changes in Common Equity Tier 1 under the Advanced Approach for the six months ended June 30, 2017 .
 


Table 48: Analysis of Changes in Common Equity Tier 1
(in millions)
 
 
Common Equity Tier 1 (Fully Phased-In) at December 31, 2016
 
$
146,424

Net income
 
10,460

Common stock dividends
 
(3,802
)
Common stock issued, repurchased, and stock compensation-related items
 
(2,716
)
Goodwill
 
120

Certain identifiable intangible assets (other than MSRs)
 
576

Other assets (1)
 
(181
)
Applicable deferred taxes (2)
 
(148
)
Investment in certain subsidiaries and other
 
1,121

Change in Common Equity Tier 1
 
5,430

Common Equity Tier 1 (Fully Phased-In) at June 30, 2017
 
$
151,854

(1)
Represents goodwill and other intangibles on nonmarketable equity investments and on held-for-sale assets, which are included in other assets.
(2)
Applicable deferred taxes relate to goodwill and other intangible assets. They were determined by applying the combined federal statutory rate and composite state income tax rates to the difference between book and tax basis of the respective goodwill and intangible assets at period end.

Table 49 presents net changes in the components of RWAs under the Advanced and Standardized Approaches for the six months ended June 30, 2017 .
 


Table 49: Analysis of Changes in RWAs
(in millions)
Advanced Approach

Standardized Approach

RWAs (Fully Phased-In) at December 31, 2016
$
1,298,688

1,358,933

Net change in credit risk RWAs
(40,492
)
(42,177
)
Net change in market risk RWAs
(6,273
)
(6,273
)
Net change in operational risk RWAs
5,600

N/A

Total change in RWAs
(41,165
)
(48,450
)
RWAs (Fully Phased-In) at June 30, 2017
1,257,523

1,310,483

Effect of Transition Requirements
(24,546
)
(23,156
)
RWAs (Transition Requirements) at June 30, 2017
$
1,232,977

1,287,327




59


TANGIBLE COMMON EQUITY We also evaluate our business based on certain ratios that utilize tangible common equity. Tangible common equity is a non-GAAP financial measure and represents total equity less preferred equity, noncontrolling interests, and goodwill and certain identifiable intangible assets (including goodwill and intangible assets associated with certain of our nonmarketable equity investments but excluding mortgage servicing rights), net of applicable deferred taxes. These tangible common equity ratios are as follows:
Tangible book value per common share, which represents tangible common equity divided by common shares outstanding.
 
Return on average tangible common equity (ROTCE), which represents our annualized earnings contribution as a percentage of tangible common equity.

The methodology of determining tangible common equity may differ among companies. Management believes that tangible book value per common share and return on average tangible common equity, which utilize tangible common equity, are useful financial measures because they enable investors and others to assess the Company's use of equity.
Table 50 provides a reconciliation of these non-GAAP financial measures to GAAP financial measures.

Table 50: Tangible Common Equity
 
 
 
Balance at period end
 
Average balance
 
 
 
Quarter ended
 
Quarter ended
 
Six months ended
(in millions, except ratios)
 
 
Jun 30,
2017

Mar 31,
2017

Jun 30,
2016

 
Jun 30,
2017

 
Mar 31,
2017

Jun 30,
2016

 
Jun 30,
2017

Jun 30,
2016

Total equity
 
 
$
206,145

202,489

202,661

 
205,968

 
201,767

201,003

 
203,879

198,795

Adjustments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Preferred stock
 
 
(25,785
)
(25,501
)
(24,830
)
 
(25,849
)
 
(25,163
)
(24,091
)
 
(25,508
)
(24,027
)
Additional paid-in capital on ESOP preferred stock
 
 
(136
)
(157
)
(150
)
 
(144
)
 
(146
)
(168
)
 
(145
)
(184
)
Unearned ESOP shares
 
 
2,119

2,546

1,868

 
2,366

 
2,198

2,094

 
2,282

2,302

Noncontrolling interests
 
 
(915
)
(989
)
(916
)
 
(910
)
 
(957
)
(984
)
 
(934
)
(944
)
Total common stockholders' equity
(A)
 
181,428

178,388

178,633

 
181,431

 
177,699

177,854

 
179,574

175,942

Adjustments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Goodwill
 
 
(26,573
)
(26,666
)
(26,963
)
 
(26,664
)
 
(26,673
)
(27,037
)
 
(26,668
)
(26,553
)
Certain identifiable intangible assets (other than MSRs)
 
 
(2,147
)
(2,449
)
(3,356
)
 
(2,303
)
 
(2,588
)
(3,600
)
 
(2,445
)
(3,503
)
Other assets (1)
 
 
(2,268
)
(2,121
)
(2,110
)
 
(2,160
)
 
(2,095
)
(2,096
)
 
(2,128
)
(2,081
)
Applicable deferred taxes (2)
 
 
1,624

1,698

1,906

 
1,648

 
1,722

1,934

 
1,685

1,974

Tangible common equity
(B)
 
$
152,064

148,850

148,110

 
151,952

 
148,065

147,055

 
150,018

145,779

Common shares outstanding
(C)
 
4,966.8

4,996.7

5,048.5

 
N/A

 
N/A

N/A

 
N/A

N/A

Net income applicable to common stock (3)
(D)
 
N/A

N/A

N/A

 
$
5,404

 
5,056

5,173

 
10,460

10,258

Book value per common share
(A)/(C)
 
$
36.53

35.70

35.38

 
N/A

 
N/A

N/A

 
N/A

N/A

Tangible book value per common share
(B)/(C)
 
30.62

29.79

29.34

 
N/A

 
N/A

N/A

 
N/A

N/A

Return on average common stockholders’ equity (ROE)
(D)/(A)
 
N/A

N/A

N/A

 
11.95

%
11.54

11.70

 
11.75

11.72

Return on average tangible common equity (ROTCE)
(D)/(B)
 
N/A

N/A

N/A

 
14.26

 
13.85

14.15

 
14.06

14.15

(1)
Represents goodwill and other intangibles on nonmarketable equity investments and on held-for-sale assets, which are included in other assets.
(2)
Applicable deferred taxes relate to goodwill and other intangible assets. They were determined by applying the combined federal statutory rate and composite state income tax rates to the difference between book and tax basis of the respective goodwill and intangible assets at period end.
(3)
Quarter ended net income applicable to common stock is annualized for the respective ROE and ROTCE ratios.


60

Capital Management ( continued )

SUPPLEMENTARY LEVERAGE RATIO In April 2014, federal banking regulators finalized a rule that enhances the SLR requirements for BHCs, like Wells Fargo, and their insured depository institutions. The SLR consists of Tier 1 capital divided by the Company’s total leverage exposure. Total leverage exposure consists of the total average on-balance sheet assets, plus off-balance sheet exposures, such as undrawn commitments and derivative exposures, less amounts permitted to be deducted from Tier 1 capital. The rule, which becomes effective on January 1, 2018, will require a covered BHC to maintain a SLR of at least 5.0% (comprised of the 3.0% minimum requirement plus a supplementary leverage buffer of 2.0%) to avoid restrictions on capital distributions and discretionary bonus payments. The rule will also require that all of our insured depository institutions maintain a SLR of 6.0% under applicable regulatory capital adequacy guidelines. In September 2014, federal banking regulators finalized additional changes to the SLR requirements to implement revisions to the Basel III leverage framework finalized by the BCBS in January 2014. These additional changes, among other things, modify the methodology for including off- balance sheet items, including credit derivatives, repo-style transactions and lines of credit, in the denominator of the SLR, and will become effective on January 1, 2018. At June 30, 2017 , our SLR for the Company was 7.9% assuming full phase-in of the Advanced Approach capital framework. Based on our review, our current leverage levels would exceed the applicable requirements for each of our insured depository institutions as well. The fully phased-in SLR is considered a non-GAAP financial measure that is used by management, bank regulatory agencies, investors and analysts to assess and monitor the Company’s leverage exposure. See Table 51 for information regarding the calculation and components of the SLR.
Table 51: Fully Phased-In SLR
(in millions, except ratio)
June 30, 2017

Tier 1 capital
$
175,258

Total average assets
1,927,079

Less: deductions from Tier 1 capital
29,983

Total adjusted average assets
1,897,096

Adjustments:
 
Derivative exposures
70,086

Repo-style transactions
3,022

Other off-balance sheet exposures
247,845

Total adjustments
320,953

Total leverage exposure
$
2,218,049

Supplementary leverage ratio
7.9
%
OTHER REGULATORY CAPITAL MATTERS In December 2016, the FRB finalized rules to address the amount of equity and unsecured long-term debt a U.S. G-SIB must hold to improve its resolvability and resiliency, often referred to as Total Loss Absorbing Capacity (TLAC). Under the rules, which become effective on January 1, 2019, U.S. G-SIBs will be required to have a minimum TLAC amount (consisting of CET1 capital and additional tier 1 capital issued directly by the top-tier or covered BHC plus eligible external long-term debt) equal to the greater of (i) 18% of RWAs and (ii) 7.5% of total leverage exposure (the denominator of the SLR calculation). Additionally, U.S. G-SIBs will be required to maintain (i) a TLAC buffer equal to 2.5% of RWAs plus the firm’s applicable G-SIB capital surcharge calculated under method one plus any applicable countercyclical buffer that will be added to the 18% minimum and (ii) an external
 
TLAC leverage buffer equal to 2.0% of total leverage exposure that will be added to the 7.5% minimum, in order to avoid restrictions on capital distributions and discretionary bonus payments. The rules will also require U.S. G-SIBs to have a minimum amount of eligible unsecured long-term debt equal to the greater of (i) 6.0% of RWAs plus the firm’s applicable G-SIB capital surcharge calculated under method two and (ii) 4.5% of the total leverage exposure. In addition, the rules will impose certain restrictions on the operations and liabilities of the top-tier or covered BHC in order to further facilitate an orderly resolution, including prohibitions on the issuance of short-term debt to external investors and on entering into derivatives and certain other types of financial contracts with external counterparties. While the rules permit permanent grandfathering of a significant portion of otherwise ineligible long-term debt that was issued prior to December 31, 2016, long-term debt issued after that date must be fully compliant with the eligibility requirements of the rules in order to count toward the minimum TLAC amount. As a result of the rules, we will be required to issue additional long-term debt.
In addition, as discussed in the “Risk Management – Asset/ Liability Management – Liquidity and Funding – Liquidity Standards” section in this Report, federal banking regulators have issued a final rule regarding the U.S. implementation of the Basel III LCR and a proposed rule regarding the NSFR.

Capital Planning and Stress Testing
Our planned long-term capital structure is designed to meet regulatory and market expectations. We believe that our long-term targeted capital structure enables us to invest in and grow our business, satisfy our customers’ financial needs in varying environments, access markets, and maintain flexibility to return capital to our shareholders. Our long-term targeted capital structure also considers capital levels sufficient to exceed capital requirements including the G-SIB surcharge. Accordingly, based on the final Basel III capital rules under the lower of the Standardized or Advanced Approaches CET1 capital ratios, we currently target a long-term CET1 capital ratio at or in excess of 10%, which includes a 2% G-SIB surcharge. Our capital targets are subject to change based on various factors, including changes to the regulatory capital framework and expectations for large banks promulgated by bank regulatory agencies, planned capital actions, changes in our risk profile and other factors.
Under the FRB’s capital plan rule, large BHCs are required to submit capital plans annually for review to determine if the FRB has any objections before making any capital distributions. The rule requires updates to capital plans in the event of material changes in a BHC’s risk profile, including as a result of any significant acquisitions. The FRB assesses the overall financial condition, risk profile, and capital adequacy of BHCs while considering both quantitative and qualitative factors when evaluating capital plans.
Our 2017 capital plan, which was submitted on April 4, 2017, as part of CCAR, included a comprehensive capital outlook supported by an assessment of expected sources and uses of capital over a given planning horizon under a range of expected and stress scenarios. As part of the 2017 CCAR, the FRB also generated a supervisory stress test, which assumed a sharp decline in the economy and significant decline in asset pricing using the information provided by the Company to estimate performance. The FRB reviewed the supervisory stress results both as required under the Dodd-Frank Act using a common set of capital actions for all large BHCs and by taking into account the Company’s proposed capital actions. The FRB published its supervisory stress test results as required under the Dodd-Frank

61


Act on June 22, 2017. On June 28, 2017, the FRB notified us that it did not object to our capital plan included in the 2017 CCAR. On July 25, 2017, the Company increased its quarterly common stock dividend to $0.39 per share, as approved by the Board.
Federal banking regulators require stress tests to evaluate whether an institution has sufficient capital to continue to operate during periods of adverse economic and financial conditions. These stress testing requirements set forth the timing and type of stress test activities large BHCs and banks must undertake as well as rules governing stress testing controls, oversight and disclosure requirements. The rules also limit a large BHC’s ability to make capital distributions to the extent its actual capital issuances were less than amounts indicated in its capital plan. As required under the FRB’s stress testing rule, we must submit a mid-cycle stress test based on second quarter data and scenarios developed by the Company.

Securities Repurchases
From time to time the Board authorizes the Company to repurchase shares of our common stock. Although we announce when the Board authorizes share repurchases, we typically do not give any public notice before we repurchase our shares. Future stock repurchases may be private or open-market repurchases, including block transactions, accelerated or delayed block transactions, forward transactions, and similar transactions. Additionally, we may enter into plans to purchase stock that satisfy the conditions of Rule 10b5-1 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. Various factors determine the amount and timing of our share repurchases, including our capital requirements, the number of shares we expect to issue for employee benefit plans and acquisitions, market conditions (including the trading price of our stock), and regulatory and legal considerations, including the FRB’s response to our capital plan and to changes in our risk profile.
In January 2016, the Board authorized the repurchase of 350 million shares of our common stock. At June 30, 2017 , we had remaining authority to repurchase approximately 171 million shares, subject to regulatory and legal conditions. For more information about share repurchases during second quarter 2017 , see Part II, Item 2 in this Report.
 
Historically, our policy has been to repurchase shares under the “safe harbor” conditions of Rule 10b-18 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 including a limitation on the daily volume of repurchases. Rule 10b-18 imposes an additional daily volume limitation on share repurchases during a pending merger or acquisition in which shares of our stock will constitute some or all of the consideration. Our management may determine that during a pending stock merger or acquisition when the safe harbor would otherwise be available, it is in our best interest to repurchase shares in excess of this additional daily volume limitation. In such cases, we intend to repurchase shares in compliance with the other conditions of the safe harbor, including the standing daily volume limitation that applies whether or not there is a pending stock merger or acquisition.
In connection with our participation in the Capital Purchase Program (CPP), a part of the Troubled Asset Relief Program (TARP), we issued to the U.S. Treasury Department warrants to purchase 110,261,688 shares of our common stock with an original exercise price of $34.01 per share expiring on October 28, 2018. The terms of the warrants require the exercise price to be adjusted under certain circumstances when the Company’s quarterly common stock dividend exceeds $0.34 per share, which began occurring in second quarter 2014. Accordingly, with each quarterly common stock dividend above $0.34 per share, we must calculate whether an adjustment to the exercise price is required by the terms of the warrants, including whether certain minimum thresholds have been met to trigger an adjustment, and notify the holders of any such change. The Board authorized the repurchase by the Company of up to $1 billion of the warrants. At June 30, 2017 , there were 27,997,283 warrants outstanding, exercisable at $33.762 per share, and $452 million of unused warrant repurchase authority. Depending on market conditions, we may purchase from time to time additional warrants in privately negotiated or open market transactions, by tender offer or otherwise.


62

Regulatory Matters ( continued )

Regulatory Matters
Since the enactment of the Dodd-Frank Act in 2010, the U.S. financial services industry has been subject to a significant increase in regulation and regulatory oversight initiatives. This increased regulation and oversight has substantially changed how most U.S. financial services companies conduct business and has increased their regulatory compliance costs.
The following supplements our discussion of the significant regulations and regulatory oversight initiatives that have affected or may affect our business contained in the “Regulatory Matters” and “Risk Factors” sections in our 2016 Form 10-K and the “Regulatory Matters” section in our 2017 First Quarter Report on Form 10-Q.

REGULATION OF CONSUMER FINANCIAL PRODUCTS The Dodd-Frank Act established the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau (CFPB) to ensure consumers receive clear and accurate disclosures regarding financial products and to protect them from hidden fees and unfair or abusive practices. With respect to residential mortgage lending, the CFPB issued a number of final rules implementing new origination, notification, disclosure and other requirements, as well as additional limitations on the fees and charges that may be increased from the estimates provided by lenders. In October 2015, the CFPB finalized amendments to the rule implementing the Home Mortgage Disclosure Act, resulting in a significant expansion of the data points lenders will be required to collect beginning January 1, 2018 and report to the CFPB beginning January 1, 2019. The CFPB also expanded the transactions covered by the rule and increased the reporting frequency from annual to quarterly for large volume lenders, such as Wells Fargo, beginning January 1, 2020. With respect to other financial products, in October 2016, the CFPB finalized rules, most of which become effective on April 1, 2018, to make prepaid cards subject to similar consumer protections as those provided by more traditional debit and credit cards such as fraud protection and expanded access to account information. In July 2017, the CFPB finalized a rule, which becomes effective on September 18, 2017, prohibiting covered providers of certain consumer financial products and services, such as Wells Fargo, from using arbitration agreements that prevent consumers from filing or participating in class action litigation.
In addition to these rulemaking activities, the CFPB is continuing its on-going supervisory examination activities of the financial services industry with respect to a number of consumer businesses and products, including mortgage lending and servicing, fair lending requirements, student lending activities, and automobile finance. At this time, the Company cannot predict the full impact of the CFPB’s rulemaking and supervisory authority on our business practices or financial results.

LIVING WILL REQUIREMENTS AND RELATED MATTERS
Rules adopted by the FRB and the FDIC under the Dodd-Frank Act require large financial institutions, including Wells Fargo, to prepare and periodically revise resolution plans, so-called “living-wills”, that would facilitate their resolution in the event of material distress or failure. Under the rules, resolution plans are required to provide strategies for resolution under the Bankruptcy Code and other applicable insolvency regimes that can be accomplished in a reasonable period of time and in a manner that mitigates the risk that failure would have serious adverse effects on the financial stability of the United States. We submitted our 2017 resolution plan to the FRB and FDIC on June 30, 2017, but have not yet received regulatory feedback on the
 
plan. If the FRB and FDIC determine that our 2017 resolution plan has deficiencies, they may impose more stringent capital, leverage or liquidity requirements on us or restrict our growth, activities or operations until we adequately remedy the deficiencies. If the FRB and FDIC ultimately determine that we have been unable to remedy any deficiencies, they could require us to divest certain assets or operations.
We must also prepare and submit to the FRB on an annual basis a recovery plan that identifies a range of options that we may consider during times of idiosyncratic or systemic economic stress to remedy any financial weaknesses and restore market confidence without extraordinary government support. Recovery options include the possible sale, transfer or disposal of assets, securities, loan portfolios or businesses. Our insured national bank subsidiary, Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. (the “Bank”), must also prepare and submit to the OCC a recovery plan that sets forth the bank’s plan to remain a going concern when the bank is experiencing considerable financial or operational stress, but has not yet deteriorated to the point where liquidation or resolution is imminent. If either the FRB or the OCC determine that our recovery plan is deficient, they may impose fines, restrictions on our business or ultimately require us to divest assets.
If Wells Fargo were to fail, it may be resolved in a bankruptcy proceeding or, if certain conditions are met, under the resolution regime created by the Dodd-Frank Act known as the “orderly liquidation authority.” The orderly liquidation authority allows for the appointment of the FDIC as receiver for a systemically important financial institution that is in default or in danger of default if, among other things, the resolution of the institution under the U.S. Bankruptcy Code would have serious adverse effects on financial stability in the United States. If the FDIC is appointed as receiver for Wells Fargo & Company (the “Parent”), then the orderly liquidation authority, rather than the U.S. Bankruptcy Code, would determine the powers of the receiver and the rights and obligations of our security holders. The FDIC’s orderly liquidation authority requires that security holders of a company in receivership bear all losses before U.S. taxpayers are exposed to any losses, and allows the FDIC to disregard the strict priority of creditor claims under the U.S. Bankruptcy Code in certain circumstances.
Whether under the U.S. Bankruptcy Code or by the FDIC under the orderly liquidation authority, Wells Fargo could be resolved using a “multiple point of entry” strategy, in which the Parent and one or more of its subsidiaries would each undergo separate resolution proceedings, or a “single point of entry” strategy, in which the Parent would likely be the only material legal entity to enter resolution proceedings. The FDIC has announced that a single point of entry strategy may be a desirable strategy under its implementation of the orderly liquidation authority, but not all aspects of how the FDIC might exercise this authority are known and additional rulemaking is possible.
To facilitate the orderly resolution of systemically important financial institutions in case of material distress or failure, federal banking regulations require that institutions, such as Wells Fargo, maintain a minimum amount of equity and unsecured debt to absorb losses and recapitalize operating subsidiaries. Federal banking regulators have also required measures to facilitate the continued operation of operating subsidiaries notwithstanding the failure of their parent companies, such as limitations on parent guarantees, and have issued guidance encouraging institutions to take legally binding measures to provide capital and liquidity resources to certain subsidiaries in

63


order to facilitate an orderly resolution. In response to the regulators’ guidance and to facilitate the implementation of the Company’s preferred “multiple point of entry” resolution strategy, on June 28, 2017, the Parent entered into a support agreement (the “Support Agreement”) with WFC Holdings, LLC, an intermediate holding company and subsidiary of the Parent (the “IHC”), and the Bank, Wells Fargo Securities, LLC (“WFS”), and Wells Fargo Clearing Services, LLC (“WFCS”), each an indirect subsidiary of the Parent. Pursuant to the Support Agreement, the Parent transferred a significant amount of its assets, including the majority of its cash, deposits, liquid securities and intercompany loans (but excluding its equity interests in its subsidiaries and certain other assets), to the IHC and will continue to transfer those types of assets to the IHC from time to time. In the event of our material financial distress or failure, the IHC will be obligated to use the transferred assets to provide capital and/or liquidity to the Bank pursuant to the Support Agreement and to WFS and WFCS through repurchase facilities entered into in connection with the Support Agreement. Under the Support Agreement, the IHC will also provide funding and liquidity to the Parent through subordinated notes and a committed line of credit, which, together with the issuance of dividends, is expected to provide the Parent, during business as usual operating conditions, with the same access to cash necessary to service its debts, pay dividends, repurchase its shares, and perform its other obligations as it would have had if it had not entered into these arrangements and transferred any assets. If certain liquidity and/or capital metrics fall below defined triggers, the subordinated notes would be forgiven and the committed line of credit would terminate, which could materially and adversely impact the Parent’s liquidity and its ability to satisfy its debts and other obligations, and could result in the commencement of bankruptcy proceedings by the Parent at an earlier time than might have otherwise occurred if the Support Agreement were not implemented. The Parent's and the IHC's respective obligations under the Support Agreement are secured pursuant to a related security agreement.

 
DEPARTMENT OF LABOR ERISA FIDUCIARY STANDARD In April 2016, the U.S. Department of Labor adopted a rule under the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 (ERISA) that, among other changes and subject to certain exceptions, as of the applicability date of June 9, 2017, makes anyone, including broker-dealers, providing investment advice to retirement investors a fiduciary who must act in the best interest of clients when providing investment advice for direct or indirect compensation to a retirement plan, to a plan fiduciary, participant or beneficiary, or to an investment retirement account (IRA) or IRA holder. The rule impacts the manner in which business is conducted with retirement investors and affects product offerings with respect to retirement plans and IRAs.

 


64


Critical Accounting Policies
Our significant accounting policies (see Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) to Financial Statements in our 2016 Form 10-K) are fundamental to understanding our results of operations and financial condition because they require that we use estimates and assumptions that may affect the value of our assets or liabilities and financial results. Six of these policies are critical because they require management to make difficult, subjective and complex judgments about matters that are inherently uncertain and because it is likely that materially different amounts would be reported under different conditions or using different assumptions. These policies govern:
the allowance for credit losses;
PCI loans;
the valuation of residential MSRs;
the fair value of financial instruments;
income taxes; and
liability for contingent litigation losses.

Starting second quarter 2017, the liability for contingent litigation losses has been designated as one of our critical accounting policies. The remaining five of these policies are described further in the “Financial Review – Critical Accounting Policies” section and Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) to Financial Statements in our 2016 Form 10-K.

Liability for Contingent Litigation Losses
The Company is involved in a number of judicial, regulatory, arbitration and other proceedings concerning matters arising from the conduct of its business activities, and many of those proceedings expose the Company to potential financial loss. We establish accruals for these legal actions when potential losses associated with the actions become probable and the costs can be reasonably estimated. For such accruals, we record the amount we consider to be the best estimate within a range of potential losses that are both probable and estimable; however, if we cannot determine a best estimate, then we record the low end of the range of those potential losses. The actual costs of resolving legal actions may be substantially higher or lower than the amounts accrued for those actions.
 
We apply judgment when establishing an accrual for potential losses associated with legal actions and in establishing the range of reasonably possible losses in excess of the accrual. Our judgment in establishing accruals and the range of reasonably possible losses in excess of the Company's accrual for probable and estimable losses is influenced by our understanding of information currently available related to the legal evaluation and potential outcome of actions, including input and advice on these matters from our internal counsel, external counsel and senior management. These matters may be in various stages of investigation, discovery or proceedings. They may also involve a wide variety of claims across our businesses, legal entities and jurisdictions. The eventual outcome may be a scenario that was not considered or was considered remote in anticipated occurrence. Accordingly, our estimate of potential losses will change over time and the actual losses may vary significantly.
The outcomes of legal actions are unpredictable and subject to significant uncertainties, and it is inherently difficult to determine whether any loss is probable or even possible. It is also inherently difficult to estimate the amount of any loss and there may be matters for which a loss is probable or reasonably possible but not currently estimable. Accordingly, actual losses may be in excess of the established accrual or the range of reasonably possible loss.
See Note 11 (Legal Actions) to Financial Statements in this Report for further information.
Management and the Board's Audit and Examination Committee have reviewed and approved these critical accounting policies.

65


Current Accounting Developments
Table 52 provides accounting pronouncements applicable to us that have been issued by the FASB but are not yet effective.

Table 52: Current Accounting Developments – Issued Standards
Standard
 
Description
 
Effective date and financial statement impact
Accounting Standards Update (ASU or Update) 2017-08 – Receivables – Nonrefundable Fees and Other Costs (Subtopic 310-20): Premium Amortization on Purchased Callable Debt Securities
 
The Update changes the accounting for certain purchased callable debt securities held at a premium to shorten the amortization period for the premium to the earliest call date rather than to the maturity date. Accounting for purchased callable debt securities held at a discount does not change. The discount would continue to amortize to the maturity date.
 
We expect to adopt the guidance in first quarter 2019 using the modified retrospective method with a cumulative-effect adjustment to retained earnings as of the beginning of the year of adoption. Our investment securities portfolio includes holdings of callable debt securities. We are evaluating the impact of the Update on our consolidated financial statements, which will be affected by our investments in callable debt securities carried at a premium at the time of adoption.
ASU 2016-13 – Financial Instruments – Credit Losses (Topic 326):  Measurement of Credit Losses on Financial Instruments
 
The Update changes the accounting for credit losses on loans and debt securities. For loans and held-to-maturity debt securities, the Update requires a current expected credit loss (CECL) approach to determine the allowance for credit losses. CECL requires loss estimates for the remaining estimated life of the financial asset using historical experience, current conditions, and reasonable and supportable forecasts. Also, the Update eliminates the existing guidance for PCI loans, but requires an allowance for purchased financial assets with more than insignificant deterioration since origination. In addition, the Update modifies the other-than-temporary impairment model for available-for-sale debt securities to require an allowance for credit impairment instead of a direct write-down, which allows for reversal of credit impairments in future periods based on improvements in credit.
 
The guidance is effective in first quarter 2020 with a cumulative-effect adjustment to retained earnings as of the beginning of the year of adoption. While early adoption is permitted beginning in first quarter 2019, we do not expect to elect that option. We are evaluating the impact of the Update on our consolidated financial statements. We expect the Update will result in an increase in the allowance for credit losses given the change to estimated losses over the contractual life adjusted for expected prepayments with an anticipated material impact from longer duration portfolios, as well as the addition of an allowance for debt securities. The amount of the increase will be impacted by the portfolio composition and credit quality at the adoption date as well as economic conditions and forecasts at that time.
ASU 2016-02 – Leases (Topic 842)
 
The Update requires lessees to recognize leases on the balance sheet with lease liabilities and corresponding right-of-use assets based on the present value of lease payments. Lessor accounting activities are largely unchanged from existing lease accounting. The Update also eliminates leveraged lease accounting but allows existing leveraged leases to continue their current accounting until maturity, termination or modification.
 
We expect to adopt the guidance in first quarter 2019 using the modified retrospective method and practical expedients for transition. The practical expedients allow us to largely account for our existing leases consistent with current guidance except for the incremental balance sheet recognition for lessees. We have started our implementation of the Update which has included an initial evaluation of our leasing contracts and activities. As a lessee we are developing our methodology to estimate the right-of use assets and lease liabilities, which is based on the present value of lease payments (the December 31, 2016 future minimum lease payments were $6.9 billion). We do not expect a material change to the timing of expense recognition. Given the limited changes to lessor accounting, we do not expect material changes to recognition or measurement, but we are early in the implementation process and will continue to evaluate the impact. We are evaluating our existing disclosures and may need to provide additional information as a result of adoption of the Update.

66

Current Accounting Developments ( continued )

Standard
 
Description
 
Effective date and financial statement impact
ASU 2016-01 – Financial Instruments – Overall (Subtopic 825-10): Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities
 
The Update amends the presentation and accounting for certain financial instruments, including liabilities measured at fair value under the fair value option and equity investments. The guidance also updates fair value presentation and disclosure requirements for financial instruments measured at amortized cost.
 
We expect to adopt the guidance in first quarter 2018 with a cumulative-effect adjustment to retained earnings as of the beginning of the year of adoption, except for changes related to nonmarketable equity investments, which is applied prospectively. We expect the primary accounting changes will relate to our equity investments.
Our investments in marketable equity securities that are classified as available-for-sale will be accounted for at fair value with unrealized gains or losses reflected in earnings. Our investments in nonmarketable equity investments accounted for under the cost method of accounting (except for Federal bank stock) will be accounted for either at fair value with unrealized gains and losses reflected in earnings or, if we elect, using an alternative method. The alternative method is similar to the cost method of accounting, except that the carrying value is adjusted (through earnings) for subsequent observable transactions in the same or similar investment. We are currently evaluating which method will be applied to these nonmarketable equity investments.
Additionally, for purposes of disclosing the fair value of loans carried at amortized cost, we are evaluating our valuation methods to determine the necessary changes to conform to an “exit price” notion as required by the Standard. Accordingly, the fair value amounts disclosed for such loans may change upon adoption.
ASU 2014-09 – Revenue from Contracts With Customers (Topic 606) and subsequent related Updates
 
The Update modifies the guidance used to recognize revenue from contracts with customers for transfers of goods or services and transfers of nonfinancial assets, unless those contracts are within the scope of other guidance. The Update also requires new qualitative and quantitative disclosures, including disaggregation of revenues and descriptions of performance obligations.
 
We will adopt the guidance in first quarter 2018 using the modified retrospective method with a cumulative-effect adjustment to opening retained earnings. Our revenue is the sum of net interest income and noninterest income. The scope of the guidance explicitly excludes net interest income as well as many other revenues for financial assets and liabilities including loans, leases, securities, and derivatives. Accordingly, the majority of our revenues will not be affected. We have performed an assessment of our revenue contracts as well as worked with industry participants on matters of interpretation and application. Our accounting policies will not change materially since the principles of revenue recognition from the Update are largely consistent with existing guidance and current practices applied by our businesses. We have not identified material changes to the timing or amount of revenue recognition. Based on changes to guidance applied by broker-dealers, we expect a minor change to the presentation of our broker-dealer’s costs for underwriting activities which will be presented in expenses rather than the current presentation against the related revenues. We will provide qualitative disclosures of our performance obligations related to our revenue recognition and we continue to evaluate disaggregation for significant categories of revenue in the scope of the guidance. 

67


In addition to the list above, the following updates are applicable to us but, subject to completion of our assessment, are not expected to have a material impact on our consolidated financial statements:
ASU 2017-09 – Compensation – Stock Compensation (Topic718): Scope of Modification Accounting
ASU 2017-04 – Goodwill and Other (Topic 350): Simplifying the Test for Goodwill Impairment
ASU 2017-03 – Accounting Changes and Error Corrections (Topic 250) and Investments-Equity Method and Joint Ventures (Topic 323): Amendments to SEC Paragraphs Pursuant to Staff Announcements at the September 22, 2016 and November 17, 2016 EITF Meetings (SEC Update)
ASU 2017-01 – Business Combinations (Topic 805): Clarifying the Definition of a Business
ASU 2016-18 – Statement of Cash Flows (Topic 230): Restricted Cash
 
ASU 2016-16 – Income Taxes (Topic 740): Intra-Entity Transfers of Assets Other Than Inventory
ASU 2016-15 – Statement of Cash Flows (Topic 230): Classification of Certain Cash Receipts and Cash Payments
ASU 2016-04 – Liabilities – Extinguishment of Liabilities (Subtopic 405-20): Recognition of Breakage for Certain Prepaid Stored-Value Products

We have determined that other existing accounting updates are either not applicable to us or have completed our assessment and determined will not have a material impact on our consolidated financial statements.
Table 53 provides proposed accounting updates that could materially impact our consolidated financial statements when finalized by the FASB.


Table 53: Current Accounting Developments – Proposed Standards
Proposed Standard
 
Description
 
Expected effective date and financial statement impact
Derivatives and Hedging (Topic 815): Targeted Improvements to Accounting for Hedging Activities
 
The proposed Update would make targeted changes to the hedge accounting model intended to facilitate financial reporting that more closely reflects an entity’s risk management activities and to simplify application of hedge accounting. Changes include expanding the types of risk management strategies eligible for hedge accounting, easing the documentation and effectiveness assessment requirements, changing how ineffectiveness is measured and changing the presentation and disclosure requirements for hedge accounting activities.
 
The guidance is expected to be issued third quarter 2017 and will be effective beginning January 1, 2019. It will include the option to early adopt in any interim or annual period upon issuance of the final Update, under a modified retrospective approach. When adopted, the proposed amendments are expected to minimize the amount of hedge ineffectiveness related to our fair value hedges of long-term debt.
    We are in the process of evaluating our ability to adopt the standard in either the third or fourth quarter of 2017, which would result in the retrospective recognition of the related cumulative effect adjustment to retained earnings as of January 1, 2017.



68

Forward-Looking Statements ( continued )

Forward-Looking Statements
This document contains “forward-looking statements” within the meaning of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. In addition, we may make forward-looking statements in our other documents filed or furnished with the SEC, and our management may make forward-looking statements orally to analysts, investors, representatives of the media and others. Forward-looking statements can be identified by words such as “anticipates,” “intends,” “plans,” “seeks,” “believes,” “estimates,” “expects,” “target,” “projects,” “outlook,” “forecast,” “will,” “may,” “could,” “should,” “can” and similar references to future periods. In particular, forward-looking statements include, but are not limited to, statements we make about: (i) the future operating or financial performance of the Company, including our outlook for future growth; (ii) our noninterest expense and efficiency ratio; (iii) future credit quality and performance, including our expectations regarding future loan losses and allowance levels; (iv) the appropriateness of the allowance for credit losses; (v) our expectations regarding net interest income and net interest margin; (vi) loan growth or the reduction or mitigation of risk in our loan portfolios; (vii) future capital or liquidity levels or targets and our estimated Common Equity Tier 1 ratio under Basel III capital standards; (viii) the performance of our mortgage business and any related exposures; (ix) the expected outcome and impact of legal, regulatory and legislative developments, as well as our expectations regarding compliance therewith; (x) future common stock dividends, common share repurchases and other uses of capital; (xi) our targeted range for return on assets and return on equity; (xii) the outcome of contingencies, such as legal proceedings; and (xiii) the Company’s plans, objectives and strategies.
Forward-looking statements are not based on historical facts but instead represent our current expectations and assumptions regarding our business, the economy and other future conditions. Because forward-looking statements relate to the future, they are subject to inherent uncertainties, risks and changes in circumstances that are difficult to predict. Our actual results may differ materially from those contemplated by the forward-looking statements. We caution you, therefore, against relying on any of these forward-looking statements. They are neither statements of historical fact nor guarantees or assurances of future performance. While there is no assurance that any list of risks and uncertainties or risk factors is complete, important factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from those in the forward-looking statements include the following, without limitation:
current and future economic and market conditions, including the effects of declines in housing prices, high unemployment rates, U.S. fiscal debt, budget and tax matters, geopolitical matters, and the overall slowdown in global economic growth;
our capital and liquidity requirements (including under regulatory capital standards, such as the Basel III capital standards) and our ability to generate capital internally or raise capital on favorable terms;
financial services reform and other current, pending or future legislation or regulation that could have a negative effect on our revenue and businesses, including the Dodd-Frank Act and other legislation and regulation relating to bank products and services;
the extent of our success in our loan modification efforts, as well as the effects of regulatory requirements or guidance regarding loan modifications;
 
the amount of mortgage loan repurchase demands that we receive and our ability to satisfy any such demands without having to repurchase loans related thereto or otherwise indemnify or reimburse third parties, and the credit quality of or losses on such repurchased mortgage loans;
negative effects relating to our mortgage servicing and foreclosure practices, as well as changes in industry standards or practices, regulatory or judicial requirements, penalties or fines, increased servicing and other costs or obligations, including loan modification requirements, or delays or moratoriums on foreclosures;
our ability to realize our efficiency ratio target as part of our expense management initiatives, including as a result of business and economic cyclicality, seasonality, changes in our business composition and operating environment, growth in our businesses and/or acquisitions, and unexpected expenses relating to, among other things, litigation and regulatory matters;
the effect of the current low interest rate environment or changes in interest rates on our net interest income, net interest margin and our mortgage originations, mortgage servicing rights and mortgages held for sale;
significant turbulence or a disruption in the capital or financial markets, which could result in, among other things, reduced investor demand for mortgage loans, a reduction in the availability of funding or increased funding costs, and declines in asset values and/or recognition of other-than-temporary impairment on securities held in our investment securities portfolio;
the effect of a fall in stock market prices on our investment banking business and our fee income from our brokerage, asset and wealth management businesses;
negative effects from the retail banking sales practices matter, including on our legal, operational and compliance costs, our ability to engage in certain business activities or offer certain products or services, our ability to keep and attract customers, our ability to attract and retain qualified team members, and our reputation;
reputational damage from negative publicity, protests, fines, penalties and other negative consequences from regulatory violations and legal actions;
a failure in or breach of our operational or security systems or infrastructure, or those of our third party vendors or other service providers, including as a result of cyber attacks;
the effect of changes in the level of checking or savings account deposits on our funding costs and net interest margin;
fiscal and monetary policies of the Federal Reserve Board; and
the other risk factors and uncertainties described under “Risk Factors” in our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2016 .
 
In addition to the above factors, we also caution that the amount and timing of any future common stock dividends or repurchases will depend on the earnings, cash requirements and financial condition of the Company, market conditions, capital requirements (including under Basel capital standards), common stock issuance requirements, applicable law and regulations (including federal securities laws and federal banking regulations), and other factors deemed relevant by the Company’s

69


Board of Directors, and may be subject to regulatory approval or conditions.
For more information about factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from our expectations, refer to our reports filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission, including the discussion under “Risk Factors” in our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2016 , as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission and available on its website at www.sec.gov. 
Any forward-looking statement made by us speaks only as of the date on which it is made. Factors or events that could cause our actual results to differ may emerge from time to time, and it is not possible for us to predict all of them. We undertake no obligation to publicly update any forward-looking statement, whether as a result of new information, future developments or otherwise, except as may be required by law.

70


Risk Factors
An investment in the Company involves risk, including the possibility that the value of the investment could fall substantially and that dividends or other distributions on the investment could be reduced or eliminated. For a discussion of risk factors that could adversely affect our financial results and condition, and the value of, and return on, an investment in the Company, we refer you to the “Risk Factors” section in our 2016 Form 10-K.

71


Controls and Procedures
Disclosure Controls and Procedures
The Company’s management evaluated the effectiveness, as of June 30, 2017 , of the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures. The Company’s chief executive officer and chief financial officer participated in the evaluation. Based on this evaluation, the Company’s chief executive officer and chief financial officer concluded that the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures were effective as of June 30, 2017 .

Internal Control Over Financial Reporting
Internal control over financial reporting is defined in Rule 13a-15(f) promulgated under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 as a process designed by, or under the supervision of, the Company’s principal executive and principal financial officers and effected by the Company’s Board, management and other personnel, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (GAAP) and includes those policies and procedures that:
pertain to the maintenance of records that in reasonable detail accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of assets of the Company;
provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with GAAP, and that receipts and expenditures of the Company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the Company; and
provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of the Company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate. No change occurred during second quarter 2017 that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.

72


Wells Fargo & Company and Subsidiaries
Consolidated Statement of Income (Unaudited)
 
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
(in millions, except per share amounts)
2017

 
2016

 
2017

 
2016

Interest income
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
Trading assets
$
710

 
572

 
$
1,353

 
1,168

Investment securities
2,698

 
2,176

 
5,373

 
4,438

Mortgages held for sale
195

 
181

 
379

 
342

Loans held for sale
4

 
3

 
5

 
5

Loans
10,358

 
9,822

 
20,499

 
19,399

Other interest income
750

 
392

 
1,332

 
766

Total interest income
14,715

 
13,146

 
28,941

 
26,118

Interest expense
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
Deposits
683

 
332

 
1,220

 
639

Short-term borrowings
163

 
77

 
277

 
144

Long-term debt
1,278

 
921

 
2,461

 
1,763

Other interest expense
108

 
83

 
200

 
172

Total interest expense
2,232

 
1,413

 
4,158

 
2,718

Net interest income
12,483

 
11,733

 
24,783


23,400

Provision for credit losses
555

 
1,074

 
1,160

 
2,160

Net interest income after provision for credit losses
11,928

 
10,659

 
23,623

 
21,240

Noninterest income
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
Service charges on deposit accounts
1,276

 
1,336

 
2,589

 
2,645

Trust and investment fees
3,629

 
3,547

 
7,199

 
6,932

Card fees
1,019

 
997

 
1,964

 
1,938

Other fees
902

 
906

 
1,767

 
1,839

Mortgage banking
1,148

 
1,414

 
2,376

 
3,012

Insurance
280

 
286

 
557

 
713

Net gains from trading activities
237

 
328

 
676

 
528

Net gains on debt securities (1)
120

 
447

 
156

 
691

Net gains from equity investments (2)
188

 
189

 
591

 
433

Lease income
493

 
497

 
974

 
870

Other
394

 
482

 
539

 
1,356

Total noninterest income
9,686

 
10,429

 
19,388

 
20,957

Noninterest expense
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
Salaries
4,343

 
4,099

 
8,604

 
8,135

Commission and incentive compensation
2,499

 
2,604

 
5,224

 
5,249

Employee benefits
1,308

 
1,244

 
2,994

 
2,770

Equipment
529

 
493

 
1,106

 
1,021

Net occupancy
706

 
716

 
1,418

 
1,427

Core deposit and other intangibles
287

 
299

 
576

 
592

FDIC and other deposit assessments
328

 
255

 
661

 
505

Other
3,541

 
3,156

 
6,750

 
6,195

Total noninterest expense
13,541

 
12,866

 
27,333

 
25,894

Income before income tax expense
8,073

 
8,222

 
15,678


16,303

Income tax expense
2,225

 
2,649

 
4,282

 
5,216

Net income before noncontrolling interests
5,848

 
5,573

 
11,396


11,087

Less: Net income from noncontrolling interests
38

 
15

 
129

 
67

Wells Fargo net income
$
5,810

 
5,558

 
$
11,267


11,020

Less: Preferred stock dividends and other
406

 
385

 
807

 
762

Wells Fargo net income applicable to common stock
$
5,404

 
5,173

 
$
10,460

 
10,258

Per share information
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
Earnings per common share
$
1.08

 
1.02

 
$
2.09

 
2.02

Diluted earnings per common share
1.07

 
1.01

 
2.07

 
2.00

Dividends declared per common share
0.380

 
0.380

 
0.760

 
0.755

Average common shares outstanding
4,989.9

 
5,066.9

 
4,999.2

 
5,071.3

Diluted average common shares outstanding
5,037.7

 
5,118.1

 
5,054.8

 
5,129.8

(1)
Total other-than-temporary impairment (OTTI) losses were $6 million and $11 million for second quarter 2017 and 2016 , respectively. Of total OTTI, losses of $48 million and $26 million were recognized in earnings, and losses (reversal of losses) of $(42) million and $(15) million were recognized as non-credit-related OTTI in other comprehensive income for second quarter 2017 and 2016 , respectively. Total OTTI losses were $49 million and $87 million for the first half of 2017 and 2016, respectively. Of total OTTI, losses of $100 million and $91 million were recognized in earnings, and reversal of losses of $(51) million and $(4) million were recognized as non-credit-related OTTI in other comprehensive income for the first half of 2017 and 2016 , respectively.
(2)
Includes OTTI losses of $25 million and $104 million for second quarter 2017 and 2016 , respectively, and $102 million and $237 million for the first half of 2017 and 2016 , respectively.
 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these statements.

73


Wells Fargo & Company and Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income (Unaudited)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
(in millions)
 
2017

 
2016

 
2017

 
2016

Wells Fargo net income
 
$
5,810

 
5,558

 
11,267

 
11,020

Other comprehensive income (loss), before tax:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Investment securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net unrealized gains arising during the period
 
1,565

 
1,571

 
1,934

 
2,366

Reclassification of net gains to net income
 
(177
)
 
(504
)
 
(322
)
 
(808
)
Derivatives and hedging activities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net unrealized gains arising during the period
 
376

 
1,057

 
243

 
3,056

Reclassification of net gains on cash flow hedges to net income
 
(153
)
 
(265
)
 
(355
)
 
(521
)
Defined benefit plans adjustments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net actuarial and prior service losses arising during the period
 

 
(19
)
 
(7
)
 
(27
)
Amortization of net actuarial loss, settlements and other to net income
 
41

 
39

 
79

 
76

Foreign currency translation adjustments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net unrealized gains (losses) arising during the period
 
31

 
(6
)
 
47

 
37

Other comprehensive income , before tax
 
1,683

 
1,873

 
1,619

 
4,179

Income tax expense related to other comprehensive income
 
(624
)
 
(714
)
 
(587
)
 
(1,571
)
Other comprehensive income, net of tax
 
1,059

 
1,159

 
1,032

 
2,608

Less: Other comprehensive income (loss) from noncontrolling interests
 
(9
)
 
(15
)
 
5

 
(43
)
Wells Fargo other comprehensive income, net of tax
 
1,068

 
1,174

 
1,027

 
2,651

Wells Fargo comprehensive income
 
6,878

 
6,732

 
12,294

 
13,671

Comprehensive income from noncontrolling interests
 
29

 

 
134

 
24

Total comprehensive income
 
$
6,907

 
6,732

 
12,428

 
13,695


The accompanying notes are an integral part of these statements.

74


Wells Fargo & Company and Subsidiaries
 
 
 
Consolidated Balance Sheet
 
 
 
(in millions, except shares)
Jun 30,
2017

 
Dec 31,
2016

Assets
(Unaudited)

 
 
Cash and due from banks
$
20,248

 
20,729

Federal funds sold, securities purchased under resale agreements and other short-term investments
264,706

 
266,038

Trading assets
83,607

 
74,397

Investment securities:
 
 
 
Available-for-sale, at fair value 
269,202

 
308,364

Held-to-maturity, at cost (fair value $140,390 and $99,155)
140,392

 
99,583

Mortgages held for sale (includes $19,543 and $22,042 carried at fair value) (1) 
24,807

 
26,309

Loans held for sale
156

 
80

Loans (includes $443 and $758 carried at fair value) (1)
957,423

 
967,604

Allowance for loan losses 
(11,073
)
 
(11,419
)
Net loans
946,350

 
956,185

Mortgage servicing rights: 
 
 
  
Measured at fair value 
12,789

 
12,959

Amortized 
1,399

 
1,406

Premises and equipment, net 
8,403

 
8,333

Goodwill 
26,573

 
26,693

Derivative assets
13,273

 
14,498

Other assets (includes $3,986 and $3,275 carried at fair value) (1) 
118,966

 
114,541

Total assets (2) 
$
1,930,871

 
1,930,115

Liabilities 
 
 
  
Noninterest-bearing deposits 
$
372,766

 
375,967

Interest-bearing deposits 
933,064

 
930,112

Total deposits 
1,305,830

 
1,306,079

Short-term borrowings 
95,356

 
96,781

Derivative liabilities
11,636

 
14,492

Accrued expenses and other liabilities
73,035

 
57,189

Long-term debt 
238,869

 
255,077

Total liabilities (3) 
1,724,726

 
1,729,618

Equity 
 
 
  
Wells Fargo stockholders' equity: 
 
 
  
Preferred stock 
25,785

 
24,551

Common stock – $1-2/3 par value, authorized 9,000,000,000 shares; issued 5,481,811,474 shares 
9,136

 
9,136

Additional paid-in capital 
60,689

 
60,234

Retained earnings 
139,524

 
133,075

 Cumulative other comprehensive income (loss)
(2,110
)
 
(3,137
)
Treasury stock – 515,041,424 shares and 465,702,148 shares 
(25,675
)
 
(22,713
)
Unearned ESOP shares 
(2,119
)
 
(1,565
)
Total Wells Fargo stockholders' equity 
205,230

 
199,581

Noncontrolling interests 
915

 
916

Total equity 
206,145

 
200,497

Total liabilities and equity
$
1,930,871

 
1,930,115

(1)
Parenthetical amounts represent assets and liabilities for which we have elected the fair value option.
(2)
Our consolidated assets at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , include the following assets of certain variable interest entities (VIEs) that can only be used to settle the liabilities of those VIEs: Cash and due from banks, $112 million and $168 million ; Federal funds sold, securities purchased under resale agreements and other short-term investments, $424 million and $74 million ; Trading assets, $50 million and $130 million ; Investment securities, $0 million at both period ends; Net loans, $12.1 billion and $12.6 billion ; Derivative assets, $0 million and $1 million ; Other assets, $339 million and $452 million ; and Total assets, $13.0 billion and $13.4 billion , respectively.
(3)
Our consolidated liabilities at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , include the following VIE liabilities for which the VIE creditors do not have recourse to Wells Fargo: Derivative liabilities, $28 million and $33 million ; Accrued expenses and other liabilities, $96 million and $107 million ; Long-term debt, $2.8 billion and $3.7 billion ; and Total liabilities, $3.0 billion and $3.8 billion , respectively.  

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these statements.

75



Wells Fargo & Company and Subsidiaries
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity (Unaudited)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Preferred stock
 
 
Common stock
 
(in millions, except shares)
Shares

 
Amount

 
Shares

 
Amount

Balance December 31, 2015
11,259,917

 
$
22,214

 
5,092,128,810

 
$
9,136

Cumulative effect from change in consolidation accounting (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance January 1, 2016
11,259,917

 
$
22,214

 
5,092,128,810

 
$
9,136

Net income
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Noncontrolling interests
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Common stock issued
 
 
 
 
38,655,156

 
 
Common stock repurchased
 
 
 
 
(96,479,740
)
 
 
Preferred stock issued to ESOP
1,150,000

 
1,150

 
 
 
 
Preferred stock released by ESOP
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Preferred stock converted to common shares
(684,244
)
 
(684
)
 
14,189,729

 
 
Common stock warrants repurchased/exercised
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Preferred stock issued
86,000

 
2,150

 
 
 
 
Common stock dividends
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Preferred stock dividends
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Tax benefit from stock incentive compensation
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Stock incentive compensation expense
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net change in deferred compensation and related plans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net change
551,756


2,616


(43,634,855
)


Balance June 30, 2016
11,811,673


$
24,830


5,048,493,955


$
9,136

Balance January 1, 2017
11,532,712

 
$
24,551

 
5,016,109,326

 
$
9,136

Net income
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other comprehensive income, net of tax
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Noncontrolling interests
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Common stock issued
 
 
 
 
39,392,446

 
 
Common stock repurchased
 
 
 
 
(96,121,157
)
 
 
Preferred stock issued to ESOP
950,000

 
950

 
 
 
 
Preferred stock released by ESOP
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Preferred stock converted to common shares
(406,185
)
 
(406
)
 
7,389,435

 
 
Common stock warrants repurchased/exercised
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Preferred stock issued
27,600

 
690

 
 
 
 
Common stock dividends
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Preferred stock dividends
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Tax benefit from stock incentive compensation (2)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Stock incentive compensation expense
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net change in deferred compensation and related plans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net change
571,415


1,234


(49,339,276
)


Balance June 30, 2017
12,104,127


$
25,785


4,966,770,050


$
9,136

(1)
Effective January 1, 2016, we adopted changes in consolidation accounting pursuant to ASU 2015-02 ( Amendments to the Consolidation Analysis ). Accordingly, we recorded a $121 million increase to beginning noncontrolling interests as a cumulative-effect adjustment.
(2)
Effective January 1, 2017, we adopted Accounting Standards Update 2016-09 ( Improvements to Employee Share-Based Payment Accounting). Accordingly, tax benefit from stock incentive compensation is reported in income tax expense in the consolidated statement of income.

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these statements.


76



 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Wells Fargo stockholders' equity
 
 
 
 
 
Additional
paid-in
capital

 
Retained
earnings

 
Cumulative
other
comprehensive
income

 
Treasury
stock

 
Unearned
ESOP
shares

 
Total
Wells Fargo
stockholders'
equity

 
Noncontrolling
interests

 
Total
equity

60,714

 
120,866

 
297

 
(18,867
)
 
(1,362
)
 
192,998

 
893

 
193,891

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
121

 
121

60,714

 
120,866

 
297

 
(18,867
)
 
(1,362
)
 
192,998

 
1,014

 
194,012

 
 
11,020

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
11,020

 
67

 
11,087

 
 
 
 
2,651

 
 
 
 
 
2,651

 
(43
)
 
2,608

1

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1

 
(122
)
 
(121
)
(184
)
 
(185
)
 
 
 
1,845

 
 
 
1,476

 
 
 
1,476

500

 
 
 
 
 
(4,743
)
 
 
 
(4,243
)
 
 
 
(4,243
)
99

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1,249
)
 

 
 
 

(59
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
743

 
684

 
 
 
684


 
 
 
 
 
684

 
 
 

 
 
 


 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
 

(49
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2,101

 
 
 
2,101

27

 
(3,861
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(3,834
)
 
 
 
(3,834
)
 
 
(764
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(764
)
 
 
 
(764
)
172

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
172

 
 
 
172

508

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
508

 
 
 
508

(1,038
)
 
 
 
 
 
13

 
 
 
(1,025
)
 
 
 
(1,025
)
(23
)

6,210


2,651


(2,201
)

(506
)

8,747


(98
)

8,649

60,691


127,076


2,948


(21,068
)

(1,868
)

201,745


916


202,661

60,234

 
133,075

 
(3,137
)
 
(22,713
)
 
(1,565
)
 
199,581

 
916

 
200,497

 
 
11,267

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
11,267

 
129

 
11,396

 
 
 
 
1,027

 
 
 
 
 
1,027

 
5

 
1,032

1

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1

 
(135
)
 
(134
)
(26
)
 
(184
)
 
 
 
1,868

 
 
 
1,658

 
 
 
1,658

750

 
 
 
 
 
(5,212
)
 
 
 
(4,462
)
 
 
 
(4,462
)
31

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(981
)
 

 
 
 

(21
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
427

 
406

 
 
 
406

41

 
 
 
 
 
365

 
 
 

 
 
 

(68
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(68
)
 
 
 
(68
)
(13
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
677

 
 
 
677

25

 
(3,827
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(3,802
)
 
 
 
(3,802
)
 
 
(807
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(807
)
 
 
 
(807
)

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
 

534

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
534

 
 
 
534

(799
)
 
 
 
 
 
17

 
 
 
(782
)
 
 
 
(782
)
455


6,449


1,027


(2,962
)

(554
)

5,649


(1
)

5,648

60,689


139,524


(2,110
)

(25,675
)

(2,119
)

205,230


915


206,145



77



Wells Fargo & Company and Subsidiaries
 
 
 
Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows (Unaudited)
 
 
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
(in millions)
2017

 
2016

Cash flows from operating activities:
 
 
 
Net income before noncontrolling interests
$
11,396

 
11,087

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities:
 
 
  

Provision for credit losses
1,160

 
2,160

Changes in fair value of MSRs, MHFS and LHFS carried at fair value
567

 
1,664

Depreciation, amortization and accretion
2,478

 
2,233

Other net losses
317

 
1,107

Stock-based compensation
1,186

 
1,176

Originations and purchases of MHFS and LHFS (1)
(86,008
)
 
(85,821
)
Proceeds from sales of and paydowns on mortgages originated for sale and LHFS (1)
53,404

 
59,824

Net change in:
 
 
  

Trading assets (1)
24,477

 
16,506

Deferred income taxes
1,281

 
(2,286
)
Derivative assets and liabilities (1)
(2,133
)
 
(10
)
Other assets (1)
1,485

 
(8,667
)
Other accrued expenses and liabilities (1)
(652
)
 
(394
)
Net cash provided (used) by operating activities
8,958

 
(1,421
)
Cash flows from investing activities:
 
 
 
Net change in:
  
 
  
Federal funds sold, securities purchased under resale agreements and other short-term investments
(5,489
)
 
(25,492
)
Available-for-sale securities:
 
 
 
Sales proceeds
23,004

 
22,631

Prepayments and maturities
24,359

 
15,182

Purchases
(45,649
)
 
(19,602
)
Held-to-maturity securities:
 
 
 
Paydowns and maturities
4,606

 
2,951

Purchases

 
(19,217
)
Nonmarketable equity investments:
 
 
 
Sales proceeds
2,146

 
1,060

Purchases
(1,225
)
 
(1,998
)
Loans:
 
 
 
Loans originated by banking subsidiaries, net of principal collected
2,317

 
(21,537
)
Proceeds from sales (including participations) of loans held for investment
6,739

 
4,736

Purchases (including participations) of loans
(1,976
)
 
(3,146
)
Principal collected on nonbank entities’ loans
6,803

 
5,885

Loans originated by nonbank entities
(5,390
)
 
(5,875
)
Net cash paid for acquisitions
(3
)
 
(28,987
)
Proceeds from sales of foreclosed assets and short sales
2,974

 
3,704

Other, net (1)
(616
)
 
201

Net cash provided (used) by investing activities
12,600

 
(69,504
)
Cash flows from financing activities:
 
 
 
Net change in:
  

 
  

Deposits
(249
)
 
22,161

Short-term borrowings
6,114

 
22,730

Long-term debt:
 
 
  

Proceeds from issuance
27,990

 
47,971

Repayment
(47,815
)
 
(14,138
)
Preferred stock:
 
 
  

Proceeds from issuance
677

 
2,101

Cash dividends paid
(807
)
 
(764
)
Common stock:
 
 
  

Proceeds from issuance
722

 
795

Stock tendered for payment of withholding taxes (1)
(368
)
 
(473
)
Repurchased
(4,462
)
 
(4,243
)
Cash dividends paid
(3,715
)
 
(3,739
)
Net change in noncontrolling interests
(66
)
 
(135
)
Other, net
(60
)
 
(45
)
Net cash provided (used) by financing activities
(22,039
)
 
72,221

Net change in cash and due from banks
(481
)
 
1,296

Cash and due from banks at beginning of period
20,729

 
19,111

Cash and due from banks at end of period
$
20,248

 
20,407

Supplemental cash flow disclosures:
 
 
 
Cash paid for interest
$
3,954

 
2,357

Cash paid for income taxes
2,794

 
4,255

(1)
Prior periods have been revised to conform to the current period presentation.
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these statements. See Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) for noncash activities.

78

Note 1: Summary of Significant Accounting Policies ( continued )

See the Glossary of Acronyms at the end of this Report for terms used throughout the Financial Statements and related Notes.
 
Note 1:    Summary of Significant Accounting Policies
Wells Fargo & Company is a diversified financial services company. We provide banking, insurance, trust and investments, mortgage banking, investment banking, retail banking, brokerage, and consumer and commercial finance through branches, the internet and other distribution channels to consumers, businesses and institutions in all 50 states, the District of Columbia, and in foreign countries. When we refer to “Wells Fargo,” “the Company,” “we,” “our” or “us,” we mean Wells Fargo & Company and Subsidiaries (consolidated). Wells Fargo & Company (the Parent) is a financial holding company and a bank holding company. We also hold a majority interest in a real estate investment trust, which has publicly traded preferred stock outstanding.
Our accounting and reporting policies conform with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (GAAP) and practices in the financial services industry. For discussion of our significant accounting policies, see Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) in our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2016 ( 2016 Form 10-K). To prepare the financial statements in conformity with GAAP, management must make estimates based on assumptions about future economic and market conditions (for example, unemployment, market liquidity, real estate prices, etc.) that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements, income and expenses during the reporting period and the related disclosures. Although our estimates contemplate current conditions and how we expect them to change in the future, it is reasonably possible that actual conditions could be significantly different than anticipated in those estimates, which could materially affect our results of operations and financial condition. Management has made significant estimates in several areas, including:
allowance for credit losses and purchased credit-impaired (PCI) loans (Note 5 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses));
valuations of residential mortgage servicing rights (MSRs) (Note 7 (Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities) and Note 8 (Mortgage Banking Activities)) and financial instruments (Note 13 (Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities));
income taxes; and
liabilities for contingent litigation losses (Note 11 (Legal Actions)).
Actual results could differ from those estimates.

These unaudited interim financial statements reflect all adjustments that are, in the opinion of management, necessary for a fair statement of the results for the periods presented. These adjustments are of a normal recurring nature, unless otherwise disclosed in this Form 10-Q. The results of operations in the interim financial statements do not necessarily indicate the results that may be expected for the full year. The interim financial information should be read in conjunction with our 2016 Form 10-K.
 
 
Accounting Standards Adopted in 2017
In first quarter 2017 , we adopted the following new accounting guidance:
Accounting Standards Update (ASU or Update) 2016-09 – Compensation – Stock Compensation (Topic 718): Improvements to Employee Share-Based Payment Accounting;
ASU 2016-07 - Investments - Equity Method and Joint Ventures (Topic 323): Simplifying the Transition to the Equity Method of Accounting;
ASU 2016-06 - Derivatives and Hedging (Topic 815): Contingent Put and Call Options in Debt Instruments; and
ASU 2016-05 - Derivatives and Hedging (Topic 815): Effect of Derivative Contract Novations on Existing Hedge Accounting Relationships.

ASU 2016-09 Simplifies the accounting for share-based payment awards issued to employees. We have income tax effects based on changes in our stock price from the grant date to the vesting date of the employee stock compensation. The Update requires these income tax effects to be recognized in the statement of income within income tax expense instead of within additional paid-in capital. In addition, the Update requires changes to the Statement of Cash Flows including the classification between the operating and financing section for tax activity related to employee stock compensation, which we adopted retrospectively. We recorded excess tax benefits and tax deficiencies within income tax expense in the statement of income in first quarter 2017, on a prospective basis.

ASU 2016-07 eliminates the requirement for companies to retroactively apply the equity method of accounting for investments when increases in ownership interests or degree of influence result in the adoption of the equity method. Under the guidance, the equity method should be applied prospectively in the period in which the ownership changes occur. We adopted this change in first quarter 2017. The Update did not impact our consolidated financial statements, as the standard is applied on a prospective basis.

ASU 2016-06 clarifies the criteria entities should use when evaluating whether embedded contingent put and call options in debt instruments should be separated from the debt instrument and accounted for separately as derivatives. The Update clarifies that companies should not consider whether the event that triggers the ability to exercise put or call options is related to interest rates or credit risk. We adopted this change in first quarter 2017. The Update did not have a material impact on our consolidated financial statements.


79

Note 1: Summary of Significant Accounting Policies ( continued )

ASU 2016-05 clarifies that a change in the counterparty to a derivative instrument that has been designated as an accounting hedge does not require the hedging relationship to be dedesignated as long as all other hedge accounting criteria continue to be met. We adopted the guidance in first quarter 2017. The Update did not have a material impact on our consolidated financial statements.

Accounting Standards with Retrospective Application
The following accounting pronouncement has been issued by the FASB but is not yet effective:
ASU 2016-15 – Statement of Cash Flows (Topic 230): Classification of Certain Cash Receipts and Cash Payments.

ASU 2016-15 addresses eight specific cash flow issues with the objective of reducing the existing diversity in practice for reporting in the Statement of Cash Flows. The Update is effective for us in first quarter 2018 with retrospective application. Subject to completion of our assessment, we are not expecting this Update to have a material impact on our financial statements.

Private Share Repurchases
From time to time we enter into private forward repurchase transactions with unrelated third parties to complement our
 
open-market common stock repurchase strategies, to allow us to manage our share repurchases in a manner consistent with our capital plans submitted annually under the Comprehensive Capital Analysis and Review (CCAR) and to provide an economic benefit to the Company.
Our payments to the counterparties for these contracts are recorded in permanent equity in the quarter paid and are not subject to re-measurement. The classification of the up-front payments as permanent equity assures that we have appropriate repurchase timing consistent with our capital plans, which contemplate a fixed dollar amount available per quarter for share repurchases pursuant to Federal Reserve Board (FRB) supervisory guidance. In return, the counterparty agrees to deliver a variable number of shares based on a per share discount to the volume-weighted average stock price over the contract period. There are no scenarios where the contracts would not either physically settle in shares or allow us to choose the settlement method. Our total number of outstanding shares of common stock is not reduced until settlement of the private share repurchase contract.
We had no unsettled private share repurchase contracts at both June 30, 2017 and June 30, 2016 .

Supplemental Cash Flow Information
Significant noncash activities are presented below.

Table 1.1: Supplemental Cash Flow Information
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
(in millions)
2017

 
2016

Trading assets retained from securitization of MHFS
$
34,317

 
23,403

Transfers from loans to MHFS
3,215

 
3,309

Transfers from available-for-sale to held-to-maturity securities
45,408

 


Subsequent Events
We have evaluated the effects of events that have occurred subsequent to June 30, 2017 , and there have been no material events that would require recognition in our second quarter 2017  consolidated financial statements or disclosure in the Notes to the consolidated financial statements.


80



Note 2:    Business Combinations
We regularly explore opportunities to acquire financial services companies and businesses. Generally, we do not make a public announcement about an acquisition opportunity until a definitive agreement has been signed. For information on additional contingent consideration related to acquisitions, which is considered to be a guarantee, see Note 10 (Guarantees, Pledged Assets and Collateral).
We completed no new acquisitions during the first half of 2017 , but did finalize the related purchase accounting for our
 
2016 acquisition of GE Capital's Commercial Distribution Finance and Vendor Finance businesses. As of June 30, 2017, we had one pending step acquisition involving an investment management firm with approximately $10 billion of assets under management, which we closed on July 1, 2017. We had previously been the majority owner.


Note 3:    Federal Funds Sold, Securities Purchased under Resale Agreements and Other   Short-Term Investments
Table 3.1 provides the detail of federal funds sold, securities purchased under short-term resale agreements (generally less than one year) and other short-term investments. Substantially all of the interest-earning deposits at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , were held at Federal Reserve Banks.
Table 3.1: Fed Funds Sold and Other Short-Term Investments
(in millions)
Jun 30,
2017

 
Dec 31,
2016

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements
$
67,687

 
58,215

Interest-earning deposits
195,700

 
200,671

Other short-term investments
1,319

 
7,152

Total
$
264,706

 
266,038


 
As part of maintaining our memberships in certain clearing organizations, we are required to stand ready to provide liquidity meant to sustain market clearing activity in the event unforeseen events occur or are deemed likely to occur. This includes commitments we have entered into to purchase securities under resale agreements from a central clearing organization that, at its option, require us to provide funding under such agreements. We do not have any outstanding amounts funded, and the amount of our unfunded contractual commitment was $1.6 billion and $2.9 billion as of June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , respectively.
We have classified securities purchased under long-term resale agreements (generally one year or more), which totaled $20.7 billion and $21.3 billion at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , respectively, in loans. For additional information on the collateral we receive from other entities under resale agreements and securities borrowings, see the “Offsetting of Resale and Repurchase Agreements and Securities Borrowing and Lending Agreements” section in Note 10 (Guarantees, Pledged Assets and Collateral).




81


Note 4:  Investment Securities
Table 4.1 provides the amortized cost and fair value by major categories of available-for-sale securities, which are carried at fair value, and held-to-maturity debt securities, which are carried at
 
amortized cost. The net unrealized gains (losses) for available-for-sale securities are reported on an after-tax basis as a component of cumulative OCI.
Table 4.1: Amortized Cost and Fair Value
(in millions)
Amortized Cost

 
Gross
unrealized
gains

 
Gross
unrealized
losses

 
Fair
value

June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Available-for-sale securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
$
17,950

 
11

 
(65
)
 
17,896

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
52,237

 
751

 
(975
)
 
52,013

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal agencies
136,336

 
1,009

 
(1,407
)
 
135,938

Residential
6,829

 
532

 
(2
)
 
7,359

Commercial
5,347

 
82

 
(16
)
 
5,413

Total mortgage-backed securities
148,512

 
1,623

 
(1,425
)
 
148,710

Corporate debt securities
9,261

 
424

 
(83
)
 
9,602

Collateralized loan and other debt obligations (1) 
33,168

 
298

 
(11
)
 
33,455

Other (2)
6,348

 
164

 
(14
)
 
6,498

Total debt securities
267,476

 
3,271

 
(2,573
)
 
268,174

Marketable equity securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Perpetual preferred securities
446

 
23

 
(4
)
 
465

Other marketable equity securities
168

 
398

 
(3
)
 
563

Total marketable equity securities
614

 
421

 
(7
)
 
1,028

Total available-for-sale securities
268,090

 
3,692

 
(2,580
)
 
269,202

Held-to-maturity securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
44,704

 
666

 
(35
)
 
45,335

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
6,325

 
60

 
(55
)
 
6,330

    Federal agency and other mortgage-backed securities (3)
87,525

 
162

 
(806
)
 
86,881

Collateralized loan obligations
993

 
5

 

 
998

Other (2)
845

 
1

 

 
846

Total held-to-maturity securities
140,392

 
894

 
(896
)
 
140,390

Total
$
408,482

 
4,586

 
(3,476
)
 
409,592

December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Available-for-sale securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
$
25,874

 
54

 
(109
)
 
25,819

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
52,121

 
551

 
(1,571
)
 
51,101

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal agencies
163,513

 
1,175

 
(3,458
)
 
161,230

Residential
7,375

 
449

 
(8
)
 
7,816

Commercial
8,475

 
101

 
(74
)
 
8,502

Total mortgage-backed securities
179,363

 
1,725

 
(3,540
)
 
177,548

Corporate debt securities
11,186

 
381

 
(110
)
 
11,457

Collateralized loan and other debt obligations (1)
34,764

 
287

 
(31
)
 
35,020

Other (2)
6,139

 
104

 
(35
)
 
6,208

Total debt securities
309,447

 
3,102

 
(5,396
)
 
307,153

Marketable equity securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Perpetual preferred securities
445

 
35

 
(11
)
 
469

Other marketable equity securities
261

 
481

 

 
742

Total marketable equity securities
706

 
516

 
(11
)
 
1,211

Total available-for-sale securities
310,153

 
3,618

 
(5,407
)
 
308,364

Held-to-maturity securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
44,690

 
466

 
(77
)
 
45,079

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
6,336

 
17

 
(144
)
 
6,209

Federal agency and other mortgage-backed securities (3)
45,161

 
100

 
(804
)
 
44,457

Collateralized loan obligations
1,065

 
6

 
(1
)
 
1,070

Other (2)
2,331

 
10

 
(1
)
 
2,340

Total held-to-maturity securities
99,583

 
599

 
(1,027
)
 
99,155

Total
$
409,736

 
4,217

 
(6,434
)
 
407,519

(1)
The available-for-sale portfolio includes collateralized debt obligations (CDOs) with a cost basis and fair value of $923 million and $998 million , respectively, at June 30, 2017 , and $819 million and $847 million , respectively, at December 31, 2016 .
(2)
The “Other” category of available-for-sale securities largely includes asset-backed securities collateralized by student loans. Included in the “Other” category of held-to-maturity securities are asset-backed securities collateralized by automobile leases or loans and cash with a cost basis and fair value of $345 million each at June 30, 2017 , and $1.3 billion each at December 31, 2016 . Also included in the “Other” category of held-to-maturity securities are asset-backed securities collateralized by dealer floorplan loans with a cost basis and fair value of $500 million and $501 million , respectively at June 30, 2017 , and $1.1 billion each at December 31, 2016 .
(3)
Predominantly consists of federal agency mortgage-backed securities at both June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016 .

82

Note 4: Investment Securities ( continued )

Gross Unrealized Losses and Fair Value
Table 4.2 shows the gross unrealized losses and fair value of securities in the investment securities portfolio by length of time that individual securities in each category have been in a continuous loss position. Debt securities on which we have taken credit-related OTTI write-downs are categorized as being “less
 
than 12 months” or “12 months or more” in a continuous loss position based on the point in time that the fair value declined to below the cost basis and not the period of time since the credit-related OTTI write-down.
Table 4.2: Gross Unrealized Losses and Fair Value
 
Less than 12 months
 
 
12 months or more
 
 
Total
 
(in millions)
Gross
unrealized
losses

 
Fair
value

 
Gross
unrealized
losses

 
Fair
value

 
Gross
unrealized
losses

 
Fair
value

June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Available-for-sale securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
$
(65
)
 
11,486

 

 

 
(65
)
 
11,486

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
(38
)
 
8,048

 
(937
)
 
19,964

 
(975
)
 
28,012

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

Federal agencies
(1,271
)
 
78,114

 
(136
)
 
5,900

 
(1,407
)
 
84,014

Residential
(1
)
 
90

 
(1
)
 
78

 
(2
)
 
168

Commercial
(2
)
 
369

 
(14
)
 
670

 
(16
)
 
1,039

Total mortgage-backed securities
(1,274
)
 
78,573

 
(151
)
 
6,648

 
(1,425
)
 
85,221

Corporate debt securities
(9
)
 
655

 
(74
)
 
665

 
(83
)
 
1,320

Collateralized loan and other debt obligations
(1
)
 
3,327

 
(10
)
 
682

 
(11
)
 
4,009

Other
(3
)
 
443

 
(11
)
 
978

 
(14
)
 
1,421

Total debt securities
(1,390
)
 
102,532

 
(1,183
)
 
28,937

 
(2,573
)
 
131,469

Marketable equity securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 

Perpetual preferred securities
(1
)
 
32

 
(3
)
 
50

 
(4
)
 
82

Other marketable equity securities
(3
)
 
10

 

 

 
(3
)
 
10

Total marketable equity securities
(4
)
 
42

 
(3
)
 
50

 
(7
)
 
92

Total available-for-sale securities
(1,394
)
 
102,574

 
(1,186
)
 
28,987

 
(2,580
)
 
131,561

Held-to-maturity securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 

Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
(35
)
 
3,347

 

 

 
(35
)
 
3,347

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
(55
)
 
3,624

 

 

 
(55
)
 
3,624

Federal agency and other mortgage-backed
   securities
(806
)
 
63,110

 

 

 
(806
)
 
63,110

Collateralized loan obligations

 

 

 

 

 

Other

 

 

 

 

 

Total held-to-maturity securities
(896
)
 
70,081

 

 

 
(896
)
 
70,081

Total
$
(2,290
)
 
172,655

 
(1,186
)
 
28,987

 
(3,476
)
 
201,642

December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Available-for-sale securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
$
(109
)
 
10,816

 

 

 
(109
)
 
10,816

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
(341
)
 
17,412

 
(1,230
)
 
16,213

 
(1,571
)
 
33,625

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal agencies
(3,338
)
 
120,735

 
(120
)
 
3,481

 
(3,458
)
 
124,216

Residential
(4
)
 
527

 
(4
)
 
245

 
(8
)
 
772

Commercial
(43
)
 
1,459

 
(31
)
 
1,690

 
(74
)
 
3,149

Total mortgage-backed securities
(3,385
)
 
122,721

 
(155
)
 
5,416

 
(3,540
)
 
128,137

Corporate debt securities
(11
)
 
946

 
(99
)
 
1,229

 
(110
)
 
2,175

Collateralized loan and other debt obligations
(2
)
 
1,899

 
(29
)
 
3,197

 
(31
)
 
5,096

Other
(9
)
 
971

 
(26
)
 
1,262

 
(35
)
 
2,233

Total debt securities
(3,857
)
 
154,765

 
(1,539
)
 
27,317

 
(5,396
)
 
182,082

Marketable equity securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Perpetual preferred securities
(3
)
 
41

 
(8
)
 
45

 
(11
)
 
86

Other marketable equity securities

 

 

 

 

 

Total marketable equity securities
(3
)
 
41

 
(8
)
 
45

 
(11
)
 
86

Total available-for-sale securities
(3,860
)
 
154,806

 
(1,547
)
 
27,362

 
(5,407
)
 
182,168

Held-to-maturity securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
(77
)
 
6,351

 

 

 
(77
)
 
6,351

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
(144
)
 
4,871

 

 

 
(144
)
 
4,871

Federal agency and other mortgage-backed securities
(804
)
 
40,095

 

 

 
(804
)
 
40,095

Collateralized loan obligations

 

 
(1
)
 
266

 
(1
)
 
266

Other

 

 
(1
)
 
633

 
(1
)
 
633

Total held-to-maturity securities
(1,025
)
 
51,317

 
(2
)
 
899

 
(1,027
)
 
52,216

Total
$
(4,885
)
 
206,123

 
(1,549
)
 
28,261

 
(6,434
)
 
234,384


83


We have assessed each security with gross unrealized losses included in the previous table for credit impairment. As part of that assessment we evaluated and concluded that we do not intend to sell any of the securities and that it is more likely than not that we will not be required to sell prior to recovery of the amortized cost basis. For debt securities, we evaluate, where necessary, whether credit impairment exists by comparing the present value of the expected cash flows to the securities’ amortized cost basis. For equity securities, we consider numerous factors in determining whether impairment exists, including our intent and ability to hold the securities for a period of time sufficient to recover the cost basis of the securities.
For descriptions of the factors we consider when analyzing securities for impairment, see Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) and Note 5 (Investment Securities) to Financial Statements in our 2016 Form 10-K. There were no material changes to our methodologies for assessing impairment in the first half of 2017. 
Table 4.3 shows the gross unrealized losses and fair value of debt and perpetual preferred investment securities by those rated investment grade and those rated less than investment grade,
 
according to their lowest credit rating by Standard & Poor’s Rating Services (S&P) or Moody’s Investors Service (Moody’s). Credit ratings express opinions about the credit quality of a security. Securities rated investment grade, that is those rated BBB- or higher by S&P or Baa3 or higher by Moody’s, are generally considered by the rating agencies and market participants to be low credit risk. Conversely, securities rated below investment grade, labeled as “speculative grade” by the rating agencies, are considered to be distinctively higher credit risk than investment grade securities. We have also included securities not rated by S&P or Moody’s in the table below based on our internal credit grade of the securities (used for credit risk management purposes) equivalent to the credit rating assigned by major credit agencies. The unrealized losses and fair value of unrated securities categorized as investment grade based on internal credit grades were $32 million and $6.6 billion , respectively, at June 30, 2017 , and $54 million and $7.0 billion , respectively, at December 31, 2016 . If an internal credit grade was not assigned, we categorized the security as non-investment grade. 
Table 4.3: Gross Unrealized Losses and Fair Value by Investment Grade
 
Investment grade
 
 
Non-investment grade
 
(in millions)
Gross
unrealized
losses

 
Fair
value

 
Gross
unrealized
losses

 
Fair
value

June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Available-for-sale securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
$
(65
)
 
11,486

 

 

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
(932
)
 
27,640

 
(43
)
 
372

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal agencies
(1,407
)
 
84,014

 

 

Residential
(1
)
 
54

 
(1
)
 
114

Commercial
(3
)
 
728

 
(13
)
 
311

Total mortgage-backed securities
(1,411
)
 
84,796

 
(14
)
 
425

Corporate debt securities
(14
)
 
630

 
(69
)
 
690

Collateralized loan and other debt obligations
(11
)
 
4,009

 

 

Other
(10
)
 
997

 
(4
)
 
424

Total debt securities
(2,443
)
 
129,558

 
(130
)
 
1,911

Perpetual preferred securities
(3
)
 
63

 
(1
)
 
19

Total available-for-sale securities
(2,446
)

129,621


(131
)

1,930

Held-to-maturity securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
(35
)
 
3,347

 

 

  Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
(55
)
 
3,624

 

 

Federal agency and other mortgage-backed securities
(805
)
 
63,075

 
(1
)
 
35

Collateralized loan obligations

 

 

 

Other

 

 

 

Total held-to-maturity securities
(895
)
 
70,046

 
(1
)
 
35

Total
$
(3,341
)
 
199,667

 
(132
)
 
1,965

December 31, 2016
 
 

 
 
 
 
Available-for-sale securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
$
(109
)
 
10,816

 

 

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
(1,517
)
 
33,271

 
(54
)
 
354

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal agencies
(3,458
)
 
124,216

 

 

Residential
(1
)
 
176

 
(7
)
 
596

Commercial
(15
)
 
2,585

 
(59
)
 
564

Total mortgage-backed securities
(3,474
)
 
126,977

 
(66
)
 
1,160

Corporate debt securities
(31
)
 
1,238

 
(79
)
 
937

Collateralized loan and other debt obligations
(31
)
 
5,096

 

 

Other
(30
)
 
1,842

 
(5
)
 
391

Total debt securities
(5,192
)
 
179,240

 
(204
)
 
2,842

Perpetual preferred securities
(10
)
 
68

 
(1
)
 
18

Total available-for-sale securities
(5,202
)
 
179,308

 
(205
)
 
2,860

Held-to-maturity securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
(77
)
 
6,351

 

 

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
(144
)
 
4,871

 

 

Federal agency and other mortgage-backed securities
(803
)
 
40,078

 
(1
)
 
17

Collateralized loan obligations
(1
)
 
266

 

 

Other
(1
)
 
633



 

Total held-to-maturity securities
(1,026
)
 
52,199

 
(1
)
 
17

Total
$
(6,228
)
 
231,507

 
(206
)
 
2,877


84

Note 4: Investment Securities ( continued )

Contractual Maturities
Table 4.4 shows the remaining contractual maturities and contractual weighted-average yields (taxable-equivalent basis) of available-for-sale debt securities. The remaining contractual principal maturities for MBS do not consider
 
prepayments. Remaining expected maturities will differ from contractual maturities because borrowers may have the right to prepay obligations before the underlying mortgages mature.
 
Table 4.4: Contractual Maturities
  
  
 
 
Remaining contractual maturity
 
  
Total

 
  

 
Within one year
 
 
After one year
through five years
 
 
After five years
through ten years
 
 
After ten years
 
(in millions)

amount

 
Yield

 
Amount

 
Yield

 
Amount

 
Yield

 
Amount

 
Yield

 
Amount

 
Yield

June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Available-for-sale debt securities (1): 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fair value:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
$
17,896

 
1.25
%
 
$
10,987

 
1.04
%
 
$
5,883

 
1.55
%
 
$
1,026

 
1.80
%
 
$

 
%
Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
52,013

 
5.77

 
1,251

 
2.25

 
10,536

 
2.86

 
2,511

 
4.59

 
37,715

 
6.78

Mortgage-backed securities:
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal agencies
135,938

 
3.18

 
1

 
4.93

 
127

 
3.01

 
5,845

 
2.93

 
129,965

 
3.19

Residential
7,359

 
3.90

 

 

 
25

 
5.55

 
19

 
3.76

 
7,315

 
3.89

Commercial
5,413

 
4.18

 

 

 

 

 
45

 
2.90

 
5,368

 
4.19

Total mortgage-backed securities
148,710

 
3.25

 
1

 
4.93

 
152

 
3.42

 
5,909

 
2.93

 
142,648

 
3.27

Corporate debt securities
9,602

 
4.95

 
1,050

 
4.13

 
2,945

 
5.69

 
4,638

 
4.62

 
969

 
5.23

Collateralized loan and other debt obligations
33,455

 
2.89

 

 

 
146

 
2.10

 
17,739

 
2.82

 
15,570

 
2.99

Other
6,498

 
2.32

 
40

 
3.24

 
779

 
2.54

 
1,632

 
1.91

 
4,047

 
2.43

Total available-for-sale debt securities at fair value
$
268,174

 
3.60
%
 
$
13,329

 
1.40
%
 
$
20,441

 
2.88
%
 
$
33,455

 
3.15
%
 
$
200,949

 
3.90
%
December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Available-for-sale debt securities (1):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
`
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fair value:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
$
25,819

 
1.44
%
 
$
1,328

 
0.92
%
 
$
23,477

 
1.45
%
 
$
1,014

 
1.80
%
 
$

 
%
Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
51,101

 
5.65

 
2,990

 
1.69

 
9,299

 
2.74

 
2,391

 
4.71

 
36,421

 
6.78

Mortgage-backed securities:
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal agencies
161,230

 
3.09

 

 

 
128

 
2.98

 
5,363

 
3.16

 
155,739

 
3.09

Residential
7,816

 
3.84

 

 

 
25

 
5.21

 
35

 
4.34

 
7,756

 
3.83

Commercial
8,502

 
4.58

 

 

 

 

 
30

 
3.13

 
8,472

 
4.59

Total mortgage-backed securities
177,548

 
3.19

 

 

 
153

 
3.34

 
5,428

 
3.16

 
171,967

 
3.19

Corporate debt securities
11,457

 
4.81

 
2,043

 
2.90

 
3,374

 
5.89

 
4,741

 
4.71

 
1,299

 
5.38

Collateralized loan and other debt obligations
35,020

 
2.70

 

 

 
168

 
1.34

 
16,482

 
2.66

 
18,370

 
2.74

Other
6,208

 
2.18

 
57

 
3.06

 
971

 
2.35

 
1,146

 
2.04

 
4,034

 
2.17

Total available-for-sale debt securities at fair value
$
307,153

 
3.44
%
 
$
6,418

 
1.93
%
 
$
37,442

 
2.20
%
 
$
31,202

 
3.17
%
 
$
232,091

 
3.72
%
(1)
Weighted-average yields displayed by maturity bucket are weighted based on fair value and predominantly represent contractual coupon rates without effect for any related hedging derivatives.


85


Table 4.5 shows the amortized cost and weighted-average yields of held-to-maturity debt securities by contractual maturity.
Table 4.5: Amortized Cost by Contractual Maturity
  
  
 
 
Remaining contractual maturity
 
  
Total

 
  

 
Within one year
 
 
After one year
through five years
 
 
After five years
through ten years
 
 
After ten years
 
(in millions)
amount

 
Yield

 
Amount

 
Yield

 
Amount

 
Yield

 
Amount

 
Yield

 
Amount

 
Yield

June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Held-to-maturity securities (1): 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Amortized cost:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
$
44,704

 
2.12
%
 
$

 
%
 
$
32,317

 
2.04
%
 
$
12,387

 
2.32
%
 
$

 
%
Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
6,325

 
6.04

 

 

 
24

 
8.20

 
553

 
6.61

 
5,748

 
5.98

Federal agency and other mortgage-backed securities
87,525

 
3.11

 

 

 

 

 



 
87,525

 
3.11

Collateralized loan obligations
993

 
2.72

 

 

 

 

 
993

 
2.72

 

 

Other
845

 
2.03

 

 

 
845

 
2.03

 

 

 

 

Total held-to-maturity debt securities at amortized cost
$
140,392

 
2.92
%
 
$

 
%
 
$
33,186

 
2.04
%
 
$
13,933

 
2.52
%
 
$
93,273

 
3.29
%
December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Held-to-maturity securities (1):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Amortized cost:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
$
44,690

 
2.12
%
 
$

 
%
 
$
31,956

 
2.05
%
 
$
12,734

 
2.30
%
 
$

 
%
Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
6,336

 
6.04

 

 

 
24

 
8.20

 
436

 
6.76

 
5,876

 
5.98

Federal agency and other mortgage-backed securities
45,161

 
3.23

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
45,161

 
3.23

Collateralized loan obligations
1,065

 
2.58

 

 

 

 

 
1,065

 
2.58

 

 

Other
2,331

 
1.83

 

 

 
1,683

 
1.81

 
648

 
1.89

 

 

Total held-to-maturity debt securities at amortized cost
$
99,583

 
2.87
%
 
$

 
%
 
$
33,663

 
2.04
%
 
$
14,883

 
2.43
%
 
$
51,037

 
3.55
%
(1)
Weighted-average yields displayed by maturity bucket are weighted based on amortized cost and predominantly represent contractual coupon rates.

Table 4.6 shows the fair value of held-to-maturity debt securities by contractual maturity.
 

Table 4.6: Fair Value by Contractual Maturity
  
  

 
Remaining contractual maturity
 
  
Total

 
Within one year

 
After one year
through five years

 
After five years
through ten years

 
After ten years

(in millions)
amount

 
Amount

 
Amount

 
Amount

 
Amount

June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Held-to-maturity securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fair value:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
$
45,335

 

 
32,774

 
12,561

 

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
6,330

 

 
24

 
559

 
5,747

Federal agency and other mortgage-backed securities
86,881

 

 

 

 
86,881

Collateralized loan obligations
998

 

 

 
998

 

Other
846

 

 
846

 

 

Total held-to-maturity debt securities at fair value
$
140,390

 

 
33,644

 
14,118

 
92,628

December 31, 2016
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Held-to-maturity securities:
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fair value:
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
$
45,079

 

 
32,313

 
12,766

 

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
6,209

 

 
24

 
430

 
5,755

Federal agency and other mortgage-backed securities
44,457

 

 

 

 
44,457

Collateralized loan obligations
1,070

 

 

 
1,070

 

Other
2,340

 

 
1,688

 
652

 

Total held-to-maturity debt securities at fair value
$
99,155

 

 
34,025

 
14,918

 
50,212


86

Note 4: Investment Securities ( continued )

Realized Gains and Losses
Table 4.7 shows the gross realized gains and losses on sales and OTTI write-downs related to the available-for-sale securities
 
portfolio, which includes marketable equity securities, as well as net realized gains and losses on nonmarketable equity investments (see Note 6 (Other Assets)).
Table 4.7: Realized Gains and Losses
  
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
(in millions)
2017

 
2016

 
2017

 
2016

Gross realized gains
$
320

 
564

 
$
561

 
949

Gross realized losses
(48
)
 
(31
)
 
(84
)
 
(44
)
OTTI write-downs
(51
)
 
(26
)
 
(104
)
 
(95
)
Net realized gains from available-for-sale securities
221

 
507

 
373

 
810

Net realized gains from nonmarketable equity investments
87

 
129

 
374

 
314

Net realized gains from debt securities and equity investments
$
308

 
636

 
$
747

 
1,124


Other-Than-Temporary Impairment
Table 4.8 shows the detail of total OTTI write-downs included in earnings for available-for-sale debt securities, marketable equity
 
securities and nonmarketable equity investments. There were no OTTI write-downs on held-to-maturity securities during the first half of 2017 and 2016 .
Table 4.8: OTTI Write-downs
 
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
(in millions)
2017

 
2016

 
2017

 
2016

OTTI write-downs included in earnings
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Debt securities:
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
$

 
6

 
$
8

 
10

Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
  

 
  

Residential
3

 
12

 
6

 
24

Commercial
41

 

 
66

 
1

Corporate debt securities
4

 
5

 
20

 
50

Other debt securities

 
3

 

 
6

Total debt securities
48

 
26

 
100

 
91

Equity securities:
 
 
 
 
  

 
  

Marketable equity securities:
 
 
 
 
  

 
 
Other marketable equity securities
3

 

 
4

 
4

Total marketable equity securities
3

 

 
4

 
4

Total investment securities (1)
51

 
26

 
104

 
95

Nonmarketable equity investments (1)
22

 
104

 
98

 
233

Total OTTI write-downs included in earnings (1)
$
73

 
130

 
$
202

 
328

(1)
The quarters ended June 30, 2017 and 2016 , include $19 million and $29 million , respectively, in OTTI write-downs of oil and gas investments, of which $7 million and $5 million , respectively, related to investment securities and $12 million and $24 million , respectively, related to nonmarketable equity investments. Oil and gas related OTTI for the first half of 2017 and 2016 , totaled $58 million and $153 million , respectively, of which $22 million and $51 million , respectively, related to investment securities and $36 million and $102 million , respectively, related to nonmarketable equity investments.

87


Other-Than-Temporarily Impaired Debt Securities
Table 4.9 shows the detail of OTTI write-downs on available-for-sale debt securities included in earnings and the related changes in OCI for the same securities.
Table 4.9: OTTI Write-downs Included in Earnings
  
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
(in millions)
2017

 
2016

 
2017

 
2016

OTTI on debt securities
 
 
 
 
  

 
  

Recorded as part of gross realized losses:
 
 
 
 
  

 
  

Credit-related OTTI
$
47

 
20

 
$
99

 
81

Intent-to-sell OTTI
1

 
6

 
1

 
10

Total recorded as part of gross realized losses
48

 
26

 
100

 
91

Changes to OCI for losses (reversal of losses) in non-credit-related OTTI (1):
 
 
 
 
  

 
 
Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions

 

 
(5
)
 

Residential mortgage-backed securities
(3
)
 
(5
)
 

 
5

Commercial mortgage-backed securities
(40
)
 
(1
)
 
(47
)
 
2

Corporate debt securities
1

 
(9
)
 
1

 
(13
)
Other debt securities

 

 

 
2

Total changes to OCI for non-credit-related OTTI
(42
)
 
(15
)
 
(51
)
 
(4
)
Total OTTI losses recorded on debt securities
$
6

 
11

 
$
49

 
87

(1)
Represents amounts recorded to OCI for impairment, due to factors other than credit, on debt securities that have also had credit-related OTTI write-downs during the period. Increases represent initial or subsequent non-credit-related OTTI on debt securities. Decreases represent partial to full reversal of impairment due to recoveries in the fair value of securities due to non-credit factors.
Table 4.10 presents a rollforward of the OTTI credit loss that has been recognized in earnings as a write-down of available-for-sale debt securities we still own (referred to as “credit-impaired” debt securities) and do not intend to sell. Recognized credit loss
 
represents the difference between the present value of expected future cash flows discounted using the security’s current effective interest rate and the amortized cost basis of the security prior to considering credit loss.
Table 4.10: Rollforward of OTTI Credit Loss
 
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
(in millions)
2017

 
2016

 
2017

 
2016

Credit loss recognized, beginning of period
$
1,086

 
1,145

 
$
1,043

 
1,092

Additions:
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
For securities with initial credit impairments
2

 

 
8

 
38

For securities with previous credit impairments
45

 
20

 
91

 
43

Total additions
47

 
20

 
99

 
81

Reductions:
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
For securities sold, matured, or intended/required to be sold
(11
)
 
(83
)
 
(18
)
 
(89
)
For recoveries of previous credit impairments (1)
(2
)
 
(2
)
 
(4
)
 
(4
)
Total reductions
(13
)
 
(85
)
 
(22
)
 
(93
)
Credit loss recognized, end of period
$
1,120

 
1,080

 
$
1,120

 
1,080

(1)
Recoveries of previous credit impairments result from increases in expected cash flows subsequent to credit loss recognition. Such recoveries are reflected prospectively as interest yield adjustments using the effective interest method.

88

Note 5: Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses ( continued )

Note 5:  Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses 
Table 5.1 presents total loans outstanding by portfolio segment and class of financing receivable. Outstanding balances include a total net reduction of $3.9 billion and $4.4 billion at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , respectively, for unearned income,
 
net deferred loan fees, and unamortized discounts and premiums.
Table 5.1: Loans Outstanding
(in millions)
Jun 30,
2017

 
Dec 31,
2016

Commercial:
  

 
  

Commercial and industrial
$
331,113

 
330,840

Real estate mortgage
130,277

 
132,491

Real estate construction
25,337

 
23,916

Lease financing
19,174

 
19,289

Total commercial
505,901

 
506,536

Consumer:
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
276,566

 
275,579

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
42,747

 
46,237

Credit card
35,305

 
36,700

Automobile
57,958

 
62,286

Other revolving credit and installment
38,946

 
40,266

Total consumer
451,522

 
461,068

Total loans
$
957,423

 
967,604


Our foreign loans are reported by respective class of financing receivable in the table above. Substantially all of our foreign loan portfolio is commercial loans. Loans are classified as foreign primarily based on whether the borrower’s primary
 
address is outside of the United States. Table 5.2 presents total commercial foreign loans outstanding by class of financing receivable.
Table 5.2: Commercial Foreign Loans Outstanding
(in millions)
Jun 30,
2017

 
Dec 31,
2016

Commercial foreign loans:
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
57,825

 
55,396

Real estate mortgage
8,359

 
8,541

Real estate construction
585

 
375

Lease financing
1,092

 
972

Total commercial foreign loans
$
67,861

 
65,284



89


Loan Purchases, Sales, and Transfers
Table 5.3 summarizes the proceeds paid or received for purchases and sales of loans and transfers from loans held for investment to mortgages/loans held for sale at lower of cost or fair value. This loan activity also includes participating interests, whereby we
 
receive or transfer a portion of a loan. The table excludes PCI loans and loans for which we have elected the fair value option, including loans originated for sale because their loan activity normally does not impact the allowance for credit losses. 
Table 5.3: Loan Purchases, Sales, and Transfers
 
2017
 
 
2016
 
(in millions)
Commercial

 
Consumer (1)

 
Total

 
Commercial (2)

 
Consumer (1)

 
Total

Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Purchases
$
810

 

 
810

 
2,607

 

 
2,607

Sales
(1,052
)
 
(84
)
 
(1,136
)
 
(385
)
 
(407
)
 
(792
)
Transfers to MHFS/LHFS
(179
)
 
(1
)
 
(180
)
 
(69
)
 
(1
)
 
(70
)
Six months ended June 30,
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Purchases
$
1,969

 
2

 
1,971

 
27,253

 

 
27,253

Sales
(1,339
)
 
(146
)
 
(1,485
)
 
(608
)
 
(679
)
 
(1,287
)
Transfers to MHFS/LHFS
(658
)
 
(1
)
 
(659
)
 
(101
)
 
(4
)
 
(105
)
(1)
Excludes activity in government insured/guaranteed real estate 1-4 family first mortgage loans. As servicer, we are able to buy delinquent insured/guaranteed loans out of the Government National Mortgage Association (GNMA) pools, and manage and/or resell them in accordance with applicable requirements. These loans are predominantly insured by the Federal Housing Administration (FHA) or guaranteed by the Department of Veterans Affairs (VA). Accordingly, these loans have limited impact on the allowance for loan losses.
(2)
Purchases include loans and capital leases from the 2016 GE Capital business acquisitions.
Commitments to Lend
A commitment to lend is a legally binding agreement to lend funds to a customer, usually at a stated interest rate, if funded, and for specific purposes and time periods. We generally require a fee to extend such commitments. Certain commitments are subject to loan agreements with covenants regarding the financial performance of the customer or borrowing base formulas on an ongoing basis that must be met before we are required to fund the commitment. We may reduce or cancel consumer commitments, including home equity lines and credit card lines, in accordance with the contracts and applicable law.
We may, as a representative for other lenders, advance funds or provide for the issuance of letters of credit under syndicated loan or letter of credit agreements. Any advances are generally repaid in less than a week and would normally require default of both the customer and another lender to expose us to loss. These temporary advance arrangements totaled approximately $76 billion and $77 billion at June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016 , respectively.
We issue commercial letters of credit to assist customers in purchasing goods or services, typically for international trade. At June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , we had $1.3 billion and $1.1 billion , respectively, of outstanding issued commercial letters of credit. We also originate multipurpose lending commitments under which borrowers have the option to draw on the facility for different purposes in one of several forms, including a standby letter of credit. See Note 10 (Guarantees, Pledged Assets and Collateral) for additional information on standby letters of credit. 
When we make commitments, we are exposed to credit risk. The maximum credit risk for these commitments will generally be lower than the contractual amount because a significant portion of these commitments is expected to expire without being used by the customer. In addition, we manage the potential risk in commitments to lend by limiting the total amount of commitments, both by individual customer and in total, by monitoring the size and maturity structure of these commitments and by applying the same credit standards for these commitments as for all of our credit activities.
 
For loans and commitments to lend, we generally require collateral or a guarantee. We may require various types of collateral, including commercial and consumer real estate, automobiles, other short-term liquid assets such as accounts receivable or inventory and long-lived assets, such as equipment and other business assets. Collateral requirements for each loan or commitment may vary based on the loan product and our assessment of a customer’s credit risk according to the specific credit underwriting, including credit terms and structure.
The contractual amount of our unfunded credit commitments, including unissued standby and commercial letters of credit, is summarized by portfolio segment and class of financing receivable in Table 5.4 . The table excludes the issued standby and commercial letters of credit and temporary advance arrangements described above.
Table 5.4: Unfunded Credit Commitments
(in millions)
Jun 30,
2017

 
Dec 31,
2016

Commercial:
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
319,058

 
319,662

Real estate mortgage
7,601

 
7,833

Real estate construction
16,728

 
18,840

Lease financing
11

 
16

Total commercial
343,398

 
346,351

Consumer:
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
35,685

 
33,498

Real estate 1-4 family
junior lien mortgage
40,044

 
41,431

Credit card
106,329

 
101,895

Other revolving credit and installment
27,541

 
28,349

Total consumer
209,599

 
205,173

Total unfunded
credit commitments
$
552,997

 
551,524


90

Note 5: Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses ( continued )

Allowance for Credit Losses
Table 5.5 presents the allowance for credit losses, which consists of the allowance for loan losses and the allowance for unfunded credit commitments.
Table 5.5: Allowance for Credit Losses
 
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
(in millions)
2017

 
2016

 
2017

 
2016

Balance, beginning of period
$
12,287

 
12,668

 
12,540

 
12,512

Provision for credit losses
555

 
1,074

 
1,160

 
2,160

Interest income on certain impaired loans (1)
(46
)
 
(51
)
 
(94
)
 
(99
)
Loan charge-offs:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
(161
)
 
(437
)
 
(414
)
 
(786
)
Real estate mortgage
(8
)
 
(3
)
 
(13
)
 
(6
)
Real estate construction

 
(1
)
 

 
(1
)
Lease financing
(13
)
 
(17
)
 
(20
)
 
(21
)
Total commercial
(182
)
 
(458
)
 
(447
)
 
(814
)
Consumer:
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
(55
)
 
(123
)
 
(124
)
 
(260
)
Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
(62
)
 
(133
)
 
(155
)
 
(266
)
Credit card
(379
)
 
(320
)
 
(746
)
 
(634
)
Automobile
(212
)
 
(176
)
 
(467
)
 
(387
)
Other revolving credit and installment
(185
)
 
(163
)
 
(374
)
 
(338
)
Total consumer
(893
)
 
(915
)
 
(1,866
)
 
(1,885
)
Total loan charge-offs
(1,075
)
 
(1,373
)
 
(2,313
)
 
(2,699
)
Loan recoveries:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
83

 
69

 
165

 
145

Real estate mortgage
14

 
23

 
44

 
55

Real estate construction
4

 
4

 
12

 
12

Lease financing
6

 
5

 
8

 
8

Total commercial
107

 
101

 
229

 
220

Consumer:
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
71

 
109

 
133

 
198

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
66

 
71

 
136

 
130

Credit card
59

 
50

 
117

 
102

Automobile
86

 
86

 
174

 
170

Other revolving credit and installment
31

 
32

 
64

 
69

Total consumer
313

 
348

 
624

 
669

Total loan recoveries
420

 
449

 
853

 
889

Net loan charge-offs
(655
)
 
(924
)
 
(1,460
)
 
(1,810
)
Other
5

 
(18
)
 

 
(14
)
Balance, end of period
$
12,146

 
12,749

 
12,146

 
12,749

Components:
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
Allowance for loan losses
$
11,073

 
11,664

 
11,073

 
11,664

Allowance for unfunded credit commitments
1,073

 
1,085

 
1,073

 
1,085

Allowance for credit losses
$
12,146

 
12,749

 
12,146

 
12,749

Net loan charge-offs (annualized) as a percentage of average total loans
0.27
%
 
0.39

 
0.31

 
0.39

Allowance for loan losses as a percentage of total loans
1.16

 
1.22

 
1.16

 
1.22

Allowance for credit losses as a percentage of total loans
1.27

 
1.33

 
1.27

 
1.33

(1)
Certain impaired loans with an allowance calculated by discounting expected cash flows using the loan’s effective interest rate over the remaining life of the loan recognize changes in allowance attributable to the passage of time as interest income.


91


Table 5.6 summarizes the activity in the allowance for credit losses by our commercial and consumer portfolio segments.
Table 5.6: Allowance Activity by Portfolio Segment
 
  

 
  

 
2017

 
  

 
  

 
2016

(in millions)
Commercial

 
Consumer

 
Total

 
Commercial

 
Consumer

 
Total

Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance, beginning of period
$
7,142

 
5,145

 
12,287

 
7,348

 
5,320

 
12,668

Provision (reversal of provision) for credit losses
(97
)
 
652

 
555

 
478

 
596

 
1,074

Interest income on certain impaired loans
(14
)
 
(32
)
 
(46
)
 
(10
)
 
(41
)
 
(51
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loan charge-offs
(182
)
 
(893
)
 
(1,075
)
 
(458
)
 
(915
)
 
(1,373
)
Loan recoveries
107

 
313

 
420

 
101

 
348

 
449

Net loan charge-offs
(75
)
 
(580
)
 
(655
)
 
(357
)
 
(567
)
 
(924
)
Other
5

 

 
5

 
(18
)
 

 
(18
)
Balance, end of period
$
6,961

 
5,185

 
12,146

 
7,441

 
5,308

 
12,749

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance, beginning of period
$
7,394

 
5,146

 
12,540

 
6,872

 
5,640

 
12,512

Provision (reversal of provision) for credit losses
(186
)
 
1,346

 
1,160

 
1,192

 
968

 
2,160

Interest income on certain impaired loans
(29
)
 
(65
)
 
(94
)
 
(15
)
 
(84
)
 
(99
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loan charge-offs
(447
)
 
(1,866
)
 
(2,313
)
 
(814
)
 
(1,885
)
 
(2,699
)
Loan recoveries
229

 
624

 
853

 
220

 
669

 
889

Net loan charge-offs
(218
)
 
(1,242
)
 
(1,460
)
 
(594
)
 
(1,216
)
 
(1,810
)
Other

 

 

 
(14
)
 

 
(14
)
Balance, end of period
$
6,961

 
5,185

 
12,146

 
7,441

 
5,308

 
12,749


Table 5.7 disaggregates our allowance for credit losses and recorded investment in loans by impairment methodology.
Table 5.7: Allowance by Impairment Methodology
 
Allowance for credit losses
 
 
Recorded investment in loans
 
(in millions)
Commercial

 
Consumer

 
Total

 
Commercial

 
Consumer

 
Total

June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Collectively evaluated (1)
$
6,131

 
3,844

 
9,975

 
500,942

 
421,646

 
922,588

Individually evaluated (2)
830

 
1,341

 
2,171

 
4,696

 
15,866

 
20,562

PCI (3)

 

 

 
263

 
14,010

 
14,273

Total
$
6,961

 
5,185

 
12,146

 
505,901

 
451,522

 
957,423

December 31, 2016
 
Collectively evaluated (1)
$
6,392

 
3,553

 
9,945

 
500,487

 
428,009

 
928,496

Individually evaluated (2)
1,000

 
1,593

 
2,593

 
5,372

 
17,005

 
22,377

PCI (3)
2

 

 
2

 
677

 
16,054

 
16,731

Total
$
7,394

 
5,146

 
12,540

 
506,536

 
461,068

 
967,604

(1)
Represents loans collectively evaluated for impairment in accordance with Accounting Standards Codification (ASC) 450-20, Loss Contingencies (formerly FAS 5), and pursuant to amendments by ASU 2010-20 regarding allowance for non-impaired loans.
(2)
Represents loans individually evaluated for impairment in accordance with ASC 310-10, Receivables  (formerly FAS 114), and pursuant to amendments by ASU 2010-20 regarding allowance for impaired loans.
(3)
Represents the allowance and related loan carrying value determined in accordance with ASC 310-30 , Receivables – Loans and Debt Securities Acquired with Deteriorated Credit Quality (formerly SOP 03-3) and pursuant to amendments by ASU 2010-20 regarding allowance for PCI loans.

Credit Quality
We monitor credit quality by evaluating various attributes and utilize such information in our evaluation of the appropriateness of the allowance for credit losses. The following sections provide the credit quality indicators we most closely monitor. The credit quality indicators are generally based on information as of our financial statement date, with the exception of updated Fair Isaac Corporation (FICO) scores and updated loan-to-value (LTV)/
 
combined LTV (CLTV). We obtain FICO scores at loan origination and the scores are generally updated at least quarterly, except in limited circumstances, including compliance with the Fair Credit Reporting Act (FCRA). Generally, the LTV and CLTV indicators are updated in the second month of each quarter, with updates no older than March 31, 2017 . See the “Purchased Credit-Impaired Loans” section in this Note for credit quality information on our PCI portfolio.

92

Note 5: Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses ( continued )

COMMERCIAL CREDIT QUALITY INDICATORS    In addition to monitoring commercial loan concentration risk, we manage a consistent process for assessing commercial loan credit quality. Generally, commercial loans are subject to individual risk assessment using our internal borrower and collateral quality ratings. Our ratings are aligned to Pass and Criticized categories. The Criticized category includes Special Mention, Substandard, and Doubtful categories which are defined by bank regulatory
 
agencies.
Table 5.8 provides a breakdown of outstanding commercial loans by risk category. Of the $19.0 billion in criticized commercial and industrial loans and $5.2 billion in criticized commercial real estate (CRE) loans at June 30, 2017 , $2.6 billion and $664 million , respectively, have been placed on nonaccrual status and written down to net realizable collateral value.

Table 5.8: Commercial Loans by Risk Category
(in millions)
Commercial
and
industrial

 
Real
estate
mortgage

 
Real
estate
construction

 
Lease
financing

 
Total

June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
By risk category:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Pass
$
311,963

 
125,283

 
25,013

 
17,970

 
480,229

Criticized
19,019

 
4,875

 
311

 
1,204

 
25,409

Total commercial loans (excluding PCI)
330,982

 
130,158

 
25,324

 
19,174

 
505,638

Total commercial PCI loans (carrying value)
131

 
119

 
13

 

 
263

Total commercial loans
$
331,113

 
130,277

 
25,337

 
19,174

 
505,901

December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
By risk category:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Pass
$
308,166

 
126,793

 
23,408

 
17,899

 
476,266

Criticized
22,437

 
5,315

 
451

 
1,390

 
29,593

Total commercial loans (excluding PCI)
330,603

 
132,108

 
23,859

 
19,289

 
505,859

Total commercial PCI loans (carrying value)
237

 
383

 
57

 

 
677

Total commercial loans
$
330,840

 
132,491

 
23,916

 
19,289

 
506,536


Table 5.9 provides past due information for commercial loans, which we monitor as part of our credit risk management practices.
 
 
Table 5.9: Commercial Loans by Delinquency Status
(in millions)
Commercial
and
industrial

 
Real
estate
mortgage

 
Real
estate
construction

 
Lease
financing

 
Total

June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
By delinquency status:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current-29 days past due (DPD) and still accruing
$
327,614

 
129,360

 
25,148

 
18,970

 
501,092

30-89 DPD and still accruing
694

 
166

 
132

 
115

 
1,107

90+ DPD and still accruing
42

 
2

 
10

 

 
54

Nonaccrual loans
2,632

 
630

 
34

 
89

 
3,385

Total commercial loans (excluding PCI)
330,982

 
130,158

 
25,324

 
19,174

 
505,638

Total commercial PCI loans (carrying value)
131

 
119

 
13

 

 
263

Total commercial loans
$
331,113

 
130,277

 
25,337

 
19,174

 
505,901

December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
By delinquency status:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current-29 DPD and still accruing
$
326,765

 
131,165

 
23,776

 
19,042

 
500,748

30-89 DPD and still accruing
594

 
222

 
40

 
132

 
988

90+ DPD and still accruing
28

 
36

 

 

 
64

Nonaccrual loans
3,216

 
685

 
43

 
115

 
4,059

Total commercial loans (excluding PCI)
330,603

 
132,108

 
23,859

 
19,289

 
505,859

Total commercial PCI loans (carrying value)
237

 
383

 
57

 

 
677

Total commercial loans
$
330,840

 
132,491

 
23,916

 
19,289

 
506,536



93


CONSUMER CREDIT QUALITY INDICATORS   We have various classes of consumer loans that present unique risks. Loan delinquency, FICO credit scores and LTV for loan types are common credit quality indicators that we monitor and utilize in our evaluation of the appropriateness of the allowance for credit losses for the consumer portfolio segment.
 
Many of our loss estimation techniques used for the allowance for credit losses rely on delinquency-based models; therefore, delinquency is an important indicator of credit quality and the establishment of our allowance for credit losses. Table 5.10 provides the outstanding balances of our consumer portfolio by delinquency status.
Table 5.10: Consumer Loans by Delinquency Status
(in millions)
Real estate
1-4 family
first
mortgage

 
Real estate
1-4 family
junior lien
mortgage

 
Credit
card

 
Automobile

 
Other
revolving
credit and
installment

 
Total

June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
By delinquency status:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current-29 DPD
$
244,862

 
41,866

 
34,455

 
56,470

 
38,591

 
416,244

30-59 DPD
1,607

 
273

 
254

 
1,085

 
130

 
3,349

60-89 DPD
637

 
151

 
185

 
298

 
88

 
1,359

90-119 DPD
269

 
81

 
142

 
100

 
79

 
671

120-179 DPD
245

 
90

 
268

 
5

 
30

 
638

180+ DPD
1,378

 
255

 
1

 

 
28

 
1,662

Government insured/guaranteed loans (1)
13,589

 

 

 

 

 
13,589

Total consumer loans (excluding PCI)
262,587

 
42,716

 
35,305

 
57,958

 
38,946

 
437,512

Total consumer PCI loans (carrying value)
13,979

 
31

 

 

 

 
14,010

Total consumer loans
$
276,566

 
42,747

 
35,305

 
57,958

 
38,946

 
451,522

December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
By delinquency status:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current-29 DPD
$
239,061

 
45,238

 
35,773

 
60,572

 
39,833

 
420,477

30-59 DPD
1,904

 
296

 
275

 
1,262

 
177

 
3,914

60-89 DPD
700

 
160

 
200

 
330

 
111

 
1,501

90-119 DPD
307

 
102

 
169

 
116

 
93

 
787

120-179 DPD
323

 
108

 
279

 
5

 
30

 
745

180+ DPD
1,661

 
297

 
4

 
1

 
22

 
1,985

Government insured/guaranteed loans (1)
15,605

 

 

 

 

 
15,605

Total consumer loans (excluding PCI)
259,561

 
46,201

 
36,700

 
62,286

 
40,266

 
445,014

Total consumer PCI loans (carrying value)
16,018

 
36

 

 

 

 
16,054

Total consumer loans
$
275,579

 
46,237

 
36,700

 
62,286

 
40,266

 
461,068

(1)
Represents loans whose repayments are predominantly insured by the FHA or guaranteed by the VA. Loans insured/guaranteed by the FHA/VA and 90+ DPD totaled $8.5 billion at June 30, 2017 , compared with $10.1 billion at December 31, 2016 .

Of the $3.0 billion of consumer loans not government insured/guaranteed that are 90 days or more past due at June 30, 2017 , $789 million was accruing, compared with $3.5 billion past due and $908 million accruing at December 31, 2016 .
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage loans 180 days or more past due totaled $1.4 billion , or 0.5% of total first mortgages (excluding PCI), at June 30, 2017 , compared with $1.7 billion , or 0.6% , at December 31, 2016 .

94

Note 5: Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses ( continued )

Table 5.11 provides a breakdown of our consumer portfolio by FICO. The June 30, 2017 FICO scores for real estate 1-4 family first and junior lien mortgages reflect a new FICO score version we adopted in first quarter 2017 to monitor and manage those portfolios. In general the impact for us is a shift to higher scores, particularly to the 800+ level, as the new FICO score version utilizes a more refined approach that better distinguishes borrower credit risk. Most of the scored consumer portfolio has
 
an updated FICO of 680 and above, reflecting a strong current borrower credit profile. FICO is not available for certain loan types, or may not be required if we deem it unnecessary due to strong collateral and other borrower attributes. Substantially all loans not requiring a FICO score are securities-based loans originated through retail brokerage, and totaled $8.2 billion at June 30, 2017 , and $8.0 billion at December 31, 2016 .
Table 5.11: Consumer Loans by FICO
(in millions)
Real estate
1-4 family
first
mortgage (1)

 
Real estate
1-4 family
junior lien
mortgage (1)

 
Credit
card

 
Automobile

 
Other
revolving
credit and
installment (1)

 
Total

June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
By FICO:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
< 600
$
5,767

 
1,949

 
3,282

 
9,716

 
892

 
21,606

600-639
3,917

 
1,422

 
2,932

 
6,468

 
945

 
15,684

640-679
7,322

 
2,689

 
5,399

 
8,741

 
2,068

 
26,219

680-719
15,579

 
5,269

 
7,195

 
9,676

 
3,743

 
41,462

720-759
28,480

 
6,756

 
7,544

 
8,282

 
5,307

 
56,369

760-799
54,249

 
7,792

 
6,018

 
6,739

 
6,481

 
81,279

800+
127,929

 
16,015

 
2,889

 
8,098

 
8,744

 
163,675

No FICO available
5,755

 
824

 
46

 
238

 
2,608

 
9,471

FICO not required

 

 

 

 
8,158

 
8,158

Government insured/guaranteed loans (2)
13,589

 

 

 

 

 
13,589

Total consumer loans (excluding PCI)
262,587

 
42,716

 
35,305

 
57,958

 
38,946

 
437,512

Total consumer PCI loans (carrying value)
13,979

 
31

 

 

 

 
14,010

Total consumer loans
$
276,566

 
42,747

 
35,305

 
57,958

 
38,946

 
451,522

December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 


By FICO:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

< 600
$
6,720

 
2,591

 
3,475

 
9,934

 
976

 
23,696

600-639
5,400

 
1,917

 
3,109

 
6,705

 
1,056

 
18,187

640-679
10,975

 
3,747

 
5,678

 
10,204

 
2,333

 
32,937

680-719
23,300

 
6,432

 
7,382

 
11,233

 
4,302

 
52,649

720-759
38,832

 
9,413

 
7,632

 
8,769

 
5,869

 
70,515

760-799
103,608

 
14,929

 
6,191

 
8,164

 
8,348

 
141,240

800+
49,508

 
6,391

 
2,868

 
6,856

 
6,434

 
72,057

No FICO available
5,613

 
781

 
365

 
421

 
2,906

 
10,086

FICO not required

 

 

 

 
8,042

 
8,042

Government insured/guaranteed loans (2)
15,605

 

 

 

 

 
15,605

Total consumer loans (excluding PCI)
259,561

 
46,201

 
36,700

 
62,286

 
40,266

 
445,014

Total consumer PCI loans (carrying value)
16,018

 
36

 

 

 

 
16,054

Total consumer loans
$
275,579

 
46,237

 
36,700

 
62,286

 
40,266

 
461,068

(1)
The June 30, 2017 , amounts reflect updated FICO score version implemented in first quarter 2017.
(2)
Represents loans whose repayments are predominantly insured by the FHA or guaranteed by the VA.
 
LTV refers to the ratio comparing the loan’s unpaid principal balance to the property’s collateral value. CLTV refers to the combination of first mortgage and junior lien mortgage (including unused line amounts for credit line products) ratios. LTVs and CLTVs are updated quarterly using a cascade approach which first uses values provided by automated valuation models (AVMs) for the property. If an AVM is not available, then the value is estimated using the original appraised value adjusted by the change in Home Price Index (HPI) for the property location. If an HPI is not available, the original appraised value is used. The HPI value is normally the only method considered for high value properties, generally with an original value of $1 million or more, as the AVM values have proven less accurate for these properties.
 
Table 5.12 shows the most updated LTV and CLTV distribution of the real estate 1-4 family first and junior lien mortgage loan portfolios. We consider the trends in residential real estate markets as we monitor credit risk and establish our allowance for credit losses. In the event of a default, any loss should be limited to the portion of the loan amount in excess of the net realizable value of the underlying real estate collateral value. Certain loans do not have an LTV or CLTV due to industry data availability and portfolios acquired from or serviced by other institutions.

95


Table 5.12: Consumer Loans by LTV/CLTV
  
June 30, 2017
 
 
December 31, 2016
 
(in millions)
Real estate
1-4 family
first
mortgage
by LTV

 
Real estate
1-4 family
junior lien
mortgage
by CLTV

 
Total

 
Real estate
1-4 family
first
mortgage
by LTV

 
Real estate
1-4 family
junior lien
mortgage
by CLTV

 
Total

By LTV/CLTV:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
0-60%
$
124,277

 
15,923

 
140,200

 
121,430

 
16,464

 
137,894

60.01-80%
104,027

 
13,974

 
118,001

 
101,726

 
15,262

 
116,988

80.01-100%
16,229

 
7,827

 
24,056

 
15,795

 
8,765

 
24,560

100.01-120% (1)
2,334

 
3,158

 
5,492

 
2,644

 
3,589

 
6,233

> 120% (1)
981

 
1,359

 
2,340

 
1,066

 
1,613

 
2,679

No LTV/CLTV available
1,150

 
475

 
1,625

 
1,295

 
508

 
1,803

Government insured/guaranteed loans (2)
13,589

 

 
13,589

 
15,605

 

 
15,605

Total consumer loans (excluding PCI)
262,587

 
42,716

 
305,303

 
259,561

 
46,201

 
305,762

Total consumer PCI loans (carrying value)
13,979

 
31

 
14,010

 
16,018

 
36

 
16,054

Total consumer loans
$
276,566

 
42,747

 
319,313

 
275,579

 
46,237

 
321,816

(1)
Reflects total loan balances with LTV/CLTV amounts in excess of 100%. In the event of default, the loss content would generally be limited to only the amount in excess of 100% LTV/CLTV.
(2)
Represents loans whose repayments are predominantly insured by the FHA or guaranteed by the VA.
 
NONACCRUAL LOANS   Table 5.13 provides loans on nonaccrual status. PCI loans are excluded from this table because they continue to earn interest from accretable yield, independent of performance in accordance with their contractual terms.
Table 5.13: Nonaccrual Loans
(in millions)
Jun 30,
2017

 
Dec 31,
2016

Commercial:
  
 
  
Commercial and industrial
$
2,632

 
3,216

Real estate mortgage
630

 
685

Real estate construction
34

 
43

Lease financing
89

 
115

Total commercial
3,385

 
4,059

Consumer:
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage (1)
4,413

 
4,962

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
1,095

 
1,206

Automobile
104

 
106

Other revolving credit and installment
59

 
51

Total consumer
5,671

 
6,325

Total nonaccrual loans
(excluding PCI)
$
9,056

 
10,384

(1)
Includes MHFS of $140 million and $149 million at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , respectively.
 
LOANS IN PROCESS OF FORECLOSURE   Our recorded investment in consumer mortgage loans collateralized by residential real estate property that are in process of foreclosure was $7.0 billion and $8.1 billion at June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016 , respectively, which included $4.1 billion and $4.8 billion , respectively, of loans that are government insured/guaranteed. We commence the foreclosure process on consumer real estate loans when a borrower becomes 120 days delinquent in accordance with Consumer Finance Protection Bureau Guidelines. Foreclosure procedures and timelines vary depending on whether the property address resides in a judicial or non-judicial state. Judicial states require the foreclosure to be processed through the state’s courts while non-judicial states are processed without court intervention. Foreclosure timelines vary according to state law.


96

Note 5: Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses ( continued )

LOANS 90 DAYS OR MORE PAST DUE AND STILL ACCRUING   Certain loans 90 days or more past due as to interest or principal are still accruing, because they are (1) well-secured and in the process of collection or (2) real estate 1-4 family mortgage loans or consumer loans exempt under regulatory rules from being classified as nonaccrual until later delinquency, usually 120 days past due. PCI loans of $1.5 billion at June 30, 2017 , and $2.0 billion at December 31, 2016 , are not included in these past due and still accruing loans even when they are 90 days or more contractually past due. These PCI loans are considered to be accruing because they continue to earn interest from accretable yield, independent of performance in accordance with their contractual terms.
Table 5.14 shows non-PCI loans 90 days or more past due and still accruing by class for loans not government insured/guaranteed.
Table 5.14: Loans 90 Days or More Past Due and Still Accruing
(in millions)
Jun 30, 2017

 
Dec 31, 2016

Total (excluding PCI):
$
9,716

 
11,858

Less: FHA insured/guaranteed by the VA (1)(2)
8,873

 
10,883

Less: Student loans guaranteed under the Federal Family Education Loan Program (FFELP) (3)

 
3

Total, not government insured/guaranteed
$
843

 
972

By segment and class, not government insured/guaranteed:
 
 
 
Commercial:
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
42

 
28

Real estate mortgage
2

 
36

Real estate construction
10

 

Total commercial
54

 
64

Consumer:
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage (2)
145

 
175

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage (2)
44

 
56

Credit card
411

 
452

Automobile
91

 
112

Other revolving credit and installment
98

 
113

Total consumer
789

 
908

Total, not government insured/guaranteed
$
843

 
972

(1)
Represents loans whose repayments are predominantly insured by the FHA or guaranteed by the VA.
(2)
Includes mortgages held for sale 90 days or more past due and still accruing.
(3)
Represents loans whose repayments are largely guaranteed by agencies on behalf of the U.S. Department of Education under the FFELP. All remaining student loans guaranteed under the FFELP were sold as of March 31, 2017.

97


IMPAIRED LOANS Table 5.15 summarizes key information for impaired loans. Our impaired loans predominantly include loans on nonaccrual status in the commercial portfolio segment and loans modified in a TDR, whether on accrual or nonaccrual status. These impaired loans generally have estimated losses which are included in the allowance for credit losses. We have impaired loans with no allowance for credit losses when loss content has been previously recognized through charge-offs and we do not anticipate additional charge-offs or losses, or certain
 
loans are currently performing in accordance with their terms and for which no loss has been estimated. Impaired loans exclude PCI loans. Table 5.15 includes trial modifications that totaled $215 million at June 30, 2017 , and $299 million at December 31, 2016 .
For additional information on our impaired loans and allowance for credit losses, see Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) in our 2016 Form 10-K.
Table 5.15: Impaired Loans Summary
 
 
 
Recorded investment
 
 
 
(in millions)
Unpaid
principal
balance (1)

 
Impaired
loans

 
Impaired loans
with related
allowance for
credit losses

 
Related
allowance for
credit losses

June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
4,401

 
3,205

 
2,901

 
558

Real estate mortgage
1,654

 
1,337

 
1,325

 
238

Real estate construction
105

 
62

 
62

 
11

Lease financing
126

 
92

 
92

 
23

Total commercial
6,286

 
4,696

 
4,380

 
830

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
15,256

 
13,299

 
8,677

 
905

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
2,273

 
2,043

 
1,557

 
295

Credit card
317

 
316

 
316

 
113

Automobile
152

 
85

 
31

 
4

Other revolving credit and installment
129

 
123

 
113

 
24

Total consumer (2)
18,127

 
15,866

 
10,694

 
1,341

Total impaired loans (excluding PCI)
$
24,413

 
20,562

 
15,074

 
2,171

December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
5,058

 
3,742

 
3,418

 
675

Real estate mortgage
1,777

 
1,418

 
1,396

 
280

Real estate construction
167

 
93

 
93

 
22

Lease financing
146

 
119

 
119

 
23

Total commercial
7,148

 
5,372

 
5,026

 
1,000

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
16,438

 
14,362

 
9,475

 
1,117

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
2,399

 
2,156

 
1,681

 
350

Credit card
300

 
300

 
300

 
104

Automobile
153

 
85

 
31

 
5

Other revolving credit and installment
109

 
102

 
91

 
17

Total consumer (2)
19,399

 
17,005

 
11,578

 
1,593

Total impaired loans (excluding PCI)
$
26,547

 
22,377

 
16,604

 
2,593

(1)
Excludes the unpaid principal balance for loans that have been fully charged off or otherwise have zero recorded investment.
(2)
Includes the recorded investment of $1.4 billion and $1.5 billion at June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016 , respectively, of government insured/guaranteed loans that are predominantly insured by the FHA or guaranteed by the VA and generally do not have an allowance. Impaired loans may also have limited, if any, allowance when the recorded investment of the loan approximates estimated net realizable value as a result of charge-offs prior to a TDR modification.

98

Note 5: Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses ( continued )

Commitments to lend additional funds on loans whose terms have been modified in a TDR amounted to $747 million and $403 million at June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016 , respectively.
 
Table 5.16 provides the average recorded investment in impaired loans and the amount of interest income recognized on impaired loans by portfolio segment and class.
Table 5.16: Average Recorded Investment in Impaired Loans
 
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
 
2017
 
 
2016
 
 
2017
 
 
2016
 
(in millions)
Average
recorded
investment

 
Recognized
interest
income

 
Average
recorded
investment

 
Recognized
interest
income

 
Average
recorded
investment

 
Recognized
interest
income

 
Average
recorded
investment

 
Recognized
interest
income

Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
3,390

 
36

 
3,803

 
21

 
3,457

 
69

 
3,146

 
40

Real estate mortgage
1,371

 
24

 
1,695

 
34

 
1,397

 
51

 
1,730

 
66

Real estate construction
66

 
2

 
116

 
3

 
75

 
3

 
122

 
5

Lease financing
98

 

 
93

 

 
110

 

 
79

 

Total commercial
4,925

 
62

 
5,707

 
58

 
5,039

 
123

 
5,077

 
111

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
13,602

 
185

 
16,278

 
211

 
13,866

 
375

 
16,595

 
432

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
2,075

 
31

 
2,325

 
33

 
2,103

 
62

 
2,354

 
67

Credit card
313

 
9

 
293

 
8

 
308

 
17

 
295

 
17

Automobile
83

 
3

 
94

 
3

 
83

 
6

 
98

 
6

Other revolving credit and installment
114

 
2

 
84

 
2

 
110

 
4

 
80

 
3

Total consumer
16,187

 
230

 
19,074

 
257

 
16,470

 
464

 
19,422

 
525

Total impaired loans (excluding PCI)
$
21,112

 
292

 
24,781

 
315

 
21,509

 
587

 
24,499

 
636

Interest income:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash basis of accounting
 
 
$
77

 
 
 
92

 
 
 
155

 
 
 
187

Other (1)
 
 
215

 
 
 
223

 
 
 
432

 
 
 
449

Total interest income
 
 
$
292

 
 
 
315

 
 
 
587

 
 
 
636

(1)
Includes interest recognized on accruing TDRs, interest recognized related to certain impaired loans which have an allowance calculated using discounting, and amortization of purchase accounting adjustments related to certain impaired loans.


TROUBLED DEBT RESTRUCTURINGS (TDRs)  When, for economic or legal reasons related to a borrower’s financial difficulties, we grant a concession for other than an insignificant period of time to a borrower that we would not otherwise consider, the related loan is classified as a TDR, the balance of which totaled $19.6 billion and $20.8 billion at June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016 , respectively. We do not consider loan resolutions such as foreclosure or short sale to be a TDR.
 
We may require some consumer borrowers experiencing financial difficulty to make trial payments generally for a period of three to four months, according to the terms of a planned permanent modification, to determine if they can perform according to those terms. These arrangements represent trial modifications, which we classify and account for as TDRs. While loans are in trial payment programs, their original terms are not considered modified and they continue to advance through delinquency status and accrue interest according to their original terms.

99


Table 5.17 summarizes our TDR modifications for the periods presented by primary modification type and includes the financial effects of these modifications. For those loans that modify more than once, the table reflects each modification that occurred during the period. Loans that both modify and pay off
 
within the period, as well as changes in recorded investment during the period for loans modified in prior periods, are not included in the table.
Table 5.17: TDR Modifications
 
Primary modification type (1)
 
 
Financial effects of modifications
 
(in millions)
Principal (2)

 
Interest
rate
reduction

 
Other
concessions (3)

 
Total

 
Charge-
offs (4)

 
Weighted
average
interest
rate
reduction

 
Recorded
investment
related to
interest rate
reduction (5)

Quarter ended June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
17

 
13

 
914

 
944

 
29

 
0.88
%
 
$
13

Real estate mortgage
4

 
25

 
137

 
166

 
13

 
1.36

 
25

Real estate construction

 
1

 
20

 
21

 

 
0.61

 
1

Lease financing

 

 
11

 
11

 

 

 

Total commercial
21

 
39

 
1,082

 
1,142

 
42

 
1.19

 
39

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
74

 
45

 
234

 
353

 
3

 
2.55

 
83

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
7

 
26

 
21

 
54

 
3

 
2.88

 
30

Credit card

 
57

 

 
57

 

 
12.48

 
57

Automobile

 
4

 
20

 
24

 
11

 
5.90

 
4

Other revolving credit and installment

 
16

 
1

 
17

 
1

 
7.27

 
15

Trial modifications (6)

 

 
(27
)
 
(27
)
 

 

 

Total consumer
81

 
148

 
249

 
478

 
18

 
6.07

 
189

Total
$
102

 
187

 
1,331

 
1,620

 
60

 
5.24
%
 
$
228

Quarter ended June 30, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$

 
35

 
697

 
732

 
137

 
2.29
%
 
$
35

Real estate mortgage

 
29

 
135

 
164

 

 
1.30

 
28

Real estate construction

 
14

 
18

 
32

 

 
1.05

 
14

Lease financing

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total commercial

 
78

 
850

 
928

 
137

 
1.70

 
77

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
92

 
78

 
314

 
484

 
12

 
2.63

 
138

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
6

 
27

 
33

 
66

 
11

 
3.11

 
33

Credit card

 
41

 

 
41

 

 
11.98

 
41

Automobile
1

 
3

 
14

 
18

 
8

 
6.40

 
3

Other revolving credit and installment

 
8

 
2

 
10

 

 
6.99

 
8

Trial modifications (6)

 

 
17

 
17

 

 

 

Total consumer
99

 
157

 
380

 
636

 
31

 
4.64

 
223

Total
$
99

 
235

 
1,230

 
1,564

 
168

 
3.88
%
 
$
300


100

Note 5: Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses ( continued )

 
Primary modification type (1)
 
 
Financial effects of modifications
 
(in millions)
Principal (2)

 
Interest
rate
reduction

 
Other
concessions (3)

 
Total

 
Charge-
offs (4)

 
Weighted
average
interest
rate
reduction

 
Recorded
investment
related to
interest rate
reduction (5)

Six months ended June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
17

 
19

 
1,842

 
1,878

 
94

 
0.86
%
 
$
19

Real estate mortgage
4

 
39

 
318

 
361

 
13

 
1.23

 
39

Real estate construction

 
1

 
23

 
24

 

 
0.69

 
1

Lease financing

 

 
14

 
14

 

 

 

Total commercial
21

 
59

 
2,197

 
2,277

 
107

 
1.10

 
59

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
148

 
117

 
525

 
790

 
12

 
2.58

 
186

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
20

 
47

 
44

 
111

 
9

 
2.91

 
54

Credit card

 
114

 

 
114

 

 
12.35

 
114

Automobile
1

 
7

 
32

 
40

 
18

 
6.14

 
7

Other revolving credit and installment

 
27

 
4

 
31

 
1

 
7.28

 
26

Trial modifications (6)

 

 
(44
)
 
(44
)
 

 

 

Total consumer
169

 
312

 
561

 
1,042

 
40

 
5.89

 
387

Total
$
190

 
371

 
2,758

 
3,319

 
147

 
5.25
%
 
$
446

Six months ended June 30, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
42

 
113

 
1,329

 
1,484

 
243

 
2.02
%
 
$
113

Real estate mortgage

 
53

 
294

 
347

 

 
1.22

 
52

Real estate construction

 
14

 
62

 
76

 

 
1.05

 
14

Lease financing

 

 
4

 
4

 

 

 

Total commercial
42

 
180

 
1,689

 
1,911

 
243

 
1.71

 
179

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
188

 
143

 
764

 
1,095

 
25

 
2.72

 
257

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
12

 
56

 
60

 
128

 
21

 
3.01

 
67

Credit card

 
85

 

 
85

 

 
11.96

 
85

Automobile
1

 
7

 
29

 
37

 
16

 
6.47

 
7

Other revolving credit and installment

 
16

 
5

 
21

 
1

 
6.53

 
16

Trial modifications (6)

 

 
32

 
32

 

 

 

Total consumer
201

 
307

 
890

 
1,398

 
63

 
4.79

 
432

Total
$
243

 
487

 
2,579

 
3,309

 
306

 
3.88
%
 
$
611

(1)
Amounts represent the recorded investment in loans after recognizing the effects of the TDR, if any. TDRs may have multiple types of concessions, but are presented only once in the first modification type based on the order presented in the table above. The reported amounts include loans remodified of $602 million and $301 million for the quarters ended June 30, 2017 and 2016 , and $1.3 billion and $649 million , for the first half of 2017 and 2016 , respectively.
(2)
Principal modifications include principal forgiveness at the time of the modification, contingent principal forgiveness granted over the life of the loan based on borrower performance, and principal that has been legally separated and deferred to the end of the loan, with a zero percent contractual interest rate.
(3)
Other concessions include loans discharged in bankruptcy, loan renewals, term extensions and other interest and noninterest adjustments, but exclude modifications that also forgive principal and/or reduce the contractual interest rate.
(4)
Charge-offs include write-downs of the investment in the loan in the period it is contractually modified. The amount of charge-off will differ from the modification terms if the loan has been charged down prior to the modification based on our policies. In addition, there may be cases where we have a charge-off/down with no legal principal modification. Modifications resulted in legally forgiving principal (actual, contingent or deferred) of $10 million and $19 million for the quarters ended June 30, 2017 and 2016, and $19 million and $38 million for the first half of 2017 and 2016 , respectively.
(5)
Reflects the effect of reduced interest rates on loans with an interest rate concession as one of their concession types, which includes loans reported as a principal primary modification type that also have an interest rate concession.
(6)
Trial modifications are granted a delay in payments due under the original terms during the trial payment period. However, these loans continue to advance through delinquency status and accrue interest according to their original terms. Any subsequent permanent modification generally includes interest rate related concessions; however, the exact concession type and resulting financial effect are usually not known until the loan is permanently modified. Trial modifications for the period are presented net of previously reported trial modifications that became permanent in the current period.

101


Table 5.18 summarizes permanent modification TDRs that have defaulted in the current period within 12 months of their permanent modification date. We are reporting these defaulted TDRs based on a payment default definition of 90 days past due for the commercial portfolio segment and 60 days past due for the consumer portfolio segment.
 


Table 5.18: Defaulted TDRs
 
Recorded investment of defaults
 
 
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
(in millions)
2017

 
2016

 
2017

 
2016

Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
30

 
20

 
92

 
45

Real estate mortgage
10

 
31

 
31

 
51

Real estate construction

 
1

 

 
3

Total commercial
40

 
52

 
123

 
99

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
26

 
30

 
51

 
61

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
5

 
4

 
9

 
9

Credit card
17

 
13

 
32

 
26

Automobile
4

 
3

 
7

 
6

Other revolving credit and installment
1

 
1

 
2

 
2

Total consumer
53

 
51

 
101

 
104

Total
$
93

 
103

 
224

 
203


Purchased Credit-Impaired Loans
Substantially all of our PCI loans were acquired from Wachovia on December 31, 2008, at which time we acquired commercial and consumer loans with a carrying value of $18.7 billion and $40.1 billion , respectively. The unpaid principal balance on December 31, 2008 was $98.2 billion for the total of commercial and consumer PCI loans. Table 5.19 presents PCI loans net of any remaining purchase accounting adjustments. Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage PCI loans are predominantly Pick-a-Pay loans.
Table 5.19: PCI Loans
(in millions)
Jun 30,
2017

 
Dec 31,
2016

Commercial:
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
131

 
237

Real estate mortgage
119

 
383

Real estate construction
13

 
57

Total commercial
263

 
677

Consumer:
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
13,979

 
16,018

Real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgage
31

 
36

Total consumer
14,010

 
16,054

Total PCI loans (carrying value)
$
14,273

 
16,731

Total PCI loans (unpaid principal balance)
$
20,928

 
24,136



102

Note 5: Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses ( continued )

ACCRETABLE YIELD The excess of cash flows expected to be collected over the carrying value of PCI loans is referred to as the accretable yield and is recognized in interest income using an effective yield method over the remaining life of the loan, or pools of loans. The accretable yield is affected by:
changes in interest rate indices for variable rate PCI loans – expected future cash flows are based on the variable rates in effect at the time of the regular evaluations of cash flows expected to be collected;
changes in prepayment assumptions – prepayments affect the estimated life of PCI loans which may change the amount of interest income, and possibly principal, expected to be collected; and
changes in the expected principal and interest payments over the estimated weighted-average life – updates to expected
 
cash flows are driven by the credit outlook and actions taken with borrowers. Changes in expected future cash flows from loan modifications are included in the regular evaluations of cash flows expected to be collected.
 
The change in the accretable yield related to PCI loans since the merger with Wachovia is presented in Table 5.20 . Changes during the first half of 2017 reflect an expectation, as a result of our quarterly evaluation of PCI cash flows, that prepayment of modified Pick-a-Pay loans will increase over their estimated weighted-average life and that expected loss has decreased as a result of reduced loan to value ratios and sustained higher housing prices. Second quarter 2017 reflects a $309 million gain on the sale of $569 million Pick-a-Pay PCI loans.
Table 5.20: Change in Accretable Yield
(in millions)
Quarter ended June 30, 2017

 
Six months
ended June 30, 2017

 
2009-2016

Balance, beginning of period
$
10,315

 
11,216

 
10,447

Change in accretable yield due to acquisitions

 
2

 
159

Accretion into interest income (1)
(374
)
 
(731
)
 
(15,577
)
Accretion into noninterest income due to sales (2)
(309
)
 
(334
)
 
(467
)
Reclassification from nonaccretable difference for loans with improving credit-related cash flows 

 
406

 
10,955

Changes in expected cash flows that do not affect nonaccretable difference (3)
(263
)
 
(1,190
)
 
5,699

Balance, end of period 
$
9,369

 
9,369

 
11,216

(1)
Includes accretable yield released as a result of settlements with borrowers, which is included in interest income.
(2)
Includes accretable yield released as a result of sales to third parties, which is included in noninterest income.
(3)
Represents changes in cash flows expected to be collected due to the impact of modifications, changes in prepayment assumptions, changes in interest rates on variable rate PCI loans and sales to third parties.

COMMERCIAL PCI CREDIT QUALITY INDICATORS   Table 5.21 provides a breakdown of commercial PCI loans by risk category.
 
 
Table 5.21: Commercial PCI Loans by Risk Category
(in millions)
Commercial
and
industrial

 
Real
estate
mortgage

 
Real
estate
construction

 
Total

June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
By risk category:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Pass
$
7

 
84

 
4

 
95

Criticized
124

 
35

 
9

 
168

Total commercial PCI loans
$
131

 
119

 
13

 
263

December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
By risk category:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Pass
$
92

 
263

 
47

 
402

Criticized
145

 
120

 
10

 
275

Total commercial PCI loans
$
237

 
383

 
57

 
677



103


Table 5.22 provides past due information for commercial PCI loans.
Table 5.22: Commercial PCI Loans by Delinquency Status
(in millions)
Commercial
and
industrial

 
Real
estate
mortgage

 
Real
estate
construction

 
Total

June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
By delinquency status:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current-29 DPD and still accruing
$
129

 
108

 
13

 
250

30-89 DPD and still accruing
2

 

 

 
2

90+ DPD and still accruing

 
11

 

 
11

Total commercial PCI loans
$
131

 
119

 
13

 
263

December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
By delinquency status:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current-29 DPD and still accruing
$
235

 
353

 
48

 
636

30-89 DPD and still accruing
2

 
10

 

 
12

90+ DPD and still accruing

 
20

 
9

 
29

Total commercial PCI loans
$
237

 
383

 
57

 
677

CONSUMER PCI CREDIT QUALITY INDICATORS   Our consumer PCI loans were aggregated into several pools of loans at acquisition. Below, we have provided credit quality indicators based on the unpaid principal balance (adjusted for write-downs) of the individual loans included in the pool, but we have not
 
allocated the remaining purchase accounting adjustments, which were established at a pool level. Table 5.23 provides the delinquency status of consumer PCI loans.
 
Table 5.23: Consumer PCI Loans by Delinquency Status
  
June 30, 2017
 
 
December 31, 2016
 
(in millions)
Real estate
1-4 family
first
mortgage

 
Real estate
1-4 family
junior lien
mortgage

 
Total

 
Real estate
1-4 family
first
mortgage

 
Real estate
1-4 family
junior lien
mortgage

 
Total

By delinquency status:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 Current-29 DPD and still accruing
$
14,524

 
158

 
14,682

 
16,095

 
171

 
16,266

30-59 DPD and still accruing
1,229

 
5

 
1,234

 
1,488

 
7

 
1,495

60-89 DPD and still accruing
574

 
3

 
577

 
668

 
2

 
670

90-119 DPD and still accruing
224

 
1

 
225

 
233

 
2

 
235

120-179 DPD and still accruing
155

 
2

 
157

 
238

 
2

 
240

180+ DPD and still accruing
1,606

 
6

 
1,612

 
2,081

 
8

 
2,089

Total consumer PCI loans (adjusted unpaid principal balance)
$
18,312

 
175

 
18,487

 
20,803

 
192

 
20,995

Total consumer PCI loans (carrying value)
$
13,979

 
31

 
14,010

 
16,018

 
36

 
16,054


104

Note 5: Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses ( continued )

Table 5.24 provides FICO scores for consumer PCI loans.
 

Table 5.24: Consumer PCI Loans by FICO
 
June 30, 2017 (1)
 
 
December 31, 2016
 
(in millions)
Real estate
1-4 family
first
mortgage

 
Real estate
1-4 family
junior lien
mortgage

 
Total

 
Real estate
1-4 family
first
mortgage

 
Real estate
1-4 family
junior lien
mortgage

 
Total

By FICO:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
< 600
$
4,450

 
42

 
4,492

 
4,292

 
46

 
4,338

600-639
2,342

 
22

 
2,364

 
3,001

 
26

 
3,027

640-679
2,599

 
30

 
2,629

 
3,972

 
35

 
4,007

680-719
2,438

 
32

 
2,470

 
3,170

 
37

 
3,207

720-759
1,845

 
25

 
1,870

 
1,767

 
24

 
1,791

760-799
930

 
12

 
942

 
962

 
15

 
977

800+
446

 
6

 
452

 
254

 
4

 
258

No FICO available
3,262

 
6

 
3,268

 
3,385

 
5

 
3,390

Total consumer PCI loans (adjusted unpaid principal balance)
$
18,312

 
175

 
18,487

 
20,803

 
192

 
20,995

Total consumer PCI loans (carrying value)
$
13,979

 
31

 
14,010

 
16,018

 
36

 
16,054

(1)
June 30, 2017 amounts reflect updated FICO score version implemented in first quarter 2017.

Table 5.25 shows the distribution of consumer PCI loans by LTV for real estate 1-4 family first mortgages and by CLTV for real estate 1-4 family junior lien mortgages.  
Table 5.25: Consumer PCI Loans by LTV/CLTV
 
June 30, 2017
 
 
December 31, 2016
 
(in millions)
Real estate
1-4 family
first
mortgage
by LTV

 
Real estate
1-4 family
junior lien
mortgage
by CLTV

 
Total

 
Real estate
1-4 family
first
mortgage
by LTV

 
Real estate
1-4 family
junior lien
mortgage
by CLTV

 
Total

By LTV/CLTV:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
0-60%
$
7,316

 
40

 
7,356

 
7,513

 
38

 
7,551

60.01-80%
7,604

 
70

 
7,674

 
9,000

 
76

 
9,076

80.01-100%
2,750

 
45

 
2,795

 
3,458

 
54

 
3,512

100.01-120% (1)
517

 
14

 
531

 
669

 
18

 
687

> 120% (1)
124

 
5

 
129

 
161

 
5

 
166

No LTV/CLTV available
1

 
1

 
2

 
2

 
1

 
3

Total consumer PCI loans (adjusted unpaid principal balance)
$
18,312

 
175

 
18,487

 
20,803

 
192

 
20,995

Total consumer PCI loans (carrying value)
$
13,979

 
31

 
14,010

 
16,018

 
36

 
16,054

(1)
Reflects total loan balances with LTV/CLTV amounts in excess of 100%. In the event of default, the loss content would generally be limited to only the amount in excess of 100% LTV/CLTV.


105


Note 6:    Other Assets
Table 6.1 presents the components of other assets.
Table 6.1: Other Assets
(in millions)
Jun 30,
2017

 
Dec 31,
2016

Nonmarketable equity investments:
 
 
 
Cost method:
 
 
 
Federal bank stock
$
5,820

 
6,407

Private equity
1,367

 
1,465

Auction rate securities
420

 
525

Total cost method
7,607

 
8,397

Equity method:
 
 
 
LIHTC (1)
9,828

 
9,714

Private equity
3,740

 
3,635

Tax-advantaged renewable energy
1,960

 
2,054

New market tax credit and other
295

 
305

Total equity method
15,823

 
15,708

Fair value (2)
3,986

 
3,275

Total nonmarketable equity investments
27,416

 
27,380

Corporate/bank-owned life insurance
19,430

 
19,325

Accounts receivable (3)
41,853

 
31,056

Interest receivable
5,401

 
5,339

Core deposit intangibles
1,193

 
1,620

Customer relationship and other amortized intangibles
940

 
1,089

Foreclosed assets:
 
 
 
Residential real estate:
 
 
 
Government insured/guaranteed (3)
149

 
197

Non-government insured/guaranteed
285

 
378

Non-residential real estate
347

 
403

Operating lease assets
9,713

 
10,089

Due from customers on acceptances
192

 
196

Other
12,047

 
17,469

Total other assets
$
118,966

 
114,541

(1)
Represents low income housing tax credit investments.
(2)
Represents nonmarketable equity investments for which we have elected the fair value option. See Note 13 (Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities) for additional information.
(3)
Certain government-guaranteed residential real estate mortgage loans upon foreclosure are included in Accounts receivable. Both principal and interest related to these foreclosed real estate assets are collectible because the loans were predominantly insured by the FHA or guaranteed by the VA. For more information on the classification of certain government-guaranteed mortgage loans upon foreclosure, see Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) to Financial Statements in our 2016 10-K.


 
Table 6.2 presents income (expense) related to nonmarketable equity investments. 
Table 6.2: Nonmarketable Equity Investments
 
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
(in millions)
2017

 
2016

 
2017

 
2016

Net realized gains from nonmarketable equity investments
$
87

 
129

 
$
374

 
314

All other
(195
)
 
(135
)
 
(240
)
 
(321
)
Total
$
(108
)
 
(6
)
 
$
134

 
(7
)
Low Income Housing Tax Credit Investments We invest in affordable housing projects that qualify for the low income housing tax credit (LIHTC), which is designed to promote private development of low income housing. These investments generate a return mostly through realization of federal tax credits.
Total LIHTC investments were $9.8 billion and $9.7 billion at June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016 , respectively. In second quarter and first half of 2017 , we recognized pre-tax losses of $227 million and $457 million , respectively, related to our LIHTC investments, compared with $199 million and $401 million , respectively, for the same periods a year ago. We also recognized total tax benefits of $347 million and $694 million in second quarter and first half of 2017 , which included tax credits recorded in income taxes of $260 million and $521 million for the same periods, respectively. In the second quarter and first half of 2016 , total tax benefits were $304 million and $611 million , respectively, which included tax credits of $230 million and $460 million for the same periods, respectively. We are periodically required to provide additional financial support during the investment period. Our liability for these unfunded commitments was $3.3 billion at June 30, 2017 and $3.6 billion at December 31, 2016 . Predominantly all of this liability is expected to be paid over the next three years. This liability is included in long-term debt.


106

Note 7: Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities ( continued )

Note 7: Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities
Involvement with SPEs
In the normal course of business, we enter into various types of on- and off-balance sheet transactions with SPEs, which are corporations, trusts, limited liability companies or partnerships that are established for a limited purpose. Generally, SPEs are formed in connection with securitization transactions and are considered variable interest entities (VIEs). For further description of our involvement with SPEs, see Note 8 (Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities) to Financial Statements in our 2016 Form 10-K.
 
We have segregated our involvement with VIEs between those VIEs which we consolidate, those which we do not consolidate and those for which we account for the transfers of financial assets as secured borrowings. Secured borrowings are transactions involving transfers of our financial assets to third parties that are accounted for as financings with the assets pledged as collateral. Accordingly, the transferred assets remain recognized on our balance sheet. Subsequent tables within this Note further segregate these transactions by structure type.
Table 7.1 provides the classifications of assets and liabilities in our balance sheet for our transactions with VIEs.
Table 7.1: Balance Sheet Transactions with VIEs
(in millions)
VIEs that we
do not
consolidate

 
VIEs
that we
consolidate

Transfers that
we account
for as secured
borrowings
 
 
Total

June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
Cash
$

 
112

 

 
112

Federal funds sold, securities purchased under resale agreements and other short-term investments

 
424

 

 
424

Trading assets
1,431

 
50

 
201

 
1,682

Investment securities   (1)
5,145

 

 
381

 
5,526

Loans
5,456

 
12,096

 
121

 
17,673

Mortgage servicing rights
13,337

 

 

 
13,337

Derivative assets
77

 

 

 
77

Other assets
10,321

 
339

 
6

 
10,666

Total assets
35,767

 
13,021

 
709

 
49,497

Short-term borrowings

 

 
539

 
539

Derivative liabilities
92

 
28

(2)

 
120

Accrued expenses and other liabilities    
235

 
96

(2)
1

 
332

Long-term debt    
3,282

 
2,835

(2)
122

 
6,239

Total liabilities
3,609

 
2,959

 
662

 
7,230

Noncontrolling interests

 
86

 

 
86

Net assets
$
32,158

 
9,976

 
47

 
42,181

December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash
$

 
168

 

 
168

Federal funds sold, securities purchased under resale agreements and other short-term investments

 
74

 

 
74

Trading assets
2,034

 
130

 
201

 
2,365

Investment securities (1)
8,530

 

 
786

 
9,316

Loans
6,698

 
12,589

 
138

 
19,425

Mortgage servicing rights
13,386

 

 

 
13,386

Derivative assets
91

 
1

 

 
92

Other assets
10,281

 
452

 
11

 
10,744

Total assets
41,020

 
13,414

 
1,136

 
55,570

Short-term borrowings

 

 
905

 
905

Derivative liabilities
59

 
33

(2)

 
92

Accrued expenses and other liabilities
306

 
107

(2)
2

 
415

Long-term debt
3,598

 
3,694

(2)
136

 
7,428

Total liabilities
3,963

 
3,834

 
1,043

 
8,840

Noncontrolling interests

 
138

 

 
138

Net assets
$
37,057

 
9,442

 
93

 
46,592

(1)
Excludes certain debt securities related to loans serviced for the Federal National Mortgage Association (FNMA), Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation (FHLMC) and GNMA.
(2)
There were no VIE liabilities with recourse to the general credit of Wells Fargo for the periods presented.


107


Transactions with Unconsolidated VIEs
Our transactions with unconsolidated VIEs include securitizations of residential mortgage loans, CRE loans, student loans, automobile loans and leases, certain dealer floorplan loans; investment and financing activities involving collateralized debt obligations (CDOs) backed by asset-backed and CRE securities, tax credit structures, collateralized loan obligations (CLOs) backed by corporate loans, and other types of structured financing. We have various forms of involvement with VIEs, including servicing, holding senior or subordinated interests, entering into liquidity arrangements, credit default swaps and other derivative contracts. Involvements with these unconsolidated VIEs are recorded on our balance sheet in trading assets, investment securities, loans, MSRs, derivative assets and liabilities, other assets, other liabilities, and long-term debt, as appropriate.
Table 7.2 provides a summary of unconsolidated VIEs with which we have significant continuing involvement, but we are not the primary beneficiary. We do not consider our continuing involvement in an unconsolidated VIE to be significant when it relates to third-party sponsored VIEs for which we were not the transferor (unless we are servicer and have other significant forms of involvement) or if we were the sponsor only or sponsor
 
and servicer but do not have any other forms of significant involvement.
Significant continuing involvement includes transactions where we were the sponsor or transferor and have other significant forms of involvement. Sponsorship includes transactions with unconsolidated VIEs where we solely or materially participated in the initial design or structuring of the entity or marketing of the transaction to investors. When we transfer assets to a VIE and account for the transfer as a sale, we are considered the transferor. We consider investments in securities (other than those held temporarily in trading), loans, guarantees, liquidity agreements, written options and servicing of collateral to be other forms of involvement that may be significant. We have excluded certain transactions with unconsolidated VIEs from the balances presented in the following table where we have determined that our continuing involvement is not significant due to the temporary nature and size of our variable interests, because we were not the transferor or because we were not involved in the design of the unconsolidated VIEs. We also exclude from the table secured borrowing transactions with unconsolidated VIEs (for information on these transactions, see the Transactions with Consolidated VIEs and Secured Borrowings section in this Note).
Table 7.2: Unconsolidated VIEs
 
 
 
Carrying value – asset (liability)
 
(in millions)
Total
VIE
assets

 
Debt and
equity
interests (1)

 
Servicing
assets

 
Derivatives

 
Other
commitments
and
guarantees

 
Net
assets

June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential mortgage loan securitizations:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Conforming (2)
$
1,171,325

 
2,299

 
12,394

 

 
(180
)
 
14,513

Other/nonconforming
16,198

 
801

 
90

 

 
(2
)
 
889

Commercial mortgage securitizations
144,257

 
2,556

 
853

 
75

 
(33
)
 
3,451

Collateralized debt obligations:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Debt securities
1,157

 

 

 

 
(20
)
 
(20
)
Loans (3)
1,511

 
1,473

 

 

 

 
1,473

Asset-based finance structures
4,862

 
3,755

 

 

 

 
3,755

Tax credit structures
29,774

 
10,811

 

 

 
(3,282
)
 
7,529

Collateralized loan obligations
29

 
8

 

 

 

 
8

Investment funds
214

 
54

 

 

 

 
54

Other (4)
2,611

 
596

 

 
(90
)
 

 
506

Total
$
1,371,938

 
22,353

 
13,337

 
(15
)
 
(3,517
)
 
32,158

 
 
 
Maximum exposure to loss
 
 
 
 
Debt and
equity
interests (1)

 
Servicing
assets

 
Derivatives

 
Other
commitments
and
guarantees

 
Total
exposure

Residential mortgage loan securitizations:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Conforming
 
 
$
2,299

 
12,394

 

 
875

 
15,568

Other/nonconforming
 
 
801

 
90

 

 
2

 
893

Commercial mortgage securitizations
 
 
2,556

 
853

 
79

 
9,767

 
13,255

Collateralized debt obligations:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Debt securities
 
 

 

 

 
20

 
20

Loans (3)
 
 
1,473

 

 

 

 
1,473

Asset-based finance structures
 
 
3,755

 

 

 
71

 
3,826

Tax credit structures
 
 
10,811

 

 

 
1,024

 
11,835

Collateralized loan obligations
 
 
8

 

 

 

 
8

Investment funds
 
 
54

 

 

 

 
54

Other (4)
 
 
596

 

 
107

 
158

 
861

Total
 
 
$
22,353

 
13,337

 
186

 
11,917

 
47,793

(continued on following page)

108

Note 7: Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities ( continued )

(continued from previous page)
 
 
 
Carrying value – asset (liability)
 
(in millions)
Total
VIE
assets

 
Debt and
equity
interests (1)

 
Servicing
assets

 
Derivatives

 
Other
commitments
and
guarantees

 
Net
assets

December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential mortgage loan securitizations:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Conforming (2)
$
1,166,296

 
3,026

 
12,434

 

 
(232
)
 
15,228

Other/nonconforming
18,805

 
873

 
109

 

 
(2
)
 
980

Commercial mortgage securitizations
166,596

 
4,258

 
843

 
87

 
(35
)
 
5,153

Collateralized debt obligations:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Debt securities
1,472

 

 

 

 
(25
)
 
(25
)
Loans (3)
1,545

 
1,507

 

 

 

 
1,507

Asset-based finance structures
9,152

 
6,522

 

 

 

 
6,522

Tax credit structures
29,713

 
10,669

 

 

 
(3,609
)
 
7,060

Collateralized loan obligations
78

 
10

 

 

 

 
10

Investment funds
214

 
48

 

 

 

 
48

Other (4)
1,733

 
630

 

 
(56
)
 

 
574

Total
$
1,395,604

 
27,543

 
13,386

 
31

 
(3,903
)
 
37,057

 
 
 
Maximum exposure to loss
 
 
 
 
Debt and
equity
interests (1)

 
Servicing
assets

 
Derivatives

 
Other
commitments
and
guarantees

 
Total
exposure

Residential mortgage loan securitizations:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Conforming
 
 
$
3,026

 
12,434

 

 
979

 
16,439

Other/nonconforming
 
 
873

 
109

 

 
2

 
984

Commercial mortgage securitizations
 
 
4,258

 
843

 
94

 
9,566

 
14,761

Collateralized debt obligations:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Debt securities
 
 

 

 

 
25

 
25

Loans (3)
 
 
1,507

 

 

 

 
1,507

Asset-based finance structures
 
 
6,522

 

 

 
72

 
6,594

Tax credit structures
 
 
10,669

 

 

 
1,104

 
11,773

Collateralized loan obligations
 
 
10

 

 

 

 
10

Investment funds
 
 
48

 

 

 

 
48

Other (4)
 
 
630

 

 
93

 

 
723

Total
 
 
$
27,543

 
13,386

 
187

 
11,748

 
52,864

(1)
Includes total equity interests of $10.3 billion at both  June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 . Also includes debt interests in the form of both loans and securities. Excludes certain debt securities held related to loans serviced for FNMA, FHLMC and GNMA.
(2)
Excludes assets and related liabilities with a recorded carrying value on our balance sheet of $1.1 billion and $1.2 billion at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , respectively, for certain delinquent loans that are eligible for repurchase from GNMA loan securitizations. The recorded carrying value represents the amount that would be payable if the Company was to exercise the repurchase option. The carrying amounts are excluded from the table because the loans eligible for repurchase do not represent interests in the VIEs.
(3)
Represents senior loans to trusts that are collateralized by asset-backed securities. The trusts invest in senior tranches from a diversified pool of U.S. asset securitizations, of which all are current and 100% were rated as investment grade by the primary rating agencies at both June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 . These senior loans are accounted for at amortized cost and are subject to the Company’s allowance and credit charge-off policies.
(4)
Includes structured financing and credit-linked note structures. Also contains investments in auction rate securities (ARS) issued by VIEs that we do not sponsor and, accordingly, are unable to obtain the total assets of the entity.

In Table 7.2 , “Total VIE assets” represents the remaining principal balance of assets held by unconsolidated VIEs using the most current information available. For VIEs that obtain exposure to assets synthetically through derivative instruments, the remaining notional amount of the derivative is included in the asset balance. “Carrying value” is the amount in our consolidated balance sheet related to our involvement with the unconsolidated VIEs. “Maximum exposure to loss” from our involvement with off-balance sheet entities, which is a required disclosure under GAAP, is determined as the carrying value of our involvement with off-balance sheet (unconsolidated) VIEs plus the remaining undrawn liquidity and lending commitments, the notional amount of net written derivative contracts, and generally the notional amount of, or stressed loss estimate for, other commitments and guarantees. It represents estimated loss that would be incurred under severe, hypothetical circumstances, for which we believe the possibility is extremely remote, such as where the value of our interests and any associated collateral declines to zero, without any consideration of recovery or offset from any economic hedges. Accordingly, this required disclosure is not an indication of expected loss.
For complete descriptions of our types of transactions with unconsolidated VIEs with which we have a significant continuing involvement, but we are not the primary beneficiary, see Note 8
 
(Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities) to Financial Statements in our 2016 Form 10-K.

INVESTMENT FUNDS Subsequent to adopting ASU 2015-02 ( Amendments to the Consolidation Analysis ) in first quarter 2016, we do not consolidate these investment funds because we do not hold variable interests that are considered significant to the funds.
We voluntarily waived a portion of our management fees for certain money market funds that are exempt from the consolidation analysis to ensure the funds maintained a minimum level of daily net investment income. The amount of fees waived in the second quarter and first half of 2017 was $13 million and $27 million , respectively, compared with $26 million and $56 million , respectively, in the same periods of 2016 .

OTHER TRANSACTIONS WITH VIEs  Other VIEs include certain entities that issue auction rate securities (ARS) which are debt instruments with long-term maturities, that re-price more frequently, and preferred equities with no maturity. At June 30, 2017 , we held $420 million of ARS issued by VIEs compared with $453 million at December 31, 2016 . We acquired the ARS pursuant to agreements entered into in 2008 and 2009.

109


We do not consolidate the VIEs that issued the ARS because we do not have power over the activities of the VIEs.

TRUST PREFERRED SECURITIES   VIEs that we wholly own issue debt securities or preferred equity to third party investors. All of the proceeds of the issuance are invested in debt securities or preferred equity that we issue to the VIEs. The VIEs’ operations and cash flows relate only to the issuance, administration and repayment of the securities held by third parties. We do not consolidate these VIEs because the sole assets of the VIEs are receivables from us, even though we own all of the voting equity shares of the VIEs, have fully guaranteed the obligations of the VIEs and may have the right to redeem the third party securities under certain circumstances. In our consolidated balance sheet at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , we reported the debt securities issued to the VIEs as long-term junior subordinated debt with a carrying value of $2.0 billion and $2.1 billion , respectively, and the preferred equity securities issued to the VIEs as preferred stock with a carrying value of $2.5 billion at both dates. These amounts are in addition to the involvements in these VIEs included in the preceding table.
 
In the first half of 2017 , we redeemed $150 million of trust preferred securities which were partially included in Tier 2 capital (50% credit in 2017 ) in the transitional framework and were not included under the fully-phased framework under the Basel III standards.
 
Loan Sales and Securitization Activity
We periodically transfer consumer and CRE loans and other types of financial assets in securitization and whole loan sale transactions. We typically retain the servicing rights from these sales and may continue to hold other beneficial interests in the transferred financial assets. We may also provide liquidity to investors in the beneficial interests and credit enhancements in the form of standby letters of credit. Through these transfers we may be exposed to liability under limited amounts of recourse as well as standard representations and warranties we make to purchasers and issuers. Table 7.3 presents the cash flows for our transfers accounted for as sales.
Table 7.3: Cash Flows From Sales and Securitization Activity
 
2017
 
 
2016
 
(in millions)
Mortgage
loans

 
Other
financial
assets

 
Mortgage
loans

 
Other
financial
assets

Quarter ended June 30,
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

Proceeds from securitizations and whole loan sales
$
52,824

 
4

 
66,455

 
83

Fees from servicing rights retained
840

 

 
864

 

Cash flows from other interests held (1)
641

 

 
627

 

Repurchases of assets/loss reimbursements (2):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Non-agency securitizations and whole loan transactions
5

 

 
15

 

Agency securitizations (3)
23

 

 
35

 

Servicing advances, net of repayments
(20
)
 

 
(39
)
 

Six months ended June 30,
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proceeds from securitizations and whole loan sales
$
111,081

 
25

 
111,471

 
133

Fees from servicing rights retained
1,694

 

 
1,745

 

Cash flows from other interests held (1)
1,475

 

 
1,034

 
1

Repurchases of assets/loss reimbursements (2):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Non-agency securitizations and whole loan transactions
7

 

 
18

 

Agency securitizations (3)
46

 

 
82

 

Servicing advances, net of repayments
(162
)
 

 
(107
)
 

(1)
Cash flows from other interests held include principal and interest payments received on retained bonds and excess cash flows received on interest-only strips.
(2)
Consists of cash paid to repurchase loans from investors and cash paid to investors to reimburse them for losses on individual loans that are already liquidated.
(3)
Represent loans repurchased from GNMA, FNMA, and FHLMC under representation and warranty provisions included in our loan sales contracts. Second quarter and first half of 2017 exclude $1.6 billion and $ 3.9 billion , respectively in delinquent insured/guaranteed loans that we service and have exercised our option to purchase out of GNMA pools, compared with $2.0 billion and $4.9 billion , respectively, in the same periods of 2016 . These loans are predominantly insured by the FHA or guaranteed by the VA.

In the second quarter and first half of 2017 , we recognized net gains of $393 million and $525 million , respectively, from transfers accounted for as sales of financial assets, compared with $100 million and $295 million , respectively, in the same periods of 2016 . These net gains primarily relate to commercial mortgage securitizations and residential mortgage securitizations where the loans were not already carried at fair value.
Sales with continuing involvement during the second quarter and first half of 2017 and 2016 largely related to securitizations of residential mortgages that are sold to the government-sponsored entities (GSEs), including FNMA, FHLMC and GNMA (conforming residential mortgage securitizations). During the second quarter and first half of 2017 , we transferred $49.7 billion
 
and $105.2 billion , respectively, in fair value of residential mortgages to unconsolidated VIEs and third-party investors and recorded the transfers as sales, compared with $65.0 billion and $102.3 billion , respectively, in the same periods of 2016 . Substantially all of these transfers did not result in a gain or loss because the loans were already carried at fair value. In connection with all of these transfers, in the first half of 2017 , we recorded a $957 million servicing asset, measured at fair value using a Level 3 measurement technique, securities of $3.5 billion , classified as Level 2, and a $14 million liability for repurchase losses which reflects management’s estimate of probable losses related to various representations and warranties for the loans transferred, initially measured at fair value. In the first half of

110

Note 7: Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities ( continued )

2016 , we recorded a $764 million servicing asset, securities of $3.2 billion , and a $15 million liability.
Table 7.4 presents the key weighted-average assumptions we used to measure residential mortgage servicing rights at the date of securitization.
Table 7.4: Residential Mortgage Servicing Rights
 
Residential mortgage
servicing rights
 
 
2017

 
2016

Quarter ended June 30,
  

 
  

Prepayment speed (1)
12.8
%
 
12.1

Discount rate
6.9

 
6.7

Cost to service ($ per loan) (2)
$
152

 
141

Six months ended June 30,
 
 
 
Prepayment speed (1)
11.5
%
 
12.5

Discount rate
6.8

 
6.8

Cost to service ($ per loan) (2)
$
142

 
143

(1)
The prepayment speed assumption for residential mortgage servicing rights includes a blend of prepayment speeds and default rates. Prepayment speed assumptions are influenced by mortgage interest rate inputs as well as our estimation of drivers of borrower behavior.
(2)
Includes costs to service and unreimbursed foreclosure costs, which can vary period to period depending on the mix of modified government-guaranteed loans sold to GNMA.
 
During the second quarter and first half of 2017 , we transferred $3.3 billion and $6.6 billion , respectively, in carrying value of commercial mortgages to unconsolidated VIEs and third-party investors and recorded the transfers as sales, compared with $1.8 billion and $9.9 billion , respectively, in the same periods of 2016 . These transfers resulted in gains of $80 million and $176 million in the second quarter and first half of 2017 , respectively, because the loans were carried at lower of cost or market value (LOCOM), compared with gains of $58 million and $193 million , respectively, in the same periods of 2016 . In connection with these transfers, in the first half of 2017 , we recorded a servicing asset of $82 million , initially measured at fair value using a Level 3 measurement technique, and securities of $65 million , classified as Level 2. In the first half of 2016 , we recorded a servicing asset of $135 million and securities of $86 million .


111


Retained Interests from Unconsolidated VIEs
Table 7.5 provides key economic assumptions and the sensitivity of the current fair value of residential mortgage servicing rights and other interests held to immediate adverse changes in those assumptions. “Other interests held” relate to residential and commercial mortgage loan securitizations. Residential mortgage-backed securities retained in securitizations issued through GSEs, such as FNMA, FHLMC and GNMA, are excluded from the table because these securities have a remote risk of credit loss due to
 
the GSE guarantee. These securities also have economic characteristics similar to GSE mortgage-backed securities that we purchase, which are not included in the table. Subordinated interests include only those bonds whose credit rating was below AAA by a major rating agency at issuance. Senior interests include only those bonds whose credit rating was AAA by a major rating agency at issuance. The information presented excludes trading positions held in inventory.
Table 7.5: Retained Interests from Unconsolidated VIEs
 
 
 
Other interests held
 
 
Residential
mortgage
servicing
rights (1)

 
Interest-only
strips

 
Consumer

 
Commercial (2)
 
($ in millions, except cost to service amounts)
 
 
Subordinated
bonds

 
Subordinated
bonds

 
Senior
bonds

Fair value of interests held at June 30, 2017
$
12,789

 
24

 

 
487

 
538

Expected weighted-average life (in years)
6.2

 
3.8

 
0.0

 
5.5

 
5.3

Key economic assumptions:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Prepayment speed assumption (3)
10.5
%
 
17.3

 

 
 
 
 
Decrease in fair value from:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
10% adverse change
$
560

 
1

 

 
 
 
 
25% adverse change
1,326

 
2

 

 
 
 
 
Discount rate assumption
6.8
%
 
13.4

 

 
4.0

 
2.8

Decrease in fair value from:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
100 basis point increase
$
632

 

 

 
21

 
24

200 basis point increase
1,206

 
1

 

 
40

 
46

Cost to service assumption ($ per loan)
149

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Decrease in fair value from:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
10% adverse change
484

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
25% adverse change
1,210

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Credit loss assumption
 
 
 
 
%
 
2.4

 

Decrease in fair value from:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
10% higher losses
 
 
 
 
$

 

 

25% higher losses
 
 
 
 

 

 

Fair value of interests held at December 31, 2016
$
12,959

 
28

 
1

 
249

 
552

Expected weighted-average life (in years)
6.3

 
3.9

 
8.3

 
3.1

 
5.1

Key economic assumptions:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Prepayment speed assumption (3)
10.3
%
 
17.4

 
13.5

 
 
 
 
Decrease in fair value from:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
10% adverse change
$
583

 
1

 

 
 
 
 
25% adverse change
1,385

 
2

 

 
 
 
 
Discount rate assumption
6.8
%
 
13.3

 
10.7

 
5.2

 
2.7

Decrease in fair value from:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
100 basis point increase
$
649

 
1

 

 
7

 
23

200 basis point increase
1,239

 
1

 

 
12

 
45

Cost to service assumption ($ per loan)
155

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Decrease in fair value from:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
10% adverse change
515

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
25% adverse change
1,282

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Credit loss assumption
 
 
 
 
3.0
%
 
4.7

 

Decrease in fair value from:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
10% higher losses
 
 
 
 
$

 

 

25% higher losses
 
 
 
 

 

 

(1)
See narrative following this table for a discussion of commercial mortgage servicing rights.
(2)
Prepayment speed assumptions do not significantly impact the value of commercial mortgage securitization bonds as the underlying commercial mortgage loans experience significantly lower prepayments due to certain contractual restrictions, impacting the borrower’s ability to prepay the mortgage.
(3)
The prepayment speed assumption for residential mortgage servicing rights includes a blend of prepayment speeds and default rates. Prepayment speed assumptions are influenced by mortgage interest rate inputs as well as our estimation of drivers of borrower behavior.

112

Note 7: Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities ( continued )

In addition to residential mortgage servicing rights (MSRs) included in the previous table, we have a small portfolio of commercial MSRs with a fair value of $2.0 billion at both June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 . The nature of our commercial MSRs, which are carried at LOCOM, is different from our residential MSRs. Prepayment activity on serviced loans does not significantly impact the value of commercial MSRs because, unlike residential mortgages, commercial mortgages experience significantly lower prepayments due to certain contractual restrictions, impacting the borrower’s ability to prepay the mortgage. Additionally, for our commercial MSR portfolio, we are typically master/primary servicer, but not the special servicer, who is separately responsible for the servicing and workout of delinquent and foreclosed loans. It is the special servicer, similar to our role as servicer of residential mortgage loans, who is affected by higher servicing and foreclosure costs due to an increase in delinquent and foreclosed loans. Accordingly, prepayment speeds and costs to service are not key assumptions for commercial MSRs as they do not significantly impact the valuation. The primary economic driver impacting the fair value of our commercial MSRs is forward interest rates, which are derived from market observable yield curves used to price capital markets instruments. Market interest rates significantly affect interest earned on custodial deposit balances. The sensitivity of the current fair value to an immediate adverse 25% change in the assumption about interest earned on deposit balances at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , results in a decrease in fair value of $225 million and $259 million , respectively. See Note 8 (Mortgage Banking Activities) for further information on our commercial MSRs.
We also have a loan to an unconsolidated third party VIE that we extended in fourth quarter 2014 in conjunction with our sale of government guaranteed student loans. The loan is carried at amortized cost and approximates fair value at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 . The carrying amount of the loan at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , was $2.1 billion and $3.2 billion , respectively. The estimated fair value of the loan is considered a Level 3 measurement that is determined using
 
discounted cash flows that are based on changes in the discount rate due to changes in the risk premium component (credit spreads). The primary economic assumption impacting the fair value of our loan is the discount rate. Changes in the credit loss assumption are not expected to affect the estimated fair value of the loan due to the government guarantee of the underlying collateral. The sensitivity of the current fair value to an immediate adverse increase of 200 basis points in the risk premium component of the discount rate assumption is a decrease in fair value of $45 million and $154 million at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , respectively.
The sensitivities in the preceding paragraphs and table are hypothetical and caution should be exercised when relying on this data. Changes in value based on variations in assumptions generally cannot be extrapolated because the relationship of the change in the assumption to the change in value may not be linear. Also, the effect of a variation in a particular assumption on the value of the other interests held is calculated independently without changing any other assumptions. In reality, changes in one factor may result in changes in others (for example, changes in prepayment speed estimates could result in changes in the credit losses), which might magnify or counteract the sensitivities.

Off-Balance Sheet Loans
Table 7.6 presents information about the principal balances of off-balance sheet loans that were sold or securitized, including residential mortgage loans sold to FNMA, FHLMC, GNMA and other investors, for which we have some form of continuing involvement (including servicer). Delinquent loans include loans 90 days or more past due and loans in bankruptcy, regardless of delinquency status. For loans sold or securitized where servicing is our only form of continuing involvement, we would only experience a loss if we were required to repurchase a delinquent loan or foreclosed asset due to a breach in representations and warranties associated with our loan sale or servicing contracts.
Table 7.6: Off-Balance Sheet Loans Sold or Securitized
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net charge-offs
 
 
Total loans
 
 
Delinquent loans and foreclosed assets (1)
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
(in millions)
Jun 30, 2017

 
Dec 31, 2016

 
Jun 30, 2017

 
Dec 31, 2016

 
2017

 
2016

Commercial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate mortgage
$
98,330

 
106,745

 
3,507

 
3,325

 
382

 
156

Total commercial
98,330

 
106,745

 
3,507

 
3,325

 
382

 
156

Consumer:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate 1-4 family first mortgage
1,149,427

 
1,160,191

 
14,287

 
16,453

 
395

 
534

Total consumer
1,149,427

 
1,160,191

 
14,287

 
16,453

 
395

 
534

Total off-balance sheet sold or securitized loans (2)
$
1,247,757

 
1,266,936

 
17,794

 
19,778

 
777

 
690

(1)
Includes $1.6 billion and $1.7 billion of commercial foreclosed assets and $1.4 billion and $1.8 billion of consumer foreclosed assets at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , respectively.
(2)
At June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , the table includes total loans of $1.2 trillion at both dates, delinquent loans of $9.1 billion and $9.8 billion , and foreclosed assets of $978 million and $1.3 billion , respectively, for FNMA, FHLMC and GNMA. Net charge-offs exclude loans sold to FNMA, FHLMC and GNMA as we do not service or manage the underlying real estate upon foreclosure and, as such, do not have access to net charge-off information.

113


Transactions with Consolidated VIEs and Secured Borrowings
Table 7.7 presents a summary of financial assets and liabilities for asset transfers accounted for as secured borrowings and involvements with consolidated VIEs. “Assets” are presented using GAAP measurement methods, which may include fair value, credit impairment or other adjustments, and therefore in
 
some instances will differ from “Total VIE assets.” For VIEs that obtain exposure synthetically through derivative instruments, the remaining notional amount of the derivative is included in “Total VIE assets.” On the consolidated balance sheet, we separately disclose the consolidated assets of certain VIEs that can only be used to settle the liabilities of those VIEs.
Table 7.7: Transactions with Consolidated VIEs and Secured Borrowings
 
 
 
Carrying value
 
(in millions)
Total VIE
assets

 
Assets

 
Liabilities

 
Noncontrolling
interests

 
Net assets

June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Secured borrowings:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Municipal tender option bond securitizations
$
677

 
588

 
(540
)
 

 
48

Residential mortgage securitizations
124

 
121

 
(122
)
 

 
(1
)
Total secured borrowings
801

 
709

 
(662
)
 

 
47

Consolidated VIEs:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial loans and leases
8,698

 
8,279

 
(2,055
)
 
(13
)
 
6,211

Nonconforming residential mortgage loan securitizations
3,006

 
2,637

 
(895
)
 

 
1,742

Commercial real estate loans
1,922

 
1,922

 

 

 
1,922

Structured asset finance
16

 
10

 
(7
)
 

 
3

Investment funds
52

 
52

 
(1
)
 
(32
)
 
19

Other
140

 
121

 
(1
)
 
(41
)
 
79

Total consolidated VIEs
13,834

 
13,021

 
(2,959
)
 
(86
)
 
9,976

Total secured borrowings and consolidated VIEs
$
14,635

 
13,730

 
(3,621
)
 
(86
)
 
10,023

December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Secured borrowings:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Municipal tender option bond securitizations
$
1,473

 
998

 
(907
)
 

 
91

Residential mortgage securitizations
139

 
138

 
(136
)
 

 
2

Total secured borrowings
1,612

 
1,136

 
(1,043
)
 

 
93

Consolidated VIEs:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial loans and leases
8,821

 
8,623

 
(2,819
)
 
(14
)
 
5,790

Nonconforming residential mortgage loan securitizations
3,349

 
2,974

 
(1,003
)
 

 
1,971

Commercial real estate loans
1,516

 
1,516

 

 

 
1,516

Structured asset finance
23

 
13

 
(9
)
 

 
4

Investment funds
142

 
142

 
(2
)
 
(67
)
 
73

Other
166

 
146

 
(1
)
 
(57
)
 
88

Total consolidated VIEs
14,017

 
13,414

 
(3,834
)
 
(138
)
 
9,442

Total secured borrowings and consolidated VIEs
$
15,629

 
14,550

 
(4,877
)
 
(138
)
 
9,535

INVESTMENT FUNDS Subsequent to adopting ASU 2015-02 ( Amendments to the Consolidation Analysis ) in first quarter 2016, we consolidate certain investment funds because we have both the power to manage fund assets and hold variable interests that are considered significant.

OTHER CONSOLIDATED VIE STRUCTURES In addition to the structure types included in the previous table, at December 31, 2016 , we had approximately $6.0 billion of private placement debt financing issued through a consolidated VIE. The issuance was classified as long-term debt in our consolidated financial statements. At December 31, 2016 , we pledged approximately $434 million in loans (principal and interest eligible to be capitalized) and $6.1 billion in available-for-sale securities to collateralize the VIE’s borrowings. These assets were not transferred to the VIE, and accordingly we excluded the VIE from the previous table. During second quarter 2017 , the private placement debt financing was repaid, and the entity was no
 
longer considered a VIE. The repayment was financed by a new $1.0 billion loan that is classified as long-term debt in our consolidated financial statements at June 30, 2017 , with the remainder paid in cash.
For complete descriptions of our accounting for transfers accounted for as secured borrowings and involvements with consolidated VIEs, see Note 8 (Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities) to Financial Statements in our 2016 Form 10-K.

114

Note 8: Mortgage Banking Activities ( continued )

Note 8:  Mortgage Banking Activities

Mortgage banking activities, included in the Community Banking and Wholesale Banking operating segments, consist of residential and commercial mortgage originations, sale activity and servicing.
 
We apply the amortization method to commercial MSRs and apply the fair value method to residential MSRs. Table 8.1 presents the changes in MSRs measured using the fair value method.
Table 8.1: Analysis of Changes in Fair Value MSRs
 
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
(in millions)
2017

 
2016

 
2017

 
2016

Fair value, beginning of period
$
13,208

 
11,333

 
$
12,959

 
12,415

Servicing from securitizations or asset transfers (1)
436

 
477

 
1,019

 
843

Sales and other (2)
(8
)
 
(22
)
 
(55
)
 
(22
)
Net additions
428

 
455

 
964

 
821

Changes in fair value:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Due to changes in valuation model inputs or assumptions:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Mortgage interest rates (3)
(305
)
 
(779
)
 
(153
)
 
(1,863
)
Servicing and foreclosure costs (4)
(14
)
 
(4
)
 
13

 
23

Prepayment estimates and other (5)
(41
)
 
(41
)
 
(46
)
 
59

Net changes in valuation model inputs or assumptions
(360
)
 
(824
)
 
(186
)
 
(1,781
)
Changes due to collection/realization of expected cash flows over time
(487
)
 
(568
)
 
(948
)
 
(1,059
)
Total changes in fair value
(847
)
 
(1,392
)
 
(1,134
)
 
(2,840
)
Fair value, end of period
$
12,789

 
10,396

 
$
12,789

 
10,396

(1)
Includes impacts associated with exercising our right to repurchase delinquent loans from GNMA loan securitization pools.
(2)
Includes sales and transfers of MSRs, which can result in an increase of total reported MSRs if the sales or transfers are related to nonperforming loan portfolios.
(3)
Includes prepayment speed changes as well as other valuation changes due to changes in mortgage interest rates (such as changes in estimated interest earned on custodial deposit balances).
(4)
Includes costs to service and unreimbursed foreclosure costs.
(5)
Represents changes driven by other valuation model inputs or assumptions including prepayment speed estimation changes and other assumption updates. Prepayment speed estimation changes are influenced by observed changes in borrower behavior and other external factors that occur independent of interest rate changes.
 
Table 8.2 presents the changes in amortized MSRs.
 
 
Table 8.2: Analysis of Changes in Amortized MSRs
 
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
(in millions)
2017

 
2016

 
2017

 
2016

Balance, beginning of period
$
1,402

 
1,359

 
$
1,406

 
1,308

Purchases
26

 
24

 
44

 
45

Servicing from securitizations or asset transfers
37

 
38

 
82

 
135

Amortization
(66
)
 
(68
)
 
(133
)
 
(135
)
Balance, end of period (1)
$
1,399

 
1,353

 
$
1,399

 
1,353

Fair value of amortized MSRs:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Beginning of period
$
2,051

 
1,725

 
$
1,956

 
1,680

End of period
1,989

 
1,620

 
1,989

 
1,620

(1)
Commercial amortized MSRs are evaluated for impairment purposes by the following risk strata: agency (GSEs) for multi-family properties and non-agency. There was no valuation allowance recorded for the periods presented on the commercial amortized MSRs.



115


We present the components of our managed servicing portfolio in Table 8.3 at unpaid principal balance for loans serviced and subserviced for others and at book value for owned loans serviced.
 
 
Table 8.3: Managed Servicing Portfolio
(in billions)
Jun 30, 2017

 
Dec 31, 2016

Residential mortgage servicing:
 
 
 
Serviced for others
$
1,189

 
1,205

Owned loans serviced
343

 
347

Subserviced for others
4

 
8

Total residential servicing
1,536

 
1,560

Commercial mortgage servicing:
 
 
 
Serviced for others
475

 
479

Owned loans serviced
130

 
132

Subserviced for others
8

 
8

Total commercial servicing
613

 
619

Total managed servicing portfolio
$
2,149

 
2,179

Total serviced for others
$
1,664

 
1,684

Ratio of MSRs to related loans serviced for others
0.85
%
 
0.85

 
Table 8.4 presents the components of mortgage banking noninterest income.  
Table 8.4: Mortgage Banking Noninterest Income

 
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
(in millions)
 
2017

 
2016

 
2017

 
2016

Servicing income, net:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Servicing fees:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Contractually specified servicing fees
 
$
900

 
949

 
$
1,807

 
1,903

Late charges
 
44

 
42

 
92

 
90

Ancillary fees
 
59

 
54

 
109

 
115

Unreimbursed direct servicing costs (1)
 
(121
)
 
(203
)
 
(244
)
 
(356
)
Net servicing fees
 
882

 
842

 
1,764

 
1,752

Changes in fair value of MSRs carried at fair value:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Due to changes in valuation model inputs or assumptions (2)
(A)
(360
)
 
(824
)
 
(186
)
 
(1,781
)
Changes due to collection/realization of expected cash flows over time
 
(487
)
 
(568
)
 
(948
)
 
(1,059
)
Total changes in fair value of MSRs carried at fair value
 
(847
)
 
(1,392
)
 
(1,134
)
 
(2,840
)
Amortization
 
(66
)
 
(68
)
 
(133
)
 
(135
)
Net derivative gains from economic hedges (3)
(B)
431

 
978

 
359

 
2,433

Total servicing income, net
 
400

 
360

 
856

 
1,210

Net gains on mortgage loan origination/sales activities
 
748

 
1,054

 
1,520

 
1,802

Total mortgage banking noninterest income
 
$
1,148

 
1,414

 
$
2,376

 
3,012

Market-related valuation changes to MSRs, net of hedge results (2)(3)
(A)+(B)
$
71

 
154

 
$
173

 
652

(1)
Includes costs associated with foreclosures, unreimbursed interest advances to investors, and other interest costs.
(2)
Refer to the analysis of changes in fair value MSRs presented in Table 8.1 in this Note for more detail.
(3)
Represents results from economic hedges used to hedge the risk of changes in fair value of MSRs. See Note 12 (Derivatives Not Designated as Hedging Instruments) for additional discussion and detail.


116

Note 8: Mortgage Banking Activities ( continued )

Table 8.5 summarizes the changes in our liability for mortgage loan repurchase losses. This liability is in “Accrued expenses and other liabilities” in our consolidated balance sheet and adjustments to the repurchase liability are recorded in net gains on mortgage loan origination/sales activities in “Mortgage banking” in our consolidated income statement.
Because of the uncertainty in the various estimates underlying the mortgage repurchase liability, there is a range of losses in excess of the recorded mortgage repurchase liability that is reasonably possible. The estimate of the range of possible loss for representations and warranties does not represent a probable
 
loss, and is based on currently available information, significant judgment, and a number of assumptions that are subject to change. The high end of this range of reasonably possible losses exceeded our recorded liability by $167 million at June 30, 2017 , and was determined based upon modifying the assumptions (particularly to assume significant changes in investor repurchase demand practices) used in our best estimate of probable loss to reflect what we believe to be the high end of reasonably possible adverse assumptions.
Table 8.5: Analysis of Changes in Liability for Mortgage Loan Repurchase Losses
 
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
(in millions)
2017

 
2016

 
2017

 
2016

Balance, beginning of period
$
222

 
355

 
$
229

 
378

Provision for repurchase losses:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loan sales
6

 
8

 
14

 
15

Change in estimate (1)
(45
)
 
(89
)
 
(53
)
 
(108
)
Net reductions
(39
)
 
(81
)
 
(39
)
 
(93
)
Losses
(5
)
 
(19
)
 
(12
)
 
(30
)
Balance, end of period
$
178

 
255

 
$
178

 
255

(1)
Results from changes in investor demand and mortgage insurer practices, credit deterioration and changes in the financial stability of correspondent lenders.


117


Note 9:  Intangible Assets
Table 9.1 presents the gross carrying value of intangible assets and accumulated amortization.
Table 9.1: Intangible Assets
 
June 30, 2017
 
 
December 31, 2016
 
(in millions)
Gross
carrying
value

 
Accumulated
amortization

 
Net
carrying
value

 
Gross
carrying
value

 
Accumulated
amortization

 
Net
carrying
value

Amortized intangible assets (1):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
MSRs (2)
$
3,721

 
(2,322
)
 
1,399

 
3,595

 
(2,189
)
 
1,406

Core deposit intangibles
12,834

 
(11,641
)
 
1,193

 
12,834

 
(11,214
)
 
1,620

Customer relationship and other intangibles
3,934

 
(2,994
)
 
940

 
3,928

 
(2,839
)
 
1,089

Total amortized intangible assets
$
20,489

 
(16,957
)
 
3,532

 
20,357

 
(16,242
)
 
4,115

Unamortized intangible assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
MSRs (carried at fair value) (2)
$
12,789

 
 
 
 
 
12,959

 
 
 
 
Goodwill
26,573

 
 
 
 
 
26,693

 
 
 
 
Trademark
14

 
 
 
 
 
14

 
 
 
 
(1)
Excludes fully amortized intangible assets.
(2)
See Note 8 (Mortgage Banking Activities) for additional information on MSRs.


Table 9.2 provides the current year and estimated future amortization expense for amortized intangible assets. We based our projections of amortization expense shown below on existing
 
asset balances at June 30, 2017 . Future amortization expense may vary from these projections.
Table 9.2: Amortization Expense for Intangible Assets
(in millions)
 
Amortized MSRs

 
Core deposit
intangibles

 
Customer
relationship
and other
intangibles (1)

 
Total

Six months ended June 30, 2017 (actual)
 
$
133

 
427

 
156

 
716

Estimate for the remainder of 2017
 
$
127

 
424

 
149

 
700

Estimate for year ended December 31,
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2018
 
227

 
769

 
293

 
1,289

2019
 
201

 


 
108

 
309

2020
 
184

 


 
89

 
273

2021
 
159

 


 
76

 
235

2022
 
140

 


 
63

 
203

(1)
The six months ended June 30, 2017 balance includes $7 million for lease intangible amortization.


118


Table 9.3 shows the allocation of goodwill to our reportable operating segments.
Table 9.3: Goodwill
(in millions)
Community
Banking

 
Wholesale
Banking

 
Wealth and Investment Management

 
Consolidated
Company

December 31, 2015
$
16,849

 
7,475

 
1,205


25,529

Reduction in goodwill related to divested businesses and other

 
(84
)
 

 
(84
)
Goodwill from business combinations

 
1,518

 

 
1,518

June 30, 2016
$
16,849

 
8,909

 
1,205

 
26,963

December 31, 2016
$
16,849

 
8,585

 
1,259

 
26,693

Reclassification of goodwill held for sale to Other Assets (1)

 
(96
)
 

 
(96
)
Reduction in goodwill related to divested businesses and other

 
(24
)
 

 
(24
)
June 30, 2017 (1)
$
16,849

 
8,465

 
1,259

 
26,573

(1)
Goodwill classified as held-for-sale in other assets of $96 million as of June 30, 2017 relates to the sales agreement for Wells Fargo Insurance Services USA (and related businesses). No goodwill was classified as held-for-sale in other assets at December 31, 2016 and 2015 .

We assess goodwill for impairment at a reporting unit level, which is one level below the operating segments. See Note 18 (Operating Segments) for further information on management reporting.


119


Note 10:  Guarantees, Pledged Assets and Collateral
Guarantees are contracts that contingently require us to make payments to a guaranteed party based on an event or a change in an underlying asset, liability, rate or index. Guarantees are generally in the form of standby letters of credit, securities lending and other indemnifications, written put options, recourse obligations, and other types of arrangements. For complete
 
descriptions of our guarantees, see Note 14 (Guarantees, Pledged Assets and Collateral) to Financial Statements in our 2016 Form 10-K. Table 10.1 shows carrying value, maximum exposure to loss on our guarantees and the related non-investment grade amounts.
 
Table 10.1: Guarantees – Carrying Value and Maximum Exposure to Loss
 
 
 
Maximum exposure to loss
 
(in millions)
Carrying
value of obligation (asset)

 
Expires in
one year
or less

 
Expires after
one year
through
three years

 
Expires after
three years
through
five years

 
Expires
after five
years

 
Total

 
Non-
investment
grade

June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Standby letters of credit (1)
$
38

 
14,725

 
8,420

 
3,451

 
685

 
27,281

 
8,915

Securities lending and other indemnifications (2)

 
1

 

 
1

 
600

 
602

 
2

Written put options (3)
(334
)
 
14,781

 
10,702

 
4,263

 
1,244

 
30,990

 
17,899

Loans and MHFS sold with recourse (4)
51

 
191

 
547

 
928

 
8,865

 
10,531

 
7,751

Factoring guarantees (5)

 
621

 

 

 

 
621

 
557

Other guarantees
1

 

 
6

 
2

 
4,228

 
4,236

 
4

Total guarantees
$
(244
)
 
30,319

 
19,675

 
8,645

 
15,622

 
74,261

 
35,128

December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Standby letters of credit (1)
$
38

 
16,050

 
8,727

 
3,194

 
658

 
28,629

 
9,898

Securities lending and other indemnifications (2)

 

 

 
1

 
1,166

 
1,167

 
2

Written put options (3)
37

 
10,427

 
10,805

 
4,573

 
1,216

 
27,021

 
15,915

Loans and MHFS sold with recourse (4)
55

 
84

 
637

 
947

 
8,592

 
10,260

 
7,228

Factoring guarantees (5)

 
1,109

 

 

 

 
1,109

 
1,109

Other guarantees
6

 
19

 
21

 
17

 
3,580

 
3,637

 
15

Total guarantees
$
136

 
27,689

 
20,190

 
8,732

 
15,212

 
71,823

 
34,167

(1)
Total maximum exposure to loss includes direct pay letters of credit (DPLCs) of $9.1 billion and $9.2 billion at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , respectively. We issue DPLCs to provide credit enhancements for certain bond issuances. Beneficiaries (bond trustees) may draw upon these instruments to make scheduled principal and interest payments, redeem all outstanding bonds because a default event has occurred, or for other reasons as permitted by the agreement. We also originate multipurpose lending commitments under which borrowers have the option to draw on the facility in one of several forms, including as a standby letter of credit. Total maximum exposure to loss includes the portion of these facilities for which we have issued standby letters of credit under the commitments.
(2)
Includes indemnifications provided to certain third-party clearing agents. Outstanding customer obligations under these arrangements were $67 million and $175 million with related collateral of $533 million and $991 million at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , respectively. Estimated maximum exposure to loss was $600 million at June 30, 2017 and $1.2 billion at December 31, 2016 .
(3)
Written put options, which are in the form of derivatives, are also included in the derivative disclosures in Note 12 (Derivatives).
(4)
Represent recourse provided, predominantly to the GSEs, on loans sold under various programs and arrangements. Under these arrangements, we repurchased $1 million and $2 million respectively, of loans associated with these agreements in the second quarter and first half of 2017 , and $1 million and $2 million in the same periods of 2016 , respectively.
(5)
Consists of guarantees made under certain factoring arrangements to purchase trade receivables from third parties, generally upon their request, if receivable debtors default on their payment obligations.

“Maximum exposure to loss” and “Non-investment grade” are required disclosures under GAAP. Non-investment grade represents those guarantees on which we have a higher risk of being required to perform under the terms of the guarantee. If the underlying assets under the guarantee are non-investment grade (that is, an external rating that is below investment grade or an internal credit default grade that is equivalent to a below investment grade external rating), we consider the risk of performance to be high. Internal credit default grades are determined based upon the same credit policies that we use to evaluate the risk of payment or performance when making loans and other extensions of credit. Credit quality indicators we usually consider in evaluating risk of payments or performance are described in Note 5 (Loans and Allowance for Credit Losses).
 
Maximum exposure to loss represents the estimated loss that would be incurred under an assumed hypothetical circumstance, despite what we believe is a remote possibility, where the value of our interests and any associated collateral declines to zero. Maximum exposure to loss estimates in Table 10.1 do not reflect economic hedges or collateral we could use to offset or recover losses we may incur under our guarantee agreements. Accordingly, this required disclosure is not an indication of expected loss. We believe the carrying value, which is either fair value for derivative-related products or the allowance for lending-related commitments, is more representative of our exposure to loss than maximum exposure to loss.


120

Note 10: Guarantees, Pledged Assets and Collateral ( continued )

Pledged Assets
As part of our liquidity management strategy, we pledge various assets to secure trust and public deposits, borrowings and letters of credit from the FHLB and FRB, securities sold under agreements to repurchase (repurchase agreements), securities lending arrangements, and for other purposes as required or permitted by law or insurance statutory requirements. The types of collateral we pledge include securities issued by federal agencies, GSEs, domestic and foreign companies and various commercial and consumer loans. Table 10.2 provides the total carrying amount of pledged assets by asset type and pledged off-
 
balance sheet securities for securities financings. The table excludes pledged consolidated VIE assets of $13.0 billion and $13.4 billion at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , respectively, which can only be used to settle the liabilities of those entities. The table also excludes $709 million and $1.1 billion in assets pledged in transactions with VIE's accounted for as secured borrowings at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , respectively. See Note 7 (Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities) for additional information on consolidated VIE assets and secured borrowings.  
Table 10.2: Pledged Assets
(in millions)
Jun 30,
2017

 
Dec 31,
2016

Trading assets and other (1)
$
107,374

 
84,603

Investment securities (2)
75,174

 
90,946

Mortgages held for sale and loans (3)
496,164

 
516,112

Total pledged assets
$
678,712

 
691,661

(1)
Consists of trading assets of $36.4 billion and $33.2 billion at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , respectively and off-balance sheet securities of $71.0 billion and $51.4 billion as of the same dates, respectively, that are pledged as collateral for repurchase agreements and other securities financings. Total trading assets and other includes $107.3 billion and $84.2 billion at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , respectively that permit the secured parties to sell or repledge the collateral.
(2)
Includes carrying value of $4.6 billion and $6.2 billion (fair value of $4.6 billion and $ 6.2 billion ) in collateral for repurchase agreements at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , respectively, which are pledged under agreements that do not permit the secured parties to sell or repledge the collateral. Also includes $87 million and $617 million in collateral pledged under repurchase agreements at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , respectively, that permit the secured parties to sell or repledge the collateral. All other pledged securities are pursuant to agreements that do not permit the secured party to sell or repledge the collateral.
(3)
Includes mortgages held for sale of $4.5 billion and $15.8 billion at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , respectively. Substantially all of the total mortgages held for sale and loans are pledged under agreements that do not permit the secured parties to sell or repledge the collateral. Amounts exclude $1.1 billion and $1.2 billion at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , respectively, of pledged loans recorded on our balance sheet representing certain delinquent loans that are eligible for repurchase from GNMA loan securitizations.




121


Securities Financing Activities
We enter into resale and repurchase agreements and securities borrowing and lending agreements (collectively, “securities financing activities”) typically to finance trading positions (including securities and derivatives), acquire securities to cover short trading positions, accommodate customers’ financing needs, and settle other securities obligations. These activities are conducted through our broker dealer subsidiaries and to a lesser extent through other bank entities. Most of our securities financing activities involve high quality, liquid securities such as U.S. Treasury securities and government agency securities, and to a lesser extent, less liquid securities, including equity securities, corporate bonds and asset-backed securities. We account for these transactions as collateralized financings in which we typically receive or pledge securities as collateral. We believe these financing transactions generally do not have material credit risk given the collateral provided and the related monitoring processes.

OFFSETTING OF RESALE AND REPURCHASE AGREEMENTS AND SECURITIES BORROWING AND LENDING AGREEMENTS Table 10.3 presents resale and repurchase agreements subject to master repurchase agreements (MRA) and securities borrowing and lending agreements subject to master securities lending agreements (MSLA). We account for
 
transactions subject to these agreements as collateralized financings, and those with a single counterparty are presented net on our balance sheet, provided certain criteria are met that permit balance sheet netting. Most transactions subject to these agreements do not meet those criteria and thus are not eligible for balance sheet netting.
Collateral we pledged consists of non-cash instruments, such as securities or loans, and is not netted on the balance sheet against the related liability. Collateral we received includes securities or loans and is not recognized on our balance sheet. Collateral pledged or received may be increased or decreased over time to maintain certain contractual thresholds as the assets underlying each arrangement fluctuate in value. Generally, these agreements require collateral to exceed the asset or liability recognized on the balance sheet. The following table includes the amount of collateral pledged or received related to exposures subject to enforceable MRAs or MSLAs. While these agreements are typically over-collateralized, U.S. GAAP requires disclosure in this table to limit the reported amount of such collateral to the amount of the related recognized asset or liability for each counterparty.
In addition to the amounts included in Table 10.3 , we also have balance sheet netting related to derivatives that is disclosed in Note 12 (Derivatives).
Table 10.3: Offsetting – Resale and Repurchase Agreements
(in millions)
Jun 30,
2017

 
Dec 31,
2016

Assets:
 
 
 
Resale and securities borrowing agreements
 
 
 
Gross amounts recognized
$
119,721

 
91,123

Gross amounts offset in consolidated balance sheet (1)
(31,383
)
 
(11,680
)
Net amounts in consolidated balance sheet (2)
88,338

 
79,443

Collateral not recognized in consolidated balance sheet (3)
(88,141
)
 
(78,837
)
Net amount (4)
$
197

 
606

Liabilities:
 
 
 
Repurchase and securities lending agreements
 
 
 
Gross amounts recognized (5)
$
109,536

 
89,111

Gross amounts offset in consolidated balance sheet (1)
(31,383
)
 
(11,680
)
Net amounts in consolidated balance sheet (6)
78,153

 
77,431

Collateral pledged but not netted in consolidated balance sheet (7)
(77,796
)
 
(77,184
)
Net amount (8)
$
357

 
247

(1)
Represents recognized amount of resale and repurchase agreements with counterparties subject to enforceable MRAs that have been offset in the consolidated balance sheet.
(2)
At June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , includes $67.6 billion and $58.1 billion , respectively, classified on our consolidated balance sheet in federal funds sold, securities purchased under resale agreements and other short-term investments and $20.7 billion and $21.3 billion , respectively, in loans.
(3)
Represents the fair value of collateral we have received under enforceable MRAs or MSLAs, limited for table presentation purposes to the amount of the recognized asset due from each counterparty. At June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , we have received total collateral with a fair value of $130.7 billion and $102.3 billion , respectively, all of which, we have the right to sell or repledge. These amounts include securities we have sold or repledged to others with a fair value of $69.8 billion at June 30, 2017 , and $50.0 billion at December 31, 2016 .
(4)
Represents the amount of our exposure that is not collateralized and/or is not subject to an enforceable MRA or MSLA.
(5)
For additional information on underlying collateral and contractual maturities, see the “Repurchase and Securities Lending Agreements” section in this Note.
(6)
Amount is classified in short-term borrowings on our consolidated balance sheet.
(7)
Represents the fair value of collateral we have pledged, related to enforceable MRAs or MSLAs, limited for table presentation purposes to the amount of the recognized liability owed to each counterparty. At June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , we have pledged total collateral with a fair value of $111.4 billion and $91.4 billion , respectively, of which, the counterparty does not have the right to sell or repledge $4.7 billion as of June 30, 2017 and $6.6 billion as of December 31, 2016 .
(8)
Represents the amount of our obligation that is not covered by pledged collateral and/or is not subject to an enforceable MRA or MSLA.


122

Note 10: Guarantees, Pledged Assets and Collateral ( continued )

REPURCHASE AND SECURITIES LENDING AGREEMENTS Securities sold under repurchase agreements and securities lending arrangements are effectively short-term collateralized borrowings. In these transactions, we receive cash in exchange for transferring securities as collateral and recognize an obligation to reacquire the securities for cash at the transaction's maturity. These types of transactions create risks, including (1) the counterparty may fail to return the securities at maturity, (2) the fair value of the securities transferred may decline below the amount of our obligation to reacquire the securities, and therefore create an obligation for us to pledge additional amounts, and (3) the counterparty may accelerate the maturity
 
on demand, requiring us to reacquire the security prior to contractual maturity. We attempt to mitigate these risks by the fact that most of our securities financing activities involve highly liquid securities, we underwrite and monitor the financial strength of our counterparties, we monitor the fair value of collateral pledged relative to contractually required repurchase amounts, and we monitor that our collateral is properly returned through the clearing and settlement process in advance of our cash repayment. Table 10.4 provides the underlying collateral types of our gross obligations under repurchase and securities lending agreements.
Table 10.4: Underlying Collateral Types of Gross Obligations
(in millions)
 
Jun 30,
2017

 
Dec 31,
2016

Repurchase agreements:
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
 
$
52,225

 
34,335

Securities of U.S. States and political subdivisions
 
131

 
81

Federal agency mortgage-backed securities
 
32,079

 
32,669

Non-agency mortgage-backed securities
 
1,679

 
2,167

Corporate debt securities
 
8,109

 
6,829

Asset-backed securities
 
2,352

 
3,010

Equity securities
 
937

 
1,309

Other
 
1,088

 
1,704

Total repurchases
 
98,600

 
82,104

Securities lending:
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
 
108

 
152

Federal agency mortgage-backed securities
 
174

 
104

Non-agency mortgage-backed securities
 

 
1

Corporate debt securities
 
611

 
653

Equity securities (1)
 
10,043

 
6,097

Total securities lending
 
10,936

 
7,007

Total repurchases and securities lending
 
$
109,536

 
89,111

(1)
Equity securities are generally exchange traded and either re-hypothecated under margin lending agreements or obtained through contemporaneous securities borrowing transactions with other counterparties.

Table 10.5 provides the contractual maturities of our gross obligations under repurchase and securities lending agreements.
Table 10.5: Contractual Maturities of Gross Obligations
(in millions)
Overnight/continuous

 
Up to 30 days

 
30-90 days

 
>90 days

 
Total gross obligation

June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Repurchase agreements
$
80,504

 
9,792

 
3,790

 
4,514

 
98,600

Securities lending
8,802

 
518

 
1,616

 

 
10,936

Total repurchases and securities lending (1)
$
89,306

 
10,310

 
5,406

 
4,514

 
109,536

December 31, 2016
 
Repurchase agreements
$
60,516

 
9,598

 
6,762

 
5,228

 
82,104

Securities lending
5,565

 
167

 
1,275

 

 
7,007

Total repurchases and securities lending (1)
$
66,081

 
9,765

 
8,037

 
5,228

 
89,111

(1)
Securities lending is executed under agreements that allow either party to terminate the transaction without notice, while repurchase agreements have a term structure to them that technically matures at a point in time. The overnight/continuous repurchase agreements require election of both parties to roll the trade rather than the election to terminate the arrangement as in securities lending.


123


Note 11:  Legal Actions
Wells Fargo and certain of our subsidiaries are involved in a number of judicial, regulatory, arbitration and other proceedings concerning matters arising from the conduct of our business activities, and many of those proceedings expose Wells Fargo to potential financial loss. These proceedings include actions brought against Wells Fargo and/or our subsidiaries with respect to corporate related matters and transactions in which Wells Fargo and/or our subsidiaries were involved. In addition, Wells Fargo and our subsidiaries may be requested to provide information or otherwise cooperate with government authorities in the conduct of investigations of other persons or industry groups.
Although there can be no assurance as to the ultimate outcome, Wells Fargo and/or our subsidiaries have generally denied, or believe we have a meritorious defense and will deny, liability in all significant legal actions pending against us, including the matters described below, and we intend to defend vigorously each case, other than matters we describe as having settled. We establish accruals for legal actions when potential losses associated with the actions become probable and the costs can be reasonably estimated. For such accruals, we record the amount we consider to be the best estimate within a range of potential losses that are both probable and estimable; however, if we cannot determine a best estimate, then we record the low end of the range of those potential losses. The actual costs of resolving legal actions may be substantially higher or lower than the amounts accrued for those actions.
ATM ACCESS FEE LITIGATION In October 2011, plaintiffs filed a putative class action, Mackmin, et. al. v. Visa, Inc. et. al. , against Wells Fargo & Company, Wells Fargo Bank, N.A., Visa, MasterCard, and several other banks in the United States District Court for the District of Columbia. Plaintiffs allege that the Visa and MasterCard requirement that if an ATM operator charges an access fee on Visa and MasterCard transactions, then that fee cannot be greater than the access fee charged for transactions on other networks violates antitrust rules. Plaintiffs seek treble damages, restitution, injunctive relief and attorneys’ fees where available under federal and state law. Two other antitrust cases which make similar allegations were filed in the same court, but these cases did not name Wells Fargo as a defendant. On February 13, 2013, the district court granted defendants’ motions to dismiss and dismissed the three actions. Plaintiffs appealed the dismissals and, on August 4, 2015, the United States Court of Appeals for the District of Columbia Circuit vacated the district court’s decisions and remanded the three cases to the district court for further proceedings. On June 28, 2016, the United States Supreme Court granted defendants’ petitions for writ of certiorari to review the decisions of the United States Court of Appeals for the District of Columbia. On November 17, 2016, the United States Supreme Court dismissed the petitions as improvidently granted, and the three cases returned to the district court for further proceedings.
AUTO LENDING MATTERS As the Company centralizes operations in its dealer services business and tightens controls and oversight of third-party risk management, the Company anticipates it will identify and remediate issues related to historical practices concerning the origination, servicing, and/or collection of indirect consumer auto loans, including related insurance products. For example, in July 2017, the Company announced a plan to remediate customers who may have been
 
financially harmed due to issues related to automobile collateral protection insurance (CPI) policies purchased through a third-party vendor on their behalf (based on an understanding by the vendor that the borrowers’ insurance had lapsed). The Company determined that certain external vendor processes and operational controls were inadequate, and, as a result, customers may have been charged premiums for CPI even if they were paying for their own vehicle insurance, as required, and in some cases the CPI premiums may have contributed to a default that led to their vehicle’s repossession. The Company discontinued the CPI program in September 2016. Multiple putative class action cases alleging, among other things, unfair and deceptive practices relating to these CPI policies, have been filed against the Company in United States federal courts, including in the United States District Courts for the Northern District of California and Southern District of New York. In addition, the Company has identified certain issues related to the unused portion of guaranteed auto protection waiver or insurance agreements between the dealer and, by assignment, the lender, which may result in refunds to customers in certain states. These and other issues related to the origination, servicing and/or collection of indirect consumer auto loans, including related insurance products, may subject the Company to formal or informal inquiries, investigations or examinations from federal, state and/or local government agencies, and may also subject the Company to litigation.
CONSUMER DEPOSIT ACCOUNT RELATED REGULATORY INVESTIGATION The Consumer Financial Protection Bureau (CFPB) has commenced an investigation into whether customers were unduly harmed by the Company’s procedures regarding the freezing (and, in many cases, closing) of consumer deposit accounts after the Company detected suspected fraudulent activity (by third-parties or account holders) that affected those accounts.
INADVERTENT CLIENT INFORMATION DISCLOSURE In July 2017, the Company inadvertently provided certain client information in response to a third-party subpoena issued in a civil litigation. The Company obtained temporary restraining orders in New Jersey and New York state courts requiring the electronic data and all copies to be delivered to the New Jersey state court for safekeeping. The Company has made voluntary self-disclosure to various regulatory agencies.
INTERCHANGE LITIGATION   Plaintiffs representing a putative class of merchants have filed putative class actions, and individual merchants have filed individual actions, against Wells Fargo Bank, N.A., Wells Fargo & Company, Wachovia Bank, N.A. and Wachovia Corporation regarding the interchange fees associated with Visa and MasterCard payment card transactions. Visa, MasterCard and several other banks and bank holding companies are also named as defendants in these actions. These actions have been consolidated in the United States District Court for the Eastern District of New York. The amended and consolidated complaint asserts claims against defendants based on alleged violations of federal and state antitrust laws and seeks damages, as well as injunctive relief. Plaintiff merchants allege that Visa, MasterCard and payment card issuing banks unlawfully colluded to set interchange rates. Plaintiffs also allege that enforcement of certain Visa and MasterCard rules and alleged tying and bundling of services offered to merchants are anticompetitive. Wells Fargo and Wachovia, along with other

124

Note 11: Legal Actions ( continued )

defendants and entities, are parties to Loss and Judgment Sharing Agreements, which provide that they, along with other entities, will share, based on a formula, in any losses from the Interchange Litigation. On July 13, 2012, Visa, MasterCard and the financial institution defendants, including Wells Fargo, signed a memorandum of understanding with plaintiff merchants to resolve the consolidated class action and reached a separate settlement in principle of the consolidated individual actions. The settlement payments to be made by all defendants in the consolidated class and individual actions totaled approximately $6.6 billion before reductions applicable to certain merchants opting out of the settlement. The class settlement also provided for the distribution to class merchants of 10 basis points of default interchange across all credit rate categories for a period of eight consecutive months. The District Court granted final approval of the settlement, which was appealed to the Second Circuit Court of Appeals by settlement objector merchants. Other merchants opted out of the settlement and are pursuing several individual actions. On June 30, 2016, the Second Circuit Court of Appeals vacated the settlement agreement and reversed and remanded the consolidated action to the United States District Court for the Eastern District of New York for further proceedings. On November 23, 2016, prior class counsel filed a petition to the United States Supreme Court, seeking review of the reversal of the settlement by the Second Circuit, and the Supreme Court denied the petition on March 27, 2017. On November 30, 2016, the District Court appointed lead class counsel for a damages class and an equitable relief class. Several of the opt-out litigations were settled during the pendency of the Second Circuit appeal while others remain pending. Discovery is proceeding in the opt-out litigations and the remanded class cases.
MORTGAGE INTEREST RATE LOCK RELATED REGULATORY INVESTIGATION The CFPB has commenced an investigation into the Company’s policies and procedures regarding the circumstances in which the Company required customers to pay fees for the extension of interest rate lock periods for residential mortgages.
MORTGAGE RELATED REGULATORY INVESTIGATIONS  Federal and state government agencies, including the United States Department of Justice (the “Department of Justice”), continue investigations or examinations of certain mortgage related activities of Wells Fargo and predecessor institutions. Wells Fargo, for itself and for predecessor institutions, has responded, and continues to respond, to requests from these agencies seeking information regarding the origination, underwriting and securitization of residential mortgages, including sub-prime mortgages. These agencies have advanced theories of purported liability with respect to certain of these activities. The Department of Justice and Wells Fargo continue to discuss the matter, including potential settlement of the Department of Justice's concerns; however, litigation with these agencies, including with the Department of Justice, remains a possibility. Other financial institutions have entered into similar settlements with these agencies, the nature of which related to the specific activities of those financial institutions, including the imposition of significant financial penalties and remedial actions.
OFAC RELATED INVESTIGATION The Company has self-identified an issue whereby certain foreign banks utilized a Wells Fargo software-based solution to conduct import/export trade-related financing transactions with countries and entities prohibited by the Office of Foreign Assets Control (“OFAC”) of the United States Department of the Treasury.
 
We do not believe any funds related to these transactions flowed through accounts at Wells Fargo as a result of the aforementioned conduct. The Company has made a voluntary self-disclosure to OFAC and is cooperating with an inquiry from the Department of Justice.
ORDER OF POSTING LITIGATION  Plaintiffs filed a series of putative class actions against Wachovia Bank, N.A. and Wells Fargo Bank, N.A., as well as many other banks, challenging the “high to low” order in which the banks post debit card transactions to consumer deposit accounts. Most of these actions were consolidated in multi-district litigation proceedings (the “MDL proceedings”) in the United States District Court for the Southern District of Florida. The court in the MDL proceedings has certified a class of putative plaintiffs, and Wells Fargo moved to compel arbitration of the claims of unnamed class members. The court denied the motions to compel arbitration on October 17, 2016. Wells Fargo has appealed this decision to the Eleventh Circuit Court of Appeals.
RMBS TRUSTEE LITIGATION In November 2014, a group of institutional investors (the “Institutional Investor Plaintiffs”) filed a putative class action in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York against Wells Fargo Bank, N.A., alleging claims against the bank in its capacity as trustee for a number of residential mortgage-backed securities (“RMBS”) trusts (the “Federal Court Complaint”). Similar complaints have been filed against other trustees in various courts, including in the Southern District of New York, in New York state court and in other states, by RMBS investors. The Federal Court Complaint alleges that Wells Fargo Bank, N.A., as trustee, caused losses to investors and asserts causes of action based upon, among other things, the trustee's alleged failure to notify and enforce repurchase obligations of mortgage loan sellers for purported breaches of representations and warranties, notify investors of alleged events of default, and abide by appropriate standards of care following alleged events of default. Plaintiffs seek money damages in an unspecified amount, reimbursement of expenses, and equitable relief. In December 2014 and December 2015, certain other investors filed four complaints alleging similar claims against Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. in the Southern District of New York, and the various cases pending against Wells Fargo are proceeding before the same judge. On January 19, 2016, an order was entered in connection with the Federal Court Complaint in which the District Court dismissed claims related to certain of the trusts at issue (the “Dismissed Trusts”). The Company's motion to dismiss the Federal Court Complaint was granted in part and denied in part in March 2017 . In May 2017, the Company filed third-party complaints against certain investment advisors affiliated with the Institutional Investor Plaintiffs seeking contribution with respect to claims alleged in the Federal Court Complaint.
A complaint raising similar allegations to the Federal Court Complaint was filed in May 2016 in New York state court by a different plaintiff investor. In addition, the Institutional Investor Plaintiffs subsequently filed a complaint relating to the Dismissed Trusts and certain additional trusts in California state court (the “California Action”). The California Action was subsequently dismissed in September 2016. In December 2016, the Institutional Investor Plaintiffs filed a new putative class action complaint in New York state court in respect of 261 RMBS trusts, including the Dismissed Trusts, for which Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. serves or served as trustee (the “State Court Action”). The Company has moved to dismiss the complaint.

125


In July 2017, certain of the plaintiffs from the State Court Action filed a civil complaint relating to Wells Fargo Bank, N.A.'s setting aside reserves for legal fees and expenses in connection with the liquidation of eleven RMBS trusts at issue in the State Court Action. The complaint seeks, among other relief, declarations that Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. is not entitled to indemnification, the advancement of funds or the taking of reserves from trust funds for legal fees and expenses it incurs in defending the claims in the State Court Action.
SALES PRACTICES MATTERS Federal, state and local government agencies, including the Department of Justice, the United States Securities and Exchange Commission and the United States Department of Labor, and state attorneys general and prosecutors’ offices, as well as Congressional committees, have undertaken formal or informal inquiries, investigations or examinations arising out of certain sales practices of the Company that were the subject of settlements with the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau, the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency and the Office of the Los Angeles City Attorney announced by the Company on September 8, 2016. The Company has responded, and continues to respond, to requests from a number of the foregoing seeking information regarding these sales practices and the circumstances of the settlements and related matters.
In addition, a number of lawsuits have also been filed by non-governmental parties seeking damages or other remedies related to these sales practices. First, various class plaintiffs purporting to represent consumers who allege that they received products or services without their authorization or consent have brought separate putative class actions against the Company in the United States District Court for the Northern District of California and various other jurisdictions. In April 2017, the Company entered into a settlement agreement in the first-filed action, Jabbari v. Wells Fargo Bank, N.A ., to resolve claims regarding certain products or services provided without authorization or consent for the time period May 1, 2002 to April 20, 2017. Pursuant to the settlement, we will pay $142 million for remediation, attorneys’ fees, and settlement fund claims administration. In the unlikely event that the $142 million settlement total is not enough to provide remediation, pay attorneys' fees, pay settlement fund claims administration costs, and have at least $25 million left over to distribute to all class members, the Company will contribute additional funds to the settlement. The court granted preliminary approval of the settlement in July 2017. A final approval hearing has been scheduled for the first quarter of 2018. Second, Wells Fargo shareholders are pursuing a consolidated securities fraud class action in the United States District Court for the Northern District of California alleging certain misstatements and omissions in the Company’s disclosures related to sales practices matters. Third, Wells Fargo shareholders have brought numerous shareholder derivative lawsuits asserting breach of fiduciary duty claims, among others, against current and former directors and officers for their alleged failure to detect and prevent sales practices issues, which lawsuits are consolidated into two separate actions in the United States District Court for the Northern District of California and California state court, as well as two separate actions in Delaware state court. Fourth, a range of employment litigation has been brought against Wells Fargo, including an Employee Retirement Income Security Act class action in the United States District Court for the District of Minnesota brought on behalf of 401(k) plan participants; class actions pending in the United States District Courts for the Northern District of California and Eastern District of New York
 
on behalf of employees who allege that they protested sales practice misconduct and/or were terminated for not meeting sales goals; various wage and hour class actions brought in federal and state court in California, New Jersey, and Pennsylvania on behalf of non-exempt branch based employees alleging sales pressure resulted in uncompensated overtime; and multiple single plaintiff Sarbanes-Oxley Act complaints and state law whistleblower actions filed with the Department of Labor or in various state courts alleging adverse employment actions for raising sales practice misconduct issues.
VA LOAN GUARANTY PROGRAM QUI TAM Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. is named as a defendant in a qui tam lawsuit, United States ex rel. Bibby & Donnelly v. Wells Fargo, et al. , brought in the United States District Court for the Northern District of Georgia by two individuals on behalf of the United States under the federal False Claims Act. The lawsuit was originally filed on March 8, 2006, and then unsealed on October 3, 2011. The United States elected not to intervene in the action. The plaintiffs allege that Wells Fargo charged certain impermissible closing or origination fees to borrowers under a U.S. Department of Veteran Affairs’ (VA) loan guaranty program and then made false statements to the VA concerning such fees in violation of the civil False Claims Act. On their behalf and on behalf of the United States, the plaintiffs seek, among other things, damages equal to three times the amount paid by the VA in connection with any loan guaranty as to which the borrower paid certain impermissible fees or charges less the net amount received by the VA upon any re-sale of collateral, statutory civil penalties of between $5,500 and $11,000 per False Claims Act violation, and attorneys’ fees. The parties have engaged in extensive discovery, and both have moved for judgment in their favor as a matter of law. In August 2017, the parties reached a settlement in which the Company will pay $108 million . The settlement amount does not include plaintiffs’ attorneys fees, which are subject to court approval.
OUTLOOK   As described above, the Company establishes accruals for legal actions when potential losses associated with the actions become probable and the costs can be reasonably estimated. The high end of the range of reasonably possible potential losses in excess of the Company’s accrual for probable and estimable losses was approximately $3.3 billion as of June 30, 2017 . The increase in the high end of the range from March 31, 2017 was due to a variety of matters, including the Company's existing mortgage related regulatory investigations. The outcomes of legal actions are unpredictable and subject to significant uncertainties, and it is inherently difficult to determine whether any loss is probable or even possible. It is also inherently difficult to estimate the amount of any loss and there may be matters for which a loss is probable or reasonably possible but not currently estimable. Accordingly, actual losses may be in excess of the established accrual or the range of reasonably possible loss. Wells Fargo is unable to determine whether the ultimate resolution of either the mortgage related regulatory investigations or the sales practices matters will have a material adverse effect on its consolidated financial condition. Based on information currently available, advice of counsel, available insurance coverage and established reserves, Wells Fargo believes that the eventual outcome of other actions against Wells Fargo and/or its subsidiaries will not, individually or in the aggregate, have a material adverse effect on Wells Fargo’s consolidated financial condition. However, it is possible that the ultimate resolution of a matter, if unfavorable, may be material to Wells Fargo’s results of operations for any particular period.

126

Note 12: Derivatives ( continued )

Note 12:  Derivatives
We use derivatives to manage exposure to market risk, including interest rate risk, credit risk and foreign currency risk, and to assist customers with their risk management objectives. We designate certain derivatives as hedging instruments in a qualifying hedge accounting relationship (fair value or cash flow hedge). Our remaining derivatives consist of economic hedges that do not qualify for hedge accounting and derivatives held for customer accommodation trading, or other purposes. For more information on our derivative activities, see Note 16 (Derivatives) to Financial Statements in our 2016 Form 10-K.
 
Table 12.1 presents the total notional or contractual amounts and fair values for our derivatives. Derivative transactions can be measured in terms of the notional amount, but this amount is not recorded on the balance sheet and is not, when viewed in isolation, a meaningful measure of the risk profile of the instruments. The notional amount is generally not exchanged but is used only as the basis on which interest and other payments are determined.
Table 12.1: Notional or Contractual Amounts and Fair Values of Derivatives
 
June 30, 2017
 
 
December 31, 2016
 
 
Notional or
contractual
amount

 
 
 
Fair value

 
Notional or
contractual
amount

 
 
 
Fair value

(in millions)
 
Derivative
assets

 
Derivative
liabilities

 
 
Derivative
assets

 
Derivative
liabilities

Derivatives designated as hedging instruments
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts (1)
$
242,711

 
2,657

 
1,205

 
235,222

 
6,587

 
2,710

Foreign exchange contracts (1)
32,640

 
581

 
1,445

 
25,861

 
673

 
2,779

Total derivatives designated as qualifying hedging instruments
 
 
3,238

 
2,650

 
 
 
7,260

 
5,489

Derivatives not designated as hedging instruments
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Economic hedges:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts (2)
235,234

 
350

 
307

 
228,051

 
1,098

 
1,441

Equity contracts
9,641

 
672

 
54

 
7,964

 
545

 
83

Foreign exchange contracts
17,007

 
32

 
429

 
20,435

 
626

 
165

Credit contracts – protection purchased
436

 
71

 

 
482

 
102

 

Subtotal
 
 
1,125

 
790

 
 
 
2,371

 
1,689

Customer accommodation trading and
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
other derivatives:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts
6,790,132

 
16,211

 
14,741

 
6,018,370

 
57,583

 
61,058

Commodity contracts
66,260

 
1,534

 
1,666

 
65,532

 
3,057

 
2,551

Equity contracts
171,899

 
5,671

 
6,966

 
151,675

 
4,813

 
6,029

Foreign exchange contracts
345,994

 
7,673

 
7,381

 
318,999

 
9,595

 
9,798

Credit contracts – protection sold
10,845

 
169

 
266

 
10,483

 
85

 
389

Credit contracts – protection purchased
21,493

 
264

 
235

 
19,964

 
365

 
138

Other contracts
966

 

 
34

 
961

 

 
47

Subtotal
 
 
31,522

 
31,289

 
 
 
75,498

 
80,010

Total derivatives not designated as hedging instruments
 
 
32,647

 
32,079

 
 
 
77,869

 
81,699

Total derivatives before netting
 
 
35,885

 
34,729

 
 
 
85,129

 
87,188

Netting (3)
 
 
(22,612
)
 
(23,093
)
 
 
 
(70,631
)
 
(72,696
)
Total
 
 
$
13,273

 
11,636

 
 
 
14,498

 
14,492

(1)
Notional amounts presented exclude $500 million and $1.9 billion of interest rate contracts at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , respectively, for certain derivatives that are combined for designation as a hedge on a single instrument. The notional amount for foreign exchange contracts at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , excludes $12.9 billion and $9.6 billion , respectively, for certain derivatives that are combined for designation as a hedge on a single instrument.
(2)
Includes economic hedge derivatives used to hedge the risk of changes in the fair value of residential MSRs, MHFS, loans, derivative loan commitments and other interests held.
(3)
Represents balance sheet netting of derivative asset and liability balances, related cash collateral and portfolio level counterparty valuation adjustments. See Table 12.2 for further information.


127


Table 12.2 provides information on the gross fair values of derivative assets and liabilities, the balance sheet netting adjustments and the resulting net fair value amount recorded on our balance sheet, as well as the non-cash collateral associated with such arrangements. We execute substantially all of our derivative transactions under master netting arrangements and reflect all derivative balances and related cash collateral subject to enforceable master netting arrangements on a net basis within the balance sheet. The “Gross amounts recognized” column in the following table includes $26.6 billion and $28.9 billion of gross derivative assets and liabilities, respectively, at June 30, 2017 , and $74.4 billion and $78.4 billion , respectively, at December 31, 2016 , with counterparties subject to enforceable master netting arrangements that are carried on the balance sheet net of offsetting amounts. The remaining gross derivative assets and liabilities of $9.3 billion and $5.8 billion , respectively, at June 30, 2017 , and $10.7 billion and $8.7 billion , respectively, at December 31, 2016 , include those with counterparties subject to master netting arrangements for which we have not assessed the enforceability because they are with counterparties where we do not currently have positions to offset, those subject to master netting arrangements where we have not been able to confirm the enforceability and those not subject to master netting arrangements. As such, we do not net derivative balances or collateral within the balance sheet for these counterparties.
We determine the balance sheet netting adjustments based on the terms specified within each master netting arrangement. We disclose the balance sheet netting amounts within the column titled “Gross amounts offset in consolidated balance sheet.” Balance sheet netting adjustments are determined at the counterparty level for which there may be multiple contract types. For disclosure purposes, we allocate these netting adjustments to the contract type for each counterparty proportionally based upon the “Gross amounts recognized” by counterparty. As a result, the net amounts disclosed by contract type may not represent the actual exposure upon settlement of the contracts.
 
We do not net non-cash collateral that we receive and pledge on the balance sheet. For disclosure purposes, we present the fair value of this non-cash collateral in the column titled “Gross amounts not offset in consolidated balance sheet (Disclosure-only netting)” within the table. We determine and allocate the Disclosure-only netting amounts in the same manner as balance sheet netting amounts.
The “Net amounts” column within Table 12.2 represents the aggregate of our net exposure to each counterparty after considering the balance sheet and Disclosure-only netting adjustments. We manage derivative exposure by monitoring the credit risk associated with each counterparty using counterparty specific credit risk limits, using master netting arrangements and obtaining collateral. Derivative contracts executed in over-the-counter markets include bilateral contractual arrangements that are not cleared through a central clearing organization but are typically subject to master netting arrangements. The percentage of our bilateral derivative transactions outstanding at period end in such markets, based on gross fair value, is provided within the following table. Other derivative contracts executed in over-the-counter or exchange-traded markets are settled through a central clearing organization and are excluded from this percentage. In addition to the netting amounts included in the table, we also have balance sheet netting related to resale and repurchase agreements that are disclosed within Note 10 (Guarantees, Pledged Assets and Collateral).

128

Note 12: Derivatives ( continued )

Table 12.2: Gross Fair Values of Derivative Assets and Liabilities
(in millions)
Gross
amounts
recognized (1)

 
Gross amounts
offset in
consolidated
balance
sheet (1)(2)

 
Net amounts in
consolidated
balance
sheet

 
Gross amounts
not offset in
consolidated
balance sheet
(Disclosure-only
netting) (3)

 
Net
amounts

 
Percent
exchanged in
over-the-counter
market (1)(4)

June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Derivative assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts
$
19,218

 
(12,424
)
 
6,794

 
(360
)
 
6,434

 
98
%
Commodity contracts
1,534

 
(683
)
 
851

 
(6
)
 
845

 
80

Equity contracts
6,343

 
(3,319
)
 
3,024

 
(452
)
 
2,572

 
76

Foreign exchange contracts
8,286

 
(5,905
)
 
2,381

 
(63
)
 
2,318

 
100

Credit contracts – protection sold
169

 
(35
)
 
134

 

 
134

 
10

Credit contracts – protection purchased
335

 
(246
)
 
89

 
(4
)
 
85

 
96

Total derivative assets
$
35,885

 
(22,612
)
 
13,273

 
(885
)
 
12,388

 
  
Derivative liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts
$
16,253

 
(12,396
)
 
3,857

 
(1,899
)
 
1,958

 
98
%
Commodity contracts
1,666

 
(321
)
 
1,345

 
(22
)
 
1,323

 
88

Equity contracts
7,020

 
(3,223
)
 
3,797

 
(394
)
 
3,403

 
84

Foreign exchange contracts
9,255

 
(6,921
)
 
2,334

 
(659
)
 
1,675

 
100

Credit contracts – protection sold
266

 
(227
)
 
39

 
(33
)
 
6

 
93

Credit contracts – protection purchased
235

 
(5
)
 
230

 
(1
)
 
229

 
8

Other contracts
34

 

 
34

 

 
34

 
100

Total derivative liabilities
$
34,729

 
(23,093
)
 
11,636

 
(3,008
)
 
8,628

 
  
December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Derivative assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts
$
65,268

 
(59,880
)
 
5,388

 
(987
)
 
4,401

 
34
%
Commodity contracts
3,057

 
(707
)
 
2,350

 
(30
)
 
2,320

 
74

Equity contracts
5,358

 
(3,018
)
 
2,340

 
(365
)
 
1,975

 
75

Foreign exchange contracts
10,894

 
(6,663
)
 
4,231

 
(362
)
 
3,869

 
97

Credit contracts – protection sold
85

 
(48
)
 
37

 

 
37

 
61

Credit contracts – protection purchased
467

 
(315
)
 
152

 
(1
)
 
151

 
98

Total derivative assets
$
85,129

 
(70,631
)
 
14,498

 
(1,745
)
 
12,753

 
  
Derivative liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts
$
65,209

 
(58,956
)
 
6,253

 
(3,129
)
 
3,124

 
30
%
Commodity contracts
2,551

 
(402
)
 
2,149

 
(37
)
 
2,112

 
38

Equity contracts
6,112

 
(2,433
)
 
3,679

 
(331
)
 
3,348

 
85

Foreign exchange contracts
12,742

 
(10,572
)
 
2,170

 
(251
)
 
1,919

 
100

Credit contracts – protection sold
389

 
(295
)
 
94

 
(44
)
 
50

 
98

Credit contracts – protection purchased
138

 
(38
)
 
100

 
(2
)
 
98

 
50

Other contracts
47

 

 
47

 

 
47

 
100

Total derivative liabilities
$
87,188

 
(72,696
)
 
14,492

 
(3,794
)
 
10,698

 
  
(1)
In second quarter, 2017, we adopted Settlement to Market treatment for the cash collateralizing our interest rate derivative contracts with certain centrally cleared counterparties. As a result of this adoption, the “gross amounts recognized” and “gross amounts offset in the consolidated balance sheet” columns do not include exposure with certain centrally cleared counterparties because the contracts are considered settled by the collateral. Likewise, what remains in these gross amount columns consists primarily of over-the-counter (OTC) market contracts for most of the contract types as reflected by the high percentage of OTC contracts in the “percent exchanged in over-the counter market” column as of June 30, 2017.
(2)
Represents amounts with counterparties subject to enforceable master netting arrangements that have been offset in the consolidated balance sheet, including related cash collateral and portfolio level counterparty valuation adjustments. Counterparty valuation adjustments were $289 million and $348 million related to derivative assets and $83 million and $114 million related to derivative liabilities at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , respectively. Cash collateral totaled $3.6 billion and $4.3 billion , netted against derivative assets and liabilities, respectively, at June 30, 2017 , and $4.8 billion and $7.1 billion , respectively, at December 31, 2016 .
(3)
Represents non-cash collateral pledged and received against derivative assets and liabilities with the same counterparty that are subject to enforceable master netting arrangements. U.S. GAAP does not permit netting of such non-cash collateral balances in the consolidated balance sheet but requires disclosure of these amounts.
(4)
Represents derivatives executed in over-the-counter markets that are not settled through a central clearing organization. Over-the-counter percentages are calculated based on gross amounts recognized as of the respective balance sheet date. The remaining percentage represents derivatives settled through a central clearing organization, which are executed in either over-the-counter or exchange-traded markets.



129


Fair Value Hedges
We use derivatives to hedge against changes in fair value of certain financial instruments, including available-for-sale debt securities, mortgages held for sale, and long-term debt. For more information on fair value hedges, see Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) and Note 16 (Derivatives) to Financial Statements in our 2016 Form 10-K.
 
Table 12.3 shows the net gains (losses) recognized in the income statement related to derivatives in fair value hedging relationships.
 
Table 12.3: Derivatives in Fair Value Hedging Relationships
 
Interest rate
contracts hedging:
 
 
Foreign exchange
contracts hedging:
 
 
Total net
gains
(losses)
on fair
value
hedges

(in millions)
Available-
for-sale
securities

 
Mortgages
held for
sale

 
Long-term
debt

 
Available-
for-sale
securities

 
Long-term
debt

 
Quarter ended June 30, 2017
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

 
  
Net interest income (expense) recognized on derivatives
$
(122
)
 
(2
)
 
372

 
2

 
(49
)
 
201

Gains (losses) recorded in noninterest income
 
 
  
 
  
 
  

 
  
 
  
Recognized on derivatives
(287
)
 
(10
)
 
431

 
(87
)
 
1,426

 
1,473

Recognized on hedged item
268

 
6

 
(399
)
 
86

 
(1,365
)
 
(1,404
)
Net recognized on fair value hedges (ineffective portion) (1) 
$
(19
)
 
(4
)
 
32

 
(1
)
 
61

 
69

Quarter ended June 30, 2016
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

Net interest income (expense) recognized on derivatives
$
(170
)
 
(2
)
 
483

 
2

 
15

 
328

Gains (losses) recorded in noninterest income
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

 
  
 
  
Recognized on derivatives
(1,012
)
 
(5
)
 
1,983

 
134

 
(455
)
 
645

Recognized on hedged item
1,018

 
6

 
(1,762
)
 
(133
)
 
394

 
(477
)
Net recognized on fair value hedges (ineffective portion) (1)
$
6

 
1

 
221

 
1

 
(61
)
 
168

Six months ended June 30, 2017
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

 
  
Net interest income (expense) recognized on derivatives (1)
$
(253
)
 
(4
)
 
799

 
6

 
(82
)
 
466

Gains (losses) recorded in noninterest income
  
 
  
 
  
 
  

 
  
 
  
Recognized on derivatives
(161
)
 
(11
)
 
(133
)
 
(129
)
 
1,583

 
1,149

Recognized on hedged item
127

 
6

 
141

 
130

 
(1,676
)
 
(1,272
)
Net recognized on fair value hedges (ineffective portion)
$
(34
)

(5
)

8


1


(93
)
 
(123
)
Six months ended June 30, 2016
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

Net interest income (expense) recognized on derivatives (1)
$
(351
)
 
(4
)
 
965

 
2

 
31

 
643

Gains (losses) recorded in noninterest income
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

 
  
 
  
Recognized on derivatives
(2,695
)
 
(42
)
 
5,086

 
68

 
1,163

 
3,580

Recognized on hedged item
2,709

 
39

 
(4,569
)
 
(74
)
 
(1,008
)
 
(2,903
)
Net recognized on fair value hedges (ineffective portion)
$
14

 
(3
)
 
517

 
(6
)
 
155

 
677

(1)
The second quarter and first half of 2017 included $0 million and $(1) million , respectively, and the second quarter and first half of 2016 included $(3) million and $(7) million , respectively, of the time value component recognized as net interest income (expense) on forward derivatives hedging foreign currency that were excluded from the assessment of hedge effectiveness.
Cash Flow Hedges
We use derivatives to hedge certain financial instruments against future interest rate increases and to limit the variability of cash flows on certain financial instruments due to changes in the benchmark interest rate. For more information on cash flow hedges, see Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) and Note 16 (Derivatives) to Financial Statements in our 2016 Form 10-K.
Based upon current interest rates, we estimate that $309 million (pre tax) of deferred net gains on derivatives in OCI
 
at June 30, 2017 , will be reclassified into net interest income during the next twelve months. Future changes to interest rates may significantly change actual amounts reclassified to earnings. We are hedging our exposure to the variability of future cash flows for all forecasted transactions for a maximum of 6 years .
Table 12.4 shows the net gains (losses) recognized related to derivatives in cash flow hedging relationships.
 
Table 12.4: Derivatives in Cash Flow Hedging Relationships
 
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
(in millions)
2017

 
2016

 
2017

 
2016

Gains (losses) (pre tax) recognized in OCI on derivatives
$
376

 
1,057

 
243

 
3,056

Gains (pre tax) reclassified from cumulative OCI into net income (1)
153

 
265

 
355

 
521

Gains (losses) (pre tax) recognized in noninterest income for hedge ineffectiveness (2)

 

 
(3
)
 
1

  
(1)
See Note 17 (Other Comprehensive Income) for detail on components of net income.
(2)
None of the change in value of the derivatives was excluded from the assessment of hedge effectiveness. 

130

Note 12: Derivatives ( continued )

Derivatives Not Designated as Hedging Instruments
We use economic hedges primarily to hedge the risk of changes in the fair value of certain residential MHFS, residential MSRs measured at fair value, derivative loan commitments and other interests held. We also use economic hedge derivatives to mitigate the periodic earnings volatility caused by ineffectiveness recognized on our fair value accounting hedges. The resulting gain or loss on these economic hedge derivatives is reflected in mortgage banking noninterest income, net gains (losses) from equity investments and other noninterest income.
The derivatives used to hedge MSRs measured at fair value, resulted in net derivative gains (losses) of $431 million and $359 million in the second quarter and first half of 2017, respectively, and $978 million and $2.4 billion in the second quarter and first half of 2016 , respectively, which are included in mortgage banking noninterest income. The aggregate fair value of these derivatives was a net asset of $96 million at June 30, 2017 , and net liability of $617 million at December 31, 2016 . The
 
change in fair value of these derivatives for each period end is due to changes in the underlying market indices and interest rates as well as the purchase and sale of derivative financial instruments throughout the period as part of our dynamic MSR risk management process.
Interest rate lock commitments for mortgage loans that we intend to sell are considered derivatives. The aggregate fair value of derivative loan commitments on the balance sheet was a net asset of $12 million and net liability of $6 million at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , respectively, and is included in the caption “Interest rate contracts” under “Customer accommodation trading and other derivatives” in Table 12.1 in this Note.
For more information on economic hedges and other derivatives, see Note 16 (Derivatives) to Financial Statements in our 2016 Form 10-K. Table 12.5 shows the net gains recognized in the income statement related to derivatives not designated as hedging instruments.
 
Table 12.5: Derivatives Not Designated as Hedging Instruments
 
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
(in millions)
2017

 
2016

 
2017

 
2016

Net gains (losses) recognized on economic hedges derivatives:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts
Recognized in noninterest income:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Mortgage banking (1)
$
351

 
566

 
342

 
1,431

Other (2)
(51
)
 
(117
)
 
(45
)
 
(252
)
Equity contracts (3)
(205
)
 
205

 
(686
)
 
288

Foreign exchange contracts (2)
(441
)
 
495

 
(534
)
 
329

Credit contracts (2)
10

 

 
14

 

Subtotal (4)
(336
)
 
1,149

 
(909
)
 
1,796

Net gains (losses) recognized on customer accommodation trading and other derivatives:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts
Recognized in noninterest income:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Mortgage banking (5)
254

 
510

 
447

 
975

Other (6)
18

 
(280
)
 
63

 
(730
)
Commodity contracts (6)
15

 
64

 
75

 
117

Equity contracts (6)
(565
)
 
(315
)
 
(1,674
)
 
(295
)
Foreign exchange contracts (6)
16

 
276

 
201

 
498

Credit contracts (6)
(13
)
 
(25
)
 
(28
)
 
(41
)
Other (2)
2

 
(9
)
 
14

 
(30
)
Subtotal
(273
)
 
221

 
(902
)
 
494

Net gains (losses) recognized related to derivatives not designated as hedging instruments
$
(609
)
 
1,370

 
(1,811
)
 
2,290

(1)
Reflected in mortgage banking noninterest income including gains (losses) on the derivatives used as economic hedges of MSRs measured at fair value, interest rate lock commitments and mortgages held for sale.
(2)
Included in other noninterest income.
(3)
Included in net gains (losses) from equity investments and other noninterest income.
(4)
Includes hedging gains (losses) of $(48) million and $(46) million for the second quarter and first half of 2017, respectively, and $(113) million and $(244) million for the second quarter and first half of 2016 , respectively, which partially offset hedge accounting ineffectiveness.
(5)
Reflected in mortgage banking noninterest income including gains (losses) on interest rate lock commitments and net gains from trading activities in noninterest income.
(6)
Included in net gains from trading activities in noninterest income.



131


Credit Derivatives
Credit derivative contracts are arrangements whose value is derived from the transfer of credit risk of a reference asset or entity from one party (the purchaser of credit protection) to another party (the seller of credit protection). We use credit derivatives to assist customers with their risk management objectives. We may also use credit derivatives in structured product transactions or liquidity agreements written to special purpose vehicles. The maximum exposure of sold credit derivatives is managed through posted collateral, purchased credit derivatives and similar products in order to achieve our desired credit risk profile. This credit risk management provides an ability to recover a significant portion of any amounts that would be paid under the sold credit derivatives. We would be
 
required to perform under sold credit derivatives in the event of default by the referenced obligors. Events of default include events such as bankruptcy, capital restructuring or lack of principal and/or interest payment. In certain cases, other triggers may exist, such as the credit downgrade of the referenced obligors or the inability of the special purpose vehicle for which we have provided liquidity to obtain funding.
Table 12.6 provides details of sold and purchased credit derivatives.
Table 12.6: Sold and Purchased Credit Derivatives
 
 
 
Notional amount
 
 
  
(in millions)
Fair value
liability

 
Protection
sold (A)

 
Protection
sold –
non-
investment
grade

 
Protection
purchased
with
identical
underlyings (B)

 
Net
protection
sold
(A) - (B)

 
Other
protection
purchased

 
Range of
maturities
June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Credit default swaps on:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Corporate bonds
$
21

 
1,860

 
470

 
1,288

 
572

 
1,197

 
2017 - 2027
Structured products
111

 
250

 
244

 
221

 
29

 
153

 
2020 - 2047
Credit protection on:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
Default swap index

 
4,638

 
761

 
494

 
4,144

 
6,803

 
2017 - 2027
Commercial mortgage-backed securities index
116

 
476

 

 
435

 
41

 
157

 
2047 - 2058
Asset-backed securities index
17

 
43

 

 
39

 
4

 
5

 
2045 - 2046
Other
1

 
3,578

 
3,579

 

 
3,578

 
11,137

 
2017 - 2028
Total credit derivatives
$
266

 
10,845

 
5,054

 
2,477

 
8,368

 
19,452

 
 
December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Credit default swaps on:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Corporate bonds
$
22

 
4,324

 
1,704

 
3,060

 
1,264

 
1,804

 
2017 - 2026
Structured products
193

 
405

 
333

 
295

 
110

 
79

 
2020 - 2047
Credit protection on:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Default swap index

 
1,515

 
257

 
139

 
1,376

 
3,668

 
2017 - 2021
Commercial mortgage-backed securities index
156

 
627

 

 
584

 
43

 
71

 
2047 - 2058
Asset-backed securities index
17

 
45

 

 
40

 
5

 
187

 
2045 - 2046
Other
1

 
3,567

 
3,568

 

 
3,567

 
10,519

 
2017 - 2047
Total credit derivatives
$
389

 
10,483

 
5,862

 
4,118

 
6,365

 
16,328

 
 

Protection sold represents the estimated maximum exposure to loss that would be incurred under an assumed hypothetical circumstance, where the value of our interests and any associated collateral declines to zero, without any consideration of recovery or offset from any economic hedges. We believe this hypothetical circumstance to be a remote possibility and accordingly, this required disclosure is not an indication of expected loss. The amounts under non-investment grade represent the notional amounts of those credit derivatives on which we have a higher risk of being required to perform under the terms of the credit derivative and are a function of the underlying assets.
 
We consider the risk of performance to be high if the underlying assets under the credit derivative have an external rating that is below investment grade or an internal credit default grade that is equivalent thereto. We believe the net protection sold, which is representative of the net notional amount of protection sold and purchased with identical underlyings, in combination with other protection purchased, is more representative of our exposure to loss than either non-investment grade or protection sold. Other protection purchased represents additional protection, which may offset the exposure to loss for protection sold, that was not purchased with an identical underlying of the protection sold.


132

Note 12: Derivatives ( continued )

Credit-Risk Contingent Features
Certain of our derivative contracts contain provisions whereby if the credit rating of our debt were to be downgraded by certain major credit rating agencies, the counterparty could demand additional collateral or require termination or replacement of derivative instruments in a net liability position. The aggregate fair value of all derivative instruments with such credit-risk-related contingent features that are in a net liability position was $10.4 billion at June 30, 2017 , and $12.8 billion at December 31, 2016 , for which we posted $8.1 billion and $8.9 billion , respectively, in collateral in the normal course of business. A credit rating below investment grade is the credit-risk-related contingent feature that if triggered requires the maximum amount of collateral to be posted. If the credit rating of our debt had been downgraded below investment grade , on June 30, 2017 , or December 31, 2016 , we would have been required to post additional collateral of $2.4 billion or $4.0 billion , respectively, or potentially settle the contract in an amount equal to its fair value. Some contracts require that we provide more collateral than the fair value of derivatives that are in a net liability position if a downgrade occurs.
 
 
Counterparty Credit Risk
By using derivatives, we are exposed to counterparty credit risk if counterparties to the derivative contracts do not perform as expected. If a counterparty fails to perform, our counterparty credit risk is equal to the amount reported as a derivative asset on our balance sheet. The amounts reported as a derivative asset are derivative contracts in a gain position, and to the extent subject to legally enforceable master netting arrangements, net of derivatives in a loss position with the same counterparty and cash collateral received. We minimize counterparty credit risk through credit approvals, limits, monitoring procedures, executing master netting arrangements and obtaining collateral, where appropriate. To the extent the master netting arrangements and other criteria meet the applicable requirements, including determining the legal enforceability of the arrangement, it is our policy to present derivative balances and related cash collateral amounts net on the balance sheet. We incorporate credit valuation adjustments (CVA) to reflect counterparty credit risk in determining the fair value of our derivatives. Such adjustments, which consider the effects of enforceable master netting agreements and collateral arrangements, reflect market-based views of the credit quality of each counterparty. Our CVA calculation is determined based on observed credit spreads in the credit default swap market and indices indicative of the credit quality of the counterparties to our derivatives.


133


Note 13:  Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities

We use fair value measurements to record fair value adjustments to certain assets and liabilities and to determine fair value disclosures. Assets and liabilities recorded at fair value on a recurring basis are presented in Table 13.2 in this Note. From time to time, we may be required to record fair value adjustments on a nonrecurring basis. These nonrecurring fair value adjustments typically involve application of LOCOM accounting or write-downs of individual assets. Assets recorded on a nonrecurring basis are presented in Table 13.14 in this Note.
See Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) to Financial Statements in our 2016 Form 10-K for discussion of how we determine fair value. For descriptions of the valuation methodologies we use for assets and liabilities recorded at fair value on a recurring or nonrecurring basis and for estimating fair value for financial instruments that are not recorded at fair value, see Note 17 (Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities) to Financial Statements in our 2016 Form 10-K.
 
FAIR VALUE HIERARCHY    We group our assets and liabilities measured at fair value in three levels based on the markets in which the assets and liabilities are traded and the reliability of the assumptions used to determine fair value. These levels are:
Level 1 – Valuation is based upon quoted prices for identical instruments traded in active markets.
Level 2 – Valuation is based upon quoted prices for similar instruments in active markets, quoted prices for identical or similar instruments in markets that are not active, and model-based valuation techniques for which all significant assumptions are observable in the market.
Level 3 – Valuation is generated from techniques that use significant assumptions that are not observable in the market. These unobservable assumptions reflect estimates of assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability. Valuation techniques include use of option pricing models, discounted cash flow models and similar techniques.
 
In accordance with new accounting guidance that we adopted effective January 1, 2016, we do not classify an investment in the fair value hierarchy if we use the non-published net asset value (NAV) per share (or its equivalent) that has been communicated to us as an investor as a practical expedient to measure fair value. We generally use NAV per share as the fair value measurement for certain nonmarketable equity fund investments. This guidance was required to be applied retrospectively. Accordingly, certain prior period fair value disclosures have been revised to conform with current period presentation. Marketable equity investments with published NAVs continue to be classified in the fair value hierarchy.
Fair Value Measurements from Vendors
For certain assets and liabilities, we obtain fair value measurements from vendors, which predominantly consist of third-party pricing services, and record the unadjusted fair value in our financial statements. For additional information, see Note 17 (Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities) to Financial Statements in our 2016 Form 10-K. Table 13.1 . presents unadjusted fair value measurements provided by brokers or third-party pricing services by fair value hierarchy level. Fair value measurements obtained from brokers or third-party pricing services that we have adjusted to determine the fair value recorded in our financial statements are excluded from Table 13.1 .

134

Note 13: Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities ( continued )

Table 13.1: Fair Value Measurements by Brokers or Third-Party Pricing Services
  
Brokers
 
 
Third-party pricing services
 
(in millions)
Level 1

 
Level 2

 
Level 3

 
Level 1

 
Level 2

 
Level 3

June 30, 2017
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Trading assets
$

 

 

 
832

 
344

 

Available-for-sale securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies

 

 

 
14,940

 
2,956

 

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions

 

 

 

 
50,456

 
208

Mortgage-backed securities

 
41

 

 

 
148,097

 
76

Other debt securities (1)

 
491

 
1,129

 

 
45,523

 
26

Total debt securities

 
532

 
1,129

 
14,940

 
247,032

 
310

Total marketable equity securities

 

 

 

 
287

 

Total available-for-sale securities

 
532

 
1,129

 
14,940

 
247,319

 
310

Derivatives assets

 

 

 
21

 
3

 

Derivatives liabilities

 

 

 
(18
)
 
(7
)
 

Other liabilities (2)

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2016
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Trading assets
$

 

 

 
899

 
60

 

Available-for-sale securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies

 

 

 
22,870

 
2,949

 

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions

 

 

 

 
49,837

 
208

Mortgage-backed securities

 
171

 

 

 
176,923

 
92

Other debt securities (1)

 
450

 
968

 

 
49,162

 
54

Total debt securities

 
621

 
968

 
22,870

 
278,871

 
354

Total marketable equity securities

 

 

 

 
358

 

Total available-for-sale securities

 
621

 
968

 
22,870

 
279,229

 
354

Derivatives assets

 

 

 
22

 

 

Derivatives liabilities

 

 

 
(109
)
 
(1
)
 

Other liabilities (2)

 

 

 

 

 

(1)
Includes corporate debt securities, collateralized loan and other debt obligations, asset-backed securities, and other debt securities.
(2)
Includes short sale liabilities and other liabilities.

135


Assets and Liabilities Recorded at Fair Value on a Recurring Basis
 
Table 13.2 presents the balances of assets and liabilities recorded at fair value on a recurring basis.
Table 13.2: Fair Value on a Recurring Basis
(in millions)
Level 1

 
Level 2

 
Level 3

 
Netting

 
Total

June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trading assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
$
13,484

 
3,061

 

  

  
16,545

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions

 
3,070

 
9

  

  
3,079

Collateralized loan obligations

 
386

 
403

  

  
789

Corporate debt securities

 
10,229

 
26

  

  
10,255

Mortgage-backed securities

 
22,480

 

  

 
22,480

Asset-backed securities

 
1,160

 

  

 
1,160

Equity securities
27,286

 
240

 

 

 
27,526

Total trading securities (1)
40,770

 
40,626

 
438

 

 
81,834

Other trading assets

 
1,734

 
39

  

 
1,773

Total trading assets
40,770

 
42,360

 
477

 

 
83,607

Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
14,940

 
2,956

 

  

 
17,896

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions

 
50,456

 
1,557

(2)

 
52,013

Mortgage-backed securities:
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
 

Federal agencies

 
135,938

 

  

 
135,938

Residential

 
7,358

 
1

  

 
7,359

Commercial

 
5,338

 
75

  

 
5,413

Total mortgage-backed securities

 
148,634

 
76

 

 
148,710

Corporate debt securities
54

 
9,172

 
376

  

 
9,602

Collateralized loan and other debt obligations (3)

 
32,453

 
1,002

(2)

 
33,455

Asset-backed securities:
  
 
  
 
  
  
  
 

Automobile loans and leases

 
530

 

 

 
530

Home equity loans

 
319

 

  

 
319

Other asset-backed securities

 
4,777

 
872

(2)

 
5,649

Total asset-backed securities

 
5,626

 
872

  

 
6,498

Other debt securities

 

 

  

 

Total debt securities
14,994

 
249,297

 
3,883

  

 
268,174

Marketable equity securities:
  
 
  
 
  
  
  
 

Perpetual preferred securities
178

 
287

 

 

 
465

Other marketable equity securities
563

 

 

  

 
563

Total marketable equity securities
741

 
287

 

 

 
1,028

Total available-for-sale securities
15,735

 
249,584

 
3,883

 

 
269,202

Mortgages held for sale

 
18,548

 
995

  

 
19,543

Loans

 

 
443

  

  
443

Mortgage servicing rights (residential)

 

 
12,789

  

  
12,789

Derivative assets:
  
 
  
 
  
  
  
  

Interest rate contracts
28

 
18,998

 
192

  

  
19,218

Commodity contracts

 
1,504

 
30

  

  
1,534

Equity contracts
1,545

 
3,618

 
1,180

  

  
6,343

Foreign exchange contracts
21

 
8,247

 
18

  

  
8,286

Credit contracts

 
320

 
184

  

  
504

Netting

 

 

  
(22,612
)
(4)
(22,612
)
Total derivative assets
1,594

 
32,687

 
1,604

  
(22,612
)
 
13,273

Other assets – excluding nonmarketable equity investments at NAV

 
26

 
3,960

  

  
3,986

Total assets included in the fair value hierarchy
$
58,099

 
343,205

 
24,151

 
(22,612
)
 
402,843

Other assets – nonmarketable equity investments at NAV (5)


 
 
 
 
 
 
 

Total assets recorded at fair value


 


 
 
 


 
$
402,843

Derivative liabilities:
  
 
  
 
  
  
  
  

Interest rate contracts
$
(30
)
 
(16,146
)
 
(77
)
  

  
(16,253
)
Commodity contracts

 
(1,653
)
 
(13
)
  

  
(1,666
)
Equity contracts
(1,089
)
 
(4,280
)
 
(1,651
)
  

  
(7,020
)
Foreign exchange contracts
(18
)
 
(9,223
)
 
(14
)
  

  
(9,255
)
Credit contracts

 
(389
)
 
(112
)
  

  
(501
)
Other derivative contracts

 

 
(34
)
  

  
(34
)
Netting

 

 

  
23,093

(4)
23,093

Total derivative liabilities
(1,137
)
 
(31,691
)
 
(1,901
)
  
23,093

  
(11,636
)
Short sale liabilities:
  
 
  
 
  
  
  
  

Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies
(8,906
)
 
(622
)
 

  

  
(9,528
)
Corporate debt securities

 
(5,180
)
 

  

  
(5,180
)
Equity securities
(2,073
)
 
(18
)
 

  

  
(2,091
)
Other securities

 
(45
)
 

  

  
(45
)
Total short sale liabilities
(10,979
)
 
(5,865
)
 

  

  
(16,844
)
Other liabilities

 

 
(3
)
  

  
(3
)
Total liabilities recorded at fair value
$
(12,116
)
 
(37,556
)
 
(1,904
)
  
23,093

  
(28,483
)
(1)
Net gains (losses) from trading activities recognized in the income statement for the first half of June 30, 2017 and 2016 include $1.1 billion and $1.1 billion in net unrealized gains (losses) on trading securities held at June 30, 2017 and 2016 , respectively.
(2)
Balances consist of securities that are mostly investment grade based on ratings received from the ratings agencies or internal credit grades categorized as investment grade if external ratings are not available. The securities are classified as Level 3 due to limited market activity.
(3)
Includes collateralized debt obligations of $998 million .
(4)
Represents balance sheet netting of derivative asset and liability balances and related cash collateral. See Note 12 (Derivatives) for additional information.
(5)
Consists of certain nonmarketable equity investments that are measured at fair value using NAV per share (or its equivalent) as a practical expedient and are excluded from the fair value hierarchy.
(continued on following page)

136

Note 13: Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities ( continued )

(continued from previous page)
(in millions)  
Level 1

 
Level 2

 
Level 3

 
Netting

 
Total

December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trading assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies  
$
14,950

 
2,710

 

 

 
17,660

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions  

 
2,910

 
3

 

 
2,913

Collateralized loan obligations

 
501

 
309

 

 
810

Corporate debt securities  

 
9,481

 
34

 

 
9,515

Mortgage-backed securities  

 
20,254

 

 

 
20,254

Asset-backed securities  

 
1,128

 

 

 
1,128

Equity securities  
20,462

 
290

 

 

 
20,752

Total trading securities (1)
35,412

 
37,274

 
346

 

 
73,032

Other trading assets  

 
1,337

 
28

 

 
1,365

Total trading assets
35,412

 
38,611

 
374

 

 
74,397

Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies  
22,870

 
2,949

 

 

 
25,819

Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions

 
49,961

 
1,140

(2)

 
51,101

Mortgage-backed securities:  
  
 
  
 
  
  
  
 

Federal agencies  

 
161,230

 

  

 
161,230

Residential  

 
7,815

 
1

  

 
7,816

Commercial  

 
8,411

 
91

  

 
8,502

Total mortgage-backed securities  

 
177,456

 
92

 

 
177,548

Corporate debt securities  
58

 
10,967

 
432

  

 
11,457

Collateralized loan and other debt obligations (3)

 
34,141

 
879

(2)

 
35,020

Asset-backed securities:  
  
 
  
 
  
  
  
 

Automobile loans and leases  

 
9

 

 

 
9

Home equity loans  

 
327

 

  

 
327

Other asset-backed securities  

 
4,909

 
962

(2)

 
5,871

Total asset-backed securities  

 
5,245

 
962

  

 
6,207

Other debt securities  

 
1

 

  

 
1

Total debt securities  
22,928

 
280,720

 
3,505

  

 
307,153

Marketable equity securities:  
  
 
  
 
  
  
  
 

Perpetual preferred securities
112

 
357

 

 

 
469

Other marketable equity securities  
741

 
1

 

  

 
742

Total marketable equity securities  
853

 
358

 

 

 
1,211

Total available-for-sale securities  
23,781

 
281,078

 
3,505

 

 
308,364

Mortgages held for sale   

 
21,057

 
985

 

 
22,042

Loans  

 

 
758

 

 
758

Mortgage servicing rights (residential)  

 

 
12,959

 

 
12,959

Derivative assets:  
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 

Interest rate contracts  
44

 
64,986

 
238

 

 
65,268

Commodity contracts  

 
3,020

 
37

 

 
3,057

Equity contracts  
1,314

 
2,997

 
1,047

 

 
5,358

Foreign exchange contracts  
22

 
10,843

 
29

 

 
10,894

Credit contracts  

 
280

 
272

 

 
552

Netting  

 

 

 
(70,631
)
(4)
(70,631
)
Total derivative assets
1,380

 
82,126

 
1,623

 
(70,631
)
 
14,498

Other assets – excluding nonmarketable equity investments at NAV

 
16

 
3,259

 

 
3,275

Total assets included in the fair value hierarchy
$
60,573

 
422,888

 
23,463

 
(70,631
)
 
436,293

Other assets – nonmarketable equity investments at NAV (5)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

Total assets recorded at fair value


 


 


 


 
$
436,293

Derivative liabilities:  
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 

Interest rate contracts  
$
(45
)
 
(65,047
)
 
(117
)
 

 
(65,209
)
Commodity contracts  

 
(2,537
)
 
(14
)
 

 
(2,551
)
Equity contracts  
(919
)
 
(3,879
)
 
(1,314
)
 

 
(6,112
)
Foreign exchange contracts  
(109
)
 
(12,616
)
 
(17
)
 

 
(12,742
)
Credit contracts  

 
(332
)
 
(195
)
 

 
(527
)
Other derivative contracts  

 

 
(47
)
 

 
(47
)
Netting  

 

 

 
72,696

(4)
72,696

Total derivative liabilities
(1,073
)
 
(84,411
)
 
(1,704
)
 
72,696

 
(14,492
)
Short sale liabilities:  
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 


Securities of U.S. Treasury and federal agencies  
(9,722
)
 
(701
)
 

 

 
(10,423
)
Corporate debt securities  

 
(4,063
)
 

 

 
(4,063
)
Equity securities  
(1,795
)
 

 

 

 
(1,795
)
Other securities  

 
(98
)
 

 

 
(98
)
Total short sale liabilities  
(11,517
)
 
(4,862
)
 

 

 
(16,379
)
Other liabilities 

 

 
(4
)
 

 
(4
)
Total liabilities recorded at fair value  
$
(12,590
)
 
(89,273
)
 
(1,708
)
 
72,696

 
(30,875
)
(1)
Net gains (losses) from trading activities recognized in the income statement for the year ended December 31, 2016 , include $820 million in net unrealized gains (losses) on trading securities held at December 31, 2016 .
(2)
Balances consist of securities that are mostly investment grade based on ratings received from the ratings agencies or internal credit grades categorized as investment grade if external ratings are not available. The securities are classified as Level 3 due to limited market activity.
(3)
Includes collateralized debt obligations of $847 million
(4)
Represents balance sheet netting of derivative asset and liability balances and related cash collateral. See Note 12 (Derivatives) for additional information.
(5)
Consists of certain nonmarketable equity investments that are measured at fair value using NAV per share (or its equivalent) as a practical expedient and are excluded from the fair value hierarchy.




137


Changes in Fair Value Levels
We monitor the availability of observable market data to assess the appropriate classification of financial instruments within the fair value hierarchy and transfer between Level 1, Level 2, and Level 3 accordingly. Observable market data includes but is not limited to quoted prices and market transactions. Changes in economic conditions or market liquidity generally will drive changes in availability of observable market data. Changes in availability of observable market data, which also may result in
 
changing the valuation technique used, are generally the cause of transfers between Level 1, Level 2, and Level 3.
Transfers into and out of Level 1, Level 2, and Level 3 are provided within Table 13.3 for the periods presented. The amounts reported as transfers represent the fair value as of the beginning of the quarter in which the transfer occurred.
Table 13.3: Transfers Between Fair Value Levels
  
Transfers Between Fair Value Levels
 
  
  
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3 (1)
 
  
(in millions)
In
 
Out
 
In
 
Out
 
In
 
Out
 
Total  
Quarter ended June 30, 2017
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Trading assets
$

 

 

 
(16
)
 
16

 

 

Available-for-sale securities

 

 
424

 

 

 
(424
)
 

Mortgages held for sale

 

 
5

 
(19
)
 
19

 
(5
)
 

Other assets

 

 

 
(1
)
 
1

 

 

Net derivative assets and liabilities (2)

 

 
80

 

 

 
(80
)
 

Short sale liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total transfers
$

 

 
509

 
(36
)
 
36

 
(509
)
 

Quarter ended June 30, 2016
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Trading assets
$

 
(4
)
 
4

 

 

 

 

Available-for-sale securities

 

 
16

 

 

 
(16
)
 

Mortgages held for sale

 

 
7

 
(25
)
 
25

 
(7
)
 

Other assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net derivative assets and liabilities (2)

 

 
(12
)
 
(3
)
 
3

 
12

 

Short sale liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total transfers
$

 
(4
)
 
15

 
(28
)
 
28

 
(11
)
 

Six months ended June 30, 2017
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Trading assets
$

 

 
1

 
(19
)
 
19

 
(1
)
 

Available-for-sale securities

 

 
496

 
(5
)
 
5

 
(496
)
 

Mortgages held for sale

 

 
6

 
(61
)
 
61

 
(6
)
 

Other assets

 

 

 
(1
)
 
1

 

 

Net derivative assets and liabilities (2)

 

 
83

 
22

 
(22
)
 
(83
)
 

Short sale liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total transfers
$

 

 
586

 
(64
)
 
64

 
(586
)
 

Six months ended June 30, 2016
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Trading assets
$
4

 
(4
)
 
15

 
(4
)
 

 
(11
)
 

Available-for-sale securities

 

 
16

 
(80
)
 
80

 
(16
)
 

Mortgages held for sale

 

 
9

 
(54
)
 
54

 
(9
)
 

Other assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net derivative assets and liabilities (2)

 

 
50

 
(28
)
 
28

 
(50
)
 

Short sale liabilities
(1
)
 

 

 
1

 

 

 

Total transfers
$
3

 
(4
)
 
90

 
(165
)
 
162

 
(86
)
 

(1)
All transfers in and out of Level 3 are disclosed within the recurring Level 3 rollforward tables in this Note.
(2)
Includes transfers of net derivative assets and net derivative liabilities between levels due to changes in observable market data.


138

Note 13: Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities ( continued )

The changes in Level 3 assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis for the quarter ended June 30, 2017 , are presented in Table 13.4 .
Table 13.4: Changes in Level 3 Fair Value Assets and Liabilities on a Recurring Basis – Quarter ended June 30, 2017
  
  

 
Total net gains
(losses) included in
 
 
Purchases,
sales,
issuances
and
settlements,
net (1)

 
  

 
  

 
  

 
Net unrealized
gains (losses)
included in
income related
to assets and
liabilities held
at period end

  
(in millions)
Balance,
beginning
of period

 
Net
income

 
Other
compre-
hensive
income

 
 
Transfers
into
Level 3

 
Transfers
out of
Level 3

 
Balance,
end of
period

 
(2)
Quarter ended June 30, 2017
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
  
Trading assets:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
  
Securities of U.S. states and
political subdivisions
$
3

 

 

 
6

 

 

 
9

 

  
Collateralized loan obligations
398

 
(7
)
 

 
12

 

 

 
403

 
7

  
Corporate debt securities
37

 
1

 

 
(12
)
 

 

 
26

 
(1
)
  
Mortgage-backed securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  
Asset-backed securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  
Equity securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  
Total trading securities
438

 
(6
)
 

 
6

 

 

 
438

 
6

  
Other trading assets
26

 
(1
)
 

 
(2
)
 
16

 

 
39

 
(1
)
 
Total trading assets
464

 
(7
)
 

 
4

 
16

 

 
477

 
5

(3)
Available-for-sale securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
  
Securities of U.S. states and
political subdivisions
1,360

 
1

 
2

 
618

 

 
(424
)
 
1,557

 

  
Mortgage-backed securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
  
  
Residential
1

 

 

 

 

 

 
1

 

  
Commercial
89

 
(3
)
 
(5
)
 
(6
)
 

 

 
75

 
(7
)
  
Total mortgage-backed securities
90

 
(3
)
 
(5
)
 
(6
)
 

 

 
76

 
(7
)
 
Corporate debt securities
391

 

 
2

 
(17
)
 

 

 
376

 

  
Collateralized loan and other
debt obligations
964

 
5

 
4

 
29

 

 

 
1,002

 

  
Asset-backed securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
  
  
Automobile loans and leases

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  
Other asset-backed securities
845

 

 
1

 
26

 

 

 
872

 

  
Total asset-backed securities
845

 

 
1

 
26

 

 

 
872

 

  
Total debt securities
3,650

 
3

 
4

 
650

 

 
(424
)
 
3,883

 
(7
)
(4)
Marketable equity securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
  
Perpetual preferred securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  
Other marketable equity securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  
Total marketable
equity securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(5)
Total available-for-sale
securities
3,650

 
3

 
4

 
650

 

 
(424
)
 
3,883

 
(7
)
  
Mortgages held for sale
957

 
(1
)
 

 
25

 
19

 
(5
)
 
995

 

(6)
Loans
505

 

 

 
(62
)
 

 

 
443

 
(4
)
(6)
Mortgage servicing rights (residential) (7)
13,208

 
(847
)
 

 
428

 

 

 
12,789

 
(360
)
(6)
Net derivative assets and liabilities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
  
  
Interest rate contracts
218

 
258

 

 
(361
)
 

 

 
115

 
12

  
Commodity contracts
19

 

 

 

 

 
(2
)
 
17

 
2

  
Equity contracts
(299
)
 
(14
)
 

 
(80
)
 

 
(78
)
 
(471
)
 
(109
)
  
Foreign exchange contracts
3

 
1

 

 

 

 

 
4

 
1

  
Credit contracts
87

 
28

 

 
(43
)
 

 

 
72

 
(17
)
  
Other derivative contracts
(36
)
 
3

 

 
(1
)
 

 

 
(34
)
 
2

  
Total derivative contracts
(8
)
 
276

 

 
(485
)
 

 
(80
)
 
(297
)
 
(109
)
(8)
Other assets
3,740

 
220

 

 
(1
)
 
1

 

 
3,960

 
226

(5)
Short sale liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(3)
Other liabilities
(4
)
 
1

 

 

 

 

 
(3
)
 

(6)
(1)
See Table 13.5 for detail.
(2)
Represents only net gains (losses) that are due to changes in economic conditions and management’s estimates of fair value and excludes changes due to the collection/realization of cash flows over time.
(3)
Included in net gains (losses) from trading activities and other noninterest income in the income statement.
(4)
Included in net gains (losses) from debt securities in the income statement.
(5)
Included in net gains (losses) from equity investments in the income statement.
(6)
Included in mortgage banking and other noninterest income in the income statement.
(7)
For more information on the changes in mortgage servicing rights, see Note 8 (Mortgage Banking Activities).
(8)
Included in mortgage banking, trading activities, equity investments and other noninterest income in the income statement.
 
(continued on following page)




139


(continued from previous page)
 
Table 13.5 presents gross purchases, sales, issuances and settlements related to the changes in Level 3 assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis for the quarter ended June 30, 2017 .
Table 13.5: Gross Purchases, Sales, Issuances and Settlements – Level 3 – Quarter ended June 30, 2017
(in millions)
Purchases

 
Sales

 
Issuances

 
Settlements

 
Net

Quarter ended June 30, 2017
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Trading assets:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
$
6

 

 

 

 
6

Collateralized loan obligations
87

 
(53
)
 

 
(22
)
 
12

Corporate debt securities
3

 
(15
)
 

 

 
(12
)
Mortgage-backed securities

 

 

 

 

Asset-backed securities

 

 

 

 

Equity securities

 

 

 

 

Total trading securities
96

 
(68
)
 

 
(22
)
 
6

Other trading assets

 

 

 
(2
)
 
(2
)
Total trading assets
96

 
(68
)
 

 
(24
)
 
4

Available-for-sale securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions

 

 
655

 
(37
)
 
618

Mortgage-backed securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Residential

 

 

 

 

Commercial

 

 

 
(6
)
 
(6
)
Total mortgage-backed securities

 

 

 
(6
)
 
(6
)
Corporate debt securities

 

 

 
(17
)
 
(17
)
Collateralized loan and other debt obligations
57

 

 

 
(28
)
 
29

Asset-backed securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Automobile loans and leases

 

 

 

 

Other asset-backed securities

 

 
161

 
(135
)
 
26

Total asset-backed securities

 

 
161

 
(135
)
 
26

Total debt securities
57

 

 
816

 
(223
)
 
650

Marketable equity securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Perpetual preferred securities

 

 

 

 

Other marketable equity securities

 

 

 

 

Total marketable equity securities

 

 

 

 

Total available-for-sale securities
57

 

 
816

 
(223
)
 
650

Mortgages held for sale
18

 
(88
)
 
133

 
(38
)
 
25

Loans
2

 

 
3

 
(67
)
 
(62
)
Mortgage servicing rights (residential) (1)

 
(8
)
 
436

 

 
428

Net derivative assets and liabilities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Interest rate contracts

 

 

 
(361
)
 
(361
)
Commodity contracts

 

 

 

 

Equity contracts

 
(69
)
 

 
(11
)
 
(80
)
Foreign exchange contracts

 

 

 

 

Credit contracts
2

 
(1
)
 

 
(44
)
 
(43
)
Other derivative contracts

 

 

 
(1
)
 
(1
)
Total derivative contracts
2

 
(70
)
 

 
(417
)
 
(485
)
Other assets

 
(1
)
 

 

 
(1
)
Short sale liabilities

 

 

 

 

Other liabilities

 

 

 

 

(1)
For more information on the changes in mortgage servicing rights, see Note 8 (Mortgage Banking Activities).


140

Note 13: Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities ( continued )

The changes in Level 3 assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis for the quarter ended June 30, 2016 , are presented in Table 13.6 .
Table 13.6: Changes in Level 3 Fair Value Assets and Liabilities on a Recurring Basis – Quarter ended June 30, 2016
  
Balance,
beginning
of period

 
Total net gains
(losses) included in
 
 
Purchases,
sales,
issuances
and
settlements,
net (1)

 
  

 
  

 
  

 
Net unrealized
gains (losses)
included in
income related
to assets and
liabilities held
at period end

  
(in millions)
 
Net
income 

 
Other
compre-
hensive
income

 
 
Transfers
into
Level 3

 
Transfers
out of
Level 3

 
Balance,
end of
period

 
(2)
Quarter ended June 30, 2016
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
  
Trading assets:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
  
Securities of U.S. states and
political subdivisions
$
8

 

 

 
(1
)
 

 

 
7

 

  
Collateralized loan obligations
268

 
1

 

 
(20
)
 

 

 
249

 
(4
)
  
Corporate debt securities
33

 
(3
)
 

 
6

 

 

 
36

 
(2
)
  
Mortgage-backed securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  
Asset-backed securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  
Equity securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  
Total trading securities
309

 
(2
)
 

 
(15
)
 

 

 
292

 
(6
)
  
Other trading assets
32

 
1

 

 

 

 

 
33

 
3

  
Total trading assets
341

 
(1
)
 

 
(15
)
 

 

 
325

 
(3
)
(3)
Available-for-sale securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
  
Securities of U.S. states and
political subdivisions
1,457

 
3

 
1

 
348

 

 
(16
)
 
1,793

 

  
Mortgage-backed securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
  
  
Residential
1

 

 

 

 

 

 
1

 

  
Commercial
73

 

 

 
21

 

 

 
94

 

  
Total mortgage-backed securities
74

 

 

 
21

 

 

 
95

 

  
Corporate debt securities
453

 
3

 
9

 
6

 

 

 
471

 

  
Collateralized loan and other
debt obligations
813

 
8

 
4

 
126

 

 

 
951

 

  
Asset-backed securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
Automobile loans and leases

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  
Other asset-backed securities
1,240

 
2

 
(7
)
 
(118
)
 

 

 
1,117

 
(4
)
  
Total asset-backed securities
1,240

 
2

 
(7
)
 
(118
)
 

 

 
1,117

 
(4
)
  
Total debt securities
4,037

 
16

 
7

 
383

 

 
(16
)
 
4,427

 
(4
)
(4)
Marketable equity securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
  
Perpetual preferred securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  
Other marketable equity securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  
Total marketable equity securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(5)
Total available-for-sale
securities
4,037

 
16

 
7

 
383

 

 
(16
)
 
4,427

 
(4
)
  
Mortgages held for sale
1,071

 
6

 

 
(11
)
 
25

 
(7
)
 
1,084

 
6

(6)
Loans
5,221

 
(3
)
 

 
(186
)
 

 

 
5,032

 
(4
)
(6)
Mortgage servicing rights (residential) (7)
11,333

 
(1,392
)
 

 
455

 

 

 
10,396

 
(824
)
(6)
Net derivative assets and liabilities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
  
  
Interest rate contracts
501

 
660

 

 
(471
)
 

 

 
690

 
357

  
Commodity contracts
11

 
6

 

 
1

 
3

 

 
21

 
9

  
Equity contracts
(283
)
 
9

 

 
10

 

 
12

 
(252
)
 
(7
)
  
Foreign exchange contracts

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  
Credit contracts

 
(1
)
 

 
62

 

 

 
61

 
(4
)
  
Other derivative contracts
(77
)
 
(9
)
 

 
(2
)
 

 

 
(88
)
 
(10
)
  
Total derivative contracts
152

 
665

 

 
(400
)
 
3

 
12

 
432

 
345

(8)
Other assets
3,097

 
(181
)
 

 
122

 

 

 
3,038

 
(181
)
(5)
Short sale liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(3)
Other liabilities
(5
)
 

 

 

 

 

 
(5
)
 

(6)
(1)
See Table 13.7 for detail.
(2)
Represents only net gains (losses) that are due to changes in economic conditions and management’s estimates of fair value and excludes changes due to the collection/realization of cash flows over time.
(3)
Included in net gains (losses) from trading activities and other noninterest income in the income statement.
(4)
Included in net gains (losses) from debt securities in the income statement.
(5)
Included in net gains (losses) from equity investments in the income statement.
(6)
Included in mortgage banking and other noninterest income in the income statement.
(7)
For more information on the changes in mortgage servicing rights, see Note 8 (Mortgage Banking Activities).
(8)
Included in mortgage banking, trading activities, equity investments and other noninterest income in the income statement.
 
(continued on following page)





141


(continued from previous page)
 
Table 13.7 presents gross purchases, sales, issuances and settlements related to the changes in Level 3 assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis for the quarter ended June 30, 2016 .
Table 13.7: Gross Purchases, Sales, Issuances and Settlements – Level 3 – Quarter ended June 30, 2016
(in millions)
Purchases

 
Sales

 
Issuances

 
Settlements

 
Net

Quarter ended June 30, 2016
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Trading assets:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
$
2

 
(2
)
 

 
(1
)
 
(1
)
Collateralized loan obligations
134

 
(154
)
 

 

 
(20
)
Corporate debt securities
10

 
(4
)
 

 

 
6

Mortgage-backed securities

 

 

 

 

Asset-backed securities

 

 

 

 

Equity securities

 

 

 

 

Total trading securities
146

 
(160
)
 

 
(1
)
 
(15
)
Other trading assets

 

 

 

 

Total trading assets
146

 
(160
)
 

 
(1
)
 
(15
)
Available-for-sale securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions

 
(7
)
 
459

 
(104
)
 
348

Mortgage-backed securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
Residential

 

 

 

 

Commercial
22

 

 

 
(1
)
 
21

Total mortgage-backed securities
22

 

 

 
(1
)
 
21

Corporate debt securities
6

 

 

 

 
6

Collateralized loan and other debt obligations
188

 
(4
)
 

 
(58
)
 
126

Asset-backed securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
Automobile loans and leases

 

 

 

 

Other asset-backed securities

 
(28
)
 
38

 
(128
)
 
(118
)
Total asset-backed securities

 
(28
)
 
38

 
(128
)
 
(118
)
Total debt securities
216

 
(39
)
 
497

 
(291
)
 
383

Marketable equity securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Perpetual preferred securities

 

 

 

 

Other marketable equity securities

 

 

 

 

Total marketable equity securities

 

 

 

 

Total available-for-sale securities
216

 
(39
)
 
497

 
(291
)
 
383

Mortgages held for sale
22

 
(152
)
 
164

 
(45
)
 
(11
)
Loans
8

 

 
84

 
(278
)
 
(186
)
Mortgage servicing rights (residential) (1)

 
(22
)
 
477

 

 
455

Net derivative assets and liabilities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
Interest rate contracts

 

 

 
(471
)
 
(471
)
Commodity contracts

 

 

 
1

 
1

Equity contracts
16

 
1

 

 
(7
)
 
10

Foreign exchange contracts

 

 

 

 

Credit contracts

 
(1
)
 

 
63

 
62

Other derivative contracts

 

 

 
(2
)
 
(2
)
Total derivative contracts
16

 

 

 
(416
)
 
(400
)
Other assets
122

 

 

 

 
122

Short sale liabilities

 

 

 

 

Other liabilities

 

 

 

 

(1)
For more information on the changes in mortgage servicing rights, see Note 8 (Mortgage Banking Activities).


142

Note 13: Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities ( continued )

The changes in Level 3 assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis for the first half of 2017 , are presented in Table 13.8 .
Table 13.8: Changes in Level 3 Fair Value Assets and Liabilities on a Recurring Basis – Six months ended June 30, 2017
  
  

 
Total net gains
(losses) included in
 
 
Purchases,
sales,
issuances
and
settlements,
net (1)

 
  

 
  

 
  

 
Net unrealized
gains (losses)
included in
income related
to assets and
liabilities held
at period end

  
(in millions)
Balance,
beginning
of period

 
Net
income

 
Other
compre-
hensive
income

 
 
Transfers
into
Level 3

 
Transfers
out of
Level 3

 
Balance,
end of
period

 
(2)
Six months ended June 30, 2017
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
  
Trading assets:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
  
Securities of U.S. states and
political subdivisions
$
3

 

 

 
6

 

 

 
9

 

  
Collateralized loan obligations
309

 
(3
)
 

 
97

 

 

 
403

 
7

  
Corporate debt securities
34

 
1

 

 
(11
)
 
3

 
(1
)
 
26

 

  
Mortgage-backed securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  
Asset-backed securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  
Equity securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  
Total trading securities
346

 
(2
)
 

 
92

 
3

 
(1
)
 
438

 
7

  
Other trading assets
28

 
(3
)
 

 
(2
)
 
16

 

 
39

 
(1
)
 
Total trading assets
374

 
(5
)
 

 
90

 
19

 
(1
)
 
477

 
6

(3)
Available-for-sale securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
  
Securities of U.S. states and
political subdivisions
1,140

 
1

 
4

 
903

 
5

 
(496
)
 
1,557

 

  
Mortgage-backed securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
  
  
Residential
1

 

 

 

 

 

 
1

 

  
Commercial
91

 
(6
)
 
(1
)
 
(9
)
 

 

 
75

 
(11
)
  
Total mortgage-backed securities
92

 
(6
)
 
(1
)
 
(9
)
 

 

 
76

 
(11
)
 
Corporate debt securities
432

 
(14
)
 
10

 
(52
)
 

 

 
376

 

  
Collateralized loan and other
debt obligations
879

 
10

 
45

 
68

 

 

 
1,002

 

  
Asset-backed securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
  
  
Automobile loans and leases

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  
Other asset-backed securities
962

 

 
3

 
(93
)
 

 

 
872

 

  
Total asset-backed securities
962

 

 
3

 
(93
)
 

 

 
872

 

  
Total debt securities
3,505

 
(9
)
 
61

 
817

 
5

 
(496
)
 
3,883

 
(11
)
(4)
Marketable equity securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
  
Perpetual preferred securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  
Other marketable equity securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  
Total marketable
equity securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(5)
Total available-for-sale
securities
3,505

 
(9
)
 
61

 
817

 
5

 
(496
)
 
3,883

 
(11
)
  
Mortgages held for sale
985

 
(10
)
 

 
(35
)
 
61

 
(6
)
 
995

 
(10
)
(6)
Loans
758

 
(6
)
 

 
(309
)
 

 

 
443

 
(8
)
(6)
Mortgage servicing rights (residential) (7)
12,959

 
(1,134
)
 

 
964

 

 

 
12,789

 
(186
)
(6)
Net derivative assets and liabilities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
  
  
Interest rate contracts
121

 
467

 

 
(473
)
 

 

 
115

 
(7
)
  
Commodity contracts
23

 
2

 

 
(6
)
 

 
(2
)
 
17

 
14

  
Equity contracts
(267
)
 
(58
)
 

 
(43
)
 
(22
)
 
(81
)
 
(471
)
 
(189
)
  
Foreign exchange contracts
12

 
(8
)
 

 

 

 

 
4

 
(5
)
  
Credit contracts
77

 
35

 

 
(40
)
 

 

 
72

 
(32
)
  
Other derivative contracts
(47
)
 
14

 

 
(1
)
 

 

 
(34
)
 
14

  
Total derivative contracts
(81
)
 
452

 

 
(563
)
 
(22
)
 
(83
)
 
(297
)
 
(205
)
(8)
Other assets
3,259

 
701

 

 
(1
)
 
1

 

 
3,960

 
711

(5)
Short sale liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(3)
Other liabilities
(4
)
 
1

 

 

 

 

 
(3
)
 

(6)
(1)
See Table 13.9 for detail.
(2)
Represents only net gains (losses) that are due to changes in economic conditions and management’s estimates of fair value and excludes changes due to the collection/realization of cash flows over time.
(3)
Included in net gains (losses) from trading activities and other noninterest income in the income statement.
(4)
Included in net gains (losses) from debt securities in the income statement.
(5)
Included in net gains (losses) from equity investments in the income statement.
(6)
Included in mortgage banking and other noninterest income in the income statement.
(7)
For more information on the changes in mortgage servicing rights, see Note 8 (Mortgage Banking Activities).
(8)
Included in mortgage banking, trading activities, equity investments and other noninterest income in the income statement.
 
(continued on following page)


143


(continued from previous page)
 
Table 13.9 presents gross purchases, sales, issuances and settlements related to the changes in Level 3 assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis for the first half of 2017 .
Table 13.9: Gross Purchases, Sales, Issuances and Settlements – Level 3 – Six months ended June 30, 2017
(in millions)
Purchases

 
Sales

 
Issuances

 
Settlements

 
Net

Six months ended June 30, 2017
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Trading assets:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
$
7

 
(1
)
 

 

 
6

Collateralized loan obligations
286

 
(129
)
 

 
(60
)
 
97

Corporate debt securities
9

 
(20
)
 

 

 
(11
)
Mortgage-backed securities

 

 

 

 

Asset-backed securities

 

 

 

 

Equity securities

 

 

 

 

Total trading securities
302

 
(150
)
 

 
(60
)
 
92

Other trading assets

 

 

 
(2
)
 
(2
)
Total trading assets
302

 
(150
)
 

 
(62
)
 
90

Available-for-sale securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions

 

 
1,001

 
(98
)
 
903

Mortgage-backed securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Residential

 

 

 

 

Commercial

 

 

 
(9
)
 
(9
)
Total mortgage-backed securities

 

 

 
(9
)
 
(9
)
Corporate debt securities
4

 

 

 
(56
)
 
(52
)
Collateralized loan and other debt obligations
129

 

 

 
(61
)
 
68

Asset-backed securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Automobile loans and leases

 

 

 

 

Other asset-backed securities

 

 
182

 
(275
)
 
(93
)
Total asset-backed securities

 

 
182

 
(275
)
 
(93
)
Total debt securities
133

 

 
1,183

 
(499
)
 
817

Marketable equity securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Perpetual preferred securities

 

 

 

 

Other marketable equity securities

 

 

 

 

Total marketable equity securities

 

 

 

 

Total available-for-sale securities
133

 

 
1,183

 
(499
)
 
817

Mortgages held for sale
40

 
(244
)
 
239

 
(70
)
 
(35
)
Loans
3

 
(129
)
 
9

 
(192
)
 
(309
)
Mortgage servicing rights (residential) (1)

 
(55
)
 
1,019

 

 
964

Net derivative assets and liabilities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Interest rate contracts

 

 

 
(473
)
 
(473
)
Commodity contracts

 

 

 
(6
)
 
(6
)
Equity contracts

 
(69
)
 

 
26

 
(43
)
Foreign exchange contracts

 

 

 

 

Credit contracts
4

 
(2
)
 

 
(42
)
 
(40
)
Other derivative contracts

 

 

 
(1
)
 
(1
)
Total derivative contracts
4

 
(71
)
 

 
(496
)
 
(563
)
Other assets

 
(1
)
 

 

 
(1
)
Short sale liabilities

 

 

 

 

Other liabilities

 

 

 

 

(1)
For more information on the changes in mortgage servicing rights, see Note 8 (Mortgage Banking Activities).


144

Note 13: Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities ( continued )

The changes in Level 3 assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis for the first half of 2016 , are presented in Table 13.10 .

Table 13.10: Changes in Level 3 Fair Value Assets and Liabilities on a Recurring Basis – Six months ended June 30, 2016
  
Balance,
beginning
of period

 
Total net gains
(losses) included in
 
 
Purchases,
sales,
issuances
and
settlements,
net (1)

 
  

 
  

 
  

 
Net unrealized
gains (losses)
included in
income related
to assets and
liabilities held
at period end

  
(in millions)
 
Net
income 

 
Other
compre-
hensive
income

 
 
Transfers
into
Level 3

 
Transfers
out of
Level 3

 
Balance,
end of
period

 
(2)
Six months ended June 30, 2016
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
  
Trading assets:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
  
Securities of U.S. states and
political subdivisions
$
8

 

 

 
(1
)
 

 

 
7

 

  
Collateralized loan obligations
343

 
(24
)
 

 
(59
)
 

 
(11
)
 
249

 
(25
)
  
Corporate debt securities
56

 
(8
)
 

 
(12
)
 

 

 
36

 
(6
)
  
Mortgage-backed securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  
Asset-backed securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  
Equity securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  
Total trading securities
407

 
(32
)
 

 
(72
)
 

 
(11
)
 
292

 
(31
)
  
Other trading assets
34

 
(1
)
 

 

 

 

 
33

 
3

  
Total trading assets
441

 
(33
)
 

 
(72
)
 

 
(11
)
 
325

 
(28
)
(3)
Available-for-sale securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
  
Securities of U.S. states and
political subdivisions
1,500

 
4

 
4

 
221

 
80

 
(16
)
 
1,793

 

  
Mortgage-backed securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
  
  
Residential
1

 

 

 

 

 

 
1

 

  
Commercial
73

 

 

 
21

 

 

 
94

 

  
Total mortgage-backed securities
74

 

 

 
21

 

 

 
95

 

  
Corporate debt securities
405

 
5

 
28

 
33

 

 

 
471

 

  
Collateralized loan and other
debt obligations
565

 
23

 
(20
)
 
383

 

 

 
951

 

  
Asset-backed securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
  
  
Automobile loans and leases

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  
Other asset-backed securities
1,182

 
2

 
(7
)
 
(60
)
 

 

 
1,117

 
(4
)
  
Total asset-backed securities
1,182

 
2

 
(7
)
 
(60
)
 

 

 
1,117

 
(4
)
  
Total debt securities
3,726

 
34

 
5

 
598

 
80

 
(16
)
 
4,427

 
(4
)
(4)
Marketable equity securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
  
Perpetual preferred securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  
Other marketable equity securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  
Total marketable equity securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(5)
Total available-for-sale
securities
3,726

 
34

 
5

 
598

 
80

 
(16
)
 
4,427

 
(4
)
  
Mortgages held for sale
1,082

 
30

 

 
(73
)
 
54

 
(9
)
 
1,084

 
27

(6)
Loans
5,316

 
(4
)
 

 
(280
)
 

 

 
5,032

 
(6
)
(6)
Mortgage servicing rights (residential) (7)
12,415

 
(2,840
)
 

 
821

 

 

 
10,396

 
(1,781
)
(6)
Net derivative assets and liabilities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
  
  
Interest rate contracts
288

 
1,259

 

 
(850
)
 

 
(7
)
 
690

 
458

  
Commodity contracts
12

 
8

 

 
(2
)
 
3

 

 
21

 
13

  
Equity contracts
(111
)
 
7

 

 
(130
)
 
25

 
(43
)
 
(252
)
 
(160
)
  
Foreign exchange contracts

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  
Credit contracts
(3
)
 
8

 

 
56

 

 

 
61

 
4

  
Other derivative contracts
(58
)
 
(30
)
 

 

 

 

 
(88
)
 
(30
)
  
Total derivative contracts
128

 
1,252

 

 
(926
)
 
28

 
(50
)
 
432

 
285

(8)
Other assets
3,065

 
(238
)
 

 
211

 

 

 
3,038

 
(239
)
(5)
Short sale liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(3)
Other liabilities
(30
)
 

 

 
25

 

 

 
(5
)
 

(6)
(1)
See Table 13.11 for detail.
(2)
Represents only net gains (losses) that are due to changes in economic conditions and management’s estimates of fair value and excludes changes due to the collection/realization of cash flows over time.
(3)
Included in net gains (losses) from trading activities and other noninterest income in the income statement.
(4)
Included in net gains (losses) from debt securities in the income statement.
(5)
Included in net gains (losses) from equity investments in the income statement.
(6)
Included in mortgage banking and other noninterest income in the income statement.
(7)
For more information on the changes in mortgage servicing rights, see Note 8 (Mortgage Banking Activities).
(8)
Included in mortgage banking, trading activities, equity investments and other noninterest income in the income statement.
 
(continued on following page)

145


(continued from previous page)

Table 13.11 presents gross purchases, sales, issuances and settlements related to the changes in Level 3 assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis for the first half of 2016 .
Table 13.11: Gross Purchases, Sales, Issuances and Settlements – Level 3 – Six months ended June 30, 2016
(in millions)
Purchases

 
Sales

 
Issuances

 
Settlements

 
Net

Six months ended June 30, 2016
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Trading assets:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
$
2

 
(2
)
 

 
(1
)
 
(1
)
Collateralized loan obligations
190

 
(249
)
 

 

 
(59
)
Corporate debt securities
13

 
(25
)
 

 

 
(12
)
Mortgage-backed securities

 

 

 

 

Asset-backed securities

 

 

 

 

Equity securities

 

 

 

 

Total trading securities
205

 
(276
)
 

 
(1
)
 
(72
)
Other trading assets

 

 

 

 

Total trading assets
205

 
(276
)
 

 
(1
)
 
(72
)
Available-for-sale securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Securities of U.S. states and political subdivisions
28

 
(7
)
 
475

 
(275
)
 
221

Mortgage-backed securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
Residential

 

 

 

 

Commercial
22

 

 

 
(1
)
 
21

Total mortgage-backed securities
22

 

 

 
(1
)
 
21

Corporate debt securities
34

 

 

 
(1
)
 
33

Collateralized loan and other debt obligations
489

 
(4
)
 

 
(102
)
 
383

Asset-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Automobile loans and leases

 

 

 

 

Other asset-backed securities

 
(28
)
 
198

 
(230
)
 
(60
)
Total asset-backed securities

 
(28
)
 
198

 
(230
)
 
(60
)
Total debt securities
573

 
(39
)
 
673

 
(609
)
 
598

Marketable equity securities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Perpetual preferred securities

 

 

 

 

Other marketable equity securities

 

 

 

 

Total marketable equity securities

 

 

 

 

Total available-for-sale securities
573

 
(39
)
 
673

 
(609
)
 
598

Mortgages held for sale
44

 
(311
)
 
282

 
(88
)
 
(73
)
Loans
12

 

 
172

 
(464
)
 
(280
)
Mortgage servicing rights (residential) (1)

 
(22
)
 
843

 

 
821

Net derivative assets and liabilities:
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
Interest rate contracts

 

 

 
(850
)
 
(850
)
Commodity contracts

 

 

 
(2
)
 
(2
)
Equity contracts
29

 
(146
)
 

 
(13
)
 
(130
)
Foreign exchange contracts

 

 

 

 

Credit contracts
3

 
(1
)
 

 
54

 
56

Other derivative contracts

 

 

 

 

Total derivative contracts
32

 
(147
)
 

 
(811
)
 
(926
)
Other assets
211

 

 

 

 
211

Short sale liabilities

 

 

 

 

Other liabilities

 

 

 
25

 
25

(1)
For more information on the changes in mortgage servicing rights, see Note 8 (Mortgage Banking Activities).

Table 13.12 and Table 13.13 provide quantitative information about the valuation techniques and significant unobservable inputs used in the valuation of substantially all of our Level 3 assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis for which we use an internal model.
The significant unobservable inputs for Level 3 assets and liabilities that are valued using fair values obtained from third party vendors are not included in the table, as the specific inputs applied are not provided by the vendor. In addition, the table excludes the valuation techniques and significant unobservable inputs for certain classes of Level 3 assets and liabilities measured using an internal model that we consider, both individually and in the aggregate, insignificant relative to our overall Level 3 assets and liabilities. We made this determination
 
based upon an evaluation of each class, which considered the magnitude of the positions, nature of the unobservable inputs and potential for significant changes in fair value due to changes in those inputs. For information on how changes in significant unobservable inputs affect the fair values of Level 3 assets and liabilities, see Note 17 (Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities) to Financial Statements in our 2016 Form 10-K. 

146

Note 13: Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities ( continued )

Table 13.12: Valuation Techniques – Recurring Basis – June 30, 2017

($ in millions, except cost to service amounts)
Fair Value Level 3

 
Valuation Technique(s)
 
Significant Unobservable Input
 
Range of Inputs 
 
 
 
Weighted
Average (1)

June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trading and available-for-sale securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. states and
political subdivisions:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Government, healthcare and
other revenue bonds
$
1,324

 
Discounted cash flow
 
Discount rate
 
1.2

-
5.0

%
 
2.1

Auction rate securities and other
municipal bonds
34

 
Discounted cash flow
 
Discount rate
 
4.2

-
4.4

 
 
4.3

 
208

 
Vendor priced
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Collateralized loan and other debt
obligations (2)
403

 
Market comparable pricing
 
Comparability adjustment
 
(19.5
)
-
20.8

 
 
2.8

 
1,002

 
Vendor priced
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Asset-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Diversified payment rights (3)
358

 
Discounted cash flow
 
Discount rate
 
1.7

-
4.0

 
 
2.9

Other commercial and consumer
488

(4)
Discounted cash flow
 
Discount rate
 
3.3

-
4.7

 
 
4.0

 
 
 
 
 
Weighted average life
 
0.3

-
3.7

yrs
 
2.2

 
26

 
Vendor priced
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Mortgages held for sale (residential)
969

 
Discounted cash flow
 
Default rate
 
0.5

-
7.0

%
 
1.7

 
 
 
 
 
Discount rate
 
1.1

-
6.9

 
 
5.2

 
 
 
 
 
Loss severity
 
0.0

-
45.2

 
 
27.1

 
 
 
 
 
Prepayment rate
 
7.1

-
18.3

 
 
10.2

 
26

 
Market comparable pricing
 
Comparability adjustment
 
(53.3
)
-
0.0

 
 
(38.5
)
Loans
443

(5)
Discounted cash flow
 
Discount rate
 
0.0

-
7.1

 
 
0.3

 
 
 
 
 
Prepayment rate
 
9.1

-
100.0

 
 
94.4

Mortgage servicing rights (residential)
12,789

 
Discounted cash flow
 
Cost to service per loan (6)
 
$
79

-
566

 
 
149

 
 
 
 
 
Discount rate
 
6.5

-
15.2

%
 
6.8

 
 
 
 
 
Prepayment rate (7)
 
9.6

-
21.7

 
 
10.5

Net derivative assets and (liabilities):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts
103

 
Discounted cash flow
 
Default rate
 
0.0

-
6.8

 
 
1.7

 
 
 
 
 
Loss severity
 
50.0

-
50.0

 
 
50.0

 
 
 
 
 
Prepayment rate
 
2.8

-
12.5

 
 
10.0

Interest rate contracts: derivative loan
commitments
12

 
Discounted cash flow
 
Fall-out factor
 
1.0

-
99.0

 
 
17.2

 
 
 
 
 
Initial-value servicing
 
(41.8
)
-
111.8

bps
 
30.8

Equity contracts
95

 
Discounted cash flow
 
Conversion factor
 
(10.1
)
-
0.0

%
 
(7.9
)
 
 
 
 
 
Weighted average life
 
0.5

-
2.5

yrs
 
1.6

 
(566
)
 
Option model
 
Correlation factor
 
(77.0
)
-
98.5

%
 
37.2

 
 
 
 
 
Volatility factor
 
5.0

-
118.2

 
 
20.0

Credit contracts
(4
)
 
Market comparable pricing
 
Comparability adjustment
 
(21.1
)
-
36.0

 
 
(1.5
)
 
76

 
Option model
 
Credit spread
 
0.0

-
10.1

 
 
1.0

 
 
 
 
 
Loss severity
 
12.0

-
60.0

 
 
48.6

Other assets: nonmarketable equity investments
10

 
Discounted cash flow
 
Discount rate
 
5.0

-
10.3

 
 
9.4

 
 
 
 
 
Volatility Factor
 
1.2

-
1.3

 
 
1.3

 
3,950

 
Market comparable pricing
 
Comparability adjustment
 
(20.1
)
-
(4.0
)
 
 
(15.1
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Insignificant Level 3 assets, net of liabilities
501

(8)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total level 3 assets, net of liabilities
$
22,247

(9)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1)
Weighted averages are calculated using outstanding unpaid principal balance for cash instruments, such as loans and securities, and notional amounts for derivative instruments.
(2)
Includes $998 million of collateralized debt obligations.
(3)
Securities backed by specified sources of current and future receivables generated from foreign originators.
(4)
A significant portion of the balance consists of investments in asset-backed securities that are revolving in nature, for which the timing of advances and repayments of principal are uncertain.
(5)
Consists of reverse mortgage loans.
(6)
The high end of the range of inputs is for servicing modified loans. For non-modified loans the range is $79 - $288 .
(7)
Includes a blend of prepayment speeds and expected defaults. Prepayment speeds are influenced by mortgage interest rates as well as our estimation of drivers of borrower behavior.
(8)
Represents the aggregate amount of Level 3 assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis that are individually and in the aggregate insignificant. The amount includes corporate debt securities, mortgage-backed securities, other trading assets, other liabilities and certain net derivative assets and liabilities, such as commodity contracts, foreign exchange contracts, and other derivative contracts.
(9)
Consists of total Level 3 assets of $24.2 billion and total Level 3 liabilities of $1.9 billion , before netting of derivative balances.


147


Table 13.13: Valuation Techniques – Recurring Basis – December 31, 2016

($ in millions, except cost to service amounts)
Fair Value Level 3

 
Valuation Technique(s)
 
Significant Unobservable Input
 
Range of Inputs 
 
 
 
Weighted
Average (1)

December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trading and available-for-sale securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities of U.S. states and
political subdivisions:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Government, healthcare and
other revenue bonds
$
906

 
Discounted cash flow
 
Discount rate
 
1.1

-
5.6

%
 
2.0

Auction rate securities and other
municipal bonds
29

 
Discounted cash flow
 
Discount rate
 
3.7

-
4.9

 
 
4.5

 
 
 
 
 
Weighted average life
 
3.6

-
3.6

yrs
 
3.6

 
208

 
Vendor priced
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Collateralized loan and other debt
obligations (2)
309

 
Market comparable pricing
 
Comparability adjustment
 
(15.5
)
-
20.3

%
 
2.9

 
879

 
Vendor priced
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Asset-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Diversified payment rights (3)
443

 
Discounted cash flow
 
Discount rate
 
1.9

-
4.8

 
 
3.3

Other commercial and consumer
492

(4)
Discounted cash flow
 
Discount rate
 
3.0

-
4.6

 
 
3.9

 
 
 
 
 
Weighted average life
 
0.8

-
4.2

yrs
 
2.9

 
27

 
Vendor priced
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Mortgages held for sale (residential)
955

 
Discounted cash flow
 
Default rate
 
0.5

-
7.9

%
 
1.9

 
 
 
 
 
Discount rate
 
1.1

-
6.9

 
 
5.1

 
 
 
 
 
Loss severity
 
0.1

-
42.5

 
 
26.9

 
 
 
 
 
Prepayment rate
 
6.3

-
17.1

 
 
10.0

 
30

 
Market comparable pricing
 
Comparability adjustment
 
(53.3
)
-
0.0

 
 
(37.8
)
Loans
758

(5)
Discounted cash flow
 
Discount rate
 
0.0

-
3.9

 
 
0.6

 
 
 
 
 
Prepayment rate
 
0.4

-
100.0

 
 
83.7

 
 
 
 
 
Utilization rate
 
0.0

-
0.8

 
 
0.1

Mortgage servicing rights (residential)
12,959

 
Discounted cash flow
 
Cost to service per loan (6)
 
$
79

-
598

 
 
155

 
 
 
 
 
Discount rate
 
6.5

-
18.4

%
 
6.8

 
 
 
 
 
Prepayment rate (7)
 
9.4

-
20.6

 
 
10.3

Net derivative assets and (liabilities):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts
127

 
Discounted cash flow
 
Default rate
 
0.1

-
6.8

 
 
2.1

 
 
 
 
 
Loss severity
 
50.0

-
50.0

 
 
50.0

 
 
 
 
 
Prepayment rate
 
2.8

-
12.5

 
 
9.6

Interest rate contracts: derivative loan
commitments
(6
)
 
Discounted cash flow
 
Fall-out factor
 
1.0

-
99.0

 
 
15.0

 
 
 
 
 
Initial-value servicing
 
(23.0
)
-
131.2

bps
 
56.8

Equity contracts
79

 
Discounted cash flow
 
Conversion factor
 
(10.6
)
-
0.0

%
 
(7.9
)
 
 
 
 
 
Weighted average life
 
1.0

-
3.0

yrs
 
2.0

 
(346
)
 
Option model
 
Correlation factor
 
(65.0
)
-
98.5

%
 
39.9

 
 
 
 
 
Volatility factor
 
6.5

-
100.0

 
 
20.7

Credit contracts
(28
)
 
Market comparable pricing
 
Comparability adjustment
 
(27.7
)
-
21.3

 
 
0.02

 
105

 
Option model
 
Credit spread
 
0.0

-
11.6

 
 
1.2

 
 
 
 
 
Loss severity
 
12.0

-
60.0

 
 
50.4

Other assets: nonmarketable equity investments
21

 
Discounted cash flow
 
Discount rate
 
5.0

-
10.3

 
 
8.7

 
 
 
 
 
Volatility Factor
 
0.3

-
2.4

 
 
1.1

 
3,238

 
Market comparable pricing
 
Comparability adjustment
 
(22.1
)
-
(5.5
)
 
 
(16.4
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Insignificant Level 3 assets, net of liabilities
570

(8)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total level 3 assets, net of liabilities
$
21,755

(9)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1)
Weighted averages are calculated using outstanding unpaid principal balance for cash instruments, such as loans and securities, and notional amounts for derivative instruments.
(2)
Includes $847 million of collateralized debt obligations.
(3)
Securities backed by specified sources of current and future receivables generated from foreign originators.
(4)
A significant portion of the balance consists of investments in asset-backed securities that are revolving in nature, for which the timing of advances and repayments of principal are uncertain.
(5)
Consists of reverse mortgage loans.
(6)
The high end of the range of inputs is for servicing modified loans. For non-modified loans the range is $79 - $293 .
(7)
Includes a blend of prepayment speeds and expected defaults. Prepayment speeds are influenced by mortgage interest rates as well as our estimation of drivers of borrower behavior.
(8)
Represents the aggregate amount of Level 3 assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis that are individually and in the aggregate insignificant. The amount includes corporate debt securities, mortgage-backed securities, other trading assets, other liabilities and certain net derivative assets and liabilities, such as commodity contracts, foreign exchange contracts, and other derivative contracts.
(9)
Consists of total Level 3 assets of $23.5 billion and total Level 3 liabilities of $1.7 billion , before netting of derivative balances.


148

Note 13: Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities ( continued )

The valuation techniques used for our Level 3 assets and liabilities, as presented in the previous tables, are described as follows: 
Discounted cash flow – Discounted cash flow valuation techniques generally consist of developing an estimate of future cash flows that are expected to occur over the life of an instrument and then discounting those cash flows at a rate of return that results in the fair value amount.
Market comparable pricing – Market comparable pricing valuation techniques are used to determine the fair value of certain instruments by incorporating known inputs, such as recent transaction prices, pending transactions, or prices of other similar investments that require significant adjustment to reflect differences in instrument characteristics.
Option model – Option model valuation techniques are generally used for instruments in which the holder has a contingent right or obligation based on the occurrence of a future event, such as the price of a referenced asset going above or below a predetermined strike price. Option models estimate the likelihood of the specified event occurring by incorporating assumptions such as volatility estimates, price of the underlying instrument and expected rate of return.
Vendor-priced  – Prices obtained from third party pricing vendors or brokers that are used to record the fair value of the asset or liability for which the related valuation technique and significant unobservable inputs are not provided.
 
Significant unobservable inputs presented in the previous tables are those we consider significant to the fair value of the Level 3 asset or liability. We consider unobservable inputs to be significant if by their exclusion the fair value of the Level 3 asset or liability would be impacted by a predetermined percentage change. We also consider qualitative factors, such as nature of the instrument, type of valuation technique used, and the significance of the unobservable inputs relative to other inputs used within the valuation. Following is a description of the significant unobservable inputs provided in the table. 
Comparability adjustment – is an adjustment made to observed market data, such as a transaction price in order to reflect dissimilarities in underlying collateral, issuer, rating, or other factors used within a market valuation approach, expressed as a percentage of an observed price.
Conversion Factor – is the risk-adjusted rate in which a particular instrument may be exchanged for another instrument upon settlement, expressed as a percentage change from a specified rate.
Correlation factor – is the likelihood of one instrument changing in price relative to another based on an established relationship expressed as a percentage of relative change in price over a period over time.

 
Cost to service – is the expected cost per loan of servicing a portfolio of loans, which includes estimates for unreimbursed expenses (including delinquency and foreclosure costs) that may occur as a result of servicing such loan portfolios.
Credit spread – is the portion of the interest rate in excess of a benchmark interest rate, such as Overnight Index Swap (OIS), LIBOR or U.S. Treasury rates, that when applied to an investment captures changes in the obligor’s creditworthiness.
Default rate – is an estimate of the likelihood of not collecting contractual amounts owed expressed as a constant default rate (CDR).
Discount rate – is a rate of return used to calculate the present value of the future expected cash flow to arrive at the fair value of an instrument. The discount rate consists of a benchmark rate component and a risk premium component. The benchmark rate component, for example, OIS, LIBOR or U.S. Treasury rates, is generally observable within the market and is necessary to appropriately reflect the time value of money. The risk premium component reflects the amount of compensation market participants require due to the uncertainty inherent in the instruments’ cash flows resulting from risks such as credit and liquidity.
Fall-out factor – is the expected percentage of loans associated with our interest rate lock commitment portfolio that are likely of not funding.
Initial-value servicing – is the estimated value of the underlying loan, including the value attributable to the embedded servicing right, expressed in basis points of outstanding unpaid principal balance.
Loss severity – is the estimated percentage of contractual cash flows lost in the event of a default.
Prepayment rate – is the estimated rate at which forecasted prepayments of principal of the related loan or debt instrument are expected to occur, expressed as a constant prepayment rate (CPR).
Utilization rate – is the estimated rate in which incremental portions of existing reverse mortgage credit lines are expected to be drawn by borrowers, expressed as an annualized rate.
Volatility factor – is the extent of change in price an item is estimated to fluctuate over a specified period of time expressed as a percentage of relative change in price over a period over time.
Weighted average life – is the weighted average number of years an investment is expected to remain outstanding based on its expected cash flows reflecting the estimated date the issuer will call or extend the maturity of the instrument or otherwise reflecting an estimate of the timing of an instrument’s cash flows whose timing is not contractually fixed.


149


Assets and Liabilities Recorded at Fair Value on a Nonrecurring Basis
We may be required, from time to time, to measure certain assets at fair value on a nonrecurring basis in accordance with GAAP. These adjustments to fair value usually result from application of
 
LOCOM accounting or write-downs of individual assets. Table 13.14 provides the fair value hierarchy and carrying amount of all assets that were still held as of June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , and for which a nonrecurring fair value adjustment was recorded during the periods presented.
Table 13.14: Fair Value on a Nonrecurring Basis
 
June 30, 2017
 
 
December 31, 2016
 
(in millions)
Level 1

 
Level 2

 
Level 3

 
Total

 
Level 1

 
Level 2

 
Level 3

 
Total

Mortgages held for sale (LOCOM) (1)
$

 
2,108

 
1,324

 
3,432

 

 
2,312

 
1,350

 
3,662

Loans held for sale

 
10

 

 
10

 

 
8

 

 
8

Loans:
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
Commercial

 
442

 

 
442

 

 
464

 

 
464

Consumer

 
349

 
5

 
354

 

 
822

 
7

 
829

Total loans (2)

 
791

 
5

 
796

 

 
1,286

 
7

 
1,293

Other assets - excluding nonmarketable equity investments at NAV (3)

 
188

 
178

 
366

 

 
233

 
412

 
645

Total included in the fair value hierarchy
$

 
3,097

 
1,507

 
4,604

 

 
3,839

 
1,769

 
5,608

Other assets - nonmarketable equity investments at NAV (4)


 


 


 
4

 


 


 


 
13

Total assets at fair value on a nonrecurring basis


 


 


 
$
4,608

 


 


 


 
5,621

(1)
Consists of commercial mortgages and residential real estate 1-4 family first mortgage loans.
(2)
Represents the carrying value of loans for which nonrecurring adjustments are based on the appraised value of the collateral.
(3)
Includes the fair value of foreclosed real estate, other collateral owned, operating lease assets and nonmarketable equity investments.
(4)
Consists of certain nonmarketable equity investments that are measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis using NAV per share (or its equivalent) as a practical expedient and are excluded from the fair value hierarchy.

Table 13.15 presents the increase (decrease) in value of certain assets held at the end of the respective reporting periods presented for which a nonrecurring fair value adjustment was recognized during the periods presented.
Table 13.15: Change in Value of Assets with Nonrecurring Fair Value Adjustment
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
(in millions)
2017

 
2016

Mortgages held for sale (LOCOM)
$
14

 
30

Loans held for sale
(1
)
 

Loans:
 
 
  
Commercial
(186
)
 
(560
)
Consumer
(261
)
 
(431
)
Total loans (1)
(447
)
 
(991
)
Other assets (2)
(66
)
 
(259
)
Total
$
(500
)
 
(1,220
)
(1)
Represents write-downs of loans based on the appraised value of the collateral.
(2)
Includes the losses on foreclosed real estate and other collateral owned that were measured at fair value subsequent to their initial classification as foreclosed assets. Also includes impairment losses on nonmarketable equity investments. 

150

Note 13: Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities ( continued )

Table 13.16 provides quantitative information about the valuation techniques and significant unobservable inputs used in the valuation of substantially all of our Level 3 assets that are measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis using an internal model. The table is limited to financial instruments that had nonrecurring fair value adjustments during the periods presented.
We have excluded from the table valuation techniques and significant unobservable inputs for certain classes of Level 3
 
assets measured using an internal model that we consider, both individually and in the aggregate, insignificant relative to our overall Level 3 nonrecurring measurements. We made this determination based upon an evaluation of each class that considered the magnitude of the positions, nature of the unobservable inputs and potential for significant changes in fair value due to changes in those inputs.
 
Table 13.16: Valuation Techniques – Nonrecurring Basis
($ in millions)
Fair Value
Level 3

 
Valuation Technique(s)   (1)
 
Significant
Unobservable Inputs (1)
 
Range of inputs
 
Weighted
Average   (2)

June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential mortgages held for sale (LOCOM)
$
1,324

(3)
Discounted cash flow
 
Default rate
(4)
0.1
8.5
%
 
1.7
%
 
 
 
 
 
Discount rate
 
1.5
8.5

 
3.8

 
 
 
 
 
Loss severity
 
0.7
48.8

 
2.5

 
 
 
 
 
Prepayment rate
(5)
3.6
100.0

 
48.8

Other assets: nonmarketable equity investments
41

 
Discounted cash flow
 
Discount rate
 
5.0
15.0

 
10.0

Insignificant level 3 assets
142

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total
$
1,507

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential mortgages held for sale (LOCOM)
$
1,350

(3)
Discounted cash flow
 
Default rate
(4)
0.2
4.3
%
 
1.9
%
 
 
 
 
 
Discount rate
 
1.5
8.5

 
3.8

 
 
 
 
 
Loss severity
 
0.7
50.1

 
2.4

 
 
 
 
 
Prepayment rate
(5)
3.0
100.0

 
50.7

Other assets: nonmarketable equity investments
220

 
Discounted cash flow
 
Discount rate
 
4.7
9.3

 
7.3

Insignificant level 3 assets
199

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total
$
1,769

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1)
Refer to the narrative following Table 13.13 for a definition of the valuation technique(s) and significant unobservable inputs.
(2)
For residential MHFS, weighted averages are calculated using the outstanding unpaid principal balance of the loans.
(3)
Consists of approximately $1.3 billion of government insured/guaranteed loans purchased from GNMA-guaranteed mortgage securitizations at both June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , and $31 million and $33 million of other mortgage loans that are not government insured/guaranteed at June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016 , respectively.
(4)
Applies only to non-government insured/guaranteed loans.
(5)
Includes the impact on prepayment rate of expected defaults for government insured/guaranteed loans, which impact the frequency and timing of early resolution of loans.

Alternative Investments
We hold certain nonmarketable equity investments for which we use NAV per share (or its equivalent) as a practical expedient for fair value measurements, including estimated fair values for investments accounted for under the cost method. The investments consist of private equity funds that invest in equity and debt securities issued by private and publicly-held companies. The fair values of these investments and related unfunded commitments totaled $22 million and $30 million , respectively, at June 30, 2017 , and $48 million and $37 million , respectively, at December 31, 2016 . The investments do not allow redemptions. We receive distributions as the underlying assets of the funds liquidate, which we expect to occur through 2025 .  


151


Fair Value Option
The fair value option is an irrevocable election, generally only permitted upon initial recognition of financial assets or liabilities, to measure eligible financial instruments at fair value with changes in fair value reflected in earnings. We may elect the fair value option to align the measurement model with how the financial assets or liabilities are managed or to reduce complexity or accounting asymmetry. For more information, including the basis for our fair value option elections, see Note 17 (Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities) to Financial Statements in our 2016 Form 10-K.
 

Table 13.17 reflects differences between the fair value carrying amount of the assets for which we have elected the fair value option and the contractual aggregate unpaid principal amount at maturity.

 
Table 13.17: Fair Value Option
  
June 30, 2017
 
 
December 31, 2016
 
(in millions)
Fair value
carrying
amount

 
Aggregate
unpaid
principal

 
Fair value
carrying
amount
less
aggregate
unpaid
principal

 
Fair value
carrying
amount

 
Aggregate
unpaid
principal

 
Fair value
carrying
amount
less
aggregate
unpaid
principal

Trading assets – loans:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     Total loans
$
1,742

 
1,804

 
(62
)
 
1,332

 
1,418

 
(86
)
     Nonaccrual loans
65

 
73

 
(8
)
 
100

 
115

 
(15
)
Mortgages held for sale:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total loans
19,543

 
19,034

 
509

 
22,042

 
21,961

 
81

Nonaccrual loans
127

 
168

 
(41
)
 
136

 
182

 
(46
)
Loans 90 days or more past due and still accruing
11

 
15

 
(4
)
 
12

 
16

 
(4
)
Loans held for sale:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total loans

 
6

 
(6
)
 

 
6

 
(6
)
Nonaccrual loans

 
6

 
(6
)
 

 
6

 
(6
)
Loans:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total loans
443

 
469

 
(26
)
 
758

 
775

 
(17
)
Nonaccrual loans
272

 
296

 
(24
)
 
297

 
318

 
(21
)
Other assets (1)
3,986

 
N/A

 
N/A

 
3,275

 
N/A

 
N/A

(1)
Consists of nonmarketable equity investments carried at fair value. See Note 6 (Other Assets) for more information.


152

Note 13: Fair Values of Assets and Liabilities ( continued )

The assets accounted for under the fair value option are initially measured at fair value. Gains and losses from initial measurement and subsequent changes in fair value are recognized in earnings. The changes in fair value related to initial
 
measurement and subsequent changes in fair value included in earnings for these assets measured at fair value are shown in Table 13.18 by income statement line item.
Table 13.18: Fair Value Option – Changes in Fair Value Included in Earnings
  
2017
 
 
2016
 
(in millions)
Mortgage banking noninterest income

 
Net gains
(losses)
from
trading
activities

 
Other
noninterest
income

 
Mortgage
banking
noninterest
income

 
Net gains
(losses)
from
trading
activities

 
Other
noninterest
income

Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

Trading assets - loans
$

 
11

 
1

 

 
16

 
1

Mortgages held for sale
288

 

 

 
611

 

 

Loans

 

 

 

 

 
(3
)
Other assets

 

 
221

 

 

 
(176
)
Other interests held (1)

 
(2
)
 

 

 
1

 

Six months ended June 30,
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trading assets – loans
$

 
36

 
1

 

 
26

 
1

Mortgages held for sale
567

 

 

 
1,176

 

 

Loans

 

 

 

 

 
(4
)
Other assets

 

 
711

 

 

 
(234
)
Other interests held (1)

 
(4
)
 

 

 
(1
)
 

(1)
Includes retained interests in securitizations.

For performing loans, instrument-specific credit risk gains or losses were derived principally by determining the change in fair value of the loans due to changes in the observable or implied credit spread. Credit spread is the market yield on the loans less the relevant risk-free benchmark interest rate. For
 
nonperforming loans, we attribute all changes in fair value to instrument-specific credit risk. Table 13.19 shows the estimated gains and losses from earnings attributable to instrument-specific credit risk related to assets accounted for under the fair value option.
Table 13.19: Fair Value Option – Gains/Losses Attributable to Instrument-Specific Credit Risk
  
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
(in millions)
2017

 
2016

 
2017

 
2016

Gains (losses) attributable to instrument-specific credit risk:
  

 
  

 
 
 
 
Trading assets – loans
$
11

 
16

 
36

 
26

Mortgages held for sale
(4
)
 
(1
)
 
(5
)
 
(5
)
Total
$
7

 
15

 
31

 
21


Disclosures about Fair Value of Financial Instruments
Table 13.20 is a summary of fair value estimates for financial instruments, excluding financial instruments recorded at fair value on a recurring basis, as they are included within Table 13.2 in this Note. The carrying amounts in the following table are recorded on the balance sheet under the indicated captions, except for nonmarketable equity investments, which are included in other assets.
We have not included assets and liabilities that are not financial instruments in our disclosure, such as the value of the long-term relationships with our deposit, credit card and trust customers, amortized MSRs, premises and equipment, goodwill and other intangibles, deferred taxes and other liabilities. The total of the fair value calculations presented does not represent, and should not be construed to represent, the underlying value of the Company.
 

153


Table 13.20: Fair Value Estimates for Financial Instruments
  
  

 
Estimated fair value
 
(in millions)
Carrying amount

 
Level 1

 
Level 2

 
Level 3

 
Total

June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and due from banks (1)
$
20,248

 
20,248

 

 

 
20,248

Federal funds sold, securities purchased under resale agreements and other short-term investments (1)
264,706

 
14,247

 
250,382

 
77

 
264,706

Held-to-maturity securities
140,392

 
45,335

 
94,033

 
1,022

 
140,390

Mortgages held for sale (2)
5,264

 

 
3,949

 
1,324

 
5,273

Loans held for sale
156

 

 
157

 

 
157

Loans, net (3)
926,970

 

 
56,351

 
882,300

 
938,651

Nonmarketable equity investments (cost method)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Excluding investments at NAV
7,587

 

 
20

 
8,104

 
8,124

Total financial assets included in the fair value hierarchy
1,365,323

 
79,830

 
404,892

 
892,827

 
1,377,549

Investments at NAV (4)
20

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
22

Total financial assets
$
1,365,343










 
1,377,571

Financial liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits
$
1,305,830

 

 
1,283,587

 
22,266

 
1,305,853

Short-term borrowings (1)
95,356

 

 
95,356

 

 
95,356

Long-term debt (5)
238,862

 

 
235,085

 
6,992

 
242,077

Total financial liabilities
$
1,640,048




1,614,028


29,258

 
1,643,286

December 31, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and due from banks (1)
$
20,729

 
20,729

 

 

 
20,729

Federal funds sold, securities purchased under resale agreements and other short-term investments (1)
266,038

 
18,670

 
247,286

 
82

 
266,038

Held-to-maturity securities
99,583

 
45,079

 
51,706

 
2,370

 
99,155

Mortgages held for sale (2)
4,267

 

 
2,927

 
1,350

 
4,277

Loans held for sale
80

 

 
81

 

 
81

Loans, net (3)
936,358

 

 
60,245

 
887,589

 
947,834

Nonmarketable equity investments (cost method)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Excluding investments at NAV
8,362

 

 
18

 
8,924

 
8,942

Total financial assets included in the fair value hierarchy
1,335,417

 
84,478

 
362,263

 
900,315

 
1,347,056

Investments at NAV (4)
35










 
48

Total financial assets
$
1,335,452










 
1,347,104

Financial liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits
$
1,306,079

 

 
1,282,158

 
23,995

 
1,306,153

Short-term borrowings (1)
96,781

 

 
96,781

 

 
96,781

Long-term debt (5)
255,070

 

 
245,704

 
10,075

 
255,779

Total financial liabilities
$
1,657,930




1,624,643


34,070

 
1,658,713

(1)
Amounts consist of financial instruments for which carrying value approximates fair value.
(2)
Excludes MHFS for which we elected the fair value option.
(3)
Excludes loans for which the fair value option was elected and also exclude lease financing with a carrying amount of $19.2 billion and $19.3 billion at June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , respectively.
(4)
Consists of certain nonmarketable equity investments for which estimated fair values are determined using NAV per share (or its equivalent) as a practical expedient and are excluded from the fair value hierarchy.
(5)
Excludes capital lease obligations under capital leases of $7 million at both June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 .
Loan commitments, standby letters of credit and commercial and similar letters of credit are not included in the table above. A reasonable estimate of the fair value of these instruments is the carrying value of deferred fees plus the allowance for unfunded credit commitments, which totaled $1.2 billion at both June 30, 2017 , and December 31, 2016 , respectively.
 



154

Note 14: Preferred Stock ( continued )

Note 14:  Preferred Stock
We are authorized to issue 20 million shares of preferred stock and 4 million shares of preference stock, both without par value. Preferred shares outstanding rank senior to common shares both as to dividends and liquidation preference but have no general voting rights. We have not issued any preference shares under
 
this authorization. If issued, preference shares would be limited to one vote per share. Our total authorized, issued and outstanding preferred stock is presented in the following two tables along with the Employee Stock Ownership Plan (ESOP) Cumulative Convertible Preferred Stock.

Table 14.1: Preferred Stock Shares
  
June 30, 2017
 
 
December 31, 2016
 
  
Liquidation
preference
per share

 
Shares
authorized
and designated

 
Liquidation
preference
per share

 
Shares
authorized
and designated

DEP Shares
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

Dividend Equalization Preferred Shares (DEP)
$
10

 
97,000

 
$
10

 
97,000

Series H
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Floating Class A Preferred Stock (1)

 

 
20,000

 
50,000

Series I
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Floating Class A Preferred Stock
100,000

 
25,010

 
100,000

 
25,010

Series J
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
8.00% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
1,000

 
2,300,000

 
1,000

 
2,300,000

Series K
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7.98% Fixed-to-Floating Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
1,000

 
3,500,000

 
1,000

 
3,500,000

Series L
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7.50% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Convertible Class A Preferred Stock
1,000

 
4,025,000

 
1,000

 
4,025,000

Series N
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.20% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
25,000

 
30,000

 
25,000

 
30,000

Series O
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.125% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
25,000

 
27,600

 
25,000

 
27,600

Series P
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.25% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
25,000

 
26,400

 
25,000

 
26,400

Series Q
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.85% Fixed-to-Floating Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
25,000

 
69,000

 
25,000

 
69,000

Series R
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
6.625% Fixed-to-Floating Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
25,000

 
34,500

 
25,000

 
34,500

Series S
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.90% Fixed-to-Floating Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
25,000

 
80,000

 
25,000

 
80,000

Series T
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
6.00% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
25,000

 
32,200

 
25,000

 
32,200

Series U
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.875% Fixed-to-Floating Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
25,000

 
80,000

 
25,000

 
80,000

Series V
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
6.00% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
25,000

 
40,000

 
25,000

 
40,000

Series W
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.70% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
25,000

 
40,000

 
25,000

 
40,000

Series X
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.50% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
25,000

 
46,000

 
25,000

 
46,000

Series Y
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.625% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
25,000

 
27,600

 

 

ESOP
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cumulative Convertible Preferred Stock (2)

 
1,982,996

 

 
1,439,181

Total
 
 
12,463,306

 
 
 
11,941,891

(1)
On January 26, 2017, we filed with the Delaware Secretary of State a Certificate Eliminating the Certificate of Designations with respect to the Series H preferred stock.
(2)
See the ESOP Cumulative Convertible Preferred Stock section in this Note for additional information about the liquidation preference for the ESOP Cumulative Convertible Preferred Stock.

155


Table 14.2: Preferred Stock – Shares Issued and Carrying Value
  
June 30, 2017
 
 
December 31, 2016
 
(in millions, except shares)
Shares
issued and
outstanding

 
Liquidation preference
value

 
Carrying
value

 
Discount

 
Shares
issued and
outstanding

 
Liquidation preference
value

 
Carrying
value

 
Discount

DEP Shares
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

Dividend Equalization Preferred Shares (DEP)
96,546

 
$

 

 

 
96,546

 
$

 

 

Series I  (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Floating Class A Preferred Stock
25,010

 
2,501

 
2,501

 

 
25,010

 
2,501

 
2,501

 

Series J  (1) 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
8.00% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
2,150,375

 
2,150

 
1,995

 
155

 
2,150,375

 
2,150

 
1,995

 
155

Series K  (1) 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7.98% Fixed-to-Floating Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
3,352,000

 
3,352

 
2,876

 
476

 
3,352,000

 
3,352

 
2,876

 
476

Series L  (1) 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7.50% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Convertible Class A Preferred Stock
3,968,000

 
3,968

 
3,200

 
768

 
3,968,000

 
3,968

 
3,200

 
768

Series N  (1) 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.20% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
30,000

 
750

 
750

 

 
30,000

 
750

 
750

 

Series O  (1) 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.125% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
26,000

 
650

 
650

 

 
26,000

 
650

 
650

 

Series P  (1) 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.25% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
25,000

 
625

 
625

 

 
25,000

 
625

 
625

 

Series Q  (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.85% Fixed-to-Floating Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
69,000

 
1,725

 
1,725

 

 
69,000

 
1,725

 
1,725

 

Series R  (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
6.625% Fixed-to-Floating Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
33,600

 
840

 
840

 

 
33,600

 
840

 
840

 

Series S  (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.90% Fixed-to-Floating Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
80,000

 
2,000

 
2,000

 

 
80,000

 
2,000

 
2,000

 

Series T  (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
6.00% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
32,000

 
800

 
800

 

 
32,000

 
800

 
800

 

Series U (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.875% Fixed-to-Floating Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
80,000

 
2,000

 
2,000

 

 
80,000

 
2,000

 
2,000

 

Series V  (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
6.00% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
40,000

 
1,000

 
1,000

 

 
40,000

 
1,000

 
1,000

 

Series W  (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.70% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
40,000

 
1,000

 
1,000

 

 
40,000

 
1,000

 
1,000

 

Series X (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.50% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
46,000

 
1,150

 
1,150

 

 
46,000

 
1,150

 
1,150

 

Series Y (1)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5.625% Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock
27,600

 
690

 
690

 

 

 

 

 

ESOP
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cumulative Convertible Preferred Stock
1,982,996

 
1,983

 
1,983

 

 
1,439,181

 
1,439

 
1,439

 

Total
12,104,127

 
$
27,184

 
25,785

 
1,399

 
11,532,712

 
$
25,950

 
24,551

 
1,399

(1)
Preferred shares qualify as Tier 1 capital.

In April 2017, we issued 27.6 million Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/1000th interest in a share of Non-Cumulative Perpetual Class A Preferred Stock, Series Y, for an aggregate public offering price of $690 million .
See Note 7 (Securitizations and Variable Interest Entities) for additional information on our trust preferred securities.


156

Note 14: Preferred Stock ( continued )

ESOP CUMULATIVE CONVERTIBLE PREFERRED STOCK   All shares of our ESOP Cumulative Convertible Preferred Stock (ESOP Preferred Stock) were issued to a trustee acting on behalf of the Wells Fargo & Company 401(k) Plan (the 401(k) Plan). Dividends on the ESOP Preferred Stock are cumulative from the date of initial issuance and are payable quarterly at annual rates based upon the year of issuance. Each share of ESOP Preferred Stock released from the unallocated reserve of the 401(k) Plan is converted into shares of our common stock based on the stated
 
value of the ESOP Preferred Stock and the then current market price of our common stock. The ESOP Preferred Stock is also convertible at the option of the holder at any time, unless previously redeemed. We have the option to redeem the ESOP Preferred Stock at any time, in whole or in part, at a redemption price per share equal to the higher of (a) $1,000 per share plus accrued and unpaid dividends or (b) the fair market value, as defined in the Certificates of Designation for the ESOP Preferred Stock.
Table 14.3: ESOP Preferred Stock
  
Shares issued and outstanding
 
 
Carrying value
 
 
Adjustable dividend rate
(in millions, except shares)
Jun 30,
2017

 
Dec 31,
2016

 
Jun 30,
2017

 
Dec 31,
2016

 
Minimum

 
Maximum
ESOP Preferred Stock
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$1,000 liquidation preference per share
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2017
700,102

 

 
$
700

 

 
7.00
%
 
8.00
2016
322,826

 
358,528

 
323

 
358

 
9.30

 
10.30
2015
187,436

 
200,820

 
187

 
201

 
8.90

 
9.90
2014
237,151

 
255,413

 
237

 
255

 
8.70

 
9.70
2013
201,948

 
222,558

 
202

 
223

 
8.50

 
9.50
2012
128,634

 
144,072

 
129

 
144

 
10.00

 
11.00
2011
129,296

 
149,301

 
129

 
149

 
9.00

 
10.00
2010
75,603

 
90,775

 
76

 
91

 
9.50

 
10.50
2008

 
17,714

 

 
18

 
10.50

 
11.50
Total ESOP Preferred Stock (1)
1,982,996

 
1,439,181

 
$
1,983

 
1,439

 
 
 
 
Unearned ESOP shares (2)
 
 
 
 
$
(2,119
)
 
(1,565
)
 
 
 
 
(1)
At June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016 , additional paid-in capital included $136 million and $126 million , respectively, related to ESOP preferred stock.
(2)
We recorded a corresponding charge to unearned ESOP shares in connection with the issuance of the ESOP Preferred Stock. The unearned ESOP shares are reduced as shares of the ESOP Preferred Stock are committed to be released.


157



Note 15: Employee Benefits
We sponsor a frozen noncontributory qualified defined benefit retirement plan called the Wells Fargo & Company Cash Balance Plan (Cash Balance Plan), which covers eligible employees of Wells Fargo. The Cash Balance Plan was frozen on July 1, 2009, and no new benefits accrue after that date.
Table 15.1 presents the components of net periodic benefit cost.
 




Table 15.1: Net Periodic Benefit Cost
  
2017
 
 
2016
 
  
Pension benefits
 
 
  

 
Pension benefits
 
 
  

(in millions)
Qualified

 
Non-qualified

 
Other
benefits

 
Qualified

 
Non-qualified

 
Other
benefits

Quarter ended June 30,
  
 
 
  
 
Service cost
$
2

 

 

 
1

 

 

Interest cost
103

 
6

 
7

 
109

 
6

 
10

Expected return on plan assets
(163
)
 

 
(8
)
 
(141
)
 

 
(7
)
Amortization of net actuarial loss (gain)
38

 
4

 
(3
)
 
33

 
3

 
(1
)
Amortization of prior service credit

 

 
(2
)
 

 

 

Settlement loss

 
4

 

 
4

 

 

Net periodic benefit cost (income)
$
(20
)
 
14

 
(6
)
 
6

 
9

 
2

Six months ended June 30,
  
 
 
  
 
Service cost
$
3

 

 

 
2

 

 

Interest cost
206

 
12

 
14

 
218

 
13

 
20

Expected return on plan assets
(326
)
 

 
(15
)
 
(283
)
 

 
(15
)
Amortization of net actuarial loss (gain)
76

 
6

 
(5
)
 
66

 
6

 
(2
)
Amortization of prior service credit

 

 
(5
)
 

 

 

Settlement loss
1

 
6

 

 
4

 
2

 

Net periodic benefit cost (income)
$
(40
)
 
24

 
(11
)
 
7

 
21

 
3





158



Note 16:    Earnings Per Common Share
Table 16.1 shows earnings per common share and diluted earnings per common share and reconciles the numerator and denominator of both earnings per common share calculations.
Table 16.1: Earnings Per Common Share Calculations
 
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
(in millions, except per share amounts)
2017

 
2016

 
2017

 
2016

Wells Fargo net income
$
5,810

 
5,558

 
$
11,267

 
11,020

Less: Preferred stock dividends and other
406

 
385

 
807

 
762

Wells Fargo net income applicable to common stock (numerator)
$
5,404

 
5,173

 
$
10,460

 
10,258

Earnings per common share
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Average common shares outstanding (denominator)
4,989.9

 
5,066.9

 
4,999.2

 
5,071.3

Per share
$
1.08

 
1.02

 
$
2.09

 
2.02

Diluted earnings per common share
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Average common shares outstanding
4,989.9

 
5,066.9

 
4,999.2

 
5,071.3

Add: Stock options
17.2

 
19.6

 
19.3

 
20.4

Restricted share rights
19.9

 
21.0

 
24.7

 
27.4

Warrants
10.7

 
10.6

 
11.6

 
10.7

Diluted average common shares outstanding (denominator)
5,037.7

 
5,118.1

 
5,054.8

 
5,129.8

Per share
$
1.07

 
1.01

 
$
2.07

 
2.00


Table 16.2 presents the outstanding options to purchase shares of common stock that were anti-dilutive (the exercise
price was higher than the weighted-average market price), and therefore not included in the calculation of diluted earnings per common share.
 

 
Table 16.2: Outstanding Anti-Dilutive Options
 
Weighted-average shares
 
 
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
(in millions)
2017

 
2016

 
2017

 
2016

Options
1.8

 
2.7

 
2.1

 
3.7



159


Note 17:  Other Comprehensive Income
Table 17.1 provides the components of other comprehensive income (OCI), reclassifications to net income by income statement line item, and the related tax effects.
Table 17.1: Summary of Other Comprehensive Income
 
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
 
2017
 
 
2016
 
 
2017
 
 
2016
 
(in millions)
Before
tax

 
Tax
effect

 
Net of
tax

 
Before
tax

 
Tax
effect

 
Net of
tax

 
Before
tax

 
Tax
effect

 
Net of
tax

 
Before
tax

 
Tax
effect

 
Net of
tax

Investment securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Net unrealized gains arising during the period
$
1,565

 
(589
)
 
976

 
1,571

 
(596
)
 
975

 
1,934

 
(722
)
 
1,212

 
2,366

 
(906
)
 
1,460

Reclassification of net (gains) losses to net income:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 


 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest income on investment securities (1)
45

 
(17
)
 
28

 
3

 
(1
)
 
2

 
52

 
(20
)
 
32

 
3

 
(1
)
 
2

Net gains on debt securities
(120
)
 
44

 
(76
)
 
(447
)
 
168

 
(279
)
 
(156
)
 
57

 
(99
)
 
(691
)
 
259

 
(432
)
Net gains from equity investments
(101
)
 
35

 
(66
)
 
(60
)
 
23

 
(37
)
 
(217
)
 
79

 
(138
)
 
(119
)
 
45

 
(74
)
Other noninterest income
(1
)
 

 
(1
)
 

 

 

 
(1
)
 

 
(1
)
 
(1
)
 

 
(1
)
Subtotal reclassifications to net income
(177
)

62


(115
)
 
(504
)
 
190

 
(314
)
 
(322
)
 
116

 
(206
)
 
(808
)
 
303

 
(505
)
Net change
1,388


(527
)

861

 
1,067

 
(406
)
 
661

 
1,612

 
(606
)
 
1,006

 
1,558

 
(603
)
 
955

Derivatives and hedging activities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Net unrealized gains arising during the period
376

 
(142
)
 
234

 
1,057

 
(399
)
 
658

 
243

 
(92
)
 
151

 
3,056

 
(1,152
)
 
1,904

Reclassification of net (gains) losses to net income:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 


 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest income on loans
(156
)
 
59

 
(97
)
 
(268
)
 
101

 
(167
)
 
(361
)
 
136

 
(225
)
 
(528
)
 
199

 
(329
)
Interest expense on long-term debt
3

 
(1
)
 
2

 
3

 
(1
)
 
2

 
6

 
(2
)
 
4

 
7

 
(3
)
 
4

Subtotal reclassifications to net income
(153
)

58


(95
)

(265
)

100


(165
)

(355
)

134


(221
)

(521
)

196


(325
)
Net change
223


(84
)

139

 
792

 
(299
)
 
493

 
(112
)

42


(70
)
 
2,535


(956
)

1,579

Defined benefit plans adjustments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Net actuarial and prior service losses arising during the period

 

 

 
(19
)
 
7

 
(12
)
 
(7
)
 
3

 
(4
)
 
(27
)
 
10

 
(17
)
Reclassification of amounts to net periodic benefit costs (2):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Amortization of net actuarial loss
39

 
(16
)
 
23

 
35

 
(14
)
 
21

 
77

 
(30
)
 
47

 
70

 
(27
)
 
43

Settlements and other
2

 
1

 
3

 
4

 
(1
)
 
3

 
2

 
1

 
3

 
6

 
(2
)
 
4

Subtotal reclassifications to net periodic benefit costs
41


(15
)

26

 
39

 
(15
)
 
24

 
79

 
(29
)
 
50

 
76

 
(29
)
 
47

Net change
41


(15
)

26

 
20

 
(8
)
 
12

 
72

 
(26
)
 
46

 
49

 
(19
)
 
30

Foreign currency translation adjustments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
Net unrealized gains (losses) arising during the period
31

 
2

 
33

 
(6
)
 
(1
)
 
(7
)
 
47

 
3

 
50

 
37

 
7

 
44

Net change
31


2


33

 
(6
)
 
(1
)
 
(7
)
 
47

 
3

 
50

 
37

 
7

 
44

Other comprehensive income
$
1,683


(624
)

1,059

 
1,873


(714
)

1,159

 
1,619

 
(587
)
 
1,032

 
4,179

 
(1,571
)
 
2,608

Less: Other comprehensive income (loss) from noncontrolling interests, net of tax
 
 
 
 
(9
)
 
 
 
 
 
(15
)
 
  
 
  
 
5

 
 
 
 
 
(43
)
Wells Fargo other comprehensive income, net of tax
 
 
 
 
$
1,068

 
 
 
 
 
1,174

 
  
 
  
 
1,027

 
 
 
 
 
2,651

(1)
Represents net unrealized gains and losses amortized over the remaining lives of securities that were transferred from the available-for-sale portfolio to the held-to-maturity portfolio.
(2)
These items are included in the computation of net periodic benefit cost, which is recorded in employee benefits expense (see Note 15 (Employee Benefits) for additional details).

160

Note 17: Other Comprehensive Income ( continued )


Table 17.2: Cumulative OCI Balances
(in millions)
Investment
securities

 
Derivatives
and
hedging
activities

 
Defined
benefit
plans
adjustments

 
Foreign
currency
translation
adjustments

 
Cumulative
other
compre-
hensive
income

Quarter ended June 30, 2017
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance, beginning of period
$
(967
)
 
(120
)
 
(1,923
)
 
(168
)
 
(3,178
)
Net unrealized gains arising during the period
976

 
234

 

 
33

 
1,243

Amounts reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive income
(115
)
 
(95
)
 
26

 

 
(184
)
Net change
861

 
139

 
26

 
33

 
1,059

Less: Other comprehensive income (loss) from noncontrolling interests
(10
)
 

 

 
1

 
(9
)
Balance, end of period
$
(96
)
 
19

 
(1,897
)
 
(136
)
 
(2,110
)
Quarter ended June 30, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance, beginning of period
$
2,137

 
1,706

 
(1,933
)
 
(136
)
 
1,774

Net unrealized gains (losses) arising during the period
975

 
658

 
(12
)
 
(7
)
 
1,614

Amounts reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive income
(314
)
 
(165
)
 
24

 

 
(455
)
Net change
661

 
493

 
12

 
(7
)
 
1,159

Less: Other comprehensive loss from noncontrolling interests
(14
)
 

 

 
(1
)
 
(15
)
Balance, end of period
$
2,812

 
2,199

 
(1,921
)
 
(142
)
 
2,948

Six months ended June 30, 2017
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

Balance, beginning of period
$
(1,099
)
 
89

 
(1,943
)
 
(184
)
 
(3,137
)
Net unrealized gains (losses) arising during the period
1,212

 
151

 
(4
)
 
50

 
1,409

Amounts reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive income
(206
)
 
(221
)
 
50

 

 
(377
)
Net change
1,006

 
(70
)
 
46

 
50

 
1,032

Less: Other comprehensive income from noncontrolling interests
3

 

 

 
2

 
5

Balance, end of period
$
(96
)
 
19

 
(1,897
)
 
(136
)
 
(2,110
)
Six months ended June 30, 2016
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

Balance, beginning of period
$
1,813

 
620

 
(1,951
)
 
(185
)
 
297

Net unrealized gains (losses) arising during the period
1,460

 
1,904

 
(17
)
 
44

 
3,391

Amounts reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive income
(505
)
 
(325
)
 
47

 

 
(783
)
Net change
955

 
1,579

 
30

 
44

 
2,608

Less: Other comprehensive income (loss) from noncontrolling interests
(44
)
 

 

 
1

 
(43
)
Balance, end of period
$
2,812

 
2,199

 
(1,921
)
 
(142
)
 
2,948



161



Note 18:  Operating Segments
We have three reportable operating segments: Community Banking; Wholesale Banking; and Wealth and Investment Management (WIM). We define our operating segments by product type and customer segment and their results are based on our management accounting process, for which there is no comprehensive, authoritative guidance equivalent to GAAP for financial accounting. The management accounting process measures the performance of the operating segments based on
 
our management structure and is not necessarily comparable with similar information for other financial services companies. If the management structure and/or the allocation process changes, allocations, transfers and assignments may change. For a description of our operating segments, including the underlying management accounting process, see Note 24 (Operating Segments) to Financial Statements in our 2016 Form 10-K. Table 18.1 presents our results by operating segment.
Table 18.1: Operating Segments
 
Community
Banking 
 
 
Wholesale
Banking
 
 
Wealth and Investment Management
 
 
Other (1)
 
 
Consolidated
Company
 
(income/expense in millions, average balances in billions)
2017

 
2016

 
2017

 
2016

 
2017

 
2016

 
2017

 
2016

 
2017

 
2016

Quarter ended June 30,
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

 
  

Net interest income (2)
$
7,548

 
7,379

 
4,278

 
3,919

 
1,127

 
932

 
(470
)
 
(497
)
 
12,483

 
11,733

Provision (reversal of provision) for credit losses
623

 
689

 
(65
)
 
385

 
7

 
2

 
(10
)
 
(2
)
 
555

 
1,074

Noninterest income
4,741

 
4,825

 
2,673

 
3,365

 
3,055

 
2,987

 
(783
)
 
(748
)
 
9,686

 
10,429

Noninterest expense
7,223

 
6,648

 
4,078

 
4,036

 
3,075

 
2,976

 
(835
)
 
(794
)
 
13,541

 
12,866

Income (loss) before income tax expense (benefit)
4,443

 
4,867

 
2,938

 
2,863

 
1,100

 
941

 
(408
)
 
(449
)
 
8,073

 
8,222

Income tax expense (benefit)
1,404

 
1,667

 
559

 
795

 
417

 
358

 
(155
)
 
(171
)
 
2,225

 
2,649

Net income (loss) before noncontrolling interests
3,039

 
3,200

 
2,379

 
2,068

 
683

 
583

 
(253
)
 
(278
)
 
5,848

 
5,573

Less: Net income (loss) from noncontrolling interests
46

 
21

 
(9
)
 
(5
)
 
1

 
(1
)
 

 

 
38

 
15

Net income (loss) (3)
$
2,993

 
3,179

 
2,388

 
2,073

 
682

 
584

 
(253
)
 
(278
)
 
5,810

 
5,558

Average loans
$
477.2

 
485.7

 
464.9

 
451.4

 
71.7

 
66.7

 
(56.9
)
 
(53.0
)
 
956.9

 
950.8

Average assets
983.5

 
967.6

 
817.3

 
772.6

 
213.1

 
205.3

 
(86.8
)
 
(83.4
)
 
1,927.1

 
1,862.1

Average deposits
727.2

 
703.7

 
463.0

 
425.8

 
188.2

 
182.5

 
(77.2
)
 
(75.3
)
 
1,301.2

 
1,236.7

Six months ended June 30,
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net interest income (2)
$
15,175

 
14,847

 
8,426

 
7,667

 
2,201

 
1,875

 
(1,019
)
 
(989
)
 
24,783

 
23,400

Provision (reversal of provision) for credit losses
1,269

 
1,409

 
(108
)
 
748

 
3

 
(12
)
 
(4
)
 
15

 
1,160

 
2,160

Noninterest income
9,207

 
9,971

 
5,563

 
6,575

 
6,174

 
5,898

 
(1,556
)
 
(1,487
)
 
19,388

 
20,957

Noninterest expense
14,444

 
13,484

 
8,303

 
8,004

 
6,281

 
6,018

 
(1,695
)
 
(1,612
)
 
27,333

 
25,894

Income (loss) before income tax expense (benefit)
8,669

 
9,925

 
5,794

 
5,490

 
2,091

 
1,767

 
(876
)
 
(879
)
 
15,678

 
16,303

Income tax expense (benefit)
2,531

 
3,364

 
1,305

 
1,514

 
779

 
672

 
(333
)
 
(334
)
 
4,282

 
5,216

Net income (loss) before noncontrolling interests
6,138

 
6,561

 
4,489

 
3,976

 
1,312

 
1,095

 
(543
)
 
(545
)
 
11,396

 
11,087

Less: Net income (loss) from noncontrolling interests
136

 
86

 
(14
)
 
(18
)
 
7

 
(1
)
 

 

 
129

 
67

Net income (loss) (3)
$
6,002

 
6,475

 
4,503

 
3,994

 
1,305

 
1,096

 
(543
)
 
(545
)
 
11,267

 
11,020

Average loans
$
479.9

 
485.0

 
465.6

 
440.6

 
71.2

 
65.4

 
(56.5
)
 
(52.0
)
 
960.2

 
939.0

Average assets
987.0

 
957.5

 
812.6

 
760.6

 
217.5

 
206.7

 
(88.1
)
 
(83.8
)
 
1,929.0

 
1,841.0

Average deposits
722.2

 
693.3

 
464.5

 
426.9

 
191.9

 
183.5

 
(78.4
)
 
(75.7
)
 
1,300.2

 
1,228.0

(1)
Includes the elimination of certain items that are included in more than one business segment, substantially all of which represents products and services for Wealth and Investment Management customers served through Community Banking distribution channels. 
(2)
Net interest income is the difference between interest earned on assets and the cost of liabilities to fund those assets. Interest earned includes actual interest earned on segment assets and, if the segment has excess liabilities, interest credits for providing funding to other segments. The cost of liabilities includes interest expense on segment liabilities and, if the segment does not have enough liabilities to fund its assets, a funding charge based on the cost of excess liabilities from another segment.
(3)
Represents segment net income (loss) for Community Banking; Wholesale Banking; and Wealth and Investment Management segments and Wells Fargo net income for the consolidated company.


162



Note 19:  Regulatory and Agency Capital Requirements
The Company and each of its subsidiary banks are subject to regulatory capital adequacy requirements promulgated by federal bank regulatory agencies. The Federal Reserve establishes capital requirements for the consolidated financial holding company, and the OCC has similar requirements for the Company’s national banks, including Wells Fargo Bank, N.A. (the Bank).
Table 19.1 presents regulatory capital information for Wells Fargo & Company and the Bank using Basel III, which increased minimum required capital ratios, and introduced a minimum Common Equity Tier 1 (CET1) ratio. We must report the lower of our CET1, tier 1 and total capital ratios calculated under the Standardized Approach and under the Advanced Approach in the assessment of our capital adequacy. The information presented reflects risk-weighted assets (RWAs) under the Standardized and Advanced Approaches with Transition Requirements. The Standardized Approach applies assigned risk weights to broad risk categories, while the calculation of RWAs under the
 
Advanced Approach differs by requiring applicable banks to utilize a risk-sensitive methodology, which relies upon the use of internal credit models, and includes an operational risk component. The Basel III revised definition of capital, and changes are being phased-in effective January 1, 2014, through the end of 2021.
The Bank is an approved seller/servicer of mortgage loans and is required to maintain minimum levels of shareholders’ equity, as specified by various agencies, including the United States Department of Housing and Urban Development, GNMA, FHLMC and FNMA. At June 30, 2017 , the Bank met these requirements. Other subsidiaries, including the Company’s insurance and broker-dealer subsidiaries, are also subject to various minimum capital levels, as defined by applicable industry regulations. The minimum capital levels for these subsidiaries, and related restrictions, are not significant to our consolidated operations.
Table 19.1: Regulatory Capital Information
 
Wells Fargo & Company
 
Wells Fargo Bank, N.A.
 
June 30, 2017
 
 
 
December 31, 2016
 
 
 
June 30, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
(in millions, except ratios)
Advanced Approach

 
Standardized
Approach

 
 
Advanced Approach

 
Standardized
Approach

 
 
Advanced Approach

 
Standardized
Approach

 
 
Advanced Approach

 
Standardized
Approach

 
Regulatory capital:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Common equity tier 1
$
152,742

 
152,742

 
 
148,785

 
148,785

 
 
139,581

 
139,581

 
 
132,225

 
132,225

 
Tier 1
176,134

 
176,134

 
 
171,364

 
171,364

 
 
139,581

 
139,581

 
 
132,225

 
132,225

 
Total
208,535

 
218,399

 
 
204,425

 
214,877

 
 
152,850

 
162,320

 
 
145,665

 
155,281

 
Assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Risk-weighted
$
1,232,977

 
1,287,327

 
 
1,274,589

 
1,336,198

 
 
1,114,978

 
1,188,024

 
 
1,143,681

 
1,222,876

 
Adjusted average (1)
1,897,370

 
1,897,370

 
 
1,914,802

 
1,914,802

 
 
1,703,737

 
1,703,737

 
 
1,714,524

 
1,714,524

 
Regulatory capital ratios:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Common equity tier 1 capital
12.39
%

11.87

*
 
11.67

 
11.13

*
 
12.52


11.75

*
 
11.56


10.81

*
Tier 1 capital
14.29


13.68

*
 
13.44

 
12.82

*
 
12.52


11.75

*
 
11.56


10.81

*
Total capital
16.91

*
16.97


 
16.04

*
16.08

 
 
13.71


13.66

*
 
12.74


12.70

*
Tier 1 leverage (1)
9.28

 
9.28

 
 
8.95

 
8.95

 
 
8.19

 
8.19

 
 
7.71

 
7.71

 
*Denotes the lowest capital ratio as determined under the Advanced and Standardized Approaches.
(1)
The leverage ratio consists of Tier 1 capital divided by quarterly average total assets, excluding goodwill and certain other items.
Table 19.2 presents the minimum required regulatory capital ratios under Transition Requirements to which the Company and the Bank were subject as of June 30, 2017 and December 31, 2016 .
 

Table 19.2: Minimum Required Regulatory Capital Ratios – Transition Requirements (1)
  
Wells Fargo & Company
 
Wells Fargo Bank, N.A.
 
June 30, 2017

 
December 31, 2016
 
June 30, 2017
 
December 31, 2016
Regulatory capital ratios:
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
Common equity tier 1 capital
6.750
%
 
5.625
 
5.750
 
5.125
Tier 1 capital
8.250

 
7.125
 
7.250
 
6.625
Total capital
10.250

 
9.125
 
9.250
 
8.625
Tier 1 leverage
4.000

 
4.000
 
4.000
 
4.000
(1)
At June 30, 2017 , under transition requirements, the CET1, tier 1 and total capital minimum ratio requirements for Wells Fargo & Company include a capital conservation buffer of 1.250% and a global systemically important bank (G-SIB) surcharge of 1.000% . Only the 1.250% capital conservation buffer applies to the Bank at June 30, 2017 .


163



Glossary of Acronyms
  
  
  
  
ABS
Asset-backed security
HAMP
Home Affordability Modification Program
ACL
Allowance for credit losses
HUD
U.S. Department of Housing and Urban Development
ALCO
Asset/Liability Management Committee
LCR
Liquidity coverage ratio
ARM  
Adjustable-rate mortgage
LHFS
Loans held for sale
ASC  
Accounting Standards Codification
LIBOR
London Interbank Offered Rate
ASU
Accounting Standards Update
LIHTC
Low income housing tax credit
AUA
Assets under administration
LOCOM
Lower of cost or market value
AUM
Assets under management
LTV
Loan-to-value
AVM
Automated valuation model
MBS
Mortgage-backed security
BCBS
Basel Committee on Bank Supervision
MHA
Making Home Affordable programs
BHC
Bank holding company
MHFS
Mortgages held for sale
CCAR
Comprehensive Capital Analysis and Review
MSR
Mortgage servicing right
CD
Certificate of deposit
MTN
Medium-term note
CDO
Collateralized debt obligation
NAV
Net asset value
CDS
Credit default swaps
NPA
Nonperforming asset
CECL
Current expected credit loss
OCC
Office of the Comptroller of the Currency
CET1
Common Equity Tier 1
OCI
Other comprehensive income
CFPB
Consumer Financial Protection Bureau
OTC
Over-the-counter
CLO
Collateralized loan obligation
OTTI
Other-than-temporary impairment
CLTV
Combined loan-to-value
PCI Loans
Purchased credit-impaired loans
CMBS
Commercial mortgage-backed securities
PTPP
Pre-tax pre-provision profit
CPP
Capital Purchase Program
RBC
Risk-based capital
CRE
Commercial real estate
RMBS
Residential mortgage-backed securities
DPD
Days past due
ROA
Wells Fargo net income to average total assets
ESOP
Employee Stock Ownership Plan
ROE
Wells Fargo net income applicable to common stock
FAS
Statement of Financial Accounting Standards
  
to average Wells Fargo common stockholders' equity
FASB
Financial Accounting Standards Board
ROTCE
Return on average tangible common equity
FDIC
Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation
RWAs
Risk-weighted assets
FFELP
Federal Family Education Loan Program
SEC
Securities and Exchange Commission
FHA
Federal Housing Administration
S&P
Standard & Poor’s Ratings Services
FHLB
Federal Home Loan Bank
SLR
Supplementary leverage ratio
FHLMC
Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation
SPE
Special purpose entity
FICO
Fair Isaac Corporation (credit rating)
TARP
Troubled Asset Relief Program
FNMA
Federal National Mortgage Association
TDR
Troubled debt restructuring
FRB
Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System
TLAC
Total Loss Absorbing Capacity
GAAP
Generally accepted accounting principles
VA
Department of Veterans Affairs
GNMA
Government National Mortgage Association
VaR
Value-at-Risk
GSE
Government-sponsored entity
VIE
Variable interest entity
G-SIB
Globally systemic important bank
 
 

164



PART II – OTHER INFORMATION

Item 1.            Legal Proceedings
 
Information in response to this item can be found in Note 11 (Legal Actions) to Financial Statements in this Report which information is incorporated by reference into this item.

Item 1A.         Risk Factors
 
Information in response to this item can be found under the “Financial Review – Risk Factors” section in this Report which information is incorporated by reference into this item. 

Item 2.           Unregistered Sales of Equity Securities and Use of Proceeds
 
The following table shows Company repurchases of its common stock for each calendar month in the quarter ended June 30, 2017 .
Calendar month
Total number
of shares
repurchased (1)

 
Weighted-average
price paid per share

 
Maximum number of
shares that may yet
be repurchased under
the authorization

April
4,426,785

 
$
52.77

 
209,831,111

May (2)
18,564,273

 
53.34

 
191,266,838

June
20,055,875

 
53.01

 
171,210,963

Total
43,046,933

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1)
All shares were repurchased under an authorization covering up to 350 million shares of common stock approved by the Board of Directors and publicly announced by the Company on January 26, 2016. Unless modified or revoked by the Board, this authorization does not expire.
(2)
May includes a private repurchase transaction of 14,153,358 shares at a weighted-average price per share of $52.99 .


The following table shows Company repurchases of the warrants for each calendar month in the quarter ended June 30, 2017 .
Calendar month
Total number
of warrants
repurchased (1)

 
Average price
paid per warrant

 
Maximum dollar value
of warrants that
may yet be repurchased

April

 
$

 
451,944,402

May

 

 
451,944,402

June

 

 
451,944,402

Total

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1)
Warrants are repurchased under the authorization covering up to $1 billion in warrants approved by the Board of Directors (ratified and approved on June 22, 2010). Unless modified or revoked by the Board, this authorization does not expire.

165



Item 6.
Exhibits
 
A list of exhibits to this Form 10-Q is set forth on the Exhibit Index immediately preceding such exhibits and is incorporated herein by reference.
 
The Company’s SEC file number is 001-2979. On and before November 2, 1998, the Company filed documents with the SEC under the name Norwest Corporation. The former Wells Fargo & Company filed documents under SEC file number 001-6214.
 

SIGNATURE
 
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this Report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.
 
Dated: August 4, 2017                                                               WELLS FARGO & COMPANY
 
 
By:      /s/ RICHARD D. LEVY                                   
Richard D. Levy
Executive Vice President and Controller
(Principal Accounting Officer)

166



EXHIBIT INDEX
 
Exhibit
Number
 
Description 
 
Location 
3(a)
 
Restated Certificate of Incorporation, as amended and in effect on the date hereof.
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3(a) to the Company's Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2017.
3(b)
 
By-Laws.
 
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed December 1, 2016.
4(a)
 
See Exhibits 3(a) and 3(b).
 
 
4(b)
 
The Company agrees to furnish upon request to the Commission a copy of each instrument defining the rights of holders of senior and subordinated debt of the Company.
 
 
10(a)
 
Form of Restricted Share Rights Award Agreement for grants on or after February 28, 2017.
 
Filed herewith.
10(b)
 
Wells Fargo Bonus Plan, as amended effective January 1, 2017.
 
Filed herewith.
10(c)
 
Amendment to Deferred Compensation Plan, effective July 1, 2017.
 
Filed herewith.
10(d)
 
Amendment to Supplemental 401(k) Plan, effective July 1, 2017.
 
Filed herewith.
10(e)
 
Amendment to Supplemental Cash Balance Plan, effective July 1, 2017.
 
Filed herewith.
10(f)
 
Amendment to Wachovia Corporation Savings Restoration Plan, effective July 1, 2017.
 
Filed herewith.
10(g)
 
Form of stock award agreement for employees of Wachovia Corporation, including Jonathan Weiss.
 
Filed herewith.
12(a)
 
Computation of Ratios of Earnings to Fixed Charges:
 
Filed herewith.
  
 
  
 
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
 
  
  
 
  
 
2017

 
2016

 
2017

 
2016

 
  
  
 
Including interest on deposits
 
4.44

 
6.41

 
4.56

 
6.55

 
  
  
 
Excluding interest on deposits
 
5.86

 
7.93

 
5.94

 
8.10

 
  
 
 
 
 
 
12(b)
 
Computation of Ratios of Earnings to Fixed Charges and Preferred Dividends:
 
Filed herewith.
  
 
  
 
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
 
  
  
 
  
 
2017

 
2016

 
2017

 
2016

 
  
  
 
Including interest on deposits
 
3.58

 
4.66

 
3.63

 
4.73

 
  
  
 
Excluding interest on deposits
 
4.38

 
5.35

 
4.39

 
5.43

 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
31(a)
 
Certification of principal executive officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
 
Filed herewith.
31(b)
 
Certification of principal financial officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
 
Filed herewith.
32(a)
 
Certification of Periodic Financial Report by Chief Executive Officer Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 and 18 U.S.C. § 1350.
 
Furnished herewith.
32(b)
 
Certification of Periodic Financial Report by Chief Financial Officer Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 and 18 U.S.C. § 1350.
 
Furnished herewith.
101.INS
 
XBRL Instance Document
 
Filed herewith.
101.SCH
 
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema Document
 
Filed herewith.
101.CAL
 
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase Document
 
Filed herewith.
101.DEF
 
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definitions Linkbase Document
 
Filed herewith.
101.LAB
 
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase Document
 
Filed herewith.
101.PRE
 
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase Document
 
Filed herewith.


167


Exhibit 10(a)

Form of Restricted Share Rights Award Agreement for Grants on or after February 28, 2017
Brackets identify provisions that may vary depending on the particular grant, grant recipient
and/or other relevant factor.

WELLS FARGO & COMPANY
LONG-TERM INCENTIVE COMPENSATION PLAN
RESTRICTED SHARE RIGHTS AWARD AGREEMENT


Grant Date: [applicable date]
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1.
Award. To encourage your continued employment with the Company or any Affiliate and to motivate you to help the Company increase stockholder value over the long term, Wells Fargo & Company (the “Company”) has awarded you the number of Restricted Share Rights as set forth on the acknowledgement screen for your grant on this website (the “Award”). Each Restricted Share Right entitles you to receive one share of Wells Fargo & Company common stock ("Common Stock") contingent upon vesting and subject to the other terms and conditions set forth in the Company’s Long‑Term Incentive Compensation Plan, as may be amended from time to time (the “Plan”) and this Award Agreement.

2.
Vesting. Except as otherwise provided in this Award Agreement, and subject to the Company’s right to recoup or forfeit all or any portion of this Award and other conditions as provided in this Award Agreement[, including but not limited to the performance conditions in [applicable paragraphs] below], the Restricted Share Rights will vest and be settled according to the following schedule:
[ Vesting Schedule ]
Shares of Common Stock in settlement of the Restricted Share Rights will be issued to you or, in case of your death, your Beneficiary determined in accordance with the Plan. Although you may receive dividend equivalents as provided below, you will have no rights as a stockholder of the Company with respect to your Restricted Share Rights until settlement. Upon vesting, each Restricted Share Right will be settled and distributed as one share of Common Stock except as otherwise provided in the Plan or this Award Agreement.
3.
Termination.
(a)
If you cease to be an Employee due to your death, any then unvested Restricted Share Right awarded hereby (including any Restricted Share Right granted with respect to dividend equivalents as provided below) will immediately vest upon your date of death and will be settled and distributed to your Beneficiary in shares of Common Stock between January 2 and March 1 of the year following the year in which you die. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if by the last date set forth herein your Beneficiary has not presented evidence deemed satisfactory by the Company to allow transfer of the shares of Common Stock to the Beneficiary under applicable laws, the Company may treat all unvested Restricted Share Rights as forfeited, in which case the Company shall have no obligation to issue shares of Common Stock or benefits in lieu of such shares to your Beneficiary and shall have no liability therefor.
(b)
If you incur an involuntary [Separation from Service][termination from employment] as a result of one of the following:
(1)
application of the Company’s Extended Absence Policy to you in connection with a Disability,
(2)
your displacement and receipt of an immediate lump sum severance benefit, placement on a Salary Continuation Leave of Absence or placement on another leave of absence which will result in your receipt of a severance benefit in connection with that leave, or
(3)
the Company or an Affiliate entering into a corporate transaction with another company (the “buyer”) (including a transaction where the buyer acquires all or any portion of the assets, stock or operations




of the Company or Affiliate) and pursuant to the terms of the transaction your continuing in employment with the buyer after completion of the corporate transaction,
any then unvested Restricted Share Right awarded hereby (including any Restricted Share Right granted with respect to dividend equivalents as provided below) will immediately vest and will be settled and distributed to you in shares of Common Stock within 90 days from your [Separation from Service][termination of employment or, if earlier, by March 1 of the year following the year in which the Restricted Share Rights vest][, subject to the performance conditions in [applicable paragraphs] below.
The definitions of the terms [“Separation from Service” (which is determined by the Company in accordance with Section 409A (as defined in paragraph 11 below)),] and “Disability” are set forth on Exhibit A to this Award Agreement, which definitions are incorporated by reference herein.
(c)
[If you have a Separation from Service that is not addressed in paragraph 3(b) above for a reason other than Cause and you satisfy the definition of Retirement under the Plan on your Separation from Service date or you satisfy the definition of Retirement following your Separation from Service date at the end of an approved leave of absence not to exceed six months, any then unvested Restricted Share Right awarded hereby (including any Restricted Share Right granted with respect to dividend equivalents as provided below) will continue to vest and be settled upon the scheduled vesting date as set forth in paragraph 2 above[, subject to the conditions and restrictions in [applicable paragraphs] below]; provided, however, if you die following Retirement, subject to the limitations set forth in paragraph 3(a), any then unvested Restricted Share Right will vest immediately upon your date of death and will be settled and distributed to your Beneficiary in shares of Common Stock between January 2 and March 1 of the year following the year in which you die. The definition of the term “Cause” is set forth on Exhibit A to this Award Agreement, which definition is incorporated by reference herein.]
(d)
If the Affiliate that employs you incurs a Change in Control and you continue employment with the buyer immediately after the Change in Control, any then unvested Restricted Share Right awarded hereby (including any Restricted Share Right granted with respect to dividend equivalents as provided below) will immediately vest and will be settled and distributed to you in shares of Common Stock within 90 days from the date the Change in Control occurred [or, if earlier, by March 1 of the year immediately following the year in which the Change in Control occurred][, subject to the conditions and restrictions in [applicable paragraphs] below]. Exhibit A to this Award Agreement sets forth the definition of the term “Change in Control,” which definition is incorporated in this Award Agreement by reference.
(a)
If you [incur a Separation from Service][terminate employment] other than for a reason described in paragraphs 3(a), (b), (c), or (d) above, any then unvested Restricted Share Right awarded hereby (including any Restricted Share Right granted with respect to dividend equivalents as provided below) will immediately terminate without notice to you and will be forfeited.

4.
Dividend Equivalents. During the period beginning on the Grant Date and ending on the date the applicable Restricted Share Rights vest and are distributed, or are forfeited, whichever occurs first, if the Company pays a dividend on the Common Stock, you will automatically receive, as of the payment date for such dividend, dividend equivalents in the form of additional Restricted Share Rights based on the amount or number of shares that would have been paid on the Restricted Share Rights had they been issued and outstanding shares of Common Stock as of the record date and, if a cash dividend, the closing price of the Common Stock on the New York Stock Exchange as of the dividend payment date. You will also automatically receive dividend equivalents with respect to such additional Restricted Share Rights, to be granted in the same manner. Restricted Share Rights granted with respect to dividend equivalents will be subject to the same vesting schedule and other terms and conditions as the underlying Restricted Share Rights, including the Company’s right of recoupment or forfeiture, and will be distributed in shares of Common Stock when, and if, the underlying Restricted Share Rights are settled and distributed.

5.
Tax Withholding. Regardless of any action the Company or an Affiliate which is your employer (the “Employer”) takes with respect to any or all income tax, payroll tax, payment on account or other tax-related items related to your participation in the Plan and legally applicable to you or deemed by the Company or the Employer to be an appropriate charge to you even if technically due by the Company or the Employer (“Tax-Related Items”), you acknowledge that the ultimate liability for all Tax-Related Items is and remains your responsibility and may exceed




the amount actually withheld by the Company or the Employer. You further acknowledge that the Company and/or the Employer: (a) make no representations or undertakings regarding the treatment of any Tax-Related Items in connection with any aspect of the Award, including the grant, vesting or settlement of the Restricted Share Rights, the issuance of shares of Common Stock upon settlement of the Restricted Share Rights, the subsequent sale of shares of Common Stock acquired pursuant to such issuance and the receipt of any dividends and/or any dividend equivalents; and (b) do not commit to and are under no obligation to structure the terms of the grant or any aspect of the Award to reduce or eliminate your liability for such Tax-Related Items or to achieve any particular tax result. Further, if you are subject to tax on the Award in more than one jurisdiction at the time of any relevant taxable event, you acknowledge that the Company and/or the Employer (or former employer, as applicable) may be required to withhold or account for Tax-Related Items in more than one jurisdiction.
Prior to any relevant taxable or tax withholding event, as applicable, you shall pay or make adequate arrangements satisfactory to the Company or the Employer to satisfy all Tax-Related Items. In this regard, you authorize the Company and/or the Employer, or their respective agents, at their discretion and pursuant to such procedures as the Company may specify from time to time, to satisfy the obligations with regard to all Tax-Related Items by one or a combination of the following: (1) withholding from any wages or other cash compensation paid to you by the Company and/or the Employer; (2) withholding from proceeds of the sale of shares of Common Stock acquired upon vesting and settlement of the Restricted Share Rights either through a voluntary sale or through a mandatory sale arranged by the Company (on your behalf pursuant to this authorization); or (3) withholding in shares of Common Stock to be issued upon vesting and settlement of the Restricted Share Rights. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if you are subject to the short-swing profit rules of Section 16(b) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (the “Exchange Act”), the Company will withhold in shares of Common Stock upon the relevant tax withholding event[, except with respect to any Tax-Related Items required to be withheld prior to the vesting dates set forth in paragraph 2 which may be withheld from your wages or other cash compensation]. Only if withholding in shares of Common Stock is prevented by applicable law or has materially adverse accounting or tax consequences, may the Tax-Related Items withholding obligation for individuals subject to Section 16(b) of the Exchange Act be satisfied by one or a combination of methods (1) and (2) above.
Depending on the withholding method, the Company may withhold or account for Tax-Related Items by considering applicable minimum statutory withholding amounts or other applicable withholding rates, including maximum applicable rates, in which case you will receive a refund of any over-withheld amount in cash and will have no entitlement to the Common Stock equivalent. Anything to the contrary in this paragraph 5 notwithstanding, the Company or the Employer’s right to withhold any amounts payable pursuant to this Award to cover Tax-Related Items for any portion of the Award that is considered deferred compensation subject to Section 409A shall be limited to the minimum amount permitted to avoid a prohibited acceleration under Section 409A. If the obligation for Tax-Related Items is satisfied by withholding in shares of Common Stock, for tax purposes, you will be deemed to have been issued the full number of shares of Common Stock subject to the vested Restricted Share Rights, notwithstanding that a number of the shares of Common Stock are held back solely for the purpose of paying the Tax-Related Items due as a result of any aspect of your participation in the Plan.
Finally, you shall pay to the Company or the Employer any amount of Tax-Related Items that the Company or the Employer may be required to withhold or account for as a result of your participation in the Plan that cannot be satisfied by the means previously described. The Company may refuse to issue or deliver the shares or the proceeds of the sale of shares of Common Stock, if you fail to comply with your obligations in connection with the Tax-Related Items.
6.
Nontransferable. Unless the Committee provides otherwise, (i) no rights under this Award will be assignable or transferable, and neither you nor your Beneficiary will have any power to anticipate, alienate, dispose of, pledge or encumber any rights under this Award, and (ii) the rights and the benefits of this Award may be exercised and received during your lifetime only by you or your legal representative.

7.
Other Restrictions; Amendment. The issuance of Common Stock hereunder is subject to compliance by the Company and you with all legal requirements applicable thereto, including compliance with the requirements of 12 C.F.R. Part 359 and tax withholding obligations, and with all applicable regulations of any stock exchange on which the Common Stock may be listed at the time of issuance. Subject to paragraph[s] 11 [and 12] below, the Committee may, in its sole discretion and without your consent, reduce, delay vesting, modify, revoke, cancel,




impose additional conditions and restrictions on or recover all or a portion of this Award if the Committee deems it necessary or advisable to comply with applicable laws, rules and regulations. This Award is subject to any applicable recoupment or “clawback” policies of the Company, as in effect from time to time, and any applicable recoupment or clawback requirements imposed under laws, rules and regulations.

8.
Performance Conditions. The Award is fully conditioned on and subject to performance adjustments, which include the right of the Committee to cause you to forfeit all or any unpaid portion of an Award, if the Committee determines in its sole discretion that:
You engage in misconduct which has or might reasonably be expected to have reputational or other harm to the Company or any conduct that constitutes Cause;
You engage in misconduct or commit a material error that causes or might reasonably be expected to cause significant financial or reputational harm to the Company or your business group;
The Award was based on materially inaccurate performance metrics, whether or not you were responsible for the inaccuracy;
You improperly or with gross negligence, including in a supervisory capacity, fail to identify, escalate, monitor, or manage, in a timely manner and as reasonably expected, risks material to the Company or your business group; or
The Company or your business group suffers a material downturn in its financial performance or suffers a material failure of risk management.
The Committee may consider any factors it determines necessary or appropriate for purposes of making a determination whether a performance adjustment is appropriate and the amount of the adjustment based on the particular facts and circumstances. All determinations by the Committee will be final and binding.
9.
Restrictive Covenants. In consideration of the terms of this Award and your access to Confidential Information, you agree to the restrictive covenants and associated remedies as set forth below, which exist independently of and in addition to any obligation to which you are subject under the terms of the Wells Fargo Agreement Regarding Trade Secrets, Confidential Information, Non-Solicitation, And Assignment Of Inventions (the “TSA”):
(a)
Trade Secrets and Confidential Information. During the course of your employment, you will acquire knowledge of the Company’s and/or any Affiliate’s (collectively “WFC”) Trade Secrets and other proprietary information relating to its business, business methods, personnel, and customers (collectively, “Confidential Information”). “Trade Secrets” means WFC’s confidential information, which has an economic value in being secret and which WFC has taken steps to keep secret and you understand and agree that Trade Secrets include, but are not limited to, confidentially maintained client and customer lists and information, and confidentially maintained prospective client and customer lists and information. You agree that Confidential Information of WFC is to be used solely and exclusively for the purpose of conducting business on behalf of WFC. You agree to keep such Confidential Information confidential and will not divulge, use or disclose this information except for that purpose. In addition, you agree that, both during and after your employment, you will not remove, share, disseminate or otherwise use WFC’s Trade Secrets to directly or indirectly solicit, participate in or promote the solicitation of any of WFC’s clients, customers, or prospective customers for the purpose of providing products or services that are in competition with WFC’s products or services. Notwithstanding the foregoing, nothing contained in this Award Agreement prohibits or restricts you (or your attorney) from initiating communications directly with, or responding to any inquiry from, or providing testimony before, the Securities and Exchange Commission, the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority, the National Labor Relations Board, the Equal Employment Opportunity Commission, or any self-regulatory organization or governmental authority charged with the enforcement of any laws.
(b)
Assignment of Inventions. You acknowledge and agree that all inventions and all worldwide intellectual property rights that you make, conceive or first reduce to practice (alone or in conjunction with others) during your employment with WFC are owned by WFC that (1) relate at the time of conception or reduction to practice of the invention to WFC’s business, or actual or demonstrably anticipated research or development of WFC whether or not you made, conceived or first reduced the inventions to practice during normal working hours; and (2) involve the use of any time, material, information, or facility of WFC.




(c)
Non-solicitation. If you are currently subject to a TSA, you shall continue to be bound by the terms of the TSA. If you are not currently subject to a TSA, you agree to the following:
For a period of one year immediately following termination of your employment for any reason, you will not do any of the following, either directly or indirectly or through associates, agents, or employees:
i.
solicit, recruit  or promote the solicitation or recruitment of any employee or consultant of WFC for the purpose of encouraging that employee or consultant to leave WFC’s employ or sever an agreement for services; or  
ii.
to the fullest extent enforceable under the applicable state law, solicit, participate in or promote the solicitation of any of WFC’s clients, customers, or prospective customers with whom you had Material Contact and/or regarding whom you received Confidential Information, for the purpose of providing products or services that are in competition with WFC’s products or services. "Material Contact" means interaction between you and the customer, client or prospective customer within one (1) year prior to your last day as a team member which takes place to manage, service or further the business relationship.
The one-year limitation is not intended to limit WFC’s right to prevent misappropriation of its Confidential Information beyond the one-year period.
(d)
Violation of TSA or Restrictive Covenants. If you breach any of the terms of a TSA and/or the restrictive covenants above, all unvested Restricted Share Rights shall be immediately and irrevocably forfeited. For any Restricted Share Rights that vested within one (1) year prior to the termination of your employment with WFC or at any time after your termination, you shall be required to repay or otherwise reimburse WFC an amount having a value equal to the aggregate fair market value (determined as of the date of vesting) of such vested shares. This paragraph does not constitute the Company’s exclusive remedy for violation of your restrictive covenant obligations, and WFC may seek any additional legal or equitable remedy, including injunctive relief, for any such violation.
10.
No Employment Agreement. Neither the award to you of the Restricted Share Rights nor the delivery to you of this Award Agreement or any other document relating to the Restricted Share Rights will confer on you the right to continued employment with the Company or any Affiliate. You understand that your employment with the Company or any Affiliate is “at will” and nothing in this document changes, alters or modifies your “at will” status or your obligation to comply with all policies, procedures and rules of the Company, as they may be adopted or amended from time to time.
11.
Section 409A . This Award is intended to [comply with the requirements of][be exempt from] Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, and the applicable Treasury Regulations or other binding guidance thereunder (“Section 409A”). Accordingly, all provisions included in this Award Agreement, or incorporated by reference, will be interpreted and administered in accordance with that intent. [Therefore, all Restricted Share Rights will be settled and distributed no later than March 1 of the year following the year when such Restricted Share Rights vest.] If any provision of the Plan or this Award Agreement would otherwise conflict with or frustrate this intent, that provision will be interpreted and deemed amended or limited so as to avoid the conflict; provided, however, that the Company makes no representation that the Award is exempt from or complies with Section 409A and makes no undertaking to preclude Section 409A from applying to the Award. The Company will have no liability to you or to any other party if the Award or payment of the Award that is intended to be [compliant with][exempt from] Section 409A is not so [compliant][exempt] or for any action taken by the Committee with respect thereto.
12.
[Six-month Delay . Notwithstanding any provision of the Plan or this Award Agreement to the contrary, if, upon your Separation from Service for any reason, the Company determines that you are a “Specified Employee” as defined in Section 409A and in accordance with the definition set forth on Exhibit A to this Award Agreement, which definition is incorporated by reference herein, your Restricted Share Rights, if subject to settlement upon your Separation from Service and if required pursuant to Section 409A, will not settle before the date that is the first business day following the six-month anniversary of such Separation from Service, or, if earlier, upon your death.]
13.
Stock Ownership Provision. In accordance with the terms of the Company’s stock ownership policy, as may be amended from time to time: (a) if you are an Executive Officer of the Company or a member of its Operating




Committee, as a condition to receiving this Award, you agree to hold, while employed by the Company or any Affiliate and for a period of one year after your Retirement, a number of shares of Common Stock equal to at least 50% of the after-tax shares of Common Stock (assuming a 50% tax rate) acquired upon vesting and settlement of Company stock-based awards or pursuant to the exercise of Company stock options (if applicable), subject to a maximum holding requirement of shares with a value equal to ten (10) times your cash salary; and (b) if you are not an Executive Officer or member of the Operating Committee, you are expected to hold that number of shares while employed by the Company or any Affiliate.
14.
Severability and Judicial Modification. If any provision of this Award Agreement is held to be invalid or unenforceable under pertinent state law or otherwise or Wells Fargo elects not to enforce such restriction, including but not limited to paragraph 9(c)ii, the remaining provisions shall remain in full force and effect and the invalid or unenforceable provision shall be modified only to the extent necessary to render that provision valid and enforceable to the fullest extent permitted by law.  If the invalid or unenforceable provision cannot be, or is not, modified, that provision shall be severed from this Award Agreement and all other provisions shall remain valid and enforceable.
15.
Additional Provisions. This Award Agreement is subject to the provisions of the Plan. Capitalized terms not defined in this Award Agreement are used as defined in the Plan. If the Plan and this Award Agreement are inconsistent, the provisions of the Plan will govern. Interpretations of the Plan and this Award Agreement by the Committee are binding on you and the Company.
16.
Applicable Law. This Award Agreement and the award of Restricted Share Rights evidenced hereby will be governed by, and construed in accordance with the laws of the state of Delaware (without regard to its choice-of-law provisions), except to the extent Federal law would apply.
17.
Imposition of Other Requirements. The Company reserves the right to impose other requirements on your participation in the Plan, on the Award and on any shares of Common Stock acquired under the Plan, to the extent the Company determines it is necessary or advisable in order to comply with applicable law or facilitate the administration of the Plan and provided the imposition of the term or condition will not result in adverse accounting expense to the Company, and to require you to sign any additional agreements or undertakings that may be necessary to accomplish the foregoing.
18.
Electronic Delivery and Acceptance. The Company is electronically delivering documents related to current or future participation in the Plan and is requesting your consent to participate in the Plan by electronic means. You hereby consent to receive such documents by electronic delivery and agree to participate in the Plan through the current plan administrator’s on-line system, or any other on-line system or electronic means that the Company may decide, in its sole discretion, to use in the future.
19.
Entire Agreement. The Plan is incorporated herein by reference. The Plan and this Award Agreement (including Exhibit A attached hereto) constitute the entire agreement of the parties with respect to the Award and supersede in their entirety all prior proposals, undertakings and agreements, written or oral, and all other communications between you and the Company with respect to the Award.
[Insert requirement to acknowledge and accept grant terms]





Exhibit A
Certain Definitions
[Separation from Service

A Participant’s “Separation from Service” occurs upon his or her death, retirement or other termination of employment or other event that qualifies as a “separation from service” under Internal Revenue Code Section 409A and the applicable regulations thereunder as in effect from time to time. The Company shall determine in each case when a Participant’s Separation from Service has occurred, which determination shall be made in a manner consistent with Treasury Regulation Section 1.409A-1(h). The Company shall determine that a Separation from Service has occurred as of a certain date when the facts and circumstances indicate that the Company (or an Affiliate, if applicable) and the Participant reasonably anticipate that, after that date, the Participant will render no further services, or the Participant’s level of bona fide services (either as an employee or independent contractor) will permanently decrease to a level that is 20% or less than the average level of the Participant’s bona fide services (either as an employee or independent contractor) previously in effect for such Participant over the immediately preceding 36-month period (or the Participant’s entire period of service, if the Participant has been providing services for less than 36 months).

The following presumptions shall also apply to all such determinations:

(1)
Transfers . A Separation from Service has not occurred upon the Participant’s transfer of employment from the Company to an Affiliate or vice versa, or from an Affiliate to another Affiliate.

(2)
Medical leave of absence . Where the Participant has a medical leave of absence due to any medically determinable physical or mental impairment that can be expected to result in death or can be expected to last for a continuous period of not less than six months, and he or she has not returned to employment with the Company or an Affiliate, a Separation from Service has occurred on the earlier of: (A) the first day on which the Participant would not be considered “disabled” under any disability policy of the Company or Affiliate under which the Participant is then receiving a benefit; or (B) the first day on which the Participant’s medical leave of absence period exceeds 29 months.

(3)
Military leave of absence . Where the Participant has a military leave of absence, and he or she has not returned to employment with the Company or an Affiliate, a Separation from Service has occurred on the day next following the last day on which the Participant is entitled to reemployment rights under USERRA.

(4)
Salary continuation leave . A Separation from Service has occurred on the first day of the Participant’s salary continuation leave taken under the Company’s Salary Continuation Pay Plan.

(5)
Other leaves of absence . In the event that the Participant is on a bona fide leave of absence, not otherwise described in this definition, from which he or she has not returned to employment with the Company or an Affiliate, the Participant’s Separation from Service has occurred on the first day on which the Participant’s leave of absence period exceeds six months or, if earlier, upon the Participant’s termination of employment (provided that such termination of employment constitutes a Separation from Service in accordance with the last sentence of the first paragraph of this definition).

(6)
Asset purchase transaction . If, in connection with the sale or other disposition of substantial assets (such as a division or substantially all assets of a trade or business) of the Company or an Affiliate to an unrelated buyer, the Participant becomes an employee of the buyer or an affiliate of the buyer upon the closing of or in connection with such transaction, a Separation from Service has not occurred if the Company and the buyer have specified that such transaction will not, with respect to any individual affected by such transaction who becomes an employee of the buyer or an affiliate, be considered a “separation from service” under Treasury Regulation Section 1.409A-1(h), and such specification meets the requirements of Treasury Regulation Section 1.409A-1(h)(4).]








[Specified Employee

A “Specified Employee” means:

(1)
Any Participant who is a “key employee” under Internal Revenue Code Section 416(i)(1)(A)(i), (ii) or (iii) (applied in accordance with the regulations thereunder and disregarding Internal Revenue Code Section 416(i)(5)) at any time during the 12-month period ending on the specified employee identification date. For purposes of determining “key employee” status under Internal Revenue Code Section 416(i)(1)(A)(i), except as required under such provision and the regulations thereunder, the term “officer” shall refer to an employee of the Company or an Affiliate with the title Senior Vice President or above, and

(2)
Any participant who served as a member of the Company’s Management Committee at any time during the 12-month period ending on the specified employee identification date.

For purposes of applying Internal Revenue Code section 409A, the “specified employee identification date” is each December 31. Any person described in (1) or (2) above on a specified employee identification date shall be treated as a Specified Employee for the entire 12-month period beginning on the following April 1.

Notwithstanding the above, in the event of a corporate transaction to which the Company or an Affiliate is a party, the Company may, in its discretion, establish a method for determining Specified Employees pursuant to Treasury Regulation Section 1.409A-1(i)(6).]

Disability
You will be considered to have a “Disability” if you are (1) receiving income replacement benefits for a period of not less than three months under the Company’s or an Affiliate’s long-term disability plan as a result of any medically determinable physical or mental impairment that can be expected to result in death or can be expected to last for a continuous period of not less than 12 months; or (2) determined by the Social Security Administration to be eligible for social security disability benefits.

Cause
“Cause” means (1) the continued failure by you to substantially perform your duties; (2) your conviction of a crime involving dishonesty or breach of trust, conviction of a felony, or commission of any act that makes you ineligible for coverage under Wells Fargo's fidelity bond or otherwise makes you ineligible for continued employment; or (3) your violation of the Company’s policies, including but not limited to Wells Fargo’s Code of Ethics and Business Conduct (or the Code applicable to your line of business), Anti-Bribery and Corruption Policy, Information Security Policies, and Risk Management Accountability Policy. For the avoidance of doubt, an event or conduct constituting Cause could take place before or after your termination of employment.

Change in Control
“Change in Control” means a change in the ownership or effective control of the Company or the Affiliate that employs you, or in the ownership of a substantial portion of the assets of the Company or the Affiliate that employs you within the meaning of Treas. Reg. section 1.409A-3(i)(5) as determined by the Company.



End of Form of Restricted Share Rights Award Agreement
For Grants on or after February 28, 2017






Exhibit 10(b)



WFCLOGO.JPG WELLS FARGO BONUS PLAN





































The Plan is amended and restated effective January 1, 2017 and supersedes the Wells Fargo Bonus Plan originally effective January 1, 2000, subsequently clarified effective January 1, 2004 and January 1, 2006, amended and restated effective January 1, 2008, amended effective January 1, 2009, amended effective January 1, 2010, amended effective January 1, 2011, and amended effective January 1, 2015. Participants, incentive opportunities and Performance Measures shall be identified annually.

Page 1 of 9 pages



PURPOSE OF THE PLAN

The purpose of the Wells Fargo Bonus Plan (the “Plan”) is to motivate a select group of management, supervisory and individual contributors to achieve superior results for Wells Fargo & Company and its subsidiaries (“Wells Fargo”). The Plan is a discretionary incentive plan designed to provide Participants with incentive compensation opportunities that focus on individual accountability for appropriate risk management and full compliance with applicable laws and regulations, as well as individual and team contributions through the measurement of meaningful performance objectives that are consistent with Wells Fargo’s corporate and business unit objectives.

The determination and payment of any incentive Award under the Plan is subject to the conditions and restrictions imposed under any applicable law, rules and regulations. A Participant’s rights to or receipt of compensation under the Plan may be limited, modified, cancelled or recovered to ensure compliance with all such applicable laws, rules, regulations and guidance that may be issued from time to time. In addition, the Plan Administrator and/or Wells Fargo (subject to the authority of the Human Resources Committee of Wells Fargo & Company’s Board of Directors (the “HRC”)) has full discretionary authority to adjust or amend a Participant’s incentive opportunity or recommended payout under the Plan at any time.

This document is comprised of four sections:

1.
Plan Eligibility
2.
Incentive Components
3.
Plan Administration
4.
Appendix A

For questions related to this document, policies or the administration of the Plan, please contact your Human Resources representative.

    
PLAN ELIGIBILITY

A.      Plan Eligibility

Wells Fargo management, supervisors, individual contributors and other groups of team members who are in a position to control or influence business results are eligible to participate in the Plan (“Participants”). Business unit managers, in consultation with their Human Resources partners, are responsible for identifying Participants within their business units who are eligible to participate in the Plan.

A Participant must have actively worked for at least three calendar months in an incentive-eligible position during the Plan Year. In addition, the Participant’s performance must have contributed towards the achievement of some or all of the Participant’s Performance Objectives. To be counted as "months worked," the Participant must be in an incentive-eligible job on or before the 15th of the month.

A Plan Participant must be employed by Wells Fargo as of the Award payment date in order to be eligible to be considered for a discretionary Award under the Plan, unless otherwise noted

Page 2 of 9 pages



below. Exceptions may be made if the termination is a result of the Participant’s retirement, death, corporate transactions, or a qualifying event under the Wells Fargo & Company Salary Continuation Pay Plan as set forth in the leave of absence or death or retirement policies in the Plan Administration section.

B.
Plan Funding

A determination by the HRC that a bonus pool will be funded and Award payouts will occur under the Plan based on its evaluation of Wells Fargo’s performance.

C.      Award Qualifiers.

In furtherance of the purpose of this Plan and consistent with the expectations of Participants in their day-to-day job duties, to be considered for a discretionary incentive under this Plan, the Participant is expected to meet the following Award Qualifiers:

1.
A Participant is expected to meet the following objectives related to Risk and Compliance:

a.
Effectively manage all risk associated with their position as set forth in Wells Fargo’s Risk Management Accountability Policy (located in Wells Fargo’s Team Member Handbook ) and other policies and procedures applicable to the Participant in the Participant’s role, including, but not limited to, credit, market, financial crimes, compliance, conduct, reputational and operational risks, as applicable; 1

b.
Fulfill all risk management and compliance requirements (including, but not limited to, training requirements) that accompany Participant’s responsibilities; 2 and

c.
Operate in compliance with all applicable laws, regulations, policies and procedures applicable to Participant’s position and job responsibilities. 3

2.
A Participant is expected to comply with Wells Fargo’s other employment policies and procedures including, but not limited to, the Code of Ethics and Business Conduct and the Information Security Policy (located on Teamworks ).

Failure to meet all Award Qualifiers may result in a downward adjustment to, or elimination of, an Award opportunity as determined by the Plan Administrator, regardless of meeting individual Performance Objectives. In addition, a Participant’s Award opportunity under the Plan may be adjusted or denied if the team member has been on or received a formal warning
1 If a Participant has a question about the policies and procedures applicable to his/her role, the Participant should promptly contact his/her manager or Human Resources representative to understand where the Participant can find his/her group’s policies and procedures.
2 See footnote 1 above.
3 See footnote 1 above.

Page 3 of 9 pages



or been on final notice of corrective action during the Plan Year. Additional performance adjustment and/or forfeitures may be made to any deferred awards for a Participant.

Business unit managers should work with their Human Resources representative to identify any other Disqualifying Factors that may impact a Participant’s eligibility under the Plan.


INCENTIVE COMPONENTS

Awards under the Plan are made in the sole and absolute discretion of Wells Fargo and the Plan Administrator, with recommendations from business unit managers and approvals from senior management. There is no guarantee that an incentive of any amount will be awarded to any Participant. To the extent an incentive may be payable, incentive recommendations should be consistent with the following guidelines:

A.
Incentive Opportunity Range

The Incentive Opportunity Range is the range of possible payout amounts that may be made without the approval of the Head of Wells Fargo Enterprise HR Consulting and the Operating Committee Member for the Participant’s line of business, or the Plan Administrator, as described below. Target award amounts are predefined by role, taking into consideration applicable regulatory and business practices. The Incentive Opportunity Range is generally up to 150% of the target award amount (the “Top of Range”). The threshold amount of an award is 50% of target; however, a Participant’s business unit manager may exercise discretion to pay below threshold. The range and threshold amounts do not guarantee an award in any amount or that any award will be made.

B.
Award Determination and Payout
The Performance Objective ratings are evaluated to determine the final incentive recommendation, subject to the Award Qualifiers and other terms of the Plan.

Performance shall be evaluated as soon as practicable following completion of the Plan Year by the Participant’s business unit manager and/or any other manager responsible for reviewing incentive recommendations in the Participant’s business unit. Lines of business are allocated incentive compensation pools used as guidelines to determine the appropriate amount of aggregate incentive compensation that should be paid at the business level. Establishment of the pool is not a guarantee that Awards will be paid to Participants nor does it guarantee the amount of any Award payable to Participants. Since Awards under the Plan are discretionary, lines of business may pay out all or a portion of their allocated pools, subject to the terms and conditions of the Plan.

All Awards under the Plan are subject to the following guidelines:

Performance related to each Performance Objective is evaluated following the end of the Plan Year. Provided the Award Qualifiers and other terms of the Plan have been met, the Participant’s manager evaluates the Participant’s performance and provides an incentive recommendation. The incentive recommendation should be within the Incentive Opportunity Range identified for the Participant’s position, unless further approvals are received as described below.

Page 4 of 9 pages



 
Incentive Awards will be paid no later than March 15th of the calendar year following the end of the Plan Year.

Awards may be paid in the form of short-term cash or long-term awards (cash or equity), or a combination thereof, in the HRC’s discretion and may be adjusted to match the time horizon of risk outcomes. To the extent the HRC directs the Company to pay all or a portion of an award in the form of an equity-based award under the Wells Fargo & Company Long-Term Incentive Compensation Plan (the “LTICP”), the equity-based award will in all cases be conditioned upon and subject to the approval of the HRC and be subject to such terms and conditions as approved by the HRC in accordance with the provisions of the LTICP and reflected in the applicable award agreement. To the extent all or a portion of an Award will be paid in long-term cash, the long-term cash award will be made under the terms of the Wells Fargo & Company Long-Term Cash Award Plan (the “LTCAP”). The terms of awards under the LTCAP will be reflected in the applicable award agreement.

All Awards under the Plan are subject to the following approval requirements:

Operating Committee Members who head a line of business must approve the aggregate value of Incentive Awards for that business. Without limiting the discretion of Wells Fargo or the Plan Administrator, a Participant’s incentive recommendation may be increased by up to 15% over the Top of Range (i.e., generally up to 172.5% of target), on a discretionary basis by the Participant’s business unit manager, subject to the Participant’s Incentive Award being approved by the Operating Committee Member for the Participant’s line of business and the Head of Wells Fargo Enterprise HR Consulting. In no event may an award exceed 15% over the Top of Range unless approved by the Plan Administrator. Notwithstanding the foregoing, Awards to Operating Committee Members are subject to the approval of the HRC.

PLAN ADMINISTRATION

A.
Plan Administrator

The Plan Administrator is the Director of Human Resources of Wells Fargo & Company. The Plan Administrator has full discretionary authority to administer and interpret the Plan and may, at any time, delegate to personnel of Wells Fargo such responsibilities as he or she considers appropriate to facilitate the day-to-day administration of the Plan. The Plan Administrator also has the full discretionary authority to adjust or amend a Participant’s incentive opportunity or recommended Award under the Plan at any time subject to the authority of the HRC to adjust Awards as described herein.

Plan commitments or interpretations (oral or written) by anyone other than the Plan Administrator or one of his/her delegates are invalid and will have no force or effect upon the policies and procedures set forth in this Plan.


Page 5 of 9 pages



B.
Plan Year

Participant performance is measured and financial records are kept on a “Plan Year” basis. The Plan Year is the 12-month period beginning each January 1 and ending on the following December 31, unless the Plan is modified, suspended or terminated.

C.
Disputes

If a Participant has a dispute regarding his/her incentive Award under the Plan, the Participant should attempt to resolve the dispute with the manager of his/her business unit. If this is not successful, the Participant should prepare a written request for review addressed to a Human Resources representative. The request for review should include any facts supporting the Participant’s request as well as any issues or comments the Participant deems pertinent. The Human Resources representative will send the Participant a written response documenting the outcome of this review in writing no later than 60 days following the date of the Participant’s written request. (If additional time is necessary, the Participant shall be notified in writing.) The determination of this request shall be final and conclusive upon all persons.

D.
Amendment or Termination

The Board of Directors of Wells Fargo & Company or the HRC may amend, suspend or terminate the Plan or any incentive opportunity or Award recommendation at any time, for any reason; the Company’s President, any Vice Chairman, the Chief Administrative Officer, the Director of Human Resources may amend, suspend or terminate any incentive opportunity or Award recommendation, other than those related to executive officers of Wells Fargo & Company, at any time, for any reason. Action taken on behalf of the Company may be taken by the Chairman, President, Chief Administrative Officer, Director of Human Resources, Head of Wells Fargo Enterprise HR Consulting or Director of Compensation and Benefits.

E.
Leaves of Absence

Incentive recommendations under the Plan may be pro-rated for Participants who go on a leave of absence provided the terms and conditions of the Plan have been satisfied, the Participant actively worked at least three months during the Plan Year and the Participant’s performance contributed towards the achievement of some or all of the Participant’s Performance Objectives. (See Section K: Pro-Rata Incentive Recommendations below.) If a Participant’s performance during the Plan Year contributed towards the achievement of all of the Participant’s Performance Objectives, the Participant’s incentive recommendation should be evaluated as if the Participant had not gone on leave. Business units should apply these criteria consistently to all Participants.

F.
Changes in Employment Status

1.
Employees (i) hired or (ii) transferred to a position that is bonus-eligible following a promotion from a non-bonus-eligible position, after the beginning of the Plan Year may be eligible to participate in the Plan, provided they meet all other Participant requirements as described in the Plan. Performance Objectives should be designed accordingly. To be eligible for any Award under the Plan, a Participant must have assigned Performance Objectives and an evaluation of performance on these objectives completed by the manager. Awards may be

Page 6 of 9 pages



pro-rated based on the number of calendar months the Participant participates in the Plan during the Plan Year. (See Section K: Pro-Rata Incentive Recommendations below.)

2.
If, during the Plan Year, a Participant transfers to another business unit or receives a promotion to a new incentive-eligible position within Wells Fargo, the former and latter business unit managers should work together to determine whether the Participant met some or all of the Performance Objectives prior to the transfer or promotion and the terms and conditions of the Plan have been satisfied. Awards, if any, will be determined following the end of the Plan Year on the same schedule as other Awards under the Plan.

3.
If during the Plan Year, a Participant transfers between two bonus eligible positions, managers should consider the Award opportunity for each position and the time in those positions when determining the year-end Award.
 
G.
Retirement, Displacement, Death or Corporate Transaction

In the event of a Participant’s death or retirement during the Plan Year, a Participant may be considered for a pro-rated incentive award provided the Participant actively worked for at least three months during the Plan Year, met some or all of the Participant’s Performance Objectives, and the terms and conditions of the Plan have been satisfied. See Section K: Pro-Rata Incentive Recommendations below.

Participants who receive notice of a qualifying event under the Wells Fargo & Company Salary Continuation Pay Plan and whose positions are eliminated before the end of the Plan Year, may be considered for a pro-rata Award provided the Participant’s performance during the Plan Year contributed towards the achievement of some or all of the Participant’s Performance Objectives. (See Section K: Pro-Rata Incentive Recommendations below.) The Notice Period (as defined by that plan) should be considered in determining whether the Participant satisfies the three-month “actively at work” requirement and should also be considered when determining the pro-ration of the award. Award recommendations will be determined following the end of the Plan Year and are subject to the other terms and conditions of the Plan.

In the event of an involuntary termination due to a corporate transaction prior to the payment date a Participant may be considered for a pro-rata incentive award provided the Participant actively worked for at least three months during the Plan Year, met some or all of the Participant’s Performance Objectives, and the terms and conditions of the Plan have been satisfied. (See Section K: Pro-Rata Incentive Recommendations below.)

H.
Withholding Taxes

Wells Fargo shall deduct from all payments under the Plan an amount necessary to satisfy federal, state or local tax withholding requirements.
    
I.
Not an Employment Contract

The Plan is not an employment contract and participation in the Plan does not alter a Participant’s at-will employment relationship with Wells Fargo. Both the Participant and Wells Fargo are free to terminate their employment relationship at any time for any reason. No rights in the Plan may

Page 7 of 9 pages



be claimed by any person whether or not he/she is selected to participate in the Plan. No person shall acquire any right to an accounting or to examine the books or the affairs of Wells Fargo.

J.
Assignment

No Participant shall have any right or power to pledge or assign any rights, privileges, or incentive awards provided for under the Plan.

K.
Pro-Rata Incentive Awards

Incentive recommendations for pro-rata awards described in this Plan are determined based on the number of calendar months the Participant worked during the Plan Year. For purposes of this calculation, Participants who work through the 15 th of a calendar month will receive credit for the entire month.

L.
Code of Conduct

Violation of the terms or the spirit of the Plan and/or Wells Fargo’s Code of Ethics and Business Conduct by the Participant and/or the Participant’s supervisor, or other serious misconduct (including, but not limited to, gaming which is more fully discussed below), are grounds for disciplinary action, including disqualification from further participation in the Plan (including awards payable under the terms of the Plan) and/or immediate termination of employment.

Participants are expected to adhere to ethical and honest business practices. A Participant who violates the spirit of the Plan by “gaming” the system becomes immediately ineligible to participate in the Plan. “Gaming” is the manipulation and/or misrepresentation of sales or sales reporting in order to receive or attempt to receive compensation, or to meet or attempt to meet goals.

N. Internal Revenue Code Section 409A

To the extent that an award is paid in cash under the Plan, Wells Fargo intends such award to qualify as a short-term deferral exempt from the requirements of Internal Revenue Code Section 409A. In the event an award payable under the Plan does not qualify for treatment as an exempt short-term deferral, such amount will be paid in a manner that will satisfy the requirements of Internal Revenue Code Section 409A and applicable guidance thereunder.




Page 8 of 9 pages



APPENDIX A


CRD IV Identified Staff and AIFMD/UCITS Identified Staff Participants

If a Participant is CRD IV Identified Staff or AIFMD/UCITS Identified Staff, the Participant’s eligibility for an incentive will be governed by, and subject to, the terms and conditions of the Plan, and any other conditions and restrictions imposed under any applicable law, rules and regulations. The form of any incentive awarded under the Plan and payout terms and conditions will be governed by the Identified Staff Incentive Payout Structure, a document that supplements the Plan and only applies to incentive awards granted to CRDIV Identified Staff and AIFMD/UCITS Identified Staff Participants.

A.
Definitions

For purposes of this Appendix A, the following definitions shall apply:

1.
CRD IV means Directive 2013/36/EU of the European Parliament and the Council of 26 June 2013 on access to the activity of credit institutions and the prudential supervision of credit institutions and investment firms and amending Directive 2002/87/EC and repealing Directives 2006/48/EC and 2006/49/EC.

2.
AIFMD means Directive 2011/61/EU of the European Parliament and of the Council of 8 June 2011 on Alternative Investment Fund Managers and amending Directives 2003/41/EC and 2009/65/EC and Regulations (EC) No 1060/2009 and (EU) No 1095/2010.

3.
UCITS means Directive 2009/65/EC on the coordination of laws, regulations and administrative provisions relating to undertakings for collective investment in transferable securities and amending Directive 2014/91/EU.

4.
CRD IV Identified Staff means all Code Staff and any other Participants who have been classified as Identified Staff for the purposes of CRD IV.

5.
AIFMD/UCITS Identified Staff means all Participants who have been classified as Identified Staff for the purposes of AIFMD and/or UCITS.


Page 9 of 9 pages

Exhibit 10(c)

Amendment to Wells Fargo & Company Deferred Compensation Plan (“DCP”)

Section 2(P) of the DCP is amended effective July 1, 2017 to read in full as follows:

(P) Plan Administrator. “Plan Administrator” of the Plan is the Director of
Human Resources, the Director of Compensation and Benefits, and the Head of
Enterprise HR Consulting of the Company, each of whom, acting individually, may take action as the Plan Administrator.




Exhibit 10(d)


Amendment to Wells Fargo & Company Supplemental 401(k) Plan (“Supplemental 401(k)”)

The first sentence of Section 24 of the Supplemental 401(k) Plan is amended effective July 1, 2017 to read in full as follows:

For purposes of Section 3(16)(A) of the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 (“ERISA”), as amended, the Plan Administrator shall be the Director of Human Resources, the Director of Compensation and Benefits, and the Head of Enterprise HR Solutions of the Company, each of whom, acting individually, may take action as the Plan Administrator.




Exhibit 10(e)


Amendment to Wells Fargo & Company Supplemental Cash Balance Plan (the “SCB”)

The first sentence of Section 19 of the SCB is amended effective July 1, 2017 to read in full as follows:

For purposes of Section 3(16)(A) of the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 (“ERISA”), as amended, the Plan Administrator shall be the Director of Human Resources, the Director of Compensation and Benefits, and the Head of Enterprise HR Solutions of the Company, each of whom, acting individually, may take action as the Plan Administrator




Exhibit 10(f)


Amendment to Wachovia Corporation Savings Restoration Plan (“SRP”)

Section 2.1(jj) of the SRP is amended effective July 1, 2017 to read in full as follows:

“Plan Administrator” of the Plan is the Director of Human Resources, the Director of Compensation and Benefits, and the Head of Enterprise HR Consulting of the Company, each of whom, acting individually, may take action as the Plan Administrator.




Exhibit 10(g)


Form of stock award agreement for employees of Wachovia Corporation, including Jonathan Weiss

[Wachovia Corporation letterhead]

[Date]

[Addressee]
[Address]
[City], [State] [Zipcode]

Re: NOTIFICATION OF GRANT UNDER WACHOVIA CORPORATION'S AMENDED AND RESTATED
2003 STOCK INCENTIVE PLAN

Dear [Addressee]:

Wachovia Corporation (the “Corporation”) adopted the Amended and Restated 2003 Stock Incentive Plan (the “Plan”) to enable the Corporation to help attract and retain the services of key employees upon whose judgment, interest and special effort the successful conduct of the Corporation's business is largely dependent. To further this purpose, the Board of Directors of the Corporation has granted to you the following stock options and/or restricted shares relating to the Corporation’s common stock. The grant of the award(s) is subject in all respects to the terms and conditions of this letter, the Plan and the related Information Statement. The terms of the Plan and the Information Statement are expressly incorporated into this letter. To the extent this letter and the Plan conflict, the terms of the Plan control. Any capitalized terms not defined in this letter will have the meanings given to them in the Plan.

Non-qualified Stock Options

On [Date] you were granted a non-qualified stock option (“NQSO”) to purchase an aggregate of [Number of Options Granted] shares of the Corporation's common stock, at a price of $[Option Price] per share. Subject to the terms of the Plan and this letter, the shares under this option shall become exercisable [Description of Vesting Period and Pro Rated Amounts, if applicable] beginning one year from the date of grant and will remain so exercisable until [Option Expiration Date] on which date the NQSO hereby granted shall terminate, to the extent not previously exercised or forfeited.

Number of Options
Vesting Schedule
[Number of Options Granted]
[Description of Vesting Period and Pro Rated Amounts, if applicable].

Restricted Shares

On [Date] you were granted [Number of Restricted Shares Awarded] restricted shares (“Restricted Shares”) of the Corporation’s common stock. The Restricted Shares granted hereby may not be sold, transferred, pledged, assigned or otherwise alienated or hypothecated (the “Transfer Restrictions”) except in accordance with the following schedule or as otherwise may be provided in the Plan:

Number of Shares
Date Transfer Restrictions Lapse
[Number of Restricted Shares Granted]
[Description of Vesting Period and Pro Rated Amounts, if applicable. May also include Performance Goals to be satisfied as a condition precedent to vesting, if applicable].

Termination of Employment:

(1) Effect on Stock Options:

Unless the Committee determines otherwise, if your employment with the Corporation shall terminate by reason of death, Retirement, displacement (as interpreted under the Wachovia severance plan) or Disability, any of the shares under this
option that are unvested shall become immediately exercisable on the Date of Termination of Employment and will remain so until [Option Expiration Date] on which date the NQSO hereby granted shall terminate, to the extent not previously exercised or




Exhibit 10(g)


forfeited. Unless the Committee determines otherwise, if your employment with the Corporation shall terminate for any reason (including upon the 91st day of a personal, administrative, or educational leave of absence) other than Death, Retirement, displacement or Disability, (i) any then outstanding but unexercisable shares granted to you under this NQSO will be forfeited on the Date of Termination of Employment, and (ii) any then outstanding and exercisable shares granted under this option will be forfeited on the expiration date of such NQSO or three months after the Date of Termination of Employment, whichever period is shorter; provided, however, if such employment terminates due to involuntary termination by the Corporation, the Committee may, in its sole discretion, (i) waive the automatic forfeiture of any or all such NQSOs, (ii) retain the full term of the option award, and/or (iii) add such new restrictions to such NQSO as it deems appropriate.

(2) Effect On RSAs:

Unless the Committee determines otherwise, if your employment with the Corporation shall terminate because of death, Retirement, displacement (as interpreted under the Wachovia severance plan), or Disability, any remaining Transfer Restrictions applicable to the RSAs granted under this award shall automatically terminate and, these RSAs shall be free of restrictions and freely transferable. Unless the Committee determines otherwise, if your employment with the Corporation shall terminate for any reason (including upon the 91st day of a personal, administrative or educational leave of absence) other than death, Retirement, displacement or Disability, then any of the RSAs granted under this award subject to Transfer Restrictions on the date of such termination shall automatically be forfeited on the Date of Termination of Employment and returned to the Corporation; provided, however, if such employment terminates due to involuntary termination by the Corporation, the Committee may, in its sole discretion, waive the automatic forfeiture of any or all such RSAs and/or may add such new restrictions to such RSAs as it deems appropriate.

Please update your beneficiary designation online via your equity account at Wachovia Stock Option Services. If you have any questions concerning your grant, please contact Wachovia Stock Option Services at 1-877-386-4661.

Sincerely,

Ken Thompson

Enclosures

End of stock award agreement for employees of Wachovia Corporation







EXHIBIT 12(a)
WELLS FARGO & COMPANY AND SUBSIDIARIES
COMPUTATION OF RATIOS OF EARNINGS TO FIXED CHARGES
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
($ in millions)
 
2017

 
2016

 
2017

 
2016

Earnings including interest on deposits   (1):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
Income before income tax expense
 
$
8,073

 
8,222

 
$
15,678

 
16,303

  
Less: Net income from noncontrolling interests
 
38

 
15

 
129

 
67

  
Income before income tax expense and after noncontrolling interests
 
8,035

 
8,207

 
15,549

 
16,236

  
Fixed charges
 
2,335

 
1,517

 
4,366

 
2,925

  
 
 
10,370

 
9,724

 
$
19,915

 
19,161

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fixed charges (1):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
Interest expense
 
$
2,232

 
1,413

 
$
4,158

 
2,718

  
Estimated interest component of net rental expense
 
103

 
104

 
208

 
207

  
  
 
$
2,335

 
1,517

 
$
4,366

 
2,925

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Ratio of earnings to fixed charges (2)
 
4.44

 
6.41

 
4.56

 
6.55

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Earnings excluding interest on deposits:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
Income before income tax expense and after noncontrolling interests
 
$
8,035

 
8,207

 
$
15,549

 
16,236

  
Fixed charges
 
1,652

 
1,185

 
3,146

 
2,286

  
  
 
$
9,687

 
9,392

 
$
18,695

 
18,522

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fixed charges:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
Interest expense
 
$
2,232

 
1,413

 
$
4,158

 
2,718

  
Less: Interest on deposits
 
683

 
332

 
1,220

 
639

  
Estimated interest component of net rental expense
 
103

 
104

 
208

 
207

  
  
 
$
1,652

 
1,185

 
$
3,146

 
2,286

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Ratio of earnings to fixed charges (2)
 
5.86

 
7.93

 
5.94

 
8.10

 
 
(1)
As defined in Item 503(d) of Regulation S-K.
(2)
These computations are included herein in compliance with Securities and Exchange Commission regulations. However, management believes that fixed charge ratios are not meaningful measures for the business of the Company because of two factors. First, even if there was no change in net income, the ratios would decline with an increase in the proportion of income which is tax-exempt or, conversely, they would increase with a decrease in the proportion of income which is tax-exempt. Second, even if there was no change in net income, the ratios would decline if interest income and interest expense increase by the same amount due to an increase in the level of interest rates or, conversely, they would increase if interest income and interest expense decrease by the same amount due to a decrease in the level of interest rates.





 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
EXHIBIT 12(b)
WELLS FARGO & COMPANY AND SUBSIDIARIES
COMPUTATION OF RATIOS OF EARNINGS TO FIXED CHARGES
AND PREFERRED DIVIDENDS
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
Quarter ended June 30,
 
 
Six months ended June 30,
 
(in millions)
 
2017

 
2016

 
2017

 
2016

Earnings including interest on deposits   (1): 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
Income before income tax expense
 
$
8,073

 
8,222

 
$
15,678

 
16,303

  
Less: Net income from noncontrolling interests
 
38

 
15

 
129

 
67

  
Income before income tax expense and after noncontrolling interests
 
8,035

 
8,207

 
15,549

 
16,236

  
Fixed charges
 
2,335

 
1,517

 
4,366

 
2,925

  
 
 
10,370

 
9,724

 
19,915

 
19,161

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Preferred dividend requirement
 
$
406

 
386

 
$
807

 
764

Tax factor (based on effective tax rate)    
 
1.38

 
1.48

 
1.38

 
1.47

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Preferred dividends (2)
 
$
561

 
570

 
$
1,114

 
1,126

Fixed charges (1):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
Interest expense
 
2,232

 
1,413

 
4,158

 
2,718

  
Estimated interest component of net rental expense
 
103

 
104

 
208

 
207

  
  
 
2,335

 
1,517

 
4,366

 
2,925

  
Fixed charges and preferred dividends
 
$
2,896

 
2,087

 
$
5,480

 
4,051

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Ratio of earnings to fixed charges and preferred dividends (3)
 
3.58

 
4.66

 
3.63

 
4.73

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Earnings excluding interest on deposits:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
Income before income tax expense and after noncontrolling interests
 
$
8,035

 
8,207

 
$
15,549

 
16,236

  
Fixed charges
 
1,652

 
1,185

 
3,146

 
2,286

  
  
 
9,687

 
9,392

 
18,695

 
18,522

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Preferred dividends (2)
 
561

 
570

 
1,114

 
1,126

Fixed charges:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
Interest expense
 
2,232

 
1,413

 
4,158

 
2,718

  
Less: Interest on deposits
 
683

 
332

 
1,220

 
639

  
Estimated interest component of net rental expense
 
103

 
104

 
208

 
207

  
  
 
1,652

 
1,185

 
3,146

 
2,286

  
Fixed charges and preferred dividends
 
$
2,213

 
1,755

 
$
4,260

 
3,412

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Ratio of earnings to fixed charges and preferred dividends (3)
 
4.38

 
5.35

 
4.39

 
5.43

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(1)
As defined in Item 503(d) of Regulation S-K.
(2)
The preferred dividends were increased to amounts representing the pretax earnings that would be required to cover such dividend requirements.
(3)
These computations are included herein in compliance with Securities and Exchange Commission regulations. However, management believes that fixed charge ratios are not meaningful measures for the business of the Company because of two factors. First, even if there was no change in net income, the ratios would decline with an increase in the proportion of income which is tax-exempt or, conversely, they would increase with a decrease in the proportion of income which is tax-exempt. Second, even if there was no change in net income, the ratios would decline if interest income and interest expense increase by the same amount due to an increase in the level of interest rates or, conversely, they would increase if interest income and interest expense decrease by the same amount due to a decrease in the level of interest rates.


263


Exhibit 31(a)
 
CERTIFICATION
 
I, Timothy J. Sloan, certify that:
 
1.        I have reviewed this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2017 , of Wells Fargo & Company;
2.        Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;
3.        Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;
4.        The registrant’s other certifying officer(s) and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have:
(a) 
Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;
(b)  
Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;
(c) 
Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and
(d)  
Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and
5.        The registrant’s other certifying officer(s) and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the registrant’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):
(a) 
All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and
(b) 
Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting.
 
Date: August 4, 2017
/s/ TIMOTHY J. SLOAN        
Timothy J. Sloan
Chief Executive Officer





Exhibit 31(b)
 
CERTIFICATION
 
I, John R. Shrewsberry, certify that:
 
1.        I have reviewed this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2017 , of Wells Fargo & Company;
2.        Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;
3.        Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;
4.        The registrant’s other certifying officer(s) and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have:
(a) 
Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;
(b)  
Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;  
(c) 
Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and
(d)  
Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and
5.        The registrant’s other certifying officer(s) and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the registrant’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):
(a) 
All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and
(b) 
Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting.
 
Date: August 4, 2017
/s/ JOHN R. SHREWSBERRY               
John R. Shrewsberry
Chief Financial Officer





Exhibit 32(a)
 
 
Certifications Pursuant to
18 U.S.C. Section 1350,
As Adopted Pursuant to
Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002  
  
In connection with the Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q of Wells Fargo & Company (the “Company”) for the period ended June 30, 2017 , as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on the date hereof (the “Report”), I, Timothy J. Sloan, Chief Executive Officer of the Company, certify, pursuant to 18 U.S.C. §1350, as adopted pursuant to §906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, that:
 
(1)    
The Report fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934; and  
 
(2)    
The information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the Company.
 
 
 
 
/s/ TIMOTHY J. SLOAN        
Timothy J. Sloan
Chief Executive Officer
Wells Fargo & Company
August 4, 2017





Exhibit 32(b)
 
 
Certifications Pursuant to
18 U.S.C. Section 1350,
As Adopted Pursuant to
Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002
  
In connection with the Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q of Wells Fargo & Company (the “Company”) for the period ended June 30, 2017 , as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on the date hereof (the “Report”), I, John R. Shrewsberry, Chief Financial Officer of the Company, certify, pursuant to 18 U.S.C. §1350, as adopted pursuant to §906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, that:
 
(1)    
The Report fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934; and  
 
(2)    
The information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the Company.
 
 
 
 
/s/ JOHN R. SHREWSBERRY                 
John R. Shrewsberry
Chief Financial Officer
Wells Fargo & Company
August 4, 2017